Implement "set cwd" command on GDB
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @end table
1041
1042 @node Mode Options
1043 @subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048 @table @code
1049 @anchor{-nx}
1050 @item -nx
1051 @itemx -n
1052 @cindex @code{--nx}
1053 @cindex @code{-n}
1054 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057 @table @code
1058 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059 This is the system-wide init file.
1060 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063 have been processed.
1064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065 This is the init file in your home directory.
1066 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067 command options have been processed.
1068 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069 This is the init file in the current directory.
1070 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073 @end table
1074
1075 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076 For documentation on how to write command files,
1077 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079 @anchor{-nh}
1080 @item -nh
1081 @cindex @code{--nh}
1082 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083 in your home directory.
1084 @xref{Startup}.
1085
1086 @item -quiet
1087 @itemx -silent
1088 @itemx -q
1089 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1090 @cindex @code{--silent}
1091 @cindex @code{-q}
1092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095 @item -batch
1096 @cindex @code{--batch}
1097 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107 make this more useful, the message
1108
1109 @smallexample
1110 Program exited normally.
1111 @end smallexample
1112
1113 @noindent
1114 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116 mode.
1117
1118 @item -batch-silent
1119 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123 for an interactive session.
1124
1125 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126 messages, for example.
1127
1128 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131 @item -return-child-result
1132 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137 @item
1138 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141 @item
1142 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143 @item
1144 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145 the exit code will be -1.
1146 @end itemize
1147
1148 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150 interface.
1151
1152 @item -nowindows
1153 @itemx -nw
1154 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155 @cindex @code{-nw}
1156 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160 @item -windows
1161 @itemx -w
1162 @cindex @code{--windows}
1163 @cindex @code{-w}
1164 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165 used if possible.
1166
1167 @item -cd @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--cd}
1169 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170 instead of the current directory.
1171
1172 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175 @cindex @code{-D}
1176 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180 @item -fullname
1181 @itemx -f
1182 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1183 @cindex @code{-f}
1184 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192 frame.
1193
1194 @item -annotate @var{level}
1195 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1196 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208 @item --args
1209 @cindex @code{--args}
1210 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212 This option stops option processing.
1213
1214 @item -baud @var{bps}
1215 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1216 @cindex @code{--baud}
1217 @cindex @code{-b}
1218 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -l @var{timeout}
1222 @cindex @code{-l}
1223 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224 for remote debugging.
1225
1226 @item -tty @var{device}
1227 @itemx -t @var{device}
1228 @cindex @code{--tty}
1229 @cindex @code{-t}
1230 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234 @item -tui
1235 @cindex @code{--tui}
1236 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257 @item -write
1258 @cindex @code{--write}
1259 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261 (@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263 @item -statistics
1264 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268 @item -version
1269 @cindex @code{--version}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273 @item -configuration
1274 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279 @end table
1280
1281 @node Startup
1282 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287 @enumerate
1288 @item
1289 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292 @item
1293 @cindex init file
1294 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 that file.
1298
1299 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300 @item
1301 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 that file.
1305
1306 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307 @item
1308 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312 gets loaded.
1313
1314 @item
1315 Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318 @item
1319 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322 This is only done if the current directory is
1323 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326 @value{GDBN}.
1327
1328 @item
1329 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335 you must do something like the following:
1336
1337 @smallexample
1338 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 @end smallexample
1340
1341 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342 off too late.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349 @item
1350 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 @end enumerate
1354
1355 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365 @cindex init file name
1366 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376 @node Quitting GDB
1377 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @itemx q
1386 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390 error code.
1391 @end table
1392
1393 @cindex interrupt
1394 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398 until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404 @node Shell Commands
1405 @section Shell Commands
1406
1407 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409 just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411 @table @code
1412 @kindex shell
1413 @kindex !
1414 @cindex shell escape
1415 @item shell @var{command-string}
1416 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1417 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 @end table
1423
1424 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426 @value{GDBN}:
1427
1428 @table @code
1429 @kindex make
1430 @cindex calling make
1431 @item make @var{make-args}
1432 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Logging Output
1437 @section Logging Output
1438 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444 @table @code
1445 @kindex set logging
1446 @item set logging on
1447 Enable logging.
1448 @item set logging off
1449 Disable logging.
1450 @cindex logging file name
1451 @item set logging file @var{file}
1452 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459 @kindex show logging
1460 @item show logging
1461 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462 @end table
1463
1464 @node Commands
1465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473 @menu
1474 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475 * Completion:: Command completion
1476 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @end menu
1478
1479 @node Command Syntax
1480 @section Command Syntax
1481
1482 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489 @cindex abbreviation
1490 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498 @cindex repeating commands
1499 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518 @cindex comment
1519 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521 Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523 @cindex repeating command sequences
1524 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528 for editing.
1529
1530 @node Completion
1531 @section Command Completion
1532
1533 @cindex completion
1534 @cindex word completion
1535 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543 enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 @noindent
1562 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577 example:
1578
1579 @smallexample
1580 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583 make_abs_section make_function_type
1584 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 command.
1594
1595 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607 main
1608 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 @noindent
1614 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616 @table @code
1617 @kindex set max-completions
1618 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626 completion slow.
1627 @kindex show max-completions
1628 @item show max-completions
1629 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630 during completion.
1631 @end table
1632
1633 @cindex quotes in commands
1634 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1635 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639 @value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1642 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1643 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1644 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1645 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1646 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1647 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1648 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1649 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1650 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1651 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1652
1653 @smallexample
1654 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1655 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1656 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1660 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1661 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1662 place:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1666 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1667 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1668 @end smallexample
1669
1670 @noindent
1671 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1672 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1673 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1674
1675 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1676 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1677 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1678 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1679
1680 @cindex completion of structure field names
1681 @cindex structure field name completion
1682 @cindex completion of union field names
1683 @cindex union field name completion
1684 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1685 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1686 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1687 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1688 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1689 left-hand-side:
1690
1691 @smallexample
1692 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1693 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1694 to_data to_isatty to_write
1695 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1696 to_flush to_read
1697 @end smallexample
1698
1699 @noindent
1700 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1701 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1702 follows:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 struct ui_file
1706 @{
1707 int *magic;
1708 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1709 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1710 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1711 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1712 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1713 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1714 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1715 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1716 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1717 void *to_data;
1718 @}
1719 @end smallexample
1720
1721
1722 @node Help
1723 @section Getting Help
1724 @cindex online documentation
1725 @kindex help
1726
1727 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1728 using the command @code{help}.
1729
1730 @table @code
1731 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1732 @item help
1733 @itemx h
1734 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1735 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 (@value{GDBP}) help
1739 List of classes of commands:
1740
1741 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1742 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1743 data -- Examining data
1744 files -- Specifying and examining files
1745 internals -- Maintenance commands
1746 obscure -- Obscure features
1747 running -- Running the program
1748 stack -- Examining the stack
1749 status -- Status inquiries
1750 support -- Support facilities
1751 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1752 stopping the program
1753 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1754
1755 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1756 commands in that class.
1757 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1758 documentation.
1759 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1760 (@value{GDBP})
1761 @end smallexample
1762 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1763
1764 @item help @var{class}
1765 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1766 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1767 help display for the class @code{status}:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1771 Status inquiries.
1772
1773 List of commands:
1774
1775 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1776 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1777 info -- Generic command for showing things
1778 about the program being debugged
1779 show -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the debugger
1781
1782 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1783 documentation.
1784 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1785 (@value{GDBP})
1786 @end smallexample
1787
1788 @item help @var{command}
1789 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1790 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1791
1792 @kindex apropos
1793 @item apropos @var{args}
1794 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1795 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1796 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1797
1798 @smallexample
1799 apropos alias
1800 @end smallexample
1801
1802 @noindent
1803 results in:
1804
1805 @smallexample
1806 @c @group
1807 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1808 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1809 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1810 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1811 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812 @c @end group
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @kindex complete
1816 @item complete @var{args}
1817 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1818 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1819 command you want completed. For example:
1820
1821 @smallexample
1822 complete i
1823 @end smallexample
1824
1825 @noindent results in:
1826
1827 @smallexample
1828 @group
1829 if
1830 ignore
1831 info
1832 inspect
1833 @end group
1834 @end smallexample
1835
1836 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1837 @end table
1838
1839 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1840 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1841 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1842 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1843 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1844 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1845 Index}.
1846
1847 @c @group
1848 @table @code
1849 @kindex info
1850 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1851 @item info
1852 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1853 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1854 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1855 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1856 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1857 @w{@code{help info}}.
1858
1859 @kindex set
1860 @item set
1861 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1862 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1863 @code{set prompt $}.
1864
1865 @kindex show
1866 @item show
1867 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1868 @value{GDBN} itself.
1869 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1870 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1871 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1872 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1873
1874 @kindex info set
1875 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1876 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1877 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1878 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1879 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1880 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1881 @end table
1882 @c @end group
1883
1884 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1885 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1886
1887 @table @code
1888 @kindex show version
1889 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1890 @item show version
1891 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1892 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1893 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1894 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1895 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1896 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1897 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1898 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1899 @value{GDBN}.
1900
1901 @kindex show copying
1902 @kindex info copying
1903 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1904 @item show copying
1905 @itemx info copying
1906 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1907
1908 @kindex show warranty
1909 @kindex info warranty
1910 @item show warranty
1911 @itemx info warranty
1912 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1913 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1914
1915 @kindex show configuration
1916 @item show configuration
1917 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1918 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1919 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1920 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1921 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1922 your report.
1923
1924 @end table
1925
1926 @node Running
1927 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1928
1929 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1930 debugging information when you compile it.
1931
1932 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1933 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1934 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1935 kill a child process.
1936
1937 @menu
1938 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1939 * Starting:: Starting your program
1940 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1941 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1942
1943 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1944 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1945 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1946 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1947
1948 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1949 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1950 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1951 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1952 @end menu
1953
1954 @node Compilation
1955 @section Compiling for Debugging
1956
1957 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1958 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1959 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1960 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1961 and addresses in the executable code.
1962
1963 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1964 the compiler.
1965
1966 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1967 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1968 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1969 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1970 executables containing debugging information.
1971
1972 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1973 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1974 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1975 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1976 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1977
1978 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1979 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1980 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1981
1982 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1983 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1984 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1985 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1986 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1987 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1988
1989 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1990 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1991 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1992
1993 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1994 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1995 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1996 format in @value{GDBN}.
1997
1998 @need 2000
1999 @node Starting
2000 @section Starting your Program
2001 @cindex starting
2002 @cindex running
2003
2004 @table @code
2005 @kindex run
2006 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2007 @item run
2008 @itemx r
2009 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2010 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2011 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2012 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2013 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2014
2015 @end table
2016
2017 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2018 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2019 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2020 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2021 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2022 message like this one:
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2026 Try "help target" or "continue".
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2031 first (@pxref{load}).
2032
2033 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2034 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2035 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2036 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2037 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2038 divided into four categories:
2039
2040 @table @asis
2041 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2042 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2043 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2044 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2045 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2046 the arguments.
2047 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2048 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2049 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2050 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2051 below for details).
2052
2053 @item The @emph{environment.}
2054 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2055 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2056 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2057 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2060 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2061 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2062 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2063 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2064
2065 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2066 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2067 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2068 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2069 set a different device for your program.
2070 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2071
2072 @cindex pipes
2073 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2074 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2075 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2076 wrong program.
2077 @end table
2078
2079 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2080 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2081 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2082 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2083 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2084
2085 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2086 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2087 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2088 your current breakpoints.
2089
2090 @table @code
2091 @kindex start
2092 @item start
2093 @cindex run to main procedure
2094 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2095 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2096 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2097 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2098 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2099 procedure, depending on the language used.
2100
2101 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2102 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2103 the @samp{run} command.
2104
2105 @cindex elaboration phase
2106 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2107 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2108 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2109 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2110 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2111 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2112 will remain to halt execution.
2113
2114 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2115 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2116 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2117 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2118 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2119
2120 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2121 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2122 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2123 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2124 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2125 use the @code{starti} command.
2126
2127 @kindex starti
2128 @item starti
2129 @cindex run to first instruction
2130 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2131 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2132 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2133 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2134 the start of the elaboration phase.
2135
2136 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2137 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2138 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2139 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2140 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2141 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2142 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2143 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2144 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2145 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2146 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2147 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2148
2149 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2150 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2151 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2152 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2153
2154 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2155 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2156 environment:
2157
2158 @smallexample
2159 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2160 (@value{GDBP}) run
2161 @end smallexample
2162
2163 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2164 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2165
2166 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2167 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2168 @item set startup-with-shell
2169 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2170 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2171 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2172 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2173 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2174 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2175 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2176 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2177 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2178 startup failures such as:
2179
2180 @smallexample
2181 (@value{GDBP}) run
2182 Starting program: ./a.out
2183 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2184 @end smallexample
2185
2186 @noindent
2187 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2188 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2189 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2190 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2191 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2192 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2193
2194 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2195 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2196 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2197 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2198 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2199 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2200
2201 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2202 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2203 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2204 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2205 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2206 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2207
2208 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2209 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2210 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2211
2212 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2213 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2214
2215 @smallexample
2216 (@value{GDBP}) run
2217 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2221 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2222
2223 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2224 @code{target native} command. For example,
2225
2226 @smallexample
2227 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2228 (@value{GDBP}) run
2229 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2230 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2231 (@value{GDBP}) run
2232 Starting program: ./a.out
2233 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2234 @end smallexample
2235
2236 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2237 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2238 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2239 disconnect.
2240
2241 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2242 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2243 proc}, @code{info os}.
2244
2245 @kindex set disable-randomization
2246 @item set disable-randomization
2247 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2248 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2249 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2250 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2251 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2252
2253 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2254 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2255
2256 @smallexample
2257 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 @item set disable-randomization off
2261 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2262 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2263 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2264 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2265 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2266 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2267
2268 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2269 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2270 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2271 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2272 a code at its expected addresses.
2273
2274 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2275 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2276 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2277 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2278 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2279 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2280 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2281 a randomly chosen address.
2282
2283 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2284 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2285 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2286 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2287 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2288
2289 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2290 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2291
2292 @item show disable-randomization
2293 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2294 the virtual address space of the started program.
2295
2296 @end table
2297
2298 @node Arguments
2299 @section Your Program's Arguments
2300
2301 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2302 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2303 @code{run} command.
2304 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2305 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2306 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2307 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2308 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2309
2310 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2311 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2312 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2313 the program, not by the shell.
2314
2315 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2316 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2317
2318 @table @code
2319 @kindex set args
2320 @item set args
2321 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2322 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2323 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2324 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2325 it again without arguments.
2326
2327 @kindex show args
2328 @item show args
2329 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @node Environment
2333 @section Your Program's Environment
2334
2335 @cindex environment (of your program)
2336 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2337 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2338 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2339 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2340 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2341 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2342 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2343
2344 @table @code
2345 @kindex path
2346 @item path @var{directory}
2347 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2348 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2349 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2350 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2351 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2352 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2353 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2354
2355 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2356 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2357 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2358 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2359 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2360 @var{directory} to the search path.
2361 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2362 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2363
2364 @kindex show paths
2365 @item show paths
2366 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2367 environment variable).
2368
2369 @kindex show environment
2370 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2371 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2372 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2373 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2374 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2375
2376 @kindex set environment
2377 @anchor{set environment}
2378 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2379 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2380 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2381 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2382 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2383 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2384 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2385 null value.
2386 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2387 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2388
2389 For example, this command:
2390
2391 @smallexample
2392 set env USER = foo
2393 @end smallexample
2394
2395 @noindent
2396 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2397 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2398 are not actually required.)
2399
2400 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2401 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2402 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2403 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2404 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2405
2406 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2407 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2408 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2409
2410 @kindex unset environment
2411 @anchor{unset environment}
2412 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2413 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2414 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2415 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2416 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2417
2418 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2419 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2420 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2421 @end table
2422
2423 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2424 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2425 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2426 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2427 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2428 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2429 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2430 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2431 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2432 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2433
2434 @node Working Directory
2435 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2436
2437 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2438 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2439 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2440 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2441 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2442 directory as its working directory.
2443
2444 @table @code
2445 @kindex set cwd
2446 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2447 @anchor{set cwd command}
2448 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2449 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2450 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2451 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2452 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2453 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2454 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2455 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2456 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2457 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2458 fallback.
2459
2460 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2461 the @code{cd} command.
2462 @xref{cd command}
2463
2464 @kindex show cwd
2465 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2466 @item show cwd
2467 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2468 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2469 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2470
2471 @kindex cd
2472 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2473 @anchor{cd command}
2474 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2475 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2476 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2477
2478 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2479 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2480 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2481 @xref{set cwd command}
2482
2483 @kindex pwd
2484 @item pwd
2485 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2486 @end table
2487
2488 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2489 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2490 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2491 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2492 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2493 current working directory of the debuggee.
2494
2495 @node Input/Output
2496 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2497
2498 @cindex redirection
2499 @cindex i/o
2500 @cindex terminal
2501 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2502 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2503 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2504 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2505 running your program.
2506
2507 @table @code
2508 @kindex info terminal
2509 @item info terminal
2510 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2511 program is using.
2512 @end table
2513
2514 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2515 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2516
2517 @smallexample
2518 run > outfile
2519 @end smallexample
2520
2521 @noindent
2522 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2523
2524 @kindex tty
2525 @cindex controlling terminal
2526 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2527 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2528 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2529 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2530 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2531
2532 @smallexample
2533 tty /dev/ttyb
2534 @end smallexample
2535
2536 @noindent
2537 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2538 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2539 that as their controlling terminal.
2540
2541 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2542 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2543 terminal.
2544
2545 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2546 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2547 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2548 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2549
2550 @cindex inferior tty
2551 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2552 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2553 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2554 program.
2555
2556 @table @code
2557 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2558 @kindex set inferior-tty
2559 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2560 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2561 @value{GDBN}.
2562
2563 @item show inferior-tty
2564 @kindex show inferior-tty
2565 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2566 @end table
2567
2568 @node Attach
2569 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2570 @kindex attach
2571 @cindex attach
2572
2573 @table @code
2574 @item attach @var{process-id}
2575 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2576 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2577 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2578 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2579 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2580
2581 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2582 executing the command.
2583 @end table
2584
2585 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2586 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2587 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2588 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2589
2590 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2591 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2592 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2593 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2594 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2595 Specify Files}.
2596
2597 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2598 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2599 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2600 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2601 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2602 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2603 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2604
2605 @table @code
2606 @kindex detach
2607 @item detach
2608 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2609 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2610 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2611 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2612 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2613 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2614 executing the command.
2615 @end table
2616
2617 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2618 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2619 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2620 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2621 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2622 Messages}).
2623
2624 @node Kill Process
2625 @section Killing the Child Process
2626
2627 @table @code
2628 @kindex kill
2629 @item kill
2630 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2631 @end table
2632
2633 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2634 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2635 is running.
2636
2637 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2638 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2639 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2640 outside the debugger.
2641
2642 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2643 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2644 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2645 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2646 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2647 breakpoint settings).
2648
2649 @node Inferiors and Programs
2650 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2651
2652 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2653 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2654 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2655 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2656 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2657 from multiple executables.
2658
2659 @cindex inferior
2660 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2661 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2662 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2663 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2664 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2665 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2666 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2667 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2668 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2669 threads running in it.
2670
2671 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2672 inferiors}}:
2673
2674 @table @code
2675 @kindex info inferiors
2676 @item info inferiors
2677 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2678
2679 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2680
2681 @enumerate
2682 @item
2683 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2684
2685 @item
2686 the target system's inferior identifier
2687
2688 @item
2689 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2690
2691 @end enumerate
2692
2693 @noindent
2694 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2695 indicates the current inferior.
2696
2697 For example,
2698 @end table
2699 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2700
2701 @smallexample
2702 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2703 Num Description Executable
2704 2 process 2307 hello
2705 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2706 @end smallexample
2707
2708 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2712 @item inferior @var{infno}
2713 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2714 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2715 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2716 @end table
2717
2718 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2719 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2720 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2721 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2722 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2723 information on convenience variables.
2724
2725 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2726 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2727 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2728 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2729 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2730 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2731
2732 @table @code
2733 @kindex add-inferior
2734 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2735 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2736 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2737 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2738 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2739 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2740
2741 @kindex clone-inferior
2742 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2743 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2744 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2745 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2746 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2747
2748 @smallexample
2749 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2750 Num Description Executable
2751 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2752 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2753 Added inferior 2.
2754 1 inferiors added.
2755 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2756 Num Description Executable
2757 2 <null> helloworld
2758 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2759 @end smallexample
2760
2761 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2762
2763 @kindex remove-inferiors
2764 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2765 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2766 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2767 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2768
2769 @end table
2770
2771 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2772 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2773 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2774 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2775
2776 @table @code
2777 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2778 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2779 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2780 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2781 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2782 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2783
2784 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2785 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2786 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2787 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2788 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2789 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2790 @end table
2791
2792 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2793 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2794 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2795 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2796
2797
2798 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2799 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2800
2801 @table @code
2802 @kindex set print inferior-events
2803 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2804 @item set print inferior-events
2805 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2806 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2807 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2808 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2809 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2810 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2811
2812 @kindex show print inferior-events
2813 @item show print inferior-events
2814 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2815 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2816 @end table
2817
2818 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2819 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2820 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2821
2822
2823 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2824 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2825 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2826 info program-spaces}} command.
2827
2828 @table @code
2829 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2830 @item maint info program-spaces
2831 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2832 @value{GDBN}.
2833
2834 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2835
2836 @enumerate
2837 @item
2838 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2839
2840 @item
2841 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2842 the @code{file} command.
2843
2844 @end enumerate
2845
2846 @noindent
2847 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2848 indicates the current program space.
2849
2850 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2851 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2852 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2853
2854 @smallexample
2855 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2856 Id Executable
2857 * 1 hello
2858 2 goodbye
2859 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2860 @end smallexample
2861
2862 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2863 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2864 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2865 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2866 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2867
2868 @smallexample
2869 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2870 Id Executable
2871 * 1 vfork-test
2872 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2873 @end smallexample
2874
2875 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2876 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2877 @end table
2878
2879 @node Threads
2880 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2881
2882 @cindex threads of execution
2883 @cindex multiple threads
2884 @cindex switching threads
2885 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2886 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2887 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2888 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2889 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2890 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2891 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2892
2893 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2894 programs:
2895
2896 @itemize @bullet
2897 @item automatic notification of new threads
2898 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2899 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2900 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2901 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2902 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2903 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2904 messages on thread start and exit.
2905 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2906 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2907 isn't compatible with the program.
2908 @end itemize
2909
2910 @cindex focus of debugging
2911 @cindex current thread
2912 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2913 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2914 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2915 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2916 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2917
2918 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2919 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2920 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2921 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2922 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2923 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2924 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2925 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2926 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2927 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2928
2929 @smallexample
2930 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2931 @end smallexample
2932
2933 @noindent
2934 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2935 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2936 further qualifier.
2937
2938 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2939 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2940 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2941 @c program?
2942 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2943 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2944 @c threads ab initio?
2945
2946 @anchor{thread numbers}
2947 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2948 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2949 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2950 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2951 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2952 between threads of different inferiors.
2953
2954 @cindex qualified thread ID
2955 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2956 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2957 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2958 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2959 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2960 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2961 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2962 inferior.
2963
2964 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2965 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2966 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2967 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2968
2969 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2970 @cindex thread ID lists
2971 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2972 argument. A list element can be:
2973
2974 @enumerate
2975 @item
2976 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2977 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2978 @samp{1}.
2979
2980 @item
2981 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2982 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2983 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2984
2985 @item
2986 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2987 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2988 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2989 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2990 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2991
2992 @end enumerate
2993
2994 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2995 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2996 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2997 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2998 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2999 7.1}.
3000
3001
3002 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3003 @cindex global thread number
3004 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3005 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3006 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3007 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3008 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3009 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3010
3011 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3012 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3013 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3014
3015 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3016 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3017 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3018 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3019 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3020 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3021 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3022 general information on convenience variables.
3023
3024 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3025 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3026 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3027
3028 @smallexample
3029 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3030 @end smallexample
3031
3032 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3033
3034 @smallexample
3035 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3036 @end smallexample
3037
3038 @table @code
3039 @kindex info threads
3040 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3041
3042 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3043 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3044 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3045 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3046
3047 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3048
3049 @enumerate
3050 @item
3051 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3052
3053 @item
3054 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3055 option was specified
3056
3057 @item
3058 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3059
3060 @item
3061 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3062 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3063 program itself.
3064
3065 @item
3066 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3067 @end enumerate
3068
3069 @noindent
3070 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3071 indicates the current thread.
3072
3073 For example,
3074 @end table
3075 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3076
3077 @smallexample
3078 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3079 Id Target Id Frame
3080 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3081 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3082 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3083 at threadtest.c:68
3084 @end smallexample
3085
3086 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3087 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3088 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3089
3090 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3091 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3092
3093 @smallexample
3094 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3095 Id GId Target Id Frame
3096 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3097 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3098 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3099 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3100 @end smallexample
3101
3102 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3103 Solaris-specific command:
3104
3105 @table @code
3106 @item maint info sol-threads
3107 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3108 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3109 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3110 @end table
3111
3112 @table @code
3113 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3114 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3115 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3116 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3117 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3118 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3119
3120 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3121 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3122
3123 @smallexample
3124 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3125 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3126 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3127 8 printf ("hello\n");
3128 @end smallexample
3129
3130 @noindent
3131 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3132 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3133 threads.
3134
3135 @kindex thread apply
3136 @cindex apply command to several threads
3137 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3138 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3139 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3140 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3141 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3142 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3143 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3144 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3145
3146
3147 @kindex thread name
3148 @cindex name a thread
3149 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3150 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3151 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3152 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3153
3154 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3155 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3156 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3157 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3158 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3159
3160 @kindex thread find
3161 @cindex search for a thread
3162 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3163 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3164 matches the supplied regular expression.
3165
3166 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3167 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3168 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3169 is the LWP id.
3170
3171 @smallexample
3172 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3173 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3174 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3175 Id Target Id Frame
3176 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3177 @end smallexample
3178
3179 @kindex set print thread-events
3180 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3181 @item set print thread-events
3182 @itemx set print thread-events on
3183 @itemx set print thread-events off
3184 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3185 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3186 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3187 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3188 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3189
3190 @kindex show print thread-events
3191 @item show print thread-events
3192 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3193 have started and exited.
3194 @end table
3195
3196 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3197 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3198 programs with multiple threads.
3199
3200 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3201 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3202
3203 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3204 @table @code
3205 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3206 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3207 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3208 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3209 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3210 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3211 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3212 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3213 macro.
3214
3215 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3216 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3217 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3218 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3219 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3220 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3221
3222 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3223 refers to the default system directories that are
3224 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3225 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3226 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3227
3228 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3229 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3230 was loaded in the inferior process.
3231
3232 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3233 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3234 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3235 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3236 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3237 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3238 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3239
3240 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3241 only on some platforms.
3242
3243 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3244 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3245 Display current libthread_db search path.
3246
3247 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3248 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3249 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3250 @item set debug libthread-db
3251 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3252 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3253 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3254 @end table
3255
3256 @node Forks
3257 @section Debugging Forks
3258
3259 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3260 @cindex multiple processes
3261 @cindex processes, multiple
3262 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3263 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3264 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3265 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3266 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3267 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3268 will cause it to terminate.
3269
3270 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3271 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3272 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3273 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3274 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3275 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3276 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3277 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3278 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3279 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3280
3281 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3282 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3283 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3284 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3285
3286 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3287 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3288 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3289
3290 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3291 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3292
3293 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3294 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3295
3296 @table @code
3297 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3298 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3299 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3300 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3301 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3302
3303 @table @code
3304 @item parent
3305 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3306 unimpeded. This is the default.
3307
3308 @item child
3309 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3310 unimpeded.
3311
3312 @end table
3313
3314 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3315 @item show follow-fork-mode
3316 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3317 @end table
3318
3319 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3320 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3321 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3322
3323 @table @code
3324 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3325 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3326 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3327 retain debugger control over them both.
3328
3329 @table @code
3330 @item on
3331 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3332 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3333 independently. This is the default.
3334
3335 @item off
3336 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3337 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3338 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3339 is held suspended.
3340
3341 @end table
3342
3343 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3344 @item show detach-on-fork
3345 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3346 @end table
3347
3348 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3349 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3350 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3351 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3352 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3353 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3354
3355 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3356 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3357 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3358 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3359 and Programs}.
3360
3361 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3362 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3363 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3364 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3365 the child process's @code{main}.
3366
3367 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3368 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3369
3370 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3371 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3372 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3373 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3374 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3375 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3376 command.
3377
3378 @table @code
3379 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3380 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3381
3382 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3383 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3384
3385 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3386
3387 @table @code
3388 @item new
3389 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3390 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3391 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3392 original inferior.
3393
3394 For example:
3395
3396 @smallexample
3397 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3398 (gdb) info inferior
3399 Id Description Executable
3400 * 1 <null> prog1
3401 (@value{GDBP}) run
3402 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3403 Program exited normally.
3404 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3405 Id Description Executable
3406 1 <null> prog1
3407 * 2 <null> prog2
3408 @end smallexample
3409
3410 @item same
3411 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3412 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3413 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3414 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3415 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3416
3417 For example:
3418
3419 @smallexample
3420 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3421 Id Description Executable
3422 * 1 <null> prog1
3423 (@value{GDBP}) run
3424 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3425 Program exited normally.
3426 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3427 Id Description Executable
3428 * 1 <null> prog2
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @end table
3432 @end table
3433
3434 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3435 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3436
3437 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3438 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3439 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3440
3441 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3442 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3443
3444 @cindex checkpoint
3445 @cindex restart
3446 @cindex bookmark
3447 @cindex snapshot of a process
3448 @cindex rewind program state
3449
3450 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3451 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3452 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3453 later.
3454
3455 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3456 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3457 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3458 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3459 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3460
3461 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3462 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3463 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3464 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3465 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3466 start again from there.
3467
3468 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3469 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3470
3471 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3472
3473 @table @code
3474 @kindex checkpoint
3475 @item checkpoint
3476 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3477 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3478 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3479
3480 @kindex info checkpoints
3481 @item info checkpoints
3482 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3483 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3484 listed:
3485
3486 @table @code
3487 @item Checkpoint ID
3488 @item Process ID
3489 @item Code Address
3490 @item Source line, or label
3491 @end table
3492
3493 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3494 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3495 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3496 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3497 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3498 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3499 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3500
3501 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3502 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3503 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3504 the debugger.
3505
3506 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3507 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3508 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3509
3510 @end table
3511
3512 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3513 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3514 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3515 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3516 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3517 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3518 previously read data can be read again.
3519
3520 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3521 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3522 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3523 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3524 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3525 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3526
3527 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3528 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3529 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3530 different execution path this time.
3531
3532 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3533 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3534 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3535 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3536 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3537 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3538 potentially pose a problem.
3539
3540 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3541
3542 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3543 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3544 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3545 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3546 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3547 next.
3548
3549 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3550 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3551 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3552 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3553 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3554
3555 @node Stopping
3556 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3557
3558 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3559 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3560 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3561
3562 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3563 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3564 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3565 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3566 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3567 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3568 explicitly request this information at any time.
3569
3570 @table @code
3571 @kindex info program
3572 @item info program
3573 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3574 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3575 @end table
3576
3577 @menu
3578 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3579 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3580 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3581 Skipping over functions and files
3582 * Signals:: Signals
3583 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3584 @end menu
3585
3586 @node Breakpoints
3587 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3588
3589 @cindex breakpoints
3590 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3591 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3592 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3593 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3594 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3595 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3596 program.
3597
3598 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3599 the executable is run.
3600
3601 @cindex watchpoints
3602 @cindex data breakpoints
3603 @cindex memory tracing
3604 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3605 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3606 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3607 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3608 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3609 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3610 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3611 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3612 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3613 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3614 same commands.
3615
3616 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3617 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3618 Automatic Display}.
3619
3620 @cindex catchpoints
3621 @cindex breakpoint on events
3622 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3623 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3624 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3625 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3626 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3627 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3628 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3629
3630 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3631 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3632 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3633 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3634 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3635 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3636 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3637 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3638 enable it again.
3639
3640 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3641 @cindex breakpoint lists
3642 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3643 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3644 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3645 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3646 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3647 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3648 are operated on.
3649
3650 @menu
3651 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3652 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3653 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3654 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3655 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3656 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3657 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3658 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3659 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3660 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3661 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3662 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3663 @end menu
3664
3665 @node Set Breaks
3666 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3667
3668 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3669 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3670 @c
3671 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3672
3673 @kindex break
3674 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3675 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3676 @cindex latest breakpoint
3677 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3678 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3679 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3680 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3681 convenience variables.
3682
3683 @table @code
3684 @item break @var{location}
3685 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3686 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3687 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3688 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3689 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3690
3691 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3692 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3693 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3694 that situation.
3695
3696 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3697 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3698 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3699
3700 @item break
3701 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3702 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3703 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3704 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3705 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3706 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3707 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3708 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3709 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3710 inside loops.
3711
3712 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3713 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3714 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3715 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3716 existed when your program stopped.
3717
3718 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3719 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3720 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3721 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3722 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3723 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3724 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3725
3726 @kindex tbreak
3727 @item tbreak @var{args}
3728 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3729 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3730 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3731 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3732
3733 @kindex hbreak
3734 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3735 @item hbreak @var{args}
3736 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3737 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3738 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3739 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3740 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3741 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3742 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3743 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3744 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3745 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3746 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3747 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3748 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3749 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3750 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3751 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3752 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3753 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3754
3755 @kindex thbreak
3756 @item thbreak @var{args}
3757 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3758 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3759 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3760 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3761 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3762 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3763 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3764 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3765
3766 @kindex rbreak
3767 @cindex regular expression
3768 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3769 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3770 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3771 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3772 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3773 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3774 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3775 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3776 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3777
3778 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3779 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3780 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3781 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3782 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3783 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3784
3785 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3786 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3787 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3788 classes.
3789
3790 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3791 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3792 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3793
3794 @smallexample
3795 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3796 @end smallexample
3797
3798 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3799 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3800 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3801 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3802 every function in a given file:
3803
3804 @smallexample
3805 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3806 @end smallexample
3807
3808 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3809 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3810
3811 @kindex info breakpoints
3812 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3813 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3814 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3815 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3816 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3817 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3818 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3819
3820 @table @emph
3821 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3822 @item Type
3823 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3824 @item Disposition
3825 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3826 @item Enabled or Disabled
3827 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3828 that are not enabled.
3829 @item Address
3830 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3831 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3832 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3833 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3834 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3835 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3836 @item What
3837 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3838 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3839 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3840 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3841 @end table
3842
3843 @noindent
3844 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3845 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3846 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3847 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3848 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3849 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3850
3851 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3852 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3853 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3854 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3855
3856 @noindent
3857 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3858 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3859 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3860 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3861 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3862
3863 @noindent
3864 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3865 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3866 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3867 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3868 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3869 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3870
3871 @noindent
3872 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3873 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3874
3875 @end table
3876
3877 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3878 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3879 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3880 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3881
3882 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3883 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3884 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3885 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3886
3887 @itemize @bullet
3888 @item
3889 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3890
3891 @item
3892 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3893 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3894
3895 @item
3896 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3897 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3898
3899 @item
3900 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3901 several places where that function is inlined.
3902 @end itemize
3903
3904 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3905 the relevant locations.
3906
3907 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3908 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3909 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3910 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3911 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3912 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3913 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3914
3915 For example:
3916
3917 @smallexample
3918 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3919 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3920 stop only if i==1
3921 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3922 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3923 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3924 @end smallexample
3925
3926 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3927 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3928 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3929 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3930 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3931 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3932 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3933 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3934 that belong to that breakpoint.
3935
3936 @cindex pending breakpoints
3937 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3938 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3939 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3940 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3941 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3942 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3943 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3944 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3945 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3946 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3947 is not yet resolved.
3948
3949 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3950 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3951 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3952 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3953 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3954 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3955
3956 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3957 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3958 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3959 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3960
3961 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3962 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3963 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3964
3965 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3966 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3967 address specification to an address:
3968
3969 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3970 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3971 @table @code
3972 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3973 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3974 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3975
3976 @item set breakpoint pending on
3977 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3978 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3979
3980 @item set breakpoint pending off
3981 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3982 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3983 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3984
3985 @item show breakpoint pending
3986 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3987 @end table
3988
3989 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3990 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3991 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3992
3993 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3994 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3995 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3996 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3997 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3998 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3999 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4000 breakpoints.
4001
4002 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4003
4004 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4005 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4006 @table @code
4007 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4008 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4009 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4010 breakpoint must be used.
4011
4012 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4013 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4014 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4015 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4016 @end table
4017
4018 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4019 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4020 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4021 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4022 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4023 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4024 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4025 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4026 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4027
4028 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4029 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4030 @table @code
4031 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4032 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4033 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4034 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4035
4036 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4037 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4038 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4039 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4040 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4041 @end table
4042
4043 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4044 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4045 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4046
4047 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4048 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4049
4050 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4051
4052 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4053 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4054 @table @code
4055 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4056 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4057 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4058 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4059 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4060
4061 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4062 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4063 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4064 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4065 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4066 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4067 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4068 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4069 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4070 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4071 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4072 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4073 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4074
4075 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4076 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4077 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4078 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4079 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4080 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4081 @end table
4082
4083
4084 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4085 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4086 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4087 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4088 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4089 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4090 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4091 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4092
4093
4094 @node Set Watchpoints
4095 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4096
4097 @cindex setting watchpoints
4098 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4099 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4100 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4101 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4102 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4103
4104 @itemize @bullet
4105 @item
4106 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4107
4108 @item
4109 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4110 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4111 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4112
4113 @item
4114 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4115 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4116 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4117 @end itemize
4118
4119 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4120 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4121 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4122 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4123 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4124 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4125 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4126 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4127 the expression changes.
4128
4129 @cindex software watchpoints
4130 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4131 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4132 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4133 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4134 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4135 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4136 culprit.)
4137
4138 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4139 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4140 slow down the running of your program.
4141
4142 @table @code
4143 @kindex watch
4144 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4145 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4146 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4147 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4148 to watch the value of a single variable:
4149
4150 @smallexample
4151 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4152 @end smallexample
4153
4154 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4155 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4156 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4157 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4158 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4159 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4160
4161 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4162 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4163 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4164 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4165 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4166 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4167 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4168 error.
4169
4170 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4171 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4172 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4173 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4174 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4175 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4176 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4177 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4178 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4179 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4180 Examples:
4181
4182 @smallexample
4183 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4184 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4185 @end smallexample
4186
4187 @kindex rwatch
4188 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4189 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4190 by the program.
4191
4192 @kindex awatch
4193 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4194 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4195 or written into by the program.
4196
4197 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4198 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4199 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4200 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4201 @end table
4202
4203 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4204 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4205 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4206 a never-changing value:
4207
4208 @smallexample
4209 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4210 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4211 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4212 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4213 @end smallexample
4214
4215 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4216 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4217 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4218 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4219 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4220 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4221
4222 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4223 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4224 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4225 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4226 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4227 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4228 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4229 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4230
4231 @table @code
4232 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4233 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4234 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4235
4236 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4237 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4238 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4239 @end table
4240
4241 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4242 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4243 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4244
4245 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4246
4247 @smallexample
4248 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4249 @end smallexample
4250
4251 @noindent
4252 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4253
4254 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4255 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4256 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4257 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4258 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4259 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4260 will print a message like this:
4261
4262 @smallexample
4263 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4264 @end smallexample
4265
4266 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4267 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4268 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4269 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4270 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4271 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4272 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4273 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4274
4275 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4276 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4277 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4278 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4279 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4280 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4281
4282 @smallexample
4283 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4284 @end smallexample
4285
4286 @noindent
4287 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4288
4289 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4290 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4291 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4292 expression with separately allocated resources.
4293
4294 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4295 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4296 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4297
4298 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4299 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4300 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4301 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4302 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4303 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4304 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4305 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4306 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4307
4308 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4309 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4310 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4311 watched expression from every thread.
4312
4313 @quotation
4314 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4315 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4316 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4317 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4318 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4319 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4320 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4321 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4322 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4323 @end quotation
4324
4325 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4326
4327 @node Set Catchpoints
4328 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4329 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4330 @cindex exception handlers
4331 @cindex event handling
4332
4333 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4334 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4335 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4336
4337 @table @code
4338 @kindex catch
4339 @item catch @var{event}
4340 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4341
4342 @table @code
4343 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4344 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4345 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4346 @kindex catch throw
4347 @kindex catch rethrow
4348 @kindex catch catch
4349 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4350 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4351
4352 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4353 regular expression will be caught.
4354
4355 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4356 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4357 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4358 exception being thrown.
4359
4360 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4361 @value{GDBN}:
4362
4363 @itemize @bullet
4364 @item
4365 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4366 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4367 supported.
4368
4369 @item
4370 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4371 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4372 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4373 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4374 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4375 built.
4376
4377 @item
4378 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4379 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4380
4381 @item
4382 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4383 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4384 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4385 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4386
4387 @item
4388 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4389 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4390 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4391 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4392 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4393 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4394 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4395 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4396 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4397
4398 @item
4399 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4400
4401 @item
4402 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4403 @end itemize
4404
4405 @item exception
4406 @kindex catch exception
4407 @cindex Ada exception catching
4408 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4409 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4410 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4411 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4412 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4413
4414 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4415 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4416 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4417 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4418 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4419 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4420 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4421 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4422
4423 @item exception unhandled
4424 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4425 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4426
4427 @item assert
4428 @kindex catch assert
4429 A failed Ada assertion.
4430
4431 @item exec
4432 @kindex catch exec
4433 @cindex break on fork/exec
4434 A call to @code{exec}.
4435
4436 @item syscall
4437 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4438 @kindex catch syscall
4439 @cindex break on a system call.
4440 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4441 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4442 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4443 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4444 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4445 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4446 will be caught.
4447
4448 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4449 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4450 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4451 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4452
4453 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4454 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4455 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4456 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4457
4458 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4459 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4460 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4461 available choices.
4462
4463 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4464 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4465 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4466 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4467 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4468 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4469 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4470 behind the OS upgrades).
4471
4472 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4473 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4474 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4475 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4476 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4477 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4478 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4479 syscall groups available on your environment.
4480
4481 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4482 arguments to it:
4483
4484 @smallexample
4485 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4486 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4487 (@value{GDBP}) r
4488 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4489
4490 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4491 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4492 (@value{GDBP}) c
4493 Continuing.
4494
4495 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4496 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4497 (@value{GDBP})
4498 @end smallexample
4499
4500 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4504 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4505 (@value{GDBP}) r
4506 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4507
4508 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4509 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4510 (@value{GDBP}) c
4511 Continuing.
4512
4513 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4514 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4515 (@value{GDBP})
4516 @end smallexample
4517
4518 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4519 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4520 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4521
4522 @smallexample
4523 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4524 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4525 (@value{GDBP}) r
4526 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4527
4528 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4529 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4530 (@value{GDBP}) c
4531 Continuing.
4532
4533 Program exited normally.
4534 (@value{GDBP})
4535 @end smallexample
4536
4537 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4538
4539 @smallexample
4540 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4541 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4542 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4543 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4544 (@value{GDBP}) r
4545 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4546
4547 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4548 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4549
4550 (@value{GDBP}) c
4551 Continuing.
4552 @end smallexample
4553
4554 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4555 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4556 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4557 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4558
4559 @smallexample
4560 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4561 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4562 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4563 (@value{GDBP})
4564 @end smallexample
4565
4566 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4567 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4568 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4569 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4570 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4571 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4572
4573 @smallexample
4574 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4575 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4576 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4577 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4578 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4579 (@value{GDBP})
4580 @end smallexample
4581
4582 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4583
4584 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4585 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4586
4587 @smallexample
4588 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4589 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4590 @end smallexample
4591
4592 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4593
4594 @item fork
4595 @kindex catch fork
4596 A call to @code{fork}.
4597
4598 @item vfork
4599 @kindex catch vfork
4600 A call to @code{vfork}.
4601
4602 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4603 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4604 @kindex catch load
4605 @kindex catch unload
4606 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4607 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4608 matches one of the affected libraries.
4609
4610 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4611 @kindex catch signal
4612 The delivery of a signal.
4613
4614 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4615 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4616 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4617
4618 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4619 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4620 signal names.
4621
4622 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4623 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4624 will be caught.
4625
4626 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4627 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4628 catchpoint.
4629
4630 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4631 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4632 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4633 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4634 commands.
4635
4636 @end table
4637
4638 @item tcatch @var{event}
4639 @kindex tcatch
4640 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4641 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4642
4643 @end table
4644
4645 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4646
4647
4648 @node Delete Breaks
4649 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4650
4651 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4652 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4653 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4654 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4655 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4656 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4657
4658 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4659 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4660 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4661 their breakpoint numbers.
4662
4663 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4664 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4665 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4666
4667 @table @code
4668 @kindex clear
4669 @item clear
4670 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4671 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4672 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4673 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4674
4675 @item clear @var{location}
4676 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4677 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4678 most useful ones are listed below:
4679
4680 @table @code
4681 @item clear @var{function}
4682 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4683 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4684
4685 @item clear @var{linenum}
4686 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4687 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4688 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 @cindex delete breakpoints
4692 @kindex delete
4693 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4694 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4695 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4696 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4697 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4698 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4699 @end table
4700
4701 @node Disabling
4702 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4703
4704 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4705 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4706 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4707 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4708 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4709
4710 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4711 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4712 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4713 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4714 do not know which numbers to use.
4715
4716 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4717 affects all of its locations.
4718
4719 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4720 different states of enablement:
4721
4722 @itemize @bullet
4723 @item
4724 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4725 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4726 @item
4727 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4728 @item
4729 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4730 disabled.
4731 @item
4732 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4733 N times, then becomes disabled.
4734 @item
4735 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4736 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4737 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4738 @end itemize
4739
4740 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4741 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4742
4743 @table @code
4744 @kindex disable
4745 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4746 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4747 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4748 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4749 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4750 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4751 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4752
4753 @kindex enable
4754 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4755 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4756 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4757
4758 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4759 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4760 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4761
4762 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4763 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4764 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4765 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4766 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4767 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4768 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4769
4770 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4771 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4772 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4773 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4774 @end table
4775
4776 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4777 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4778 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4779 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4780 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4781 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4782 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4783 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4784 Stepping}.)
4785
4786 @node Conditions
4787 @subsection Break Conditions
4788 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4789 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4790
4791 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4792 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4793 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4794 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4795 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4796 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4797 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4798 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4799
4800 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4801 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4802 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4803 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4804 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4805
4806 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4807 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4808 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4809 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4810 one.
4811
4812 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4813 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4814 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4815 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4816 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4817 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4818 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4819 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4820 conditions for the
4821 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4822 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4823
4824 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4825 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4826 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4827 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4828 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4829 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4830
4831 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4832 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4833 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4834 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4835 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4836
4837 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4838 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4839 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4840 with the @code{condition} command.
4841
4842 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4843 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4844 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4845 catchpoint.
4846
4847 @table @code
4848 @kindex condition
4849 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4850 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4851 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4852 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4853 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4854 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4855 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4856 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4857 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4858 prints an error message:
4859
4860 @smallexample
4861 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4862 @end smallexample
4863
4864 @noindent
4865 @value{GDBN} does
4866 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4867 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4868 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4869
4870 @item condition @var{bnum}
4871 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4872 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4873 @end table
4874
4875 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4876 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4877 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4878 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4879 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4880 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4881 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4882 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4883 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4884 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4885 your program reaches it.
4886
4887 @table @code
4888 @kindex ignore
4889 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4890 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4891 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4892 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4893 takes no action.
4894
4895 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4896 a count of zero.
4897
4898 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4899 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4900 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4901 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4902
4903 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4904 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4905 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4906
4907 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4908 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4909 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4910 Variables}.
4911 @end table
4912
4913 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4914
4915
4916 @node Break Commands
4917 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4918
4919 @cindex breakpoint commands
4920 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4921 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4922 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4923 enable other breakpoints.
4924
4925 @table @code
4926 @kindex commands
4927 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4928 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4929 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4930 @itemx end
4931 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4932 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4933 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4934
4935 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4936 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4937
4938 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4939 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4940 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4941 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4942 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4943 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4944 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4945 Expressions}).
4946 @end table
4947
4948 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4949 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4950
4951 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4952 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4953 that resumes execution.
4954
4955 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4956 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4957 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4958 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4959 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4960
4961 @kindex silent
4962 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4963 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4964 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4965 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4966 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4967 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4968
4969 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4970 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4971 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4972
4973 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4974 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4975
4976 @smallexample
4977 break foo if x>0
4978 commands
4979 silent
4980 printf "x is %d\n",x
4981 cont
4982 end
4983 @end smallexample
4984
4985 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4986 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4987 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4988 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4989 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4990 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4991 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4992
4993 @smallexample
4994 break 403
4995 commands
4996 silent
4997 set x = y + 4
4998 cont
4999 end
5000 @end smallexample
5001
5002 @node Dynamic Printf
5003 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5004
5005 @cindex dynamic printf
5006 @cindex dprintf
5007 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5008 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5009 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5010 having to recompile it.
5011
5012 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5013 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5014 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5015 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5016 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5017 redirects to files and so forth.
5018
5019 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5020 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5021 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5022 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5023 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5024 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5025 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5026
5027 @table @code
5028 @kindex dprintf
5029 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5030 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5031 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5032 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5033
5034 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5035 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5036 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5037 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5038 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5039 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5040
5041 @table @code
5042 @item gdb
5043 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5044 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5045
5046 @item call
5047 @kindex dprintf-style call
5048 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5049 @code{printf}).
5050
5051 @item agent
5052 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5053 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5054 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5055 support running commands on the target.
5056 @end table
5057
5058 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5059 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5060 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5061 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5062 command.
5063
5064 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5065 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5066 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5067 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5068 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5069 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5070
5071 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5072 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5073 you could do the following:
5074
5075 @example
5076 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5077 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5078 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5079 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5080 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5081 (gdb) info break
5082 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5083 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5084 continue
5085 (gdb)
5086 @end example
5087
5088 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5089 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5090 the variable settings.
5091
5092 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5093 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5094 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5095 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5096 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5097 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5098
5099 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5100 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5101 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5102
5103 @end table
5104
5105 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5106 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5107 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5108 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5109 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5110 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5111
5112 @node Save Breakpoints
5113 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5114
5115 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5116 breakpoints}} command.
5117
5118 @table @code
5119 @kindex save breakpoints
5120 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5121 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5122 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5123 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5124 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5125 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5126 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5127 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5128 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5129 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5130 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5131 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5132 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5133 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5134 that can no longer be recreated.
5135 @end table
5136
5137 @node Static Probe Points
5138 @subsection Static Probe Points
5139
5140 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5141 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5142 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5143 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5144 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5145
5146 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5147 ELF-compatible systems:
5148
5149 @itemize @bullet
5150
5151 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5152 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5153 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5154 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5155 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5156 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5157 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5158 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5159
5160 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5161 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5162 C@t{++} languages.
5163 @end itemize
5164
5165 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5166 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5167 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5168 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5169 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5170 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5171 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5172 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5173 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5174
5175 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5176 probes}, with optional arguments:
5177
5178 @table @code
5179 @kindex info probes
5180 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5181 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5182 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5183 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5184
5185 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5186 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5187 probes from all providers are listed.
5188
5189 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5190 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5191 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5192
5193 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5194 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5195 given, all object files are considered.
5196
5197 @item info probes all
5198 List the available static probes, from all types.
5199 @end table
5200
5201 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5202 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5203 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5204 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5205 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5206
5207 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5208 commands, with optional arguments:
5209
5210 @table @code
5211 @kindex enable probes
5212 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5213 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5214 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5215 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5216
5217 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5218 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5219 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5220
5221 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5222 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5223 given, all object files are considered.
5224
5225 @kindex disable probes
5226 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5227 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5228 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5229 @end table
5230
5231 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5232 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5233 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5234 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5235 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5236 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5237 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5238 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5239 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5240 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5241 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5242 at the current probe point.
5243
5244 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5245 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5246 an error message.
5247
5248
5249 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5250 @node Error in Breakpoints
5251 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5252
5253 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5254 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5255
5256 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5257 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5258 @smallexample
5259 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5260 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5261 @end smallexample
5262
5263 @noindent
5264 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5265 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5266 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5267
5268 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5269 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5270
5271 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5272 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5273 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5274
5275 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5276 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5277 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5278 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5279
5280 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5281 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5282 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5283 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5284 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5285 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5286 first in the bundle.
5287
5288 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5289 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5290 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5291 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5292 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5293 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5294 is hit.
5295
5296 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5297 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5298
5299 @smallexample
5300 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5301 @end smallexample
5302
5303 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5304 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5305 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5306 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5307 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5308 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5309 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5310 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5311
5312 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5313 adjusted breakpoints:
5314
5315 @smallexample
5316 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5317 to 0x00010410.
5318 @end smallexample
5319
5320 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5321 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5322 frequently than expected.
5323
5324 @node Continuing and Stepping
5325 @section Continuing and Stepping
5326
5327 @cindex stepping
5328 @cindex continuing
5329 @cindex resuming execution
5330 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5331 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5332 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5333 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5334 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5335 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5336 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5337 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5338 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5339 handlers}).)
5340
5341 @table @code
5342 @kindex continue
5343 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5344 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5345 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5346 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5347 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5348 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5349 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5350 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5351 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5352 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5353
5354 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5355 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5356 @code{continue} is ignored.
5357
5358 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5359 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5360 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5361 @code{continue}.
5362 @end table
5363
5364 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5365 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5366 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5367 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5368
5369 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5370 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5371 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5372 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5373 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5374 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5375
5376 @table @code
5377 @kindex step
5378 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5379 @item step
5380 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5381 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5382 abbreviated @code{s}.
5383
5384 @quotation
5385 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5386 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5387 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5388 @c distinction here.
5389 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5390 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5391 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5392 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5393 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5394 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5395 below.
5396 @end quotation
5397
5398 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5399 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5400 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5401 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5402 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5403 called within the line.
5404
5405 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5406 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5407 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5408 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5409 was any debugging information about the routine.
5410
5411 @item step @var{count}
5412 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5413 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5414 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5415
5416 @kindex next
5417 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5418 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5419 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5420 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5421 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5422 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5423 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5424 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5425
5426 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5427
5428
5429 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5430 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5431 @c
5432 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5433 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5434 @c function are executed without stopping.
5435
5436 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5437 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5438 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5439
5440 @kindex set step-mode
5441 @item set step-mode
5442 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5443 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5444 @itemx set step-mode on
5445 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5446 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5447 information rather than stepping over it.
5448
5449 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5450 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5451 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5452
5453 @item set step-mode off
5454 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5455 debug information. This is the default.
5456
5457 @item show step-mode
5458 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5459 source line debug information.
5460
5461 @kindex finish
5462 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5463 @item finish
5464 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5465 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5466 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5467
5468 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5469 ,Returning from a Function}).
5470
5471 @kindex until
5472 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5473 @cindex run until specified location
5474 @item until
5475 @itemx u
5476 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5477 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5478 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5479 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5480 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5481 than the address of the jump.
5482
5483 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5484 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5485 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5486 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5487 through the next iteration.
5488
5489 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5490 stack frame.
5491
5492 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5493 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5494 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5495 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5496 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5497
5498 @smallexample
5499 (@value{GDBP}) f
5500 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5501 206 expand_input();
5502 (@value{GDBP}) until
5503 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5504 @end smallexample
5505
5506 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5507 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5508 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5509 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5510 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5511 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5512 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5513
5514 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5515 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5516 argument.
5517
5518 @item until @var{location}
5519 @itemx u @var{location}
5520 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5521 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5522 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5523 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5524 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5525 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5526 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5527 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5528 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5529 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5530 invocations have returned.
5531
5532 @smallexample
5533 94 int factorial (int value)
5534 95 @{
5535 96 if (value > 1) @{
5536 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5537 98 @}
5538 99 return (value);
5539 100 @}
5540 @end smallexample
5541
5542
5543 @kindex advance @var{location}
5544 @item advance @var{location}
5545 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5546 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5547 @ref{Specify Location}.
5548 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5549 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5550 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5551 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5552
5553
5554 @kindex stepi
5555 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5556 @item stepi
5557 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5558 @itemx si
5559 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5560
5561 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5562 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5563 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5564 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5565
5566 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5567
5568 @need 750
5569 @kindex nexti
5570 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5571 @item nexti
5572 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5573 @itemx ni
5574 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5575 proceed until the function returns.
5576
5577 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5578
5579 @end table
5580
5581 @anchor{range stepping}
5582 @cindex range stepping
5583 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5584 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5585 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5586 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5587 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5588 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5589 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5590 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5591 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5592 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5593 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5594 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5595 if necessary:
5596
5597 @table @code
5598 @kindex set range-stepping
5599 @kindex show range-stepping
5600 @item set range-stepping
5601 @itemx show range-stepping
5602 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5603
5604 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5605 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5606 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5607 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5608 default is @code{on}.
5609
5610 @end table
5611
5612 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5613 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5614 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5615
5616 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5617 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5618 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5619 a particular file when stepping.
5620
5621 For example, consider the following C function:
5622
5623 @smallexample
5624 101 int func()
5625 102 @{
5626 103 foo(boring());
5627 104 bar(boring());
5628 105 @}
5629 @end smallexample
5630
5631 @noindent
5632 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5633 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5634 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5635 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5636
5637 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5638 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5639 is called from many places.
5640
5641 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5642 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5643 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5644 @code{foo}.
5645
5646 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5647 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5648 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5649
5650 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5651 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5652 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5653 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5654 the underlying system.
5655 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5656 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5657
5658 @table @code
5659 @kindex skip
5660 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5661 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5662 that specify what to skip.
5663 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5664
5665 @table @code
5666 @item -file @var{file}
5667 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5668 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5669
5670 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5671 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5672 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5673 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5674 over when stepping.
5675
5676 @smallexample
5677 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5678 @end smallexample
5679
5680 @item -function @var{linespec}
5681 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5682 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5683 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5684 @xref{Specify Location}.
5685
5686 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5687 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5688 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5689 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5690
5691 This form is useful for complex function names.
5692 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5693 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5694 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5695 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5696 regular expression makes this easier.
5697
5698 @smallexample
5699 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5700 @end smallexample
5701
5702 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5703 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5704
5705 @smallexample
5706 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5707 @end smallexample
5708 @end table
5709
5710 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5711 will be skipped.
5712
5713 @kindex skip function
5714 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5715 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5716 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5717 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5718
5719 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5720 will be skipped.
5721
5722 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5723 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5724
5725 @kindex skip file
5726 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5727 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5728 will be skipped over when stepping.
5729
5730 @smallexample
5731 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5732 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5733 @end smallexample
5734
5735 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5736 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5737 @end table
5738
5739 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5740 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5741
5742 @table @code
5743 @kindex info skip
5744 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5745 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5746 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5747 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5748
5749 @table @emph
5750 @item Identifier
5751 A number identifying this skip.
5752 @item Enabled or Disabled
5753 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5754 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5755 @item Glob
5756 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5757 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5758 @item File
5759 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5760 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5761 @item RE
5762 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5763 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5764 @item Function
5765 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5766 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5767 @end table
5768
5769 @kindex skip delete
5770 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5771 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5772 skips.
5773
5774 @kindex skip enable
5775 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5776 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5777 skips.
5778
5779 @kindex skip disable
5780 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5781 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5782 skips.
5783
5784 @end table
5785
5786 @node Signals
5787 @section Signals
5788 @cindex signals
5789
5790 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5791 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5792 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5793 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5794 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5795 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5796 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5797 requested an alarm).
5798
5799 @cindex fatal signals
5800 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5801 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5802 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5803 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5804 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5805 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5806
5807 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5808 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5809 signal.
5810
5811 @cindex handling signals
5812 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5813 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5814 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5815 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5816 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5817
5818 @table @code
5819 @kindex info signals
5820 @kindex info handle
5821 @item info signals
5822 @itemx info handle
5823 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5824 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5825 the defined types of signals.
5826
5827 @item info signals @var{sig}
5828 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5829
5830 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5831
5832 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5833 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5834 for details about this command.
5835
5836 @kindex handle
5837 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5838 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5839 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5840 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5841 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5842 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5843 say what change to make.
5844 @end table
5845
5846 @c @group
5847 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5848 Their full names are:
5849
5850 @table @code
5851 @item nostop
5852 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5853 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5854
5855 @item stop
5856 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5857 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5858
5859 @item print
5860 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5861
5862 @item noprint
5863 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5864 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5865
5866 @item pass
5867 @itemx noignore
5868 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5869 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5870 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5871
5872 @item nopass
5873 @itemx ignore
5874 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5875 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5876 @end table
5877 @c @end group
5878
5879 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5880 program until you
5881 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5882 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5883 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5884 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5885 program sees that signal when you continue.
5886
5887 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5888 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5889 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5890 erroneous signals.
5891
5892 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5893 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5894 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5895 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5896 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5897 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5898 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5899 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5900 Program a Signal}.
5901
5902 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5903 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5904
5905 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5906 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5907 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5908 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5909 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5910 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5911 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5912 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5913 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5914 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5915 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5916 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5917 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5918
5919 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5920
5921 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5922 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5923 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5924 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5925
5926 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5927 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5928 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5929 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5930
5931 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5932 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5933
5934 @smallexample
5935 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5936 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5937 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5938 (@value{GDBP}) c
5939 Continuing.
5940
5941 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5942 main () sigusr1.c:28
5943 28 p = 0;
5944 (@value{GDBP}) si
5945 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5946 9 @{
5947 @end smallexample
5948
5949 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5950 program to receive the signal first:
5951
5952 @smallexample
5953 (@value{GDBP}) n
5954 28 p = 0;
5955 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5956 (@value{GDBP}) si
5957 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5958 9 @{
5959 (@value{GDBP})
5960 @end smallexample
5961
5962 @cindex extra signal information
5963 @anchor{extra signal information}
5964
5965 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5966 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5967 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5968 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5969 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5970 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5971 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5972 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5973 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5974 system header.
5975
5976 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5977 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5978
5979 @smallexample
5980 @group
5981 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5982 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5983 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5984 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5985 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5986 type = struct @{
5987 int si_signo;
5988 int si_errno;
5989 int si_code;
5990 union @{
5991 int _pad[28];
5992 struct @{...@} _kill;
5993 struct @{...@} _timer;
5994 struct @{...@} _rt;
5995 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5996 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5997 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5998 @} _sifields;
5999 @}
6000 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6001 type = struct @{
6002 void *si_addr;
6003 @}
6004 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6005 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6006 @end group
6007 @end smallexample
6008
6009 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6010
6011 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6012 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6013 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6014 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6015 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6016 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6017 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6018 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6019 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6020 information is displayed.
6021
6022 The usual output of a segfault is:
6023 @smallexample
6024 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6025 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6026 68 value = *(p + len);
6027 @end smallexample
6028
6029 While a bound violation is presented as:
6030 @smallexample
6031 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6032 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6033 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6034 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6035 68 value = *(p + len);
6036 @end smallexample
6037
6038 @node Thread Stops
6039 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6040
6041 @cindex stopped threads
6042 @cindex threads, stopped
6043
6044 @cindex continuing threads
6045 @cindex threads, continuing
6046
6047 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6048 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6049 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6050 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6051 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6052 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6053 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6054 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6055 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6056
6057 @menu
6058 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6059 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6060 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6061 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6062 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6063 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6064 @end menu
6065
6066 @node All-Stop Mode
6067 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6068
6069 @cindex all-stop mode
6070
6071 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6072 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6073 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6074 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6075 underfoot.
6076
6077 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6078 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6079 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6080
6081 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6082 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6083 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6084 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6085 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6086 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6087 stops.
6088
6089 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6090 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6091 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6092 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6093
6094 @cindex automatic thread selection
6095 @cindex switching threads automatically
6096 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6097 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6098 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6099 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6100 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6101 thread.
6102
6103 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6104 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6105
6106 @table @code
6107 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6108 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6109 @cindex lock scheduler
6110 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6111 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6112 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6113 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6114 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6115 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6116 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6117 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6118 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6119 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6120 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6121 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6122 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6123 @code{on} in replay mode.
6124
6125 @item show scheduler-locking
6126 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6127 @end table
6128
6129 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6130 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6131 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6132 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6133 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6134 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6135 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6136 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6137 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6138 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6139 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6140 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6141 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6142 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6143
6144 @table @code
6145 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6146 @item set schedule-multiple
6147 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6148 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6149 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6150 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6151 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6152 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6153
6154 @item show schedule-multiple
6155 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6156 multiple processes.
6157 @end table
6158
6159 @node Non-Stop Mode
6160 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6161
6162 @cindex non-stop mode
6163
6164 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6165 @c with more details.
6166
6167 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6168 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6169 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6170 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6171 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6172 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6173
6174 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6175 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6176 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6177 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6178 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6179 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6180 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6181 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6182 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6183 independently and simultaneously.
6184
6185 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6186 or attach to your program:
6187
6188 @smallexample
6189 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6190 set pagination off
6191
6192 # Finally, turn it on!
6193 set non-stop on
6194 @end smallexample
6195
6196 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6197
6198 @table @code
6199 @kindex set non-stop
6200 @item set non-stop on
6201 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6202 @item set non-stop off
6203 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6204 @kindex show non-stop
6205 @item show non-stop
6206 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6207 @end table
6208
6209 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6210 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6211 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6212 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6213 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6214 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6215 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6216 default.
6217
6218 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6219 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6220 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6221
6222 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6223 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6224 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6225 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6226 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6227
6228 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6229 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6230 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6231 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6232 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6233
6234 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6235
6236 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6237 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6238 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6239 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6240 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6241 previously current thread.
6242
6243 @node Background Execution
6244 @subsection Background Execution
6245
6246 @cindex foreground execution
6247 @cindex background execution
6248 @cindex asynchronous execution
6249 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6250
6251 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6252 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6253 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6254 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6255 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6256 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6257
6258 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6259 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6260
6261 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6262 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6263 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6264 are:
6265
6266 @table @code
6267 @kindex run&
6268 @item run
6269 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6270
6271 @item attach
6272 @kindex attach&
6273 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6274
6275 @item step
6276 @kindex step&
6277 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6278
6279 @item stepi
6280 @kindex stepi&
6281 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6282
6283 @item next
6284 @kindex next&
6285 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6286
6287 @item nexti
6288 @kindex nexti&
6289 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6290
6291 @item continue
6292 @kindex continue&
6293 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6294
6295 @item finish
6296 @kindex finish&
6297 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6298
6299 @item until
6300 @kindex until&
6301 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6302
6303 @end table
6304
6305 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6306 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6307 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6308 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6309 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6310 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6311
6312 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6313 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6314
6315 @table @code
6316 @kindex interrupt
6317 @item interrupt
6318 @itemx interrupt -a
6319
6320 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6321 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6322 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6323 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6324 @end table
6325
6326 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6327 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6328
6329 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6330 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6331 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6332
6333 @table @code
6334 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6335 @cindex thread breakpoints
6336 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6337 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6338 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6339 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6340 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6341 specify some source line.
6342
6343 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6344 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6345 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6346 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6347 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6348
6349 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6350 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6351 program.
6352
6353 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6354 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6355 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6356
6357 @smallexample
6358 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6359 @end smallexample
6360
6361 @end table
6362
6363 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6364 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6365 thread list. For example:
6366
6367 @smallexample
6368 (@value{GDBP}) c
6369 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6370 @end smallexample
6371
6372 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6373 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6374 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6375 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6376 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6377 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6378 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6379 command.
6380
6381 @node Interrupted System Calls
6382 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6383
6384 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6385 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6386 @cindex premature return from system calls
6387 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6388 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6389 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6390 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6391 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6392 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6393 stop execution.
6394
6395 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6396 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6397 style anyways.
6398
6399 For example, do not write code like this:
6400
6401 @smallexample
6402 sleep (10);
6403 @end smallexample
6404
6405 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6406 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6407
6408 Instead, write this:
6409
6410 @smallexample
6411 int unslept = 10;
6412 while (unslept > 0)
6413 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6414 @end smallexample
6415
6416 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6417 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6418 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6419 @value{GDBN}.
6420
6421 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6422 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6423 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6424 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6425
6426 @node Observer Mode
6427 @subsection Observer Mode
6428
6429 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6430 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6431 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6432 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6433 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6434
6435 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6436 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6437 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6438 mode.
6439
6440 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6441 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6442 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6443 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6444 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6445
6446 @table @code
6447
6448 @kindex observer
6449 @item set observer on
6450 @itemx set observer off
6451 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6452 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6453 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6454 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6455
6456 @item show observer
6457 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6458
6459 @kindex may-write-registers
6460 @item set may-write-registers on
6461 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6462 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6463 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6464 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6465
6466 @item show may-write-registers
6467 Show the current permission to write registers.
6468
6469 @kindex may-write-memory
6470 @item set may-write-memory on
6471 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6472 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6473 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6474 defaults to @code{on}.
6475
6476 @item show may-write-memory
6477 Show the current permission to write memory.
6478
6479 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6480 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6481 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6482 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6483 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6484 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6485
6486 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6487 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6488
6489 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6490 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6491 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6492 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6493 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6494 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6495 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6496
6497 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6498 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6499
6500 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6501 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6502 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6503 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6504 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6505 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6506 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6507
6508 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6509 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6510
6511 @kindex may-interrupt
6512 @item set may-interrupt on
6513 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6514 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6515 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6516 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6517 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6518
6519 @item show may-interrupt
6520 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6521
6522 @end table
6523
6524 @node Reverse Execution
6525 @chapter Running programs backward
6526 @cindex reverse execution
6527 @cindex running programs backward
6528
6529 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6530 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6531 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6532 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6533
6534 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6535 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6536 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6537 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6538 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6539 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6540
6541 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6542 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6543 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6544 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6545 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6546 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6547 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6548 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6549 prior values@footnote{
6550 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6551 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6552 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6553
6554 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6555 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6556 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6557 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6558 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6559 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6560 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6561 }.
6562
6563 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6564 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6565
6566 @table @code
6567 @kindex reverse-continue
6568 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6569 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6570 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6571 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6572 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6573 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6574 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6575
6576 @kindex reverse-step
6577 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6578 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6579 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6580 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6581
6582 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6583 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6584 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6585 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6586 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6587 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6588
6589 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6590 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6591
6592 @kindex reverse-stepi
6593 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6594 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6595 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6596 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6597 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6598 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6599 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6600
6601 @kindex reverse-next
6602 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6603 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6604 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6605 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6606 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6607 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6608 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6609 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6610 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6611 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6612
6613 @kindex reverse-nexti
6614 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6615 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6616 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6617 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6618 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6619 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6620 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6621 frame) is reached.
6622
6623 @kindex reverse-finish
6624 @item reverse-finish
6625 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6626 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6627 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6628 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6629
6630 @kindex set exec-direction
6631 @item set exec-direction
6632 Set the direction of target execution.
6633 @item set exec-direction reverse
6634 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6635 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6636 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6637 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6638 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6639 @item set exec-direction forward
6640 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6641 This is the default.
6642 @end table
6643
6644
6645 @node Process Record and Replay
6646 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6647 @cindex process record and replay
6648 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6649
6650 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6651 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6652 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6653
6654 @cindex replay mode
6655 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6656 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6657 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6658 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6659 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6660 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6661 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6662 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6663 execution log.
6664
6665 @cindex record mode
6666 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6667 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6668 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6669 for future replay.
6670
6671 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6672 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6673 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6674 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6675 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6676 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6677
6678 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6679 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6680 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6681 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6682
6683 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6684 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6685
6686 @table @code
6687 @kindex target record
6688 @kindex target record-full
6689 @kindex target record-btrace
6690 @kindex record
6691 @kindex record full
6692 @kindex record btrace
6693 @kindex record btrace bts
6694 @kindex record btrace pt
6695 @kindex record bts
6696 @kindex record pt
6697 @kindex rec
6698 @kindex rec full
6699 @kindex rec btrace
6700 @kindex rec btrace bts
6701 @kindex rec btrace pt
6702 @kindex rec bts
6703 @kindex rec pt
6704 @item record @var{method}
6705 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6706 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6707 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6708 recording methods are available:
6709
6710 @table @code
6711 @item full
6712 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6713 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6714 execution.
6715
6716 @item btrace @var{format}
6717 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6718 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6719 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6720 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6721 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6722 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6723 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6724
6725 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6726 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6727 formats are available:
6728
6729 @table @code
6730 @item bts
6731 @cindex branch trace store
6732 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6733 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6734 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6735
6736 @item pt
6737 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6738 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6739 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6740 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6741
6742 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6743 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6744 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6745
6746 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6747 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6748 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6749 buffer-size with care.
6750 @end table
6751
6752 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6753 @end table
6754
6755 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6756 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6757 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6758 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6759
6760 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6761 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6762 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6763 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6764 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6765
6766 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6767 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6768 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6769 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6770 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6771 does not support these two modes.
6772
6773 @kindex record stop
6774 @kindex rec s
6775 @item record stop
6776 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6777 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6778 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6779
6780 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6781 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6782 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6783 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6784 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6785
6786 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6787 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6788 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6789 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6790 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6791
6792 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6793 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6794
6795 @kindex record goto
6796 @item record goto
6797 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6798 ways to specify the location to go to:
6799
6800 @table @code
6801 @item record goto begin
6802 @itemx record goto start
6803 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6804
6805 @item record goto end
6806 Go to the end of the execution log.
6807
6808 @item record goto @var{n}
6809 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6810 @end table
6811
6812 @kindex record save
6813 @item record save @var{filename}
6814 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6815 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6816 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6817
6818 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6819
6820 @kindex record restore
6821 @item record restore @var{filename}
6822 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6823 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6824
6825 @kindex set record full
6826 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6827 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6828 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6829 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6830
6831 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6832 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6833 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6834 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6835 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6836 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6837 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6838 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6839
6840 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6841 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6842 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6843
6844 @kindex show record full
6845 @item show record full insn-number-max
6846 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6847 recording method.
6848
6849 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6850 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6851 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6852 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6853 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6854 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6855 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6856 oldest one to be deleted.
6857
6858 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6859 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6860
6861 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6862 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6863
6864 @item set record full memory-query
6865 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6866 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6867 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6868 case.
6869
6870 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6871 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6872 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6873 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6874 results.
6875
6876 @item show record full memory-query
6877 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6878
6879 @kindex set record btrace
6880 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6881 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6882 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6883 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6884 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6885 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6886 You can use the following command for that:
6887
6888 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6889 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6890 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6891 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6892 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6893 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6894 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6895 position.
6896
6897 @kindex show record btrace
6898 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6899 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6900
6901 @kindex set record btrace bts
6902 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6903 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6904 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6905 format. Default is 64KB.
6906
6907 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6908 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6909 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6910 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6911 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6912 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6913 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6914
6915 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6916 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6917
6918 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6919 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6920
6921 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6922 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6923 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6924
6925 @kindex set record btrace pt
6926 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6927 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6928 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6929 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6930
6931 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6932 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6933 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6934 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6935 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6936 actual buffer size for each thread.
6937
6938 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6939 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6940
6941 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6942 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6943
6944 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6945 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6946 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6947
6948 @kindex info record
6949 @item info record
6950 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6951 method:
6952
6953 @table @code
6954 @item full
6955 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6956 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6957
6958 @itemize @bullet
6959 @item
6960 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6961 @item
6962 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6963 @item
6964 Highest recorded instruction number.
6965 @item
6966 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6967 @item
6968 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6969 @item
6970 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6971 @end itemize
6972
6973 @item btrace
6974 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6975
6976 @itemize @bullet
6977 @item
6978 Recording format.
6979 @item
6980 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6981 @item
6982 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6983 instructions.
6984 @item
6985 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6986 @end itemize
6987
6988 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6989 @itemize @bullet
6990 @item
6991 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6992 @end itemize
6993
6994 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6995 @itemize @bullet
6996 @item
6997 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6998 @end itemize
6999 @end table
7000
7001 @kindex record delete
7002 @kindex rec del
7003 @item record delete
7004 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7005 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7006 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7007 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7008
7009 @kindex record instruction-history
7010 @kindex rec instruction-history
7011 @item record instruction-history
7012 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7013 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7014 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7015 are printed in execution order.
7016
7017 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7018 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7019 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7020
7021 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7022 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7023 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7024 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7025 @code{/p} modifier.
7026
7027 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7028 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7029 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7030
7031 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7032 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7033
7034 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7035 disassemble:
7036
7037 @table @code
7038 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7039 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7040 @var{insn}.
7041
7042 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7043 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7044 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7045 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7046 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7047 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7048
7049 @item record instruction-history
7050 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7051
7052 @item record instruction-history -
7053 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7054
7055 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7056 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7057 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7058 number @var{end} is included.
7059 @end table
7060
7061 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7062
7063 @kindex set record
7064 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7065 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7066 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7067 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7068 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7069
7070 @kindex show record
7071 @item show record instruction-history-size
7072 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7073 instruction-history} command.
7074
7075 @kindex record function-call-history
7076 @kindex rec function-call-history
7077 @item record function-call-history
7078 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7079 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7080 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7081 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7082 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7083 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7084 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7085 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7086 given together.
7087
7088 @smallexample
7089 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7090 1 void foo (void)
7091 2 @{
7092 3 @}
7093 4
7094 5 void bar (void)
7095 6 @{
7096 7 ...
7097 8 foo ();
7098 9 ...
7099 10 @}
7100 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7101 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7102 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7103 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7104 @end smallexample
7105
7106 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7107 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7108 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7109 to print:
7110
7111 @table @code
7112 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7113 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7114
7115 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7116 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7117 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7118 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7119 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7120
7121 @item record function-call-history
7122 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7123
7124 @item record function-call-history -
7125 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7126
7127 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7128 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7129 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7130 @end table
7131
7132 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7133
7134 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7135 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7136 Define how many lines to print in the
7137 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7138 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7139
7140 @item show record function-call-history-size
7141 Show how many lines to print in the
7142 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7143 @end table
7144
7145
7146 @node Stack
7147 @chapter Examining the Stack
7148
7149 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7150 stopped and how it got there.
7151
7152 @cindex call stack
7153 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7154 is generated.
7155 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7156 the arguments of the call,
7157 and the local variables of the function being called.
7158 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7159 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7160 stack}.
7161
7162 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7163 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7164
7165 @cindex selected frame
7166 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7167 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7168 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7169 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7170 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7171 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7172
7173 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7174 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7175 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7176
7177 @menu
7178 * Frames:: Stack frames
7179 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7180 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7181 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7182 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7183
7184 @end menu
7185
7186 @node Frames
7187 @section Stack Frames
7188
7189 @cindex frame, definition
7190 @cindex stack frame
7191 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7192 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7193 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7194 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7195 which the function is executing.
7196
7197 @cindex initial frame
7198 @cindex outermost frame
7199 @cindex innermost frame
7200 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7201 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7202 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7203 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7204 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7205 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7206 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7207 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7208
7209 @cindex frame pointer
7210 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7211 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7212 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7213 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7214 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7215 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7216
7217 @cindex frame number
7218 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7219 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7220 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7221 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7222 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7223
7224 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7225 @c underflow problems.
7226 @cindex frameless execution
7227 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7228 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7229 @smallexample
7230 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7231 @end smallexample
7232 generates functions without a frame.)
7233 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7234 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7235 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7236 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7237 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7238 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7239 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7240
7241 @node Backtrace
7242 @section Backtraces
7243
7244 @cindex traceback
7245 @cindex call stack traces
7246 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7247 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7248 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7249 stack.
7250
7251 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7252 @table @code
7253 @kindex backtrace
7254 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7255 @item backtrace
7256 @itemx bt
7257 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7258 frames in the stack.
7259
7260 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7261 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7262
7263 @item backtrace @var{n}
7264 @itemx bt @var{n}
7265 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7266
7267 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7268 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7269 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7270
7271 @item backtrace full
7272 @itemx bt full
7273 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7274 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7275 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7276 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7277
7278 @item backtrace no-filters
7279 @itemx bt no-filters
7280 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7281 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7282 @itemx bt no-filters full
7283 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7284 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7285 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7286 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7287 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7288 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7289 support.
7290 @end table
7291
7292 @kindex where
7293 @kindex info stack
7294 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7295 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7296
7297 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7298 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7299 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7300 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7301 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7302 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7303 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7304 multi-threaded program.
7305
7306 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7307 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7308 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7309 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7310 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7311 line number.
7312
7313 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7314 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7315
7316 @smallexample
7317 @group
7318 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7319 at builtin.c:993
7320 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7321 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7322 at macro.c:71
7323 (More stack frames follow...)
7324 @end group
7325 @end smallexample
7326
7327 @noindent
7328 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7329 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7330 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7331
7332 @noindent
7333 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7334 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7335 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7336 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7337 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7338
7339 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7340 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7341 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7342 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7343 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7344 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7345 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7346 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7347 such a backtrace might look like:
7348
7349 @smallexample
7350 @group
7351 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7352 at builtin.c:993
7353 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7354 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7355 at macro.c:71
7356 (More stack frames follow...)
7357 @end group
7358 @end smallexample
7359
7360 @noindent
7361 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7362 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7363
7364 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7365 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7366 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7367
7368 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7369 @cindex program entry point
7370 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7371 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7372 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7373 @code{main}@footnote{
7374 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7375 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7376 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7377 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7378 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7379 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7380
7381 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7382 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7383
7384 @table @code
7385 @item set backtrace past-main
7386 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7387 @kindex set backtrace
7388 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7389
7390 @item set backtrace past-main off
7391 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7392 default.
7393
7394 @item show backtrace past-main
7395 @kindex show backtrace
7396 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7397
7398 @item set backtrace past-entry
7399 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7400 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7401 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7402 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7403
7404 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7405 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7406 application. This is the default.
7407
7408 @item show backtrace past-entry
7409 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7410
7411 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7412 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7413 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7414 @cindex backtrace limit
7415 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7416 or zero means unlimited levels.
7417
7418 @item show backtrace limit
7419 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7420 @end table
7421
7422 You can control how file names are displayed.
7423
7424 @table @code
7425 @item set filename-display
7426 @itemx set filename-display relative
7427 @cindex filename-display
7428 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7429
7430 @item set filename-display basename
7431 Display only basename of a filename.
7432
7433 @item set filename-display absolute
7434 Display an absolute filename.
7435
7436 @item show filename-display
7437 Show the current way to display filenames.
7438 @end table
7439
7440 @node Selection
7441 @section Selecting a Frame
7442
7443 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7444 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7445 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7446 of the stack frame just selected.
7447
7448 @table @code
7449 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7450 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7451 @item frame @var{n}
7452 @itemx f @var{n}
7453 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7454 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7455 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7456 @code{main}.
7457
7458 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7459 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7460 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7461 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7462 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7463 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7464 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7465 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7466
7467 @kindex up
7468 @item up @var{n}
7469 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7470 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7471 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7472
7473 @kindex down
7474 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7475 @item down @var{n}
7476 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7477 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7478 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7479 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7480 @end table
7481
7482 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7483 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7484 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7485 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7486
7487 @need 1000
7488 For example:
7489
7490 @smallexample
7491 @group
7492 (@value{GDBP}) up
7493 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7494 at env.c:10
7495 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7496 @end group
7497 @end smallexample
7498
7499 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7500 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7501 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7502 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7503 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7504 for details.
7505
7506 @table @code
7507 @kindex select-frame
7508 @item select-frame
7509 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7510 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7511 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7512 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7513
7514 @kindex down-silently
7515 @kindex up-silently
7516 @item up-silently @var{n}
7517 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7518 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7519 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7520 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7521 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7522 distracting.
7523 @end table
7524
7525 @node Frame Info
7526 @section Information About a Frame
7527
7528 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7529 stack frame.
7530
7531 @table @code
7532 @item frame
7533 @itemx f
7534 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7535 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7536 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7537 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7538 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7539
7540 @kindex info frame
7541 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7542 @item info frame
7543 @itemx info f
7544 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7545 including:
7546
7547 @itemize @bullet
7548 @item
7549 the address of the frame
7550 @item
7551 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7552 @item
7553 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7554 @item
7555 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7556 @item
7557 the address of the frame's arguments
7558 @item
7559 the address of the frame's local variables
7560 @item
7561 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7562 @item
7563 which registers were saved in the frame
7564 @end itemize
7565
7566 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7567 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7568 the usual conventions.
7569
7570 @item info frame @var{addr}
7571 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7572 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7573 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7574 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7575 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7576 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7577
7578 @kindex info args
7579 @item info args
7580 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7581
7582 @item info locals
7583 @kindex info locals
7584 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7585 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7586 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7587
7588 @end table
7589
7590 @node Frame Filter Management
7591 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7592 @cindex managing frame filters
7593
7594 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7595 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7596
7597 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7598 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7599
7600 @table @code
7601 @kindex info frame-filter
7602 @item info frame-filter
7603 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7604 their name, priority and enabled status.
7605
7606 @kindex disable frame-filter
7607 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7608 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7609 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7610 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7611 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7612 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7613 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7614 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7615 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7616 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7617 may be enabled again later.
7618
7619 @kindex enable frame-filter
7620 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7621 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7622 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7623 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7624 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7625 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7626 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7627 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7628 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7629
7630 Example:
7631
7632 @smallexample
7633 (gdb) info frame-filter
7634
7635 global frame-filters:
7636 Priority Enabled Name
7637 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7638 100 Yes Reverse
7639
7640 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7641 Priority Enabled Name
7642 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7643
7644 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7645 Priority Enabled Name
7646 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7647
7648 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7649 (gdb) info frame-filter
7650
7651 global frame-filters:
7652 Priority Enabled Name
7653 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7654 100 Yes Reverse
7655
7656 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7657 Priority Enabled Name
7658 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7659
7660 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7661 Priority Enabled Name
7662 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7663
7664 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7665 (gdb) info frame-filter
7666
7667 global frame-filters:
7668 Priority Enabled Name
7669 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7670 100 Yes Reverse
7671
7672 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7673 Priority Enabled Name
7674 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7675
7676 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7677 Priority Enabled Name
7678 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7679 @end smallexample
7680
7681 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7682 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7683 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7684 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7685 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7686 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7687 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7688
7689 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7690 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7691 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7692 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7693 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7694 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7695 dictionary resides.
7696
7697 Example:
7698
7699 @smallexample
7700 (gdb) info frame-filter
7701
7702 global frame-filters:
7703 Priority Enabled Name
7704 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7705 100 Yes Reverse
7706
7707 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7708 Priority Enabled Name
7709 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7710
7711 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7712 Priority Enabled Name
7713 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7714
7715 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7716 (gdb) info frame-filter
7717
7718 global frame-filters:
7719 Priority Enabled Name
7720 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7721 50 Yes Reverse
7722
7723 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7724 Priority Enabled Name
7725 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7726
7727 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7728 Priority Enabled Name
7729 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7730 @end smallexample
7731 @end table
7732
7733 @node Source
7734 @chapter Examining Source Files
7735
7736 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7737 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7738 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7739 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7740 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7741 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7742 source files by explicit command.
7743
7744 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7745 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7746 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7747
7748 @menu
7749 * List:: Printing source lines
7750 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7751 * Edit:: Editing source files
7752 * Search:: Searching source files
7753 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7754 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7755 @end menu
7756
7757 @node List
7758 @section Printing Source Lines
7759
7760 @kindex list
7761 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7762 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7763 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7764 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7765 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7766
7767 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7768
7769 @table @code
7770 @item list @var{linenum}
7771 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7772 current source file.
7773
7774 @item list @var{function}
7775 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7776 @var{function}.
7777
7778 @item list
7779 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7780 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7781 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7782 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7783 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7784
7785 @item list -
7786 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7787 @end table
7788
7789 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7790 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7791 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7792
7793 @table @code
7794 @kindex set listsize
7795 @item set listsize @var{count}
7796 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7797 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7798 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7799 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7800
7801 @kindex show listsize
7802 @item show listsize
7803 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7804 @end table
7805
7806 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7807 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7808 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7809 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7810 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7811
7812 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7813 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7814 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7815 to specify some source line.
7816
7817 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7818
7819 @table @code
7820 @item list @var{location}
7821 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7822
7823 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7824 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7825 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7826 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7827 the same source file as the first location.
7828
7829 @item list ,@var{last}
7830 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7831
7832 @item list @var{first},
7833 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7834
7835 @item list +
7836 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7837
7838 @item list -
7839 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7840
7841 @item list
7842 As described in the preceding table.
7843 @end table
7844
7845 @node Specify Location
7846 @section Specifying a Location
7847 @cindex specifying location
7848 @cindex location
7849 @cindex source location
7850
7851 @menu
7852 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7853 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7854 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7855 @end menu
7856
7857 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7858 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7859 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7860 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7861 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7862
7863 @node Linespec Locations
7864 @subsection Linespec Locations
7865 @cindex linespec locations
7866
7867 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7868 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7869 specifying a linespec:
7870
7871 @table @code
7872 @item @var{linenum}
7873 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7874
7875 @item -@var{offset}
7876 @itemx +@var{offset}
7877 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7878 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7879 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7880 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7881 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7882 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7883 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7884 linespec.
7885
7886 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7887 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7888 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7889 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7890 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7891 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7892 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7893
7894 @item @var{function}
7895 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7896 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7897
7898 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7899 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7900
7901 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7902 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7903 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7904 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7905 functions in different source files.
7906
7907 @item @var{label}
7908 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7909 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7910 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7911 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7912
7913 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7914 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7915 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7916 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7917 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7918 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7919
7920 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7921 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7922 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7923 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7924 each one of those probes.
7925 @end table
7926
7927 @node Explicit Locations
7928 @subsection Explicit Locations
7929 @cindex explicit locations
7930
7931 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7932 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7933
7934 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7935 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7936 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7937 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7938 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7939
7940 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7941 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7942 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7943 the symbol table to know.
7944
7945 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7946 following table:
7947
7948 @table @code
7949 @item -source @var{filename}
7950 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7951 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7952 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7953 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7954 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7955
7956 @item -function @var{function}
7957 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7958 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7959 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7960 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7961
7962 @item -label @var{label}
7963 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7964 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7965 selected stack frame.
7966
7967 @item -line @var{number}
7968 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7969 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7970 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7971 relative to the current line.
7972 @end table
7973
7974 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7975 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7976
7977 @node Address Locations
7978 @subsection Address Locations
7979 @cindex address locations
7980
7981 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7982 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7983
7984 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7985 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7986 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7987 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7988 source files.
7989
7990 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7991 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7992 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7993 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7994 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7995 of @var{address}:
7996
7997 @table @code
7998 @item @var{expression}
7999 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8000
8001 @item @var{funcaddr}
8002 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8003 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8004 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8005 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8006 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8007 (although the Pascal form also works).
8008
8009 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8010 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8011
8012 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8013 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8014 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8015 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8016 functions with identical names in different source files.
8017 @end table
8018
8019 @node Edit
8020 @section Editing Source Files
8021 @cindex editing source files
8022
8023 @kindex edit
8024 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8025 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8026 The editing program of your choice
8027 is invoked with the current line set to
8028 the active line in the program.
8029 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8030 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8031
8032 @table @code
8033 @item edit @var{location}
8034 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8035 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8036 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8037 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8038 command most commonly used:
8039
8040 @table @code
8041 @item edit @var{number}
8042 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8043
8044 @item edit @var{function}
8045 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8046 @end table
8047
8048 @end table
8049
8050 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8051 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8052 @footnote{
8053 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8054 following command-line syntax:
8055 @smallexample
8056 ex +@var{number} file
8057 @end smallexample
8058 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8059 the file where to start editing.}.
8060 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8061 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8062 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8063 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8064 @smallexample
8065 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8066 export EDITOR
8067 gdb @dots{}
8068 @end smallexample
8069 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8070 @smallexample
8071 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8072 gdb @dots{}
8073 @end smallexample
8074
8075 @node Search
8076 @section Searching Source Files
8077 @cindex searching source files
8078
8079 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8080 regular expression.
8081
8082 @table @code
8083 @kindex search
8084 @kindex forward-search
8085 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8086 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8087 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8088 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8089 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8090 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8091 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8092 @code{fo}.
8093
8094 @kindex reverse-search
8095 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8096 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8097 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8098 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8099 this command as @code{rev}.
8100 @end table
8101
8102 @node Source Path
8103 @section Specifying Source Directories
8104
8105 @cindex source path
8106 @cindex directories for source files
8107 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8108 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8109 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8110 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8111 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8112 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8113 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8114
8115 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8116 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8117 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8118 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8119 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8120 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8121 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8122 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8123 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8124 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8125 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8126
8127 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8128 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8129 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8130 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8131 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8132 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8133
8134 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8135 source files.
8136
8137 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8138 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8139 each line is in the file.
8140
8141 @kindex directory
8142 @kindex dir
8143 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8144 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8145 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8146
8147 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8148 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8149
8150 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8151 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8152 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8153 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8154 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8155 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8156 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8157 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8158 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8159 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8160 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8161 name to look up the sources.
8162
8163 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8164 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8165 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8166 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8167 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8168 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8169 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8170 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8171
8172 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8173 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8174 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8175 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8176 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8177 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8178 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8179
8180 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8181 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8182 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8183 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8184 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8185 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8186 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8187 command.
8188
8189 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8190 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8191 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8192 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8193 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8194 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8195 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8196
8197 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8198 @cindex default source path substitution
8199 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8200 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8201 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8202 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8203 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8204 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8205 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8206 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8207 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8208 together.
8209
8210 @table @code
8211 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8212 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8213 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8214 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8215 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8216 part of absolute file names) or
8217 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8218 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8219
8220 @kindex cdir
8221 @kindex cwd
8222 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8223 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8224 @cindex compilation directory
8225 @cindex current directory
8226 @cindex working directory
8227 @cindex directory, current
8228 @cindex directory, compilation
8229 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8230 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8231 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8232 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8233 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8234 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8235
8236 @item directory
8237 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8238
8239 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8240 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8241
8242 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8243 @kindex set directories
8244 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8245 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8246
8247 @item show directories
8248 @kindex show directories
8249 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8250
8251 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8252 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8253 @kindex set substitute-path
8254 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8255 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8256 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8257
8258 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8259 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8260
8261 @smallexample
8262 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8263 @end smallexample
8264
8265 @noindent
8266 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8267 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8268 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8269
8270 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8271 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8272 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8273 the substitution.
8274
8275 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8276
8277 @smallexample
8278 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8279 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8280 @end smallexample
8281
8282 @noindent
8283 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8284 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8285 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8286 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8287
8288
8289 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8290 @kindex unset substitute-path
8291 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8292 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8293 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8294
8295 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8296
8297 @item show substitute-path [path]
8298 @kindex show substitute-path
8299 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8300 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8301
8302 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8303 rules.
8304
8305 @end table
8306
8307 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8308 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8309 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8310
8311 @enumerate
8312 @item
8313 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8314
8315 @item
8316 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8317 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8318 directories in one command.
8319 @end enumerate
8320
8321 @node Machine Code
8322 @section Source and Machine Code
8323 @cindex source line and its code address
8324
8325 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8326 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8327 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8328 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8329 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8330 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8331 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8332 well as hex.
8333
8334 @table @code
8335 @kindex info line
8336 @item info line @var{location}
8337 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8338 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8339 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8340 @end table
8341
8342 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8343 the object code for the first line of function
8344 @code{m4_changequote}:
8345
8346 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8347 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8348 @smallexample
8349 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8350 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8351 @end smallexample
8352
8353 @noindent
8354 @cindex code address and its source line
8355 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8356 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8357 @smallexample
8358 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8359 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8360 @end smallexample
8361
8362 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8363 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8364 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8365 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8366 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8367 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8368 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8369 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8370 Variables}).
8371
8372 @table @code
8373 @kindex disassemble
8374 @cindex assembly instructions
8375 @cindex instructions, assembly
8376 @cindex machine instructions
8377 @cindex listing machine instructions
8378 @item disassemble
8379 @itemx disassemble /m
8380 @itemx disassemble /s
8381 @itemx disassemble /r
8382 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8383 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8384 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8385 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8386 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8387 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8388 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8389 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8390 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8391 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8392
8393 @table @code
8394 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8395 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8396 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8397 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8398 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8399 @end table
8400
8401 @noindent
8402 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8403 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8404
8405 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8406 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8407
8408 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8409 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8410 @end table
8411
8412 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8413 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8414
8415 @smallexample
8416 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8417 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8418 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8419 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8420 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8421 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8422 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8423 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8424 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8425 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8426 End of assembler dump.
8427 @end smallexample
8428
8429 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8430 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8431 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8432
8433 @smallexample
8434 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8435 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8436 5 @{
8437 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8438 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8439 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8440 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8441 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8442
8443 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8444 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8445 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8446
8447 7 return 0;
8448 8 @}
8449 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8450 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8451 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8452
8453 End of assembler dump.
8454 @end smallexample
8455
8456 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8457 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8458 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8459 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8460 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8461 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8462 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8463 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8464 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8465
8466 @file{foo.h}:
8467
8468 @smallexample
8469 int
8470 foo (int a)
8471 @{
8472 if (a < 0)
8473 return a * 2;
8474 if (a == 0)
8475 return 1;
8476 return a + 10;
8477 @}
8478 @end smallexample
8479
8480 @file{foo.c}:
8481
8482 @smallexample
8483 #include "foo.h"
8484 volatile int x, y;
8485 int
8486 main ()
8487 @{
8488 x = foo (y);
8489 return 0;
8490 @}
8491 @end smallexample
8492
8493 @smallexample
8494 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8495 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8496 5 @{
8497
8498 6 x = foo (y);
8499 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8500 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8501
8502 7 return 0;
8503 8 @}
8504 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8505 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8506 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8507 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8508
8509 End of assembler dump.
8510 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8511 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8512 foo.c:
8513 5 @{
8514 6 x = foo (y);
8515 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8516
8517 foo.h:
8518 4 if (a < 0)
8519 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8520 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8521
8522 6 if (a == 0)
8523 7 return 1;
8524 8 return a + 10;
8525 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8526 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8527 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8528 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8529
8530 foo.c:
8531 6 x = foo (y);
8532 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8533
8534 7 return 0;
8535 8 @}
8536 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8537 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8538
8539 foo.h:
8540 5 return a * 2;
8541 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8542 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8543 End of assembler dump.
8544 @end smallexample
8545
8546 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8547
8548 @smallexample
8549 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8550 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8551 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8552 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8553 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8554 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8555 End of assembler dump.
8556 @end smallexample
8557
8558 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8559 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8560 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8561 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8562
8563 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8564 mnemonics or other syntax.
8565
8566 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8567 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8568 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8569 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8570 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8571
8572 @table @code
8573 @kindex set disassembler-options
8574 @cindex disassembler options
8575 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8576 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8577 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8578 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8579 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8580 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8581 The default value is the empty string.
8582
8583 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8584 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8585 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8586 and S/390.
8587
8588 @kindex show disassembler-options
8589 @item show disassembler-options
8590 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8591 @end table
8592
8593 @table @code
8594 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8595 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8596 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8597 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8598 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8599 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8600
8601 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8602 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8603 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8604 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8605
8606 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8607 @item show disassembly-flavor
8608 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8609 @end table
8610
8611 @table @code
8612 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8613 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8614 @item set disassemble-next-line
8615 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8616 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8617 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8618 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8619 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8620 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8621 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8622 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8623 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8624 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8625 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8626 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8627 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8628 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8629 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8630 instruction.
8631 @end table
8632
8633
8634 @node Data
8635 @chapter Examining Data
8636
8637 @cindex printing data
8638 @cindex examining data
8639 @kindex print
8640 @kindex inspect
8641 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8642 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8643 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8644 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8645 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8646 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8647
8648 @table @code
8649 @item print @var{expr}
8650 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8651 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8652 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8653 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8654 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8655 Formats}.
8656
8657 @item print
8658 @itemx print /@var{f}
8659 @cindex reprint the last value
8660 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8661 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8662 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8663 @end table
8664
8665 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8666 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8667 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8668
8669 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8670 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8671 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8672 Table}.
8673
8674 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8675 @kindex explore
8676 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8677 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8678 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8679 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8680 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8681 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8682 embedded in the higher level data types.
8683
8684 @table @code
8685 @item explore @var{arg}
8686 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8687 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8688 @end table
8689
8690 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8691 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8692 C program as
8693
8694 @smallexample
8695 struct SimpleStruct
8696 @{
8697 int i;
8698 double d;
8699 @};
8700
8701 struct ComplexStruct
8702 @{
8703 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8704 int arr[10];
8705 @};
8706 @end smallexample
8707
8708 @noindent
8709 followed by variable declarations as
8710
8711 @smallexample
8712 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8713 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8714 @end smallexample
8715
8716 @noindent
8717 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8718 @code{explore} command as follows.
8719
8720 @smallexample
8721 (gdb) explore cs
8722 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8723 the following fields:
8724
8725 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8726 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8727
8728 Enter the field number of choice:
8729 @end smallexample
8730
8731 @noindent
8732 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8733 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8734 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8735 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8736 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8737 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8738 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8739 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8740
8741 @smallexample
8742 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8743 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8744 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8745 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8746
8747 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8748 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8749
8750 Press enter to return to parent value:
8751 @end smallexample
8752
8753 @noindent
8754 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8755 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8756 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8757 to explore.
8758
8759 @smallexample
8760 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8761 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8762
8763 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8764
8765 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8766
8767 Press enter to return to parent value:
8768 @end smallexample
8769
8770 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8771 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8772 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8773 level data structure).
8774
8775 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8776 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8777 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8778 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8779 same example as above, your can explore the type
8780 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8781 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8782
8783 @smallexample
8784 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8785 @end smallexample
8786
8787 @noindent
8788 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8789 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8790 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8791 example.
8792
8793 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8794 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8795 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8796 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8797 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8798
8799 @table @code
8800 @item explore value @var{expr}
8801 @cindex explore value
8802 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8803 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8804 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8805 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8806 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8807
8808 @item explore type @var{arg}
8809 @cindex explore type
8810 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8811 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8812 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8813 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8814 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8815 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8816 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8817 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8818 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8819 @end table
8820
8821 @menu
8822 * Expressions:: Expressions
8823 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8824 * Variables:: Program variables
8825 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8826 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8827 * Memory:: Examining memory
8828 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8829 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8830 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8831 * Value History:: Value history
8832 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8833 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8834 * Registers:: Registers
8835 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8836 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8837 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8838 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8839 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8840 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8841 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8842 character set than GDB does
8843 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8844 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8845 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8846 @end menu
8847
8848 @node Expressions
8849 @section Expressions
8850
8851 @cindex expressions
8852 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8853 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8854 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8855 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8856 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8857 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8858 @ref{Compilation}.
8859
8860 @cindex arrays in expressions
8861 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8862 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8863 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8864 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8865 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8866 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8867
8868 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8869 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8870 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8871 languages.
8872
8873 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8874 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8875
8876 @cindex casts, in expressions
8877 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8878 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8879 at that address in memory.
8880 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8881
8882 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8883 to programming languages:
8884
8885 @table @code
8886 @item @@
8887 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8888 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8889
8890 @item ::
8891 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8892 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8893
8894 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8895 @cindex type casting memory
8896 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8897 @cindex casts, to view memory
8898 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8899 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8900 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8901 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8902 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8903 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8904 @end table
8905
8906 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8907 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8908 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8909
8910 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8911 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8912 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8913 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8914 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8915 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8916 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8917
8918 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8919 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8920 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8921 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8922 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8923 as well.
8924
8925 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8926 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8927 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8928 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8929 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8930 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8931 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8932 choices.
8933
8934 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8935 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8936 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8937
8938 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8939 @smallexample
8940 @group
8941 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8942 [0] cancel
8943 [1] all
8944 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8945 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8946 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8947 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8948 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8949 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8950 > 2 4 6
8951 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8952 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8953 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8954 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8955 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8956 breakpoints.
8957 (@value{GDBP})
8958 @end group
8959 @end smallexample
8960
8961 @table @code
8962 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8963 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8964 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8965
8966 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8967 is ambiguous.
8968
8969 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8970 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8971 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8972 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8973 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8974 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8975 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8976 in the use of the menu.
8977
8978 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8979 when an ambiguity is detected.
8980
8981 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8982 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8983
8984 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8985 @item show multiple-symbols
8986 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8987 @end table
8988
8989 @node Variables
8990 @section Program Variables
8991
8992 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8993 in your program.
8994
8995 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8996 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8997
8998 @itemize @bullet
8999 @item
9000 global (or file-static)
9001 @end itemize
9002
9003 @noindent or
9004
9005 @itemize @bullet
9006 @item
9007 visible according to the scope rules of the
9008 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9009 @end itemize
9010
9011 @noindent This means that in the function
9012
9013 @smallexample
9014 foo (a)
9015 int a;
9016 @{
9017 bar (a);
9018 @{
9019 int b = test ();
9020 bar (b);
9021 @}
9022 @}
9023 @end smallexample
9024
9025 @noindent
9026 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9027 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9028 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9029 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9030
9031 @cindex variable name conflict
9032 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9033 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9034 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9035 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9036 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9037 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9038 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9039
9040 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9041 @ifnotinfo
9042 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9043 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9044 @end ifnotinfo
9045 @smallexample
9046 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9047 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9048 @end smallexample
9049
9050 @noindent
9051 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9052 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9053 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9054 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9055
9056 @smallexample
9057 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9058 @end smallexample
9059
9060 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9061 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9062 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9063 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9064 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9065
9066 @smallexample
9067 void
9068 foo (int a)
9069 @{
9070 if (a < 10)
9071 bar (a);
9072 else
9073 process (a); /* Stop here */
9074 @}
9075
9076 int
9077 bar (int a)
9078 @{
9079 foo (a + 5);
9080 @}
9081 @end smallexample
9082
9083 @noindent
9084 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9085 here is what you might see
9086 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9087
9088 @smallexample
9089 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9090 $1 = 10
9091 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9092 $2 = 5
9093 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9094 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9095 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9096 $3 = 5
9097 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9098 $4 = 0
9099 @end smallexample
9100
9101 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9102 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9103 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9104 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9105 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9106
9107 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9108 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9109 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9110 @code{some_global}.
9111
9112 @smallexample
9113 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9114 $1 = 23
9115 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9116 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9117 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9118 $2 = 27
9119 @end smallexample
9120
9121 @cindex wrong values
9122 @cindex variable values, wrong
9123 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9124 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9125 @quotation
9126 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9127 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9128 scope, and just before exit.
9129 @end quotation
9130 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9131 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9132 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9133 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9134 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9135 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9136 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9137 variable definitions may be gone.
9138
9139 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9140 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9141 when compiling.
9142
9143 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9144 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9145 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9146 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9147 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9148 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9149 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9150
9151 @smallexample
9152 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9153 @end smallexample
9154
9155 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9156 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9157 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9158 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9159 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9160
9161 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9162 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9163 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9164 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9165
9166 @cindex no debug info variables
9167 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9168 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9169 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9170 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9171 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9172 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9173 example, in a C program:
9174
9175 @smallexample
9176 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9177 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9178 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9179 $1 = 3.14
9180 @end smallexample
9181
9182 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9183 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9184 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9185 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9186 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9187
9188 @smallexample
9189 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9190 29 i++;
9191 (gdb) next
9192 30 e (i);
9193 (gdb) print i
9194 $1 = 31
9195 (gdb) print i@@entry
9196 $2 = 30
9197 @end smallexample
9198
9199 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9200 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9201 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9202 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9203 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9204 For program code
9205
9206 @smallexample
9207 char var0[] = "A";
9208 signed char var1[] = "A";
9209 @end smallexample
9210
9211 You get during debugging
9212 @smallexample
9213 (gdb) print var0
9214 $1 = "A"
9215 (gdb) print var1
9216 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9217 @end smallexample
9218
9219 @node Arrays
9220 @section Artificial Arrays
9221
9222 @cindex artificial array
9223 @cindex arrays
9224 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9225 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9226 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9227 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9228 program.
9229
9230 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9231 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9232 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9233 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9234 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9235 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9236 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9237 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9238 example. If a program says
9239
9240 @smallexample
9241 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9242 @end smallexample
9243
9244 @noindent
9245 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9246
9247 @smallexample
9248 p *array@@len
9249 @end smallexample
9250
9251 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9252 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9253 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9254 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9255 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9256
9257 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9258 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9259 The value need not be in memory:
9260 @smallexample
9261 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9262 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9263 @end smallexample
9264
9265 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9266 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9267 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9268 @smallexample
9269 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9270 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9271 @end smallexample
9272
9273 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9274 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9275 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9276 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9277 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9278 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9279 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9280 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9281 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9282 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9283
9284 @smallexample
9285 set $i = 0
9286 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9287 @key{RET}
9288 @key{RET}
9289 @dots{}
9290 @end smallexample
9291
9292 @node Output Formats
9293 @section Output Formats
9294
9295 @cindex formatted output
9296 @cindex output formats
9297 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9298 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9299 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9300 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9301 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9302
9303 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9304 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9305 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9306 letters supported are:
9307
9308 @table @code
9309 @item x
9310 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9311 hexadecimal.
9312
9313 @item d
9314 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9315
9316 @item u
9317 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9318
9319 @item o
9320 Print as integer in octal.
9321
9322 @item t
9323 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9324 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9325 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9326 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9327
9328 @item a
9329 @cindex unknown address, locating
9330 @cindex locate address
9331 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9332 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9333 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9334
9335 @smallexample
9336 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9337 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9338 @end smallexample
9339
9340 @noindent
9341 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9342 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9343
9344 @item c
9345 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9346 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9347 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9348 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9349
9350 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9351 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9352 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9353 data.
9354
9355 @item f
9356 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9357 using typical floating point syntax.
9358
9359 @item s
9360 @cindex printing strings
9361 @cindex printing byte arrays
9362 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9363 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9364 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9365 natural types.
9366
9367 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9368 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9369 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9370 array.
9371
9372 @item z
9373 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9374 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9375 to the size of the integer type.
9376
9377 @item r
9378 @cindex raw printing
9379 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9380 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9381 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9382 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9383 pretty-printer which might exist.
9384 @end table
9385
9386 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9387
9388 @smallexample
9389 p/x $pc
9390 @end smallexample
9391
9392 @noindent
9393 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9394 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9395
9396 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9397 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9398 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9399
9400 @node Memory
9401 @section Examining Memory
9402
9403 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9404 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9405
9406 @cindex examining memory
9407 @table @code
9408 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9409 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9410 @itemx x @var{addr}
9411 @itemx x
9412 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9413 @end table
9414
9415 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9416 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9417 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9418 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9419 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9420
9421 @table @r
9422 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9423 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9424 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9425 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9426 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9427 @c 4.1.2.
9428
9429 @item @var{f}, the display format
9430 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9431 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9432 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9433 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9434 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9435
9436 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9437 The unit size is any of
9438
9439 @table @code
9440 @item b
9441 Bytes.
9442 @item h
9443 Halfwords (two bytes).
9444 @item w
9445 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9446 @item g
9447 Giant words (eight bytes).
9448 @end table
9449
9450 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9451 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9452 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9453 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9454 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9455 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9456 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9457 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9458 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9459 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9460 be altered.
9461
9462 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9463 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9464 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9465 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9466 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9467 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9468 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9469 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9470 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9471 a value from memory).
9472 @end table
9473
9474 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9475 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9476 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9477 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9478 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9479
9480 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9481 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9482 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9483
9484 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9485 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9486 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9487 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9488 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9489
9490 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9491 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9492 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9493 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9494 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9495 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9496 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9497 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9498 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9499
9500 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9501 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9502 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9503 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9504 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9505 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9506
9507 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9508 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9509 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9510 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9511 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9512 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9513 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9514
9515 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9516 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9517
9518 @smallexample
9519 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9520 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9521 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9522 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9523 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9524 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9525 @end smallexample
9526
9527 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9528 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9529 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9530 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9531 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9532 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9533 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9534 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9535 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9536
9537 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9538 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9539 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9540
9541 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9542 @cindex addressable memory unit
9543 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9544 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9545 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9546 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9547 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9548 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9549 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9550 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9551 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9552
9553 @cindex remote memory comparison
9554 @cindex target memory comparison
9555 @cindex verify remote memory image
9556 @cindex verify target memory image
9557 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9558 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9559 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9560 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9561 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9562 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9563
9564 @table @code
9565 @kindex compare-sections
9566 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9567 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9568 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9569 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9570 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9571 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9572
9573 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9574 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9575 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9576 @end table
9577
9578 @node Auto Display
9579 @section Automatic Display
9580 @cindex automatic display
9581 @cindex display of expressions
9582
9583 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9584 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9585 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9586 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9587 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9588 The automatic display looks like this:
9589
9590 @smallexample
9591 2: foo = 38
9592 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9593 @end smallexample
9594
9595 @noindent
9596 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9597 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9598 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9599 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9600 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9601 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9602
9603 @table @code
9604 @kindex display
9605 @item display @var{expr}
9606 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9607 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9608
9609 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9610
9611 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9612 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9613 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9614 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9615 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9616
9617 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9618 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9619 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9620 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9621 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9622 @end table
9623
9624 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9625 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9626 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9627
9628 @table @code
9629 @kindex delete display
9630 @kindex undisplay
9631 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9632 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9633 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9634 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9635 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9636 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9637 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9638
9639 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9640 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9641
9642 @kindex disable display
9643 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9644 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9645 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9646 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9647 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9648 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9649 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9650 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9651
9652 @kindex enable display
9653 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9654 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9655 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9656 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9657 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9658 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9659 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9660
9661 @item display
9662 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9663 done when your program stops.
9664
9665 @kindex info display
9666 @item info display
9667 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9668 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9669 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9670 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9671 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9672 @end table
9673
9674 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9675 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9676 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9677 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9678 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9679 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9680 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9681 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9682 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9683 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9684 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9685
9686 @node Print Settings
9687 @section Print Settings
9688
9689 @cindex format options
9690 @cindex print settings
9691 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9692 and symbols are printed.
9693
9694 @noindent
9695 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9696
9697 @table @code
9698 @kindex set print
9699 @item set print address
9700 @itemx set print address on
9701 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9702 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9703 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9704 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9705 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9706 @code{set print address on}:
9707
9708 @smallexample
9709 @group
9710 (@value{GDBP}) f
9711 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9712 at input.c:530
9713 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9714 @end group
9715 @end smallexample
9716
9717 @item set print address off
9718 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9719 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9720
9721 @smallexample
9722 @group
9723 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9724 (@value{GDBP}) f
9725 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9726 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9727 @end group
9728 @end smallexample
9729
9730 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9731 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9732 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9733 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9734
9735 @kindex show print
9736 @item show print address
9737 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9738 @end table
9739
9740 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9741 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9742 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9743 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9744 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9745 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9746 it prints a symbolic address:
9747
9748 @table @code
9749 @item set print symbol-filename on
9750 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9751 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9752 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9753 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9754
9755 @item set print symbol-filename off
9756 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9757 default.
9758
9759 @item show print symbol-filename
9760 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9761 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9762 @end table
9763
9764 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9765 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9766 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9767
9768 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9769 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9770
9771 @table @code
9772 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9773 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9774 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9775 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9776 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9777 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9778 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9779 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9780
9781 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9782 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9783 symbolic address.
9784 @end table
9785
9786 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9787 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9788 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9789 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9790 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9791 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9792 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9793 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9794
9795 @smallexample
9796 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9797 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9798 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9799 @end smallexample
9800
9801 @quotation
9802 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9803 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9804 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9805 @end quotation
9806
9807 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9808 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9809
9810 @table @code
9811 @item set print symbol on
9812 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9813 one exists.
9814
9815 @item set print symbol off
9816 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9817 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9818 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9819
9820 @item show print symbol
9821 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9822 address.
9823 @end table
9824
9825 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9826
9827 @table @code
9828 @item set print array
9829 @itemx set print array on
9830 @cindex pretty print arrays
9831 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9832 but uses more space. The default is off.
9833
9834 @item set print array off
9835 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9836
9837 @item show print array
9838 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9839 arrays.
9840
9841 @cindex print array indexes
9842 @item set print array-indexes
9843 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9844 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9845 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9846 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9847
9848 @item set print array-indexes off
9849 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9850
9851 @item show print array-indexes
9852 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9853 arrays.
9854
9855 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9856 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9857 @cindex number of array elements to print
9858 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9859 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9860 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9861 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9862 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9863 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9864 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9865 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9866
9867 @item show print elements
9868 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9869 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9870
9871 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9872 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9873 @cindex printing frame argument values
9874 @cindex print all frame argument values
9875 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9876 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9877 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9878 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9879 values are:
9880
9881 @table @code
9882 @item all
9883 The values of all arguments are printed.
9884
9885 @item scalars
9886 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9887 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9888 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9889 only scalar arguments are shown:
9890
9891 @smallexample
9892 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9893 at frame-args.c:23
9894 @end smallexample
9895
9896 @item none
9897 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9898 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9899
9900 @smallexample
9901 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9902 at frame-args.c:23
9903 @end smallexample
9904 @end table
9905
9906 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9907 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9908 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9909 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9910 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9911 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9912 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9913 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9914 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9915 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9916
9917 @item show print frame-arguments
9918 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9919
9920 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9921 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9922
9923 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9924 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9925 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9926 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9927 This is the default.
9928
9929 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9930 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9931
9932 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9933 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9934 @kindex set print entry-values
9935 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9936 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9937 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9938 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9939 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9940
9941 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9942 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9943 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9944 @code{no} setting.
9945
9946 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9947 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
9948 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9949 this information.
9950
9951 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9952
9953 @table @code
9954 @item no
9955 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9956 point.
9957 @smallexample
9958 #0 equal (val=5)
9959 #0 different (val=6)
9960 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9961 #0 born (val=10)
9962 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @item only
9966 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9967 values are never printed.
9968 @smallexample
9969 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9970 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9971 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9972 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9973 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9974 @end smallexample
9975
9976 @item preferred
9977 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9978 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9979 value for such parameter.
9980 @smallexample
9981 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9982 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9983 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9984 #0 born (val=10)
9985 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9986 @end smallexample
9987
9988 @item if-needed
9989 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9990 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9991 parameter.
9992 @smallexample
9993 #0 equal (val=5)
9994 #0 different (val=6)
9995 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9996 #0 born (val=10)
9997 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9998 @end smallexample
9999
10000 @item both
10001 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10002 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10003 optimizations.
10004 @smallexample
10005 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10006 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10007 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10008 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10009 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10010 @end smallexample
10011
10012 @item compact
10013 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10014 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10015 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10016 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10017 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10018 @smallexample
10019 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10020 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10021 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10022 #0 born (val=10)
10023 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10024 @end smallexample
10025
10026 @item default
10027 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10028 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10029 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10030 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10031 @smallexample
10032 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10033 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10034 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10035 #0 born (val=10)
10036 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10037 @end smallexample
10038 @end table
10039
10040 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10041 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10042
10043 @item show print entry-values
10044 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10045 entry.
10046
10047 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10048 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10049 @cindex repeated array elements
10050 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10051 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10052 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10053 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10054 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10055 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10056 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10057 is 10.
10058
10059 @item show print repeats
10060 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10061 elements.
10062
10063 @item set print null-stop
10064 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10065 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10066 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10067 contain only short strings.
10068 The default is off.
10069
10070 @item show print null-stop
10071 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10072 @sc{null} character.
10073
10074 @item set print pretty on
10075 @cindex print structures in indented form
10076 @cindex indentation in structure display
10077 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10078 per line, like this:
10079
10080 @smallexample
10081 @group
10082 $1 = @{
10083 next = 0x0,
10084 flags = @{
10085 sweet = 1,
10086 sour = 1
10087 @},
10088 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10089 @}
10090 @end group
10091 @end smallexample
10092
10093 @item set print pretty off
10094 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10095
10096 @smallexample
10097 @group
10098 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10099 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10100 @end group
10101 @end smallexample
10102
10103 @noindent
10104 This is the default format.
10105
10106 @item show print pretty
10107 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10108
10109 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10110 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10111 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10112 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10113 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10114 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10115 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10116 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10117
10118 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10119 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10120 international character sets, and is the default.
10121
10122 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10123 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10124
10125 @item set print union on
10126 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10127 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10128 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10129
10130 @item set print union off
10131 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10132 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10133 instead.
10134
10135 @item show print union
10136 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10137 structures and other unions.
10138
10139 For example, given the declarations
10140
10141 @smallexample
10142 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10143 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10144 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10145 Bug_forms;
10146
10147 struct thing @{
10148 Species it;
10149 union @{
10150 Tree_forms tree;
10151 Bug_forms bug;
10152 @} form;
10153 @};
10154
10155 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10156 @end smallexample
10157
10158 @noindent
10159 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10160
10161 @smallexample
10162 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10163 @end smallexample
10164
10165 @noindent
10166 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10167
10168 @smallexample
10169 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10170 @end smallexample
10171
10172 @noindent
10173 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10174 and in Pascal.
10175 @end table
10176
10177 @need 1000
10178 @noindent
10179 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10180
10181 @table @code
10182 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10183 @item set print demangle
10184 @itemx set print demangle on
10185 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10186 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10187 linkage. The default is on.
10188
10189 @item show print demangle
10190 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10191
10192 @item set print asm-demangle
10193 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10194 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10195 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10196 The default is off.
10197
10198 @item show print asm-demangle
10199 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10200 or demangled form.
10201
10202 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10203 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10204 @kindex set demangle-style
10205 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10206 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10207 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10208
10209 @table @code
10210 @item auto
10211 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10212 This is the default.
10213
10214 @item gnu
10215 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10216
10217 @item hp
10218 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10219
10220 @item lucid
10221 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10222
10223 @item arm
10224 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10225 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10226 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10227 require further enhancement to permit that.
10228
10229 @end table
10230 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10231
10232 @item show demangle-style
10233 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10234
10235 @item set print object
10236 @itemx set print object on
10237 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10238 @cindex display derived types
10239 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10240 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10241 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10242 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10243 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10244 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10245 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10246
10247 @item set print object off
10248 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10249 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10250
10251 @item show print object
10252 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10253
10254 @item set print static-members
10255 @itemx set print static-members on
10256 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10257 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10258
10259 @item set print static-members off
10260 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10261
10262 @item show print static-members
10263 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10264
10265 @item set print pascal_static-members
10266 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10267 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10268 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10269 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10270
10271 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10272 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10273
10274 @item show print pascal_static-members
10275 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10276
10277 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10278 @item set print vtbl
10279 @itemx set print vtbl on
10280 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10281 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10282 @cindex VTBL display
10283 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10284 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10285 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10286
10287 @item set print vtbl off
10288 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10289
10290 @item show print vtbl
10291 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10292 @end table
10293
10294 @node Pretty Printing
10295 @section Pretty Printing
10296
10297 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10298 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10299 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10300
10301 @menu
10302 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10303 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10304 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10305 @end menu
10306
10307 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10308 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10309
10310 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10311 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10312 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10313
10314 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10315 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10316 pretty-printers with their names.
10317 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10318 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10319 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10320 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10321
10322 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10323 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10324 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10325 do anything special.
10326
10327 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10328
10329 @itemize @bullet
10330 @item
10331 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10332 all inferiors.
10333
10334 @item
10335 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10336 when debugging that program.
10337 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10338
10339 @item
10340 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10341 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10342 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10343 @end itemize
10344
10345 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10346 pretty-printers are selected,
10347
10348 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10349 for new types.
10350
10351 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10352 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10353
10354 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10355
10356 @smallexample
10357 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10358 $1 = @{
10359 static npos = 4294967295,
10360 _M_dataplus = @{
10361 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10362 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10363 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10364 @},
10365 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10366 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10367 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10368 @}
10369 @}
10370 @end smallexample
10371
10372 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10373
10374 @smallexample
10375 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10376 $2 = "abcd"
10377 @end smallexample
10378
10379 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10380 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10381 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10382
10383 @table @code
10384 @kindex info pretty-printer
10385 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10386 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10387 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10388
10389 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10390 whose pretty-printers to list.
10391 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10392 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10393 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10394 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10395 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10396
10397 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10398 to list.
10399
10400 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10401 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10402 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10403 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10404
10405 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10406 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10407 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10408 @end table
10409
10410 Example:
10411
10412 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10413 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10414 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10415 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10416
10417 @smallexample
10418 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10419 library1.so:
10420 foo
10421 library2.so:
10422 bar
10423 bar1
10424 bar2
10425 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10426 library2.so:
10427 bar
10428 bar1
10429 bar2
10430 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10431 1 printer disabled
10432 2 of 3 printers enabled
10433 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10434 library1.so:
10435 foo [disabled]
10436 library2.so:
10437 bar
10438 bar1
10439 bar2
10440 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10441 1 printer disabled
10442 1 of 3 printers enabled
10443 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10444 library1.so:
10445 foo [disabled]
10446 library2.so:
10447 bar
10448 bar1 [disabled]
10449 bar2
10450 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10451 1 printer disabled
10452 0 of 3 printers enabled
10453 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10454 library1.so:
10455 foo [disabled]
10456 library2.so:
10457 bar [disabled]
10458 bar1 [disabled]
10459 bar2
10460 @end smallexample
10461
10462 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10463 as can each individual subprinter.
10464
10465 @node Value History
10466 @section Value History
10467
10468 @cindex value history
10469 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10470 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10471 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10472 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10473 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10474 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10475 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10476 symbol table.
10477
10478 @cindex @code{$}
10479 @cindex @code{$$}
10480 @cindex history number
10481 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10482 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10483 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10484 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10485 history number.
10486
10487 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10488 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10489 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10490 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10491 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10492 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10493 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10494
10495 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10496 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10497
10498 @smallexample
10499 p *$
10500 @end smallexample
10501
10502 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10503 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10504
10505 @smallexample
10506 p *$.next
10507 @end smallexample
10508
10509 @noindent
10510 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10511 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10512
10513 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10514 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10515
10516 @smallexample
10517 print x
10518 set x=5
10519 @end smallexample
10520
10521 @noindent
10522 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10523 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10524
10525 @table @code
10526 @kindex show values
10527 @item show values
10528 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10529 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10530 values} does not change the history.
10531
10532 @item show values @var{n}
10533 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10534
10535 @item show values +
10536 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10537 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10538 @end table
10539
10540 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10541 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10542
10543 @node Convenience Vars
10544 @section Convenience Variables
10545
10546 @cindex convenience variables
10547 @cindex user-defined variables
10548 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10549 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10550 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10551 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10552 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10553
10554 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10555 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10556 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10557 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10558 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10559
10560 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10561 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10562 For example:
10563
10564 @smallexample
10565 set $foo = *object_ptr
10566 @end smallexample
10567
10568 @noindent
10569 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10570 @code{object_ptr}.
10571
10572 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10573 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10574 value with another assignment at any time.
10575
10576 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10577 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10578 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10579 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10580
10581 @table @code
10582 @kindex show convenience
10583 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10584 @item show convenience
10585 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10586 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10587 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10588
10589 @kindex init-if-undefined
10590 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10591 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10592 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10593 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10594 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10595 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10596 override default values used in a command script.
10597
10598 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10599 any side-effects do not occur.
10600 @end table
10601
10602 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10603 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10604 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10605
10606 @smallexample
10607 set $i = 0
10608 print bar[$i++]->contents
10609 @end smallexample
10610
10611 @noindent
10612 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10613
10614 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10615 values likely to be useful.
10616
10617 @table @code
10618 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10619 @item $_
10620 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10621 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10622 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10623 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10624 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10625 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10626 to the type of @code{$__}.
10627
10628 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10629 @item $__
10630 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10631 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10632 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10633
10634 @item $_exitcode
10635 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10636 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10637 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10638 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10639
10640 @item $_exitsignal
10641 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10642 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10643 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10644 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10645
10646 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10647 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10648 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10649 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10650 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10651
10652 @smallexample
10653 #include <signal.h>
10654
10655 int
10656 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10657 @{
10658 raise (SIGALRM);
10659 return 0;
10660 @}
10661 @end smallexample
10662
10663 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10664 or signalled would be:
10665
10666 @smallexample
10667 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10668 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10669 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10670 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10671 >echo The program has exited\n
10672 >else
10673 >echo The program has signalled\n
10674 >end
10675 >end
10676 (@value{GDBP}) run
10677 Starting program:
10678
10679 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10680 The program no longer exists.
10681 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10682 The program has signalled
10683 @end smallexample
10684
10685 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10686 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10687 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10688 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10689
10690 @smallexample
10691 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10692 The program has exited
10693 @end smallexample
10694
10695 @item $_exception
10696 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10697 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10698
10699 @item $_probe_argc
10700 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10701 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10702
10703 @item $_sdata
10704 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10705 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10706 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10707 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10708 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10709
10710 @item $_siginfo
10711 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10712 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10713 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10714 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10715 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10716
10717 @item $_tlb
10718 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10719 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10720 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10721 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10722 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10723 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10724
10725 @item $_inferior
10726 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10727 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10728
10729 @item $_thread
10730 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10731
10732 @item $_gthread
10733 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10734
10735 @end table
10736
10737 @node Convenience Funs
10738 @section Convenience Functions
10739
10740 @cindex convenience functions
10741 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10742 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10743 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10744 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10745 @value{GDBN}.
10746
10747 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10748 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10749
10750 @table @code
10751
10752 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10753 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10754 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10755 returns zero.
10756
10757 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10758 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10759 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10760 it is @code{void}:
10761
10762 @smallexample
10763 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10764 $1 = void
10765 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10766 $2 = 1
10767 (@value{GDBP}) run
10768 Starting program: ./a.out
10769 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10770 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10771 $3 = 0
10772 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10773 $4 = 0
10774 @end smallexample
10775
10776 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10777 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10778 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10779 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10780 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10781 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10782 anymore.
10783
10784 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10785 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10786
10787 @smallexample
10788 void
10789 foo (void)
10790 @{
10791 @}
10792 @end smallexample
10793
10794 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10795
10796 @smallexample
10797 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10798 $1 = void
10799 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10800 $2 = 1
10801 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10802 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10803 $3 = void
10804 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10805 $4 = 1
10806 @end smallexample
10807
10808 @end table
10809
10810 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10811 @code{Python} support.
10812
10813 @table @code
10814
10815 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10816 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10817 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10818 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10819 Otherwise it returns zero.
10820
10821 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10822 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10823 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10824 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10825 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10826 regular expression support.
10827
10828 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10829 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10830 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10831 Otherwise it returns zero.
10832
10833 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10834 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10835 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10836
10837 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10838 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10839 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10840 Otherwise it returns zero.
10841
10842 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10843 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10844 The default is 1.
10845
10846 Example:
10847
10848 @smallexample
10849 (gdb) backtrace
10850 #0 bottom_func ()
10851 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10852 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10853 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10854 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10855 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10856 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10857 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10858 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10859 $1 = 1
10860 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10861 $1 = 1
10862 @end smallexample
10863
10864 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10865 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10866 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10867 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10868
10869 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10870 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10871 The default is 1.
10872
10873 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10874 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10875 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10876 Otherwise it returns zero.
10877
10878 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10879 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10880 The default is 1.
10881
10882 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10883 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10884 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10885 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10886
10887 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10888 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10889 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10890 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10891
10892 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10893 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10894 The default is 1.
10895
10896 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10897 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10898 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10899 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10900
10901 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10902 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10903 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10904
10905 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10906 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10907 an enumerated type:
10908
10909 @smallexample
10910 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10911 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10912 @end smallexample
10913
10914 @end table
10915
10916 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10917 convenience functions.
10918
10919 @table @code
10920 @item help function
10921 @kindex help function
10922 @cindex show all convenience functions
10923 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10924 @end table
10925
10926 @node Registers
10927 @section Registers
10928
10929 @cindex registers
10930 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10931 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10932 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10933 your machine.
10934
10935 @table @code
10936 @kindex info registers
10937 @item info registers
10938 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10939 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10940
10941 @kindex info all-registers
10942 @cindex floating point registers
10943 @item info all-registers
10944 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10945 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10946
10947 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10948 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10949 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10950 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10951 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10952 @end table
10953
10954 @anchor{standard registers}
10955 @cindex stack pointer register
10956 @cindex program counter register
10957 @cindex process status register
10958 @cindex frame pointer register
10959 @cindex standard registers
10960 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10961 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10962 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10963 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10964 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10965 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10966 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10967 you could print the program counter in hex with
10968
10969 @smallexample
10970 p/x $pc
10971 @end smallexample
10972
10973 @noindent
10974 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10975
10976 @smallexample
10977 x/i $pc
10978 @end smallexample
10979
10980 @noindent
10981 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10982 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10983 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10984 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10985 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10986 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10987 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10988
10989 @smallexample
10990 set $sp += 4
10991 @end smallexample
10992
10993 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10994 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10995 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10996 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10997 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10998 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10999 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11000
11001 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11002 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11003 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11004 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11005 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11006 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11007 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11008
11009 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11010 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11011 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11012 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11013 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11014 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11015 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11016 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11017 prints the data in both formats.
11018
11019 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11020 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11021 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11022 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11023 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11024 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11025 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11026
11027 @smallexample
11028 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11029 $1 = @{
11030 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11031 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11032 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11033 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11034 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11035 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11036 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11037 @}
11038 @end smallexample
11039
11040 @noindent
11041 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11042 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11043 value to a @code{struct} member:
11044
11045 @smallexample
11046 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11047 @end smallexample
11048
11049 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11050 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11051 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11052 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11053 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11054 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11055
11056 @cindex caller-saved registers
11057 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11058 @cindex volatile registers
11059 @cindex <not saved> values
11060 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11061 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11062 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11063 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11064 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11065 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11066 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11067 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11068 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11069 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11070 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11071 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11072 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11073 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11074 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11075 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11076 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11077 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11078 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11079 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11080 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11081 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11082 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11083
11084 @node Floating Point Hardware
11085 @section Floating Point Hardware
11086 @cindex floating point
11087
11088 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11089 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11090
11091 @table @code
11092 @kindex info float
11093 @item info float
11094 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11095 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11096 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11097 the ARM and x86 machines.
11098 @end table
11099
11100 @node Vector Unit
11101 @section Vector Unit
11102 @cindex vector unit
11103
11104 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11105 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11106
11107 @table @code
11108 @kindex info vector
11109 @item info vector
11110 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11111 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11112 @end table
11113
11114 @node OS Information
11115 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11116 @cindex OS information
11117
11118 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11119 you debug your program.
11120
11121 @cindex auxiliary vector
11122 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11123 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11124 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11125 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11126 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11127 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11128 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11129 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11130 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11131 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11132 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11133 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11134
11135 @table @code
11136 @kindex info auxv
11137 @item info auxv
11138 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11139 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11140 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11141 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11142 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11143 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11144 an unrecognized tag.
11145 @end table
11146
11147 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11148 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11149 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11150 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11151 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11152 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11153 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11154
11155 @table @code
11156 @kindex info os
11157 @item info os @var{infotype}
11158
11159 Display OS information of the requested type.
11160
11161 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11162
11163 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11164 @table @code
11165 @kindex info os cpus
11166 @item cpus
11167 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11168 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11169 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11170 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11171 kernel initialization.
11172
11173 @kindex info os files
11174 @item files
11175 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11176 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11177 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11178 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11179
11180 @kindex info os modules
11181 @item modules
11182 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11183 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11184 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11185 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11186 in memory.
11187
11188 @kindex info os msg
11189 @item msg
11190 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11191 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11192 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11193 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11194 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11195 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11196 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11197 the message queue was last changed.
11198
11199 @kindex info os processes
11200 @item processes
11201 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11202 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11203 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11204 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11205 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11206 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11207
11208 @kindex info os procgroups
11209 @item procgroups
11210 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11211 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11212 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11213 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11214 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11215 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11216 and the process group leader is listed first.
11217
11218 @kindex info os semaphores
11219 @item semaphores
11220 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11221 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11222 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11223 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11224 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11225
11226 @kindex info os shm
11227 @item shm
11228 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11229 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11230 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11231 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11232 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11233 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11234 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11235
11236 @kindex info os sockets
11237 @item sockets
11238 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11239 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11240 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11241 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11242 connection.
11243
11244 @kindex info os threads
11245 @item threads
11246 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11247 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11248 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11249 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11250 process is not listed.
11251 @end table
11252
11253 @item info os
11254 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11255 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11256 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11257 types, this command will report an error.
11258 @end table
11259
11260 @node Memory Region Attributes
11261 @section Memory Region Attributes
11262 @cindex memory region attributes
11263
11264 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11265 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11266 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11267 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11268 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11269 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11270 user can override the fetched regions.
11271
11272 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11273 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11274 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11275 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11276 all memory.
11277
11278 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11279 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11280
11281 @table @code
11282 @kindex mem
11283 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11284 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11285 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11286 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11287 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11288 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11289
11290 @item mem auto
11291 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11292 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11293
11294 @kindex delete mem
11295 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11296 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11297 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11298
11299 @kindex disable mem
11300 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11301 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11302 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11303 It may be enabled again later.
11304
11305 @kindex enable mem
11306 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11307 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11308
11309 @kindex info mem
11310 @item info mem
11311 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11312 for each region:
11313
11314 @table @emph
11315 @item Memory Region Number
11316 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11317 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11318 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11319
11320 @item Lo Address
11321 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11322
11323 @item Hi Address
11324 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11325
11326 @item Attributes
11327 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11328 @end table
11329 @end table
11330
11331
11332 @subsection Attributes
11333
11334 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11335 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11336 write accesses to a memory region.
11337
11338 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11339 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11340 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11341
11342 @table @code
11343 @item ro
11344 Memory is read only.
11345 @item wo
11346 Memory is write only.
11347 @item rw
11348 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11349 @end table
11350
11351 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11352 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11353 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11354 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11355 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11356
11357 @table @code
11358 @item 8
11359 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11360 @item 16
11361 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11362 @item 32
11363 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11364 @item 64
11365 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11366 @end table
11367
11368 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11369 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11370 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11371 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11372 @c
11373 @c @table @code
11374 @c @item hwbreak
11375 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11376 @c @item swbreak (default)
11377 @c @end table
11378
11379 @subsubsection Data Cache
11380 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11381 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11382 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11383 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11384 registers.
11385
11386 @table @code
11387 @item cache
11388 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11389 @item nocache
11390 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11391 @end table
11392
11393 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11394 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11395 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11396 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11397 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11398
11399 @table @code
11400 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11401 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11402 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11403 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11404 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11405 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11406 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11407 The default value is @code{on}.
11408 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11409 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11410 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11411 @end table
11412
11413
11414 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11415 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11416 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11417 @c
11418 @c @table @code
11419 @c @item verify
11420 @c @item noverify (default)
11421 @c @end table
11422
11423 @node Dump/Restore Files
11424 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11425 @cindex dump/restore files
11426 @cindex append data to a file
11427 @cindex dump data to a file
11428 @cindex restore data from a file
11429
11430 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11431 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11432 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11433 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11434 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11435 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11436 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11437
11438 @table @code
11439
11440 @kindex dump
11441 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11442 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11443 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11444 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11445
11446 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11447 @table @code
11448 @item binary
11449 Raw binary form.
11450 @item ihex
11451 Intel hex format.
11452 @item srec
11453 Motorola S-record format.
11454 @item tekhex
11455 Tektronix Hex format.
11456 @item verilog
11457 Verilog Hex format.
11458 @end table
11459
11460 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11461 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11462 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11463 form.
11464
11465 @kindex append
11466 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11467 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11468 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11469 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11470 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11471
11472 @kindex restore
11473 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11474 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11475 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11476 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11477 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11478
11479 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11480 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11481 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11482 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11483 from that location.
11484
11485 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11486 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11487 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11488 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11489
11490 @end table
11491
11492 @node Core File Generation
11493 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11494 @cindex dump core from inferior
11495
11496 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11497 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11498 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11499 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11500 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11501 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11502 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11503
11504 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11505 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11506 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11507
11508 @table @code
11509 @kindex gcore
11510 @kindex generate-core-file
11511 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11512 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11513 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11514 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11515 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11516 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11517
11518 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11519 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11520
11521 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11522 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11523 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11524
11525 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11526 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11527 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11528 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11529 Enable or disable the use of the file
11530 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11531 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11532 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11533 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11534
11535 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11536 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11537 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11538 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11539 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11540 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11541 about the bits that can be set in the
11542 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11543 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11544
11545 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11546 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11547 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11548 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11549 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11550 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11551 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11552 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11553 @end table
11554
11555 @node Character Sets
11556 @section Character Sets
11557 @cindex character sets
11558 @cindex charset
11559 @cindex translating between character sets
11560 @cindex host character set
11561 @cindex target character set
11562
11563 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11564 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11565 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11566 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11567 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11568 @dfn{target character set}.
11569
11570 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11571 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11572 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11573 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11574 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11575 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11576 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11577 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11578 character and string literals in expressions.
11579
11580 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11581 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11582 target-charset} command, described below.
11583
11584 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11585 support:
11586
11587 @table @code
11588 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11589 @kindex set target-charset
11590 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11591 list of supported target character sets, type
11592 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11593
11594 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11595 @kindex set host-charset
11596 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11597
11598 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11599 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11600 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11601 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11602 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11603
11604 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11605 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11606 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11607
11608 @item set charset @var{charset}
11609 @kindex set charset
11610 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11611 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11612 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11613 for both host and target.
11614
11615 @item show charset
11616 @kindex show charset
11617 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11618
11619 @item show host-charset
11620 @kindex show host-charset
11621 Show the name of the current host character set.
11622
11623 @item show target-charset
11624 @kindex show target-charset
11625 Show the name of the current target character set.
11626
11627 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11628 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11629 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11630 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11631 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11632 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11633
11634 @item show target-wide-charset
11635 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11636 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11637 @end table
11638
11639 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11640 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11641 @file{charset-test.c}:
11642
11643 @smallexample
11644 #include <stdio.h>
11645
11646 char ascii_hello[]
11647 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11648 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11649 char ibm1047_hello[]
11650 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11651 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11652
11653 main ()
11654 @{
11655 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11656 @}
11657 @end smallexample
11658
11659 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11660 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11661 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11662
11663 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11664
11665 @smallexample
11666 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11667 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11668 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11669 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11670 @dots{}
11671 (@value{GDBP})
11672 @end smallexample
11673
11674 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11675 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11676 strings:
11677
11678 @smallexample
11679 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11680 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11681 (@value{GDBP})
11682 @end smallexample
11683
11684 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11685 initial character set:
11686 @smallexample
11687 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11688 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11689 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11690 (@value{GDBP})
11691 @end smallexample
11692
11693 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11694 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11695 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11696 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11697 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11698
11699 @smallexample
11700 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11701 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11702 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11703 $2 = 72 'H'
11704 (@value{GDBP})
11705 @end smallexample
11706
11707 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11708 literals you use in expressions:
11709
11710 @smallexample
11711 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11712 $3 = 43 '+'
11713 (@value{GDBP})
11714 @end smallexample
11715
11716 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11717 character.
11718
11719 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11720 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11721 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11722
11723 @smallexample
11724 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11725 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11726 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11727 $5 = 200 '\310'
11728 (@value{GDBP})
11729 @end smallexample
11730
11731 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11732 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11733
11734 @smallexample
11735 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11736 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11737 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11738 @end smallexample
11739
11740 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11741 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11742 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11743 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11744 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11745
11746 @smallexample
11747 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11748 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11749 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11750 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11751 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11752 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11753 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11754 $7 = 72 '\110'
11755 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11756 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11757 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11758 $9 = 200 'H'
11759 (@value{GDBP})
11760 @end smallexample
11761
11762 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11763 string literals you use in expressions:
11764
11765 @smallexample
11766 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11767 $10 = 78 '+'
11768 (@value{GDBP})
11769 @end smallexample
11770
11771 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11772 character.
11773
11774 @node Caching Target Data
11775 @section Caching Data of Targets
11776 @cindex caching data of targets
11777
11778 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11779 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11780 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11781 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11782 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11783 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11784 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11785 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11786 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11787 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11788 is executing.
11789 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11790 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11791 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11792 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11793 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11794 in the code segment.
11795 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11796 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11797
11798 @table @code
11799 @kindex set remotecache
11800 @item set remotecache on
11801 @itemx set remotecache off
11802 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11803 with old scripts.
11804
11805 @kindex show remotecache
11806 @item show remotecache
11807 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11808
11809 @kindex set stack-cache
11810 @item set stack-cache on
11811 @itemx set stack-cache off
11812 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11813 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11814
11815 @kindex show stack-cache
11816 @item show stack-cache
11817 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11818
11819 @kindex set code-cache
11820 @item set code-cache on
11821 @itemx set code-cache off
11822 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11823 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11824 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11825
11826 @kindex show code-cache
11827 @item show code-cache
11828 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11829 accesses.
11830
11831 @kindex info dcache
11832 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11833 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11834 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11835 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11836 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11837 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11838
11839 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11840 printed in hex.
11841
11842 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11843 @cindex dcache size
11844 @kindex set dcache size
11845 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11846
11847 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11848 @cindex dcache line-size
11849 @kindex set dcache line-size
11850 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11851 Must be a power of 2.
11852
11853 @item show dcache size
11854 @kindex show dcache size
11855 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11856
11857 @item show dcache line-size
11858 @kindex show dcache line-size
11859 Show default size of dcache lines.
11860
11861 @end table
11862
11863 @node Searching Memory
11864 @section Search Memory
11865 @cindex searching memory
11866
11867 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11868 @code{find} command.
11869
11870 @table @code
11871 @kindex find
11872 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11873 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11874 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11875 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11876 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11877 @end table
11878
11879 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11880 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11881
11882 @table @r
11883 @item @var{s}, search query size
11884 The size of each search query value.
11885
11886 @table @code
11887 @item b
11888 bytes
11889 @item h
11890 halfwords (two bytes)
11891 @item w
11892 words (four bytes)
11893 @item g
11894 giant words (eight bytes)
11895 @end table
11896
11897 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11898 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11899 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11900
11901 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11902 value's type in the current language.
11903 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11904 pattern as a mixture of types.
11905 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11906 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11907 which is typically four bytes.
11908
11909 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11910 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11911 @end table
11912
11913 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11914 (@code{"}).
11915 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11916 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11917
11918 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11919 number of matches found.
11920
11921 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11922 @samp{$_}.
11923 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11924
11925 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11926
11927 @smallexample
11928 void
11929 hello ()
11930 @{
11931 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11932 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11933 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11934 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11935 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11936 @}
11937 @end smallexample
11938
11939 @noindent
11940 you get during debugging:
11941
11942 @smallexample
11943 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11944 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11945 1 pattern found
11946 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11947 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11948 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11949 2 patterns found
11950 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11951 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11952 1 pattern found
11953 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11954 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11955 1 pattern found
11956 (gdb) print $numfound
11957 $1 = 1
11958 (gdb) print $_
11959 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11960 @end smallexample
11961
11962 @node Value Sizes
11963 @section Value Sizes
11964
11965 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11966 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11967 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11968 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11969 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11970
11971 @table @code
11972 @kindex set max-value-size
11973 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11974 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11975 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11976 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11977 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11978
11979 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11980 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11981
11982 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11983 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11984 currently 16 bytes.
11985
11986 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11987 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11988 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11989 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11990 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11991 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11992 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11993 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11994
11995 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11996
11997 @kindex show max-value-size
11998 @item show max-value-size
11999 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12000 allocate for the contents of a value.
12001 @end table
12002
12003 @node Optimized Code
12004 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12005 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12006 @cindex debugging optimized code
12007
12008 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12009 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12010 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12011 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12012 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12013 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12014 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12015
12016 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12017 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12018 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12019 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12020
12021 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12022 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12023 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12024 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12025 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12026 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12027
12028 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12029 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12030 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12031 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12032 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12033
12034 @menu
12035 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12036 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12037 @end menu
12038
12039 @node Inline Functions
12040 @section Inline Functions
12041 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12042
12043 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12044 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12045 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12046 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12047 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12048 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12049 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12050 @code{info frame} command.
12051
12052 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12053 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12054 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12055 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12056 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12057 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12058 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12059 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12060 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12061 local variables in the caller.
12062
12063 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12064 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12065 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12066 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12067 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12068 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12069 instructions are executed.
12070
12071 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12072 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12073 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12074 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12075
12076 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12077 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12078
12079 @itemize @bullet
12080 @item
12081 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12082 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12083 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12084 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12085 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12086 or inside the inlined function instead.
12087
12088 @item
12089 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12090 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12091 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12092 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12093
12094 @end itemize
12095
12096 @node Tail Call Frames
12097 @section Tail Call Frames
12098 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12099
12100 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12101 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12102 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12103 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12104 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12105
12106 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12107 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12108 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12109 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12110 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12111 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12112 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12113
12114 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12115 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12116 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12117 this information.
12118
12119 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12120 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12121
12122 @smallexample
12123 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12124 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12125 (gdb) info frame
12126 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12127 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12128 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12129 source language c++.
12130 Arglist at unknown address.
12131 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12132 @end smallexample
12133
12134 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12135 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12136 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12137 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12138 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12139 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12140
12141 @table @code
12142 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12143 @item set debug entry-values
12144 @kindex set debug entry-values
12145 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12146 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12147 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12148 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12149 result.
12150
12151 @item show debug entry-values
12152 @kindex show debug entry-values
12153 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12154 values at function entry and tail calls.
12155 @end table
12156
12157 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12158 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12159 reference by variable @code{x}):
12160
12161 @smallexample
12162 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12163 void (*x) (void) = c;
12164 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12165 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12166 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12167
12168 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12169 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12170 a () at t.c:3
12171 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12172 (gdb) bt
12173 #0 a () at t.c:3
12174 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12175 @end smallexample
12176
12177 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12178
12179 @smallexample
12180 int i;
12181 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12182 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12183 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12184 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12185 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12186 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12187 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12188 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12189
12190 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12191 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12192 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12193 (gdb) bt
12194 #0 f () at t.c:2
12195 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12196 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12197 @end smallexample
12198
12199 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12200 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12201
12202 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12203 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12204 @set ARROW @click{}
12205 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12206 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12207 @end ifset
12208 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12209 @set ARROW ->
12210 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12211 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12212 @end ifclear
12213
12214 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12215 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12216 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12217
12218 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12219 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12220 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12221 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12222 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12223 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12224
12225 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12226 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12227 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12228 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12229 omitted.
12230
12231 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12232 entry may fail:
12233
12234 @smallexample
12235 int v;
12236 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12237 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12238 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12239 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12240 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12241 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12242
12243 (gdb) bt
12244 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12245 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12246 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12247 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12248 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12249 @end smallexample
12250
12251 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12252 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12253 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12254 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12255 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12256
12257 @node Macros
12258 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12259
12260 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12261 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12262 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12263 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12264 where it was defined.
12265
12266 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12267 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12268 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12269 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12270
12271 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12272 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12273 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12274 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12275 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12276 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12277 see @ref{List}.
12278
12279 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12280 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12281 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12282
12283 @table @code
12284
12285 @kindex macro expand
12286 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12287 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12288 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12289 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12290 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12291 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12292 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12293 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12294 it can be any string of tokens.
12295
12296 @kindex macro exp1
12297 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12298 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12299 @cindex expand macro once
12300 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12301 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12302 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12303 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12304 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12305 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12306 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12307 can be any string of tokens.
12308
12309 @kindex info macro
12310 @cindex macro definition, showing
12311 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12312 @cindex macros, from debug info
12313 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12314 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12315 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12316 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12317 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12318 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12319
12320 @kindex info macros
12321 @item info macros @var{location}
12322 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12323 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12324 command-line where those definitions were established.
12325
12326 @kindex macro define
12327 @cindex user-defined macros
12328 @cindex defining macros interactively
12329 @cindex macros, user-defined
12330 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12331 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12332 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12333 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12334 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12335 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12336 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12337 @var{arglist}.
12338
12339 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12340 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12341 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12342 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12343 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12344
12345 @kindex macro undef
12346 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12347 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12348 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12349 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12350 in the program being debugged.
12351
12352 @kindex macro list
12353 @item macro list
12354 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12355 @end table
12356
12357 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12358 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12359 show our source files:
12360
12361 @smallexample
12362 $ cat sample.c
12363 #include <stdio.h>
12364 #include "sample.h"
12365
12366 #define M 42
12367 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12368
12369 main ()
12370 @{
12371 #define N 28
12372 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12373 #undef N
12374 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12375 #define N 1729
12376 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12377 @}
12378 $ cat sample.h
12379 #define Q <
12380 $
12381 @end smallexample
12382
12383 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12384 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12385 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12386 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12387 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12388 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12389 information.
12390
12391 @smallexample
12392 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12393 $
12394 @end smallexample
12395
12396 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12397
12398 @smallexample
12399 $ gdb -nw sample
12400 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12401 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12402 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12403 (@value{GDBP})
12404 @end smallexample
12405
12406 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12407 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12408 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12409
12410 @smallexample
12411 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12412 3
12413 4 #define M 42
12414 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12415 6
12416 7 main ()
12417 8 @{
12418 9 #define N 28
12419 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12420 11 #undef N
12421 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12422 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12423 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12424 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12425 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12426 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12427 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12428 #define Q <
12429 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12430 expands to: (42 + 1)
12431 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12432 expands to: once (M + 1)
12433 (@value{GDBP})
12434 @end smallexample
12435
12436 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12437 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12438 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12439 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12440
12441 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12442 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12443
12444 @smallexample
12445 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12446 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12447 (@value{GDBP}) run
12448 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12449
12450 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12451 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12452 (@value{GDBP})
12453 @end smallexample
12454
12455 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12456
12457 @smallexample
12458 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12459 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12460 #define N 28
12461 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12462 expands to: 28 < 42
12463 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12464 $1 = 1
12465 (@value{GDBP})
12466 @end smallexample
12467
12468 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12469 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12470 thereof) in force at each point:
12471
12472 @smallexample
12473 (@value{GDBP}) next
12474 Hello, world!
12475 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12476 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12477 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12478 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12479 (@value{GDBP}) next
12480 We're so creative.
12481 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12482 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12483 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12484 #define N 1729
12485 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12486 expands to: 1729 < 42
12487 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12488 $2 = 0
12489 (@value{GDBP})
12490 @end smallexample
12491
12492 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12493 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12494 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12495 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12496
12497 @smallexample
12498 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12499 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12500 -D__STDC__=1
12501 (@value{GDBP})
12502 @end smallexample
12503
12504
12505 @node Tracepoints
12506 @chapter Tracepoints
12507 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12508 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12509
12510 @cindex tracepoints
12511 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12512 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12513 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12514 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12515 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12516 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12517 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12518
12519 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12520 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12521 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12522 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12523 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12524 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12525 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12526 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12527 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12528 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12529 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12530
12531 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12532 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12533 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12534 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12535 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12536 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12537 Packets}.
12538
12539 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12540 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12541 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12542
12543 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12544
12545 @menu
12546 * Set Tracepoints::
12547 * Analyze Collected Data::
12548 * Tracepoint Variables::
12549 * Trace Files::
12550 @end menu
12551
12552 @node Set Tracepoints
12553 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12554
12555 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12556 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12557 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12558 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12559 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12560 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12561 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12562
12563 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12564 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12565 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12566 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12567 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12568 tracepoint was hit.
12569
12570 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12571 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12572 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12573 either.
12574
12575 @cindex fast tracepoints
12576 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12577 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12578 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12579
12580 @cindex static tracepoints
12581 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12582 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12583 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12584 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12585 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12586 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12587 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12588 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12589 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12590 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12591 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12592 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12593 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12594 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12595 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12596 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12597 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12598 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12599 static tracepoint marker.
12600
12601 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12602 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12603
12604 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12605 conditions and actions.
12606
12607 @menu
12608 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12609 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12610 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12611 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12612 * Trace State Variables::
12613 * Tracepoint Actions::
12614 * Listing Tracepoints::
12615 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12616 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12617 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12618 @end menu
12619
12620 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12621 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12622
12623 @table @code
12624 @cindex set tracepoint
12625 @kindex trace
12626 @item trace @var{location}
12627 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12628 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12629 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12630 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12631 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12632 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12633 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12634 in tracing}).
12635 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12636 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12637 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12638 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12639 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12640 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12641 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12642 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12643 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12644 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12645 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12646 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12647
12648 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12649
12650 @smallexample
12651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12652
12653 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12654
12655 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12656
12657 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12658
12659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12660 @end smallexample
12661
12662 @noindent
12663 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12664
12665 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12666 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12667 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12668 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12669 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12670 information on tracepoint conditions.
12671
12672 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12673 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12674 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12675 @kindex ftrace
12676 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12677 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12678 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12679 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12680 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12681 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12682 message.
12683
12684 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12685 @code{trace}.
12686
12687 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12688 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12689 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12690 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12691 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12692 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12693 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12694 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12695
12696 @example
12697 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12698 @end example
12699
12700 @noindent
12701 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12702 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12703
12704 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12705 @cindex set static tracepoint
12706 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12707 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12708 @kindex strace
12709 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12710 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12711 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12712 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12713 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12714
12715 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12716 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12717 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12718 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12719 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12720 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12721 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12722 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12723 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12724 tracing engine:
12725
12726 @smallexample
12727 main ()
12728 @{
12729 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12730 @}
12731 @end smallexample
12732
12733 @noindent
12734 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12735 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12736
12737 @smallexample
12738 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12739 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12740 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12741 Data: "str %s"
12742 [etc...]
12743 @end smallexample
12744
12745 @noindent
12746 so you may probe the marker above with:
12747
12748 @smallexample
12749 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12750 @end smallexample
12751
12752 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12753 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12754 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12755 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12756 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12757 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12758 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12759 the @samp{Data:} field.
12760
12761 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12762 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12763 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12764
12765 @vindex $tpnum
12766 @cindex last tracepoint number
12767 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12768 @cindex tracepoint number
12769 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12770 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12771
12772 @kindex delete tracepoint
12773 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12774 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12775 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12776 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12777 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12778
12779 Examples:
12780
12781 @smallexample
12782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12783
12784 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12785 @end smallexample
12786
12787 @noindent
12788 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12789 @end table
12790
12791 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12792 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12793
12794 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12795
12796 @table @code
12797 @kindex disable tracepoint
12798 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12799 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12800 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12801 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12802 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12803 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12804 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12805 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12806 next trace experiment.
12807
12808 @kindex enable tracepoint
12809 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12810 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12811 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12812 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12813 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12814 next time a trace experiment is run.
12815 @end table
12816
12817 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12818 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12819
12820 @table @code
12821 @kindex passcount
12822 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12823 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12824 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12825 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12826 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12827 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12828 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12829 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12830 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12831 user.
12832
12833 Examples:
12834
12835 @smallexample
12836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12837 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12838
12839 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12840 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12841 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12842 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12843 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12844 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12845 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12846 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12847 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12848 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12849 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12850 @end smallexample
12851 @end table
12852
12853 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12854 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12855 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12856 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12857
12858 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12859 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12860 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12861 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12862 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12863 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12864 is true.
12865
12866 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12867 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12868 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12869 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12870 just as with breakpoints.
12871
12872 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12873 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12874 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12875 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12876 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12877 accesses, and so forth.
12878
12879 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12880 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12881 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12882 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12883 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12884 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12885 search through.
12886
12887 @smallexample
12888 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12889 @end smallexample
12890
12891 @node Trace State Variables
12892 @subsection Trace State Variables
12893 @cindex trace state variables
12894
12895 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12896 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12897 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12898 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12899 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12900 integers.
12901
12902 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12903 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12904 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12905 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12906
12907 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12908 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12909 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12910 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12911 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12912 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12913 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12914 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12915 variable with the same name.
12916
12917 @table @code
12918
12919 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12920 @kindex tvariable
12921 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12922 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12923 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12924 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12925 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12926 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12927 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12928 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12929 value. The default initial value is 0.
12930
12931 @item info tvariables
12932 @kindex info tvariables
12933 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12934 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12935 currently running.
12936
12937 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12938 @kindex delete tvariable
12939 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12940 are specified.
12941
12942 @end table
12943
12944 @node Tracepoint Actions
12945 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12946
12947 @table @code
12948 @kindex actions
12949 @cindex tracepoint actions
12950 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12951 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12952 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12953 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12954 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12955 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12956 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12957 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12958 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12959 @code{while-stepping}.
12960
12961 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12962 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12963 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12964
12965 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12966 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12967 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12968
12969 @smallexample
12970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12971
12972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12973
12974 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12975 @end smallexample
12976
12977 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12978 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12979 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12980 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12981 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12982 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12983 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12984 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12985
12986 @smallexample
12987 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12988 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12989 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12990 > collect bar,baz
12991 > collect $regs
12992 > while-stepping 12
12993 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12994 > end
12995 end
12996 @end smallexample
12997
12998 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12999 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13000 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13001 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13002 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13003 special arguments are supported:
13004
13005 @table @code
13006 @item $regs
13007 Collect all registers.
13008
13009 @item $args
13010 Collect all function arguments.
13011
13012 @item $locals
13013 Collect all local variables.
13014
13015 @item $_ret
13016 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13017 of a backtrace.
13018
13019 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13020 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13021 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13022 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13023 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13024 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13025
13026 @item $_probe_argc
13027 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13028 tracepoint is located.
13029 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13030
13031 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13032 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13033 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13034 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13035
13036 @item $_sdata
13037 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13038 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13039 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13040 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13041 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13042 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13043 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13044 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13045 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13046
13047 @smallexample
13048 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13049 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13050 @end smallexample
13051
13052 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13053 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13054 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13055 @value{GDBN}.
13056 @end table
13057
13058 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13059 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13060 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13061
13062 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13063 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13064 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13065 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13066 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13067 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13068 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13069 @samp{mystr}.
13070
13071 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13072 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13073
13074 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13075 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13076 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13077 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13078 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13079 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13080 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13081 action were used.
13082
13083 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13084 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13085 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13086 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13087 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13088 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13089
13090 @smallexample
13091 > while-stepping 12
13092 > collect $regs, myglobal
13093 > end
13094 >
13095 @end smallexample
13096
13097 @noindent
13098 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13099 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13100 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13101 @code{stepping}.
13102
13103 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13104 @kindex set default-collect
13105 @cindex default collection action
13106 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13107 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13108 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13109 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13110 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13111 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13112
13113 @item show default-collect
13114 @kindex show default-collect
13115 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13116 tracepoint hit.
13117
13118 @end table
13119
13120 @node Listing Tracepoints
13121 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13122
13123 @table @code
13124 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13125 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13126 @cindex information about tracepoints
13127 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13128 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13129 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13130 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13131 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13132 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13133
13134 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13135 tracing:
13136
13137 @itemize @bullet
13138 @item
13139 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13140
13141 @item
13142 the state about installed on target of each location
13143 @end itemize
13144
13145 @smallexample
13146 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13147 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13148 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13149 while-stepping 20
13150 collect globfoo, $regs
13151 end
13152 collect globfoo2
13153 end
13154 pass count 1200
13155 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13156 collect $eip
13157 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13158 installed on target
13159 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13160 installed on target
13161 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13162 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13163 not installed on target
13164 (@value{GDBP})
13165 @end smallexample
13166
13167 @noindent
13168 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13169 @end table
13170
13171 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13172 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13173
13174 @table @code
13175 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13176 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13177 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13178 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13179 program.
13180
13181 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13182
13183 @table @emph
13184 @item Count
13185 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13186 stable identifier.
13187 @item ID
13188 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13189 @item Enabled or Disabled
13190 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13191 that are not enabled.
13192 @item Address
13193 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13194 @item What
13195 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13196 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13197 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13198 will be left blank.
13199 @end table
13200
13201 @noindent
13202 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13203
13204 @table @emph
13205 @item Data
13206 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13207 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13208 marker call.
13209 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13210 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13211 @end table
13212
13213 @smallexample
13214 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13215 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13216 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13217 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13218 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13219 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13220 Data: str %s
13221 (@value{GDBP})
13222 @end smallexample
13223 @end table
13224
13225 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13226 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13227
13228 @table @code
13229 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13230 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13231 @cindex collected data discarded
13232 @item tstart
13233 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13234 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13235 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13236 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13237 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13238 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13239 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13240 information, and so forth.
13241
13242 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13243 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13244 @item tstop
13245 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13246 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13247 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13248 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13249 needs to be stopped quickly.
13250
13251 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13252 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13253 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13254
13255 @kindex tstatus
13256 @cindex status of trace data collection
13257 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13258 @item tstatus
13259 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13260 collection.
13261 @end table
13262
13263 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13264
13265 @smallexample
13266 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13267 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13268 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13269 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13270 > while-stepping 11
13271 > collect $regs
13272 > end
13273 > end
13274 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13275 [time passes @dots{}]
13276 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13277 @end smallexample
13278
13279 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13280 @cindex disconnected tracing
13281 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13282 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13283 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13284 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13285 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13286 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13287 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13288 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13289
13290 @table @code
13291 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13292 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13293 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13294 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13295 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13296 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13297 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13298 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13299
13300 @item show disconnected-tracing
13301 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13302 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13303
13304 @end table
13305
13306 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13307 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13308 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13309 it will continue after reconnection.
13310
13311 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13312 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13313 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13314 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13315 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13316 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13317 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13318 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13319 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13320 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13321
13322 @cindex circular trace buffer
13323 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13324 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13325 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13326 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13327 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13328 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13329 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13330 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13331 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13332 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13333 the next run.
13334
13335 @table @code
13336 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13337 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13338 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13339 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13340 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13341 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13342 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13343
13344 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13345 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13346 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13347 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13348 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13349 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13350
13351 @end table
13352
13353 @table @code
13354 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13355 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13356 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13357 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13358 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13359 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13360 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13361 likes. This is also the default.
13362
13363 @item show trace-buffer-size
13364 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13365 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13366 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13367 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13368 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13369 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13370 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13371 @end table
13372
13373 @table @code
13374 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13375 @kindex set trace-user
13376
13377 @item show trace-user
13378 @kindex show trace-user
13379
13380 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13381 @kindex set trace-notes
13382 Set the trace run's notes.
13383
13384 @item show trace-notes
13385 @kindex show trace-notes
13386 Show the trace run's notes.
13387
13388 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13389 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13390 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13391 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13392 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13393
13394 @item show trace-stop-notes
13395 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13396 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13397
13398 @end table
13399
13400 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13401 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13402
13403 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13404 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13405 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13406 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13407 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13408 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13409 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13410 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13411 mentioned here.
13412
13413 @itemize @bullet
13414
13415 @item
13416 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13417 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13418 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13419 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13420 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13421 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13422 cannot be collected either.
13423
13424 @item
13425 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13426 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13427 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13428 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13429 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13430 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13431 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13432 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13433 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13434 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13435
13436 @item
13437 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13438 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13439 in a misleading way.
13440
13441 @item
13442 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13443 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13444 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13445 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13446 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13447 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13448 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13449 by @code{ptr}.
13450
13451 @item
13452 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13453 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13454 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13455 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13456 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13457 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13458 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13459 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13460 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13461 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13462 invalid address.
13463
13464 @item
13465 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13466 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13467 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13468 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13469 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13470 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13471 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13472 it to zero.
13473
13474 @end itemize
13475
13476 @node Analyze Collected Data
13477 @section Using the Collected Data
13478
13479 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13480 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13481 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13482 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13483 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13484 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13485 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13486 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13487 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13488 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13489 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13490 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13491 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13492 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13493 the buffer will fail.
13494
13495 @menu
13496 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13497 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13498 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13499 @end menu
13500
13501 @node tfind
13502 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13503
13504 @kindex tfind
13505 @cindex select trace snapshot
13506 @cindex find trace snapshot
13507 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13508 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13509 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13510 snapshot is selected.
13511
13512 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13513
13514 @table @code
13515 @item tfind start
13516 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13517 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13518
13519 @item tfind none
13520 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13521
13522 @item tfind end
13523 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13524
13525 @item tfind
13526 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13527 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13528
13529 @item tfind -
13530 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13531 retracing earlier steps.
13532
13533 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13534 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13535 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13536 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13537 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13538
13539 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13540 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13541 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13542 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13543 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13544
13545 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13546 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13547 addresses (exclusive).
13548
13549 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13550 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13551 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13552
13553 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13554 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13555 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13556 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13557 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13558 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13559 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13560 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13561 @end table
13562
13563 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13564 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13565 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13566 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13567 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13568 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13569 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13570 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13571 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13572 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13573 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13574 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13575 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13576 tracepoint as the current one.
13577
13578 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13579 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13580 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13581 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13582 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13583
13584 @smallexample
13585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13586 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13587 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13588 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13589 > tfind
13590 > end
13591
13592 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13593 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13594 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13595 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13596 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13597 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13598 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13599 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13600 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13601 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13602 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13603 @end smallexample
13604
13605 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13606 the buffer:
13607
13608 @smallexample
13609 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13610 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13611 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13612 > tfind line
13613 > end
13614
13615 Frame 0, X = 1
13616 Frame 7, X = 2
13617 Frame 13, X = 255
13618 @end smallexample
13619
13620 @node tdump
13621 @subsection @code{tdump}
13622 @kindex tdump
13623 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13624 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13625
13626 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13627 the current trace snapshot.
13628
13629 @smallexample
13630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13632 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13633 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13634 > end
13635
13636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13637
13638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13639 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13640 at gdb_test.c:444
13641 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13642
13643 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13644 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13645 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13646 d1 0x18 24
13647 d2 0x80 128
13648 d3 0x33 51
13649 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13650 d5 0x22 34
13651 d6 0xe0 224
13652 d7 0x380035 3670069
13653 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13654 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13655 a2 0x100 256
13656 a3 0x322000 3284992
13657 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13658 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13659 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13660 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13661 ps 0x0 0
13662 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13663 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13664 fpstatus 0x0 0
13665 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13666 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13667 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13668 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13669 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13670 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13671 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13672 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13673 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13674
13675 (@value{GDBP})
13676 @end smallexample
13677
13678 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13679 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13680 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13681 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13682
13683 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13684 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13685 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13686 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13687 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13688 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13689 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13690 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13691 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13692 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13693
13694 @node save tracepoints
13695 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13696 @kindex save tracepoints
13697 @kindex save-tracepoints
13698 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13699
13700 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13701 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13702 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13703 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13704 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13705 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13706
13707 @node Tracepoint Variables
13708 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13709 @cindex tracepoint variables
13710 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13711
13712 @table @code
13713 @vindex $trace_frame
13714 @item (int) $trace_frame
13715 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13716 snapshot is selected.
13717
13718 @vindex $tracepoint
13719 @item (int) $tracepoint
13720 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13721
13722 @vindex $trace_line
13723 @item (int) $trace_line
13724 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13725
13726 @vindex $trace_file
13727 @item (char []) $trace_file
13728 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13729
13730 @vindex $trace_func
13731 @item (char []) $trace_func
13732 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13733 @end table
13734
13735 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13736 use @code{output} instead.
13737
13738 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13739 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13740 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13741 which are managed by the target.
13742
13743 @smallexample
13744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13745
13746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13747 > output $trace_file
13748 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13749 > tfind
13750 > end
13751 @end smallexample
13752
13753 @node Trace Files
13754 @section Using Trace Files
13755 @cindex trace files
13756
13757 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13758 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13759 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13760 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13761 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13762
13763 @table @code
13764
13765 @kindex tsave
13766 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13767 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13768 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13769 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13770 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13771 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13772 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13773 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13774 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13775 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13776 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13777 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13778 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13779 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13780 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13781
13782 @kindex target tfile
13783 @kindex tfile
13784 @kindex target ctf
13785 @kindex ctf
13786 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13787 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13788 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13789 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13790 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13791 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13792 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13793 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13794 the host.
13795
13796 @smallexample
13797 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13798 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13799 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13800 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13801 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13802 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13803 i = 0
13804 a = 0
13805 b = 1 '\001'
13806 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13807 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13808 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13809 $1 = 1
13810 @end smallexample
13811
13812 @end table
13813
13814 @node Overlays
13815 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13816 @cindex overlays
13817
13818 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13819 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13820 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13821 use overlays.
13822
13823 @menu
13824 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13825 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13826 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13827 mapped by asking the inferior.
13828 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13829 @end menu
13830
13831 @node How Overlays Work
13832 @section How Overlays Work
13833 @cindex mapped overlays
13834 @cindex unmapped overlays
13835 @cindex load address, overlay's
13836 @cindex mapped address
13837 @cindex overlay area
13838
13839 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13840 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13841 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13842 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13843 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13844
13845 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13846 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13847 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13848 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13849 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13850 largest overlay as well.
13851
13852 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13853 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13854 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13855 there.
13856
13857 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13858 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13859 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13860
13861 @smallexample
13862 @group
13863 Data Instruction Larger
13864 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13865 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13866 | | | | | |
13867 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13868 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13869 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13870 | and heap | | | | | |
13871 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13872 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13873 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13874 | | | | | |
13875 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13876 address | | | | | |
13877 | overlay | <-' | | |
13878 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13879 | | <---. | | load address
13880 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13881 | | | |
13882 +-----------+ | |
13883 +-----------+
13884 | |
13885 +-----------+
13886
13887 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13888 @end group
13889 @end smallexample
13890
13891 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13892 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13893 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13894 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13895 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13896 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13897 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13898 program and the overlay area.
13899
13900 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13901 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13902 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13903 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13904 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13905 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13906 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13907
13908 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13909 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13910 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13911
13912 @itemize @bullet
13913
13914 @item
13915 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13916 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13917 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13918 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13919
13920 @item
13921 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13922 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13923 your program's performance.
13924
13925 @item
13926 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13927 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13928 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13929 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13930 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13931 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13932 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13933
13934 @item
13935 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13936 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13937 instruction and data spaces.
13938
13939 @end itemize
13940
13941 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13942 improved in many ways:
13943
13944 @itemize @bullet
13945
13946 @item
13947 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13948 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13949 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13950 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13951 area in the usual way.
13952
13953 @item
13954 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13955 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13956
13957 @item
13958 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13959 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13960 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13961 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13962 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13963 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13964 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13965
13966 @end itemize
13967
13968
13969 @node Overlay Commands
13970 @section Overlay Commands
13971
13972 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13973 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13974 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13975 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13976 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13977 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13978
13979 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13980 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13981
13982 @table @code
13983 @item overlay off
13984 @kindex overlay
13985 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13986 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13987 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13988 overlay support is disabled.
13989
13990 @item overlay manual
13991 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13992 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13993 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13994 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13995 commands described below.
13996
13997 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13998 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13999 @cindex map an overlay
14000 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14001 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14002 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14003 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14004 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14005 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14006
14007 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14008 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14009 @cindex unmap an overlay
14010 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14011 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14012 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14013 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14014
14015 @item overlay auto
14016 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14017 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14018 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14019 Overlay Debugging}.
14020
14021 @item overlay load-target
14022 @itemx overlay load
14023 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14024 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14025 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14026 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14027 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14028 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14029
14030 @item overlay list-overlays
14031 @itemx overlay list
14032 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14033 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14034 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14035
14036 @end table
14037
14038 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14039 of the function the address falls in:
14040
14041 @smallexample
14042 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14043 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14044 @end smallexample
14045 @noindent
14046 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14047 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14048 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14049 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14050
14051 @smallexample
14052 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14053 No sections are mapped.
14054 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14055 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14056 @end smallexample
14057 @noindent
14058 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14059 name normally:
14060
14061 @smallexample
14062 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14063 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14064 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14065 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14066 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14067 @end smallexample
14068
14069 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14070 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14071 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14072 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14073 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14074
14075 @itemize @bullet
14076 @item
14077 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14078 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14079 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14080 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14081 @item
14082 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14083 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14084 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14085 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14086 breakpoints properly.
14087 @end itemize
14088
14089
14090 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14091 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14092 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14093
14094 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14095 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14096 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14097 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14098 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14099 current state of the overlays.
14100
14101 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14102 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14103
14104 @table @asis
14105
14106 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14107 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14108
14109 @smallexample
14110 struct
14111 @{
14112 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14113 unsigned long vma;
14114
14115 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14116 unsigned long size;
14117
14118 /* The overlay's load address. */
14119 unsigned long lma;
14120
14121 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14122 zero otherwise. */
14123 unsigned long mapped;
14124 @}
14125 @end smallexample
14126
14127 @item @code{_novlys}:
14128 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14129 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14130
14131 @end table
14132
14133 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14134 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14135 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14136 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14137 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14138 currently mapped.
14139
14140 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14141 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14142 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14143 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14144 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14145 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14146 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14147 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14148 are not being executed.
14149
14150 @node Overlay Sample Program
14151 @section Overlay Sample Program
14152 @cindex overlay example program
14153
14154 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14155 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14156 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14157 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14158 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14159 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14160 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14161
14162 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14163 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14164 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14165 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14166
14167 @table @file
14168 @item overlays.c
14169 The main program file.
14170 @item ovlymgr.c
14171 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14172 @item foo.c
14173 @itemx bar.c
14174 @itemx baz.c
14175 @itemx grbx.c
14176 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14177 @item d10v.ld
14178 @itemx m32r.ld
14179 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14180 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14181 @end table
14182
14183 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14184 cross-compiler like this:
14185
14186 @smallexample
14187 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14188 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14189 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14190 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14191 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14192 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14193 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14194 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14195 @end smallexample
14196
14197 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14198 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14199 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14200
14201
14202 @node Languages
14203 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14204 @cindex languages
14205
14206 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14207 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14208 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14209 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14210 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14211 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14212
14213 @cindex working language
14214 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14215 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14216 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14217 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14218 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14219 language}.
14220
14221 @menu
14222 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14223 * Show:: Displaying the language
14224 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14225 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14226 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14227 @end menu
14228
14229 @node Setting
14230 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14231
14232 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14233 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14234 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14235 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14236 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14237 are printed, etc.
14238
14239 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14240 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14241 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14242 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14243 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14244 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14245 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14246 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14247 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14248 Displaying the Language}.
14249
14250 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14251 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14252 another language. In that case, make the
14253 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14254 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14255 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14256
14257 @menu
14258 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14259 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14260 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14261 @end menu
14262
14263 @node Filenames
14264 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14265
14266 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14267 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14268
14269 @table @file
14270 @item .ada
14271 @itemx .ads
14272 @itemx .adb
14273 @itemx .a
14274 Ada source file.
14275
14276 @item .c
14277 C source file
14278
14279 @item .C
14280 @itemx .cc
14281 @itemx .cp
14282 @itemx .cpp
14283 @itemx .cxx
14284 @itemx .c++
14285 C@t{++} source file
14286
14287 @item .d
14288 D source file
14289
14290 @item .m
14291 Objective-C source file
14292
14293 @item .f
14294 @itemx .F
14295 Fortran source file
14296
14297 @item .mod
14298 Modula-2 source file
14299
14300 @item .s
14301 @itemx .S
14302 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14303 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14304 @end table
14305
14306 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14307 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14308
14309 @node Manually
14310 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14311
14312 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14313 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14314 your program.
14315
14316 @kindex set language
14317 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14318 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14319 a language, such as
14320 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14321 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14322
14323 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14324 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14325 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14326 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14327 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14328 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14329 command such as:
14330
14331 @smallexample
14332 print a = b + c
14333 @end smallexample
14334
14335 @noindent
14336 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14337 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14338 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14339 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14340
14341 @node Automatically
14342 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14343
14344 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14345 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14346 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14347 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14348 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14349 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14350 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14351 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14352 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14353
14354 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14355 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14356 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14357 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14358 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14359
14360 @node Show
14361 @section Displaying the Language
14362
14363 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14364 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14365
14366 @table @code
14367 @item show language
14368 @anchor{show language}
14369 @kindex show language
14370 Display the current working language. This is the
14371 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14372 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14373
14374 @item info frame
14375 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14376 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14377 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14378 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14379 information listed here.
14380
14381 @item info source
14382 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14383 Display the source language of this source file.
14384 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14385 information listed here.
14386 @end table
14387
14388 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14389 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14390 with a language explicitly:
14391
14392 @table @code
14393 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14394 @kindex set extension-language
14395 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14396 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14397
14398 @item info extensions
14399 @kindex info extensions
14400 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14401 @end table
14402
14403 @node Checks
14404 @section Type and Range Checking
14405
14406 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14407 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14408 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14409 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14410 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14411 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14412 errors when your program is running.
14413
14414 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14415 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14416 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14417 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14418
14419 @menu
14420 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14421 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14422 @end menu
14423
14424 @cindex type checking
14425 @cindex checks, type
14426 @node Type Checking
14427 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14428
14429 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14430 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14431 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14432 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14433
14434 @smallexample
14435 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14436
14437 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14438 $1 = 2
14439 @exdent but
14440 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14441 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14442 @end smallexample
14443
14444 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14445 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14446
14447 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14448 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14449 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14450 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14451 expressions like the second example above.
14452
14453 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14454 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14455 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14456 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14457 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14458 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14459
14460 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14461
14462 @kindex set check type
14463 @kindex show check type
14464 @table @code
14465 @item set check type on
14466 @itemx set check type off
14467 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14468 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14469 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14470
14471 @item show check type
14472 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14473 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14474 @end table
14475
14476 @cindex range checking
14477 @cindex checks, range
14478 @node Range Checking
14479 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14480
14481 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14482 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14483 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14484 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14485 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14486
14487 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14488 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14489 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14490 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14491
14492 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14493 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14494 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14495 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14496 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14497 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14498
14499 @smallexample
14500 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14501 @end smallexample
14502
14503 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14504 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14505 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14506
14507 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14508
14509 @kindex set check range
14510 @kindex show check range
14511 @table @code
14512 @item set check range auto
14513 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14514 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14515 each language.
14516
14517 @item set check range on
14518 @itemx set check range off
14519 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14520 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14521 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14522 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14523
14524 @item set check range warn
14525 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14526 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14527 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14528 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14529 systems).
14530
14531 @item show range
14532 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14533 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14534 @end table
14535
14536 @node Supported Languages
14537 @section Supported Languages
14538
14539 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14540 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14541 @c This is false ...
14542 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14543 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14544 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14545 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14546 language.
14547
14548 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14549 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14550 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14551 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14552 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14553 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14554 language reference or tutorial.
14555
14556 @menu
14557 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14558 * D:: D
14559 * Go:: Go
14560 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14561 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14562 * Fortran:: Fortran
14563 * Pascal:: Pascal
14564 * Rust:: Rust
14565 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14566 * Ada:: Ada
14567 @end menu
14568
14569 @node C
14570 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14571
14572 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14573 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14574
14575 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14576 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14577 together.
14578
14579 @cindex C@t{++}
14580 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14581 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14582 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14583 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14584 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14585 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14586 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14587
14588 @menu
14589 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14590 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14591 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14592 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14593 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14594 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14595 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14596 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14597 @end menu
14598
14599 @node C Operators
14600 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14601
14602 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14603
14604 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14605 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14606 often defined on groups of types.
14607
14608 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14609
14610 @itemize @bullet
14611
14612 @item
14613 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14614 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14615
14616 @item
14617 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14618 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14619
14620 @item
14621 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14622
14623 @item
14624 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14625
14626 @end itemize
14627
14628 @noindent
14629 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14630 in order of increasing precedence:
14631
14632 @table @code
14633 @item ,
14634 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14635 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14636 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14637
14638 @item =
14639 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14640 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14641
14642 @item @var{op}=
14643 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14644 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14645 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14646 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14647 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14648
14649 @item ?:
14650 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14651 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14652 should be of an integral type.
14653
14654 @item ||
14655 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14656
14657 @item &&
14658 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14659
14660 @item |
14661 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14662
14663 @item ^
14664 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14665
14666 @item &
14667 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14668
14669 @item ==@r{, }!=
14670 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14671 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14672
14673 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14674 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14675 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14676 and non-zero for true.
14677
14678 @item <<@r{, }>>
14679 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14680
14681 @item @@
14682 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14683
14684 @item +@r{, }-
14685 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14686 pointer types.
14687
14688 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14689 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14690 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14691 integral types.
14692
14693 @item ++@r{, }--
14694 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14695 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14696 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14697 operation takes place.
14698
14699 @item *
14700 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14701 @code{++}.
14702
14703 @item &
14704 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14705
14706 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14707 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14708 to examine the address
14709 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14710 stored.
14711
14712 @item -
14713 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14714 precedence as @code{++}.
14715
14716 @item !
14717 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14718 @code{++}.
14719
14720 @item ~
14721 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14722 @code{++}.
14723
14724
14725 @item .@r{, }->
14726 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14727 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14728 pointer based on the stored type information.
14729 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14730
14731 @item .*@r{, }->*
14732 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14733
14734 @item []
14735 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14736 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14737
14738 @item ()
14739 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14740
14741 @item ::
14742 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14743 and @code{class} types.
14744
14745 @item ::
14746 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14747 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14748 above.
14749 @end table
14750
14751 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14752 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14753 predefined meaning.
14754
14755 @node C Constants
14756 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14757
14758 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14759
14760 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14761 following ways:
14762
14763 @itemize @bullet
14764 @item
14765 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14766 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14767 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14768 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14769 @code{long} value.
14770
14771 @item
14772 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14773 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14774 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14775 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14776 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14777 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14778 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14779 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14780 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14781 constant.
14782
14783 @item
14784 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14785 integral equivalents.
14786
14787 @item
14788 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14789 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14790 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14791 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14792 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14793 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14794 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14795 @samp{\n} for newline.
14796
14797 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14798 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14799 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14800 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14801
14802 @item
14803 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14804 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14805 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14806 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14807 characters.
14808
14809 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14810 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14811 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14812
14813 @item
14814 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14815 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14816
14817 @item
14818 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14819 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14820 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14821 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14822 @end itemize
14823
14824 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14825 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14826
14827 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14828 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14829
14830 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14831 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14832 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14833 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14834 @quotation
14835 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14836 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14837 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14838 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14839 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14840 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14841 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14842 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14843 @end quotation
14844
14845 @enumerate
14846
14847 @cindex member functions
14848 @item
14849 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14850
14851 @smallexample
14852 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14853 @end smallexample
14854
14855 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14856 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14857 @item
14858 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14859 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14860 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14861 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14862 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14863
14864 @cindex call overloaded functions
14865 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14866 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14867 @item
14868 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14869 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14870 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14871 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14872 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14873 default arguments.
14874
14875 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14876 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14877 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14878 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14879 number of function arguments.
14880
14881 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14882 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14883 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14884
14885 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14886 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14887 @smallexample
14888 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14889 @end smallexample
14890
14891 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14892 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14893
14894 @cindex reference declarations
14895 @item
14896 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14897 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14898 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14899
14900 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14901 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14902 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14903 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14904 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14905
14906 @item
14907 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14908 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14909 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14910 necessary, for example in an expression like
14911 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14912 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14913 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14914
14915 @item
14916 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14917 specification.
14918 @end enumerate
14919
14920 @node C Defaults
14921 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14922
14923 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14924
14925 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14926 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14927 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14928 selects the working language.
14929
14930 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14931 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14932 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14933 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14934 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14935 for further details.
14936
14937 @node C Checks
14938 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14939
14940 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14941
14942 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14943 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14944 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14945 constants to pointers.
14946
14947 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14948 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14949 that is not itself an array.
14950
14951 @node Debugging C
14952 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14953
14954 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14955 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14956 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14957 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14958
14959 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14960 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14961 ,Expressions}.
14962
14963 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14964 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14965
14966 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14967
14968 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14969 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14970
14971 @table @code
14972 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14973 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14974 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14975 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14976 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14977 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14978
14979 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14980 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14981 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14982 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14983 classes.
14984 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14985
14986 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14987 @item catch throw
14988 @itemx catch rethrow
14989 @itemx catch catch
14990 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14991 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14992
14993 @cindex inheritance
14994 @item ptype @var{typename}
14995 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14996 @var{typename}.
14997 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14998
14999 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15000 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15001 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15002 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15003 multiple inheritance is in use.
15004
15005 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15006 @item demangle @var{name}
15007 Demangle @var{name}.
15008 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15009
15010 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15011 @item set print demangle
15012 @itemx show print demangle
15013 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15014 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15015 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15016 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15017 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15018
15019 @item set print object
15020 @itemx show print object
15021 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15022 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15023
15024 @item set print vtbl
15025 @itemx show print vtbl
15026 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15027 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15028 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15029 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15030
15031 @kindex set overload-resolution
15032 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15033 @item set overload-resolution on
15034 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15035 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15036 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15037 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15038 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15039 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15040
15041 @item set overload-resolution off
15042 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15043 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15044 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15045 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15046 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15047 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15048 argument types.
15049
15050 @kindex show overload-resolution
15051 @item show overload-resolution
15052 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15053
15054 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15055 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15056 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15057 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15058 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15059 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15060 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15061 @end table
15062
15063 @node Decimal Floating Point
15064 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15065 @cindex decimal floating point format
15066
15067 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15068 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15069 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15070 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15071
15072 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15073 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15074 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15075 configured target.
15076
15077 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15078 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15079 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15080
15081 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15082 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15083 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15084
15085 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15086 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15087 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15088
15089 @node D
15090 @subsection D
15091
15092 @cindex D
15093 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15094 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15095 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15096
15097 @node Go
15098 @subsection Go
15099
15100 @cindex Go (programming language)
15101 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15102 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15103
15104 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15105
15106 @table @code
15107 @cindex current Go package
15108 @item The current Go package
15109 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15110 specifying global variables and functions.
15111
15112 For example, given the program:
15113
15114 @example
15115 package main
15116 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15117 func main () @{
15118 // ...
15119 @}
15120 @end example
15121
15122 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15123
15124 @example
15125 (gdb) p myglob
15126 (gdb) p main.myglob
15127 @end example
15128
15129 @cindex builtin Go types
15130 @item Builtin Go types
15131 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15132 as a string.
15133
15134 @cindex builtin Go functions
15135 @item Builtin Go functions
15136 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15137 function and handles it internally.
15138
15139 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15140 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15141 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15142 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15143 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15144 @end table
15145
15146 @node Objective-C
15147 @subsection Objective-C
15148
15149 @cindex Objective-C
15150 This section provides information about some commands and command
15151 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15152 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15153 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15154
15155 @menu
15156 * Method Names in Commands::
15157 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15158 @end menu
15159
15160 @node Method Names in Commands
15161 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15162
15163 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15164 names as line specifications:
15165
15166 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15167 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15168 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15169 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15170 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15171 @itemize
15172 @item @code{clear}
15173 @item @code{break}
15174 @item @code{info line}
15175 @item @code{jump}
15176 @item @code{list}
15177 @end itemize
15178
15179 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15180
15181 @smallexample
15182 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15183 @end smallexample
15184
15185 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15186 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15187 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15188 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15189 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15190 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15191 debugged, enter:
15192
15193 @smallexample
15194 break -[Fruit create]
15195 @end smallexample
15196
15197 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15198 enter:
15199
15200 @smallexample
15201 list +[NSText initialize]
15202 @end smallexample
15203
15204 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15205 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15206 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15207 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15208
15209 @smallexample
15210 break create
15211 @end smallexample
15212
15213 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15214 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15215 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15216 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15217 none apply.
15218
15219 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15220 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15221
15222 @smallexample
15223 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15224 @end smallexample
15225
15226 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15227 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15228 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15229 @kindex print-object
15230 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15231
15232 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15233
15234 @smallexample
15235 print -[@var{object} hash]
15236 @end smallexample
15237
15238 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15239 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15240 @noindent
15241 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15242 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15243 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15244 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15245 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15246 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15247
15248 @node OpenCL C
15249 @subsection OpenCL C
15250
15251 @cindex OpenCL C
15252 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15253
15254 @menu
15255 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15256 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15257 * OpenCL C Operators::
15258 @end menu
15259
15260 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15261 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15262
15263 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15264 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15265 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15266 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15267 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15268
15269 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15270 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15271
15272 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15273 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15274 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15275 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15276
15277 @node OpenCL C Operators
15278 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15279
15280 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15281 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15282 vector data types.
15283
15284 @node Fortran
15285 @subsection Fortran
15286 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15287
15288 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15289 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15290
15291 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15292 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15293 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15294 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15295 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15296 underscore.
15297
15298 @menu
15299 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15300 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15301 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15302 @end menu
15303
15304 @node Fortran Operators
15305 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15306
15307 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15308
15309 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15310 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15311 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15312
15313 @table @code
15314 @item **
15315 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15316 of the second one.
15317
15318 @item :
15319 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15320 represent a section of array.
15321
15322 @item %
15323 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15324 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15325 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15326 union type.
15327 @end table
15328
15329 @node Fortran Defaults
15330 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15331
15332 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15333
15334 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15335 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15336 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15337 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15338
15339 @node Special Fortran Commands
15340 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15341
15342 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15343
15344 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15345 such as displaying common blocks.
15346
15347 @table @code
15348 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15349 @kindex info common
15350 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15351 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15352 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15353 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15354 printed.
15355 @end table
15356
15357 @node Pascal
15358 @subsection Pascal
15359
15360 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15361 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15362 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15363 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15364 syntax.
15365
15366 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15367 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15368 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15369
15370 @node Rust
15371 @subsection Rust
15372
15373 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15374 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15375 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15376 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15377
15378 @itemize @bullet
15379 @item
15380 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15381 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15382 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15383
15384 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15385 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15386 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15387 @samp{B}.
15388
15389 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15390 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15391
15392 @item
15393 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15394 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15395 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15396 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15397 @samp{K::x::y}.
15398
15399 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15400 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15401 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15402 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15403 scope.
15404
15405 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15406 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15407
15408 @item
15409 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15410 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15411
15412 @item
15413 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15414
15415 @item
15416 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15417 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15418 never be destroyed.
15419
15420 @item
15421 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15422 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15423 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15424
15425 @item
15426 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15427 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15428 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15429 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15430 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15431 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15432 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15433 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15434
15435 @item
15436 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15437 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15438 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15439 @itemize @bullet
15440
15441 @item
15442 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15443
15444 @item
15445 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15446
15447 @item
15448 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15449
15450 @item
15451 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15452 type names.
15453
15454 @item
15455 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15456
15457 @item
15458 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15459 available in the crate.
15460 @end itemize
15461 @end itemize
15462
15463 @node Modula-2
15464 @subsection Modula-2
15465
15466 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15467
15468 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15469 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15470 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15471 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15472 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15473 table.
15474
15475 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15476 @menu
15477 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15478 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15479 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15480 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15481 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15482 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15483 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15484 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15485 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15486 @end menu
15487
15488 @node M2 Operators
15489 @subsubsection Operators
15490 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15491
15492 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15493 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15494 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15495 following definitions hold:
15496
15497 @itemize @bullet
15498
15499 @item
15500 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15501 their subranges.
15502
15503 @item
15504 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15505
15506 @item
15507 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15508
15509 @item
15510 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15511 @var{type}}.
15512
15513 @item
15514 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15515
15516 @item
15517 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15518
15519 @item
15520 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15521 @end itemize
15522
15523 @noindent
15524 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15525 increasing precedence:
15526
15527 @table @code
15528 @item ,
15529 Function argument or array index separator.
15530
15531 @item :=
15532 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15533 @var{value}.
15534
15535 @item <@r{, }>
15536 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15537 types.
15538
15539 @item <=@r{, }>=
15540 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15541 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15542 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15543
15544 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15545 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15546 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15547 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15548 comment character.
15549
15550 @item IN
15551 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15552 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15553
15554 @item OR
15555 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15556
15557 @item AND@r{, }&
15558 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15559
15560 @item @@
15561 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15562
15563 @item +@r{, }-
15564 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15565 and difference on set types.
15566
15567 @item *
15568 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15569 on set types.
15570
15571 @item /
15572 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15573 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15574
15575 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15576 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15577 precedence as @code{*}.
15578
15579 @item -
15580 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15581
15582 @item ^
15583 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15584
15585 @item NOT
15586 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15587 @code{^}.
15588
15589 @item .
15590 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15591 precedence as @code{^}.
15592
15593 @item []
15594 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15595
15596 @item ()
15597 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15598 as @code{^}.
15599
15600 @item ::@r{, }.
15601 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15602 @end table
15603
15604 @quotation
15605 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15606 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15607 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15608 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15609 @end quotation
15610
15611
15612 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15613 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15614 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15615
15616 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15617 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15618
15619 @table @var
15620
15621 @item a
15622 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15623
15624 @item c
15625 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15626
15627 @item i
15628 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15629
15630 @item m
15631 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15632 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15633 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15634
15635 @item n
15636 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15637
15638 @item r
15639 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15640
15641 @item t
15642 represents a type.
15643
15644 @item v
15645 represents a variable.
15646
15647 @item x
15648 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15649 explanation of the function for details.
15650 @end table
15651
15652 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15653
15654 @table @code
15655 @item ABS(@var{n})
15656 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15657
15658 @item CAP(@var{c})
15659 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15660 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15661
15662 @item CHR(@var{i})
15663 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15664
15665 @item DEC(@var{v})
15666 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15667
15668 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15669 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15670 new value.
15671
15672 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15673 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15674 set.
15675
15676 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15677 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15678
15679 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15680 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15681
15682 @item INC(@var{v})
15683 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15684
15685 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15686 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15687 new value.
15688
15689 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15690 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15691 there. Returns the new set.
15692
15693 @item MAX(@var{t})
15694 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15695
15696 @item MIN(@var{t})
15697 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15698
15699 @item ODD(@var{i})
15700 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15701
15702 @item ORD(@var{x})
15703 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15704 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15705 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15706 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15707
15708 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15709 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15710 variable or a type.
15711
15712 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15713 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15714
15715 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15716 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15717 variable or a type.
15718
15719 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15720 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15721 @end table
15722
15723 @quotation
15724 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15725 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15726 an error.
15727 @end quotation
15728
15729 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15730 @node M2 Constants
15731 @subsubsection Constants
15732
15733 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15734 ways:
15735
15736 @itemize @bullet
15737
15738 @item
15739 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15740 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15741 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15742 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15743
15744 @item
15745 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15746 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15747 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15748 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15749 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15750 digits.
15751
15752 @item
15753 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15754 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15755 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15756 followed by a @samp{C}.
15757
15758 @item
15759 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15760 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15761 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15762 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15763 sequences.
15764
15765 @item
15766 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15767
15768 @item
15769 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15770 @code{FALSE}.
15771
15772 @item
15773 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15774
15775 @item
15776 Set constants are not yet supported.
15777 @end itemize
15778
15779 @node M2 Types
15780 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15781 @cindex Modula-2 types
15782
15783 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15784 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15785 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15786 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15787 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15788 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15789
15790 The first example contains the following section of code:
15791
15792 @smallexample
15793 VAR
15794 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15795 r: [20..40] ;
15796 @end smallexample
15797
15798 @noindent
15799 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15800 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15801
15802 @smallexample
15803 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15804 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15805 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15806 SET OF CHAR
15807 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15808 21
15809 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15810 [20..40]
15811 @end smallexample
15812
15813 @noindent
15814 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15815
15816 @smallexample
15817 VAR
15818 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15819 @end smallexample
15820
15821 @noindent
15822 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15823
15824 @smallexample
15825 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15826 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15827 @end smallexample
15828
15829 @noindent
15830 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15831 expressions using the debugger.
15832
15833 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15834 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15835
15836 @smallexample
15837 VAR
15838 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15839 @end smallexample
15840
15841 @smallexample
15842 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15843 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15844 @end smallexample
15845
15846 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15847 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15848 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15849 above.
15850
15851 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15852
15853 @smallexample
15854 TYPE
15855 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15856 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15857 VAR
15858 s: t ;
15859 BEGIN
15860 s := blue ;
15861 @end smallexample
15862
15863 @noindent
15864 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15865 and value of a variable.
15866
15867 @smallexample
15868 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15869 $1 = blue
15870 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15871 type = [blue..yellow]
15872 @end smallexample
15873
15874 @noindent
15875 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15876 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15877 their @code{C} counterparts.
15878
15879 @smallexample
15880 VAR
15881 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15882 BEGIN
15883 s[1] := 1 ;
15884 @end smallexample
15885
15886 @smallexample
15887 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15888 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15889 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15890 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15891 @end smallexample
15892
15893 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15894 pointer types as shown in this example:
15895
15896 @smallexample
15897 VAR
15898 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15899 BEGIN
15900 NEW(s) ;
15901 s^[1] := 1 ;
15902 @end smallexample
15903
15904 @noindent
15905 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15906
15907 @smallexample
15908 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15909 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15910 @end smallexample
15911
15912 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15913 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15914 types:
15915
15916 @smallexample
15917 TYPE
15918 foo = RECORD
15919 f1: CARDINAL ;
15920 f2: CHAR ;
15921 f3: myarray ;
15922 END ;
15923
15924 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15925 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15926 VAR
15927 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15928 @end smallexample
15929
15930 @noindent
15931 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15932 below.
15933
15934 @smallexample
15935 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15936 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15937 f1 : CARDINAL;
15938 f2 : CHAR;
15939 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15940 END
15941 @end smallexample
15942
15943 @node M2 Defaults
15944 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15945 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15946
15947 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15948 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15949 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15950 selected the working language.
15951
15952 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15953 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15954 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15955 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15956
15957 @node Deviations
15958 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15959 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15960
15961 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15962 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15963
15964 @itemize @bullet
15965 @item
15966 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15967 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15968 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15969 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15970 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15971 returned a pointer.)
15972
15973 @item
15974 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15975 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15976 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15977 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15978
15979 @item
15980 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15981 argument.
15982
15983 @item
15984 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15985 @end itemize
15986
15987 @node M2 Checks
15988 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15989 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15990
15991 @quotation
15992 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15993 range checking.
15994 @end quotation
15995 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15996
15997 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15998
15999 @itemize @bullet
16000 @item
16001 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16002 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16003
16004 @item
16005 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16006 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16007 @end itemize
16008
16009 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16010 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16011
16012 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16013 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16014
16015 @node M2 Scope
16016 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16017 @cindex scope
16018 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16019 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16020 @ifinfo
16021 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16022 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16023 @end ifinfo
16024 @ifnotinfo
16025 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16026 @end ifnotinfo
16027
16028 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16029 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16030 similar syntax:
16031
16032 @smallexample
16033
16034 @var{module} . @var{id}
16035 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16036 @end smallexample
16037
16038 @noindent
16039 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16040 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16041 identifier within your program, except another module.
16042
16043 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16044 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16045 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16046 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16047
16048 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16049 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16050 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16051 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16052 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16053 @var{module}.
16054
16055 @node GDB/M2
16056 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16057
16058 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16059 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16060 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16061 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16062 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16063 analogue in Modula-2.
16064
16065 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16066 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16067 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16068 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16069 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16070 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16071
16072 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16073 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16074 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16075
16076 @node Ada
16077 @subsection Ada
16078 @cindex Ada
16079
16080 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16081 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16082 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16083 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16084 to be difficult.
16085
16086
16087 @cindex expressions in Ada
16088 @menu
16089 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16090 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16091 in @value{GDBN}.
16092 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16093 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16094 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16095 subprograms.
16096 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16097 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16098 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16099 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16100 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16101 Profile
16102 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16103 @end menu
16104
16105 @node Ada Mode Intro
16106 @subsubsection Introduction
16107 @cindex Ada mode, general
16108
16109 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16110 syntax, with some extensions.
16111 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16112
16113 @itemize @bullet
16114 @item
16115 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16116 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16117 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16118 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16119
16120 @item
16121 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16122 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16123
16124 @item
16125 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16126 @end itemize
16127
16128 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16129 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16130 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16131 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16132 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16133
16134 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16135 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16136 was translated from an Ada source file.
16137
16138 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16139 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16140 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16141 middle (to allow based literals).
16142
16143 @node Omissions from Ada
16144 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16145 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16146
16147 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16148
16149 @itemize @bullet
16150 @item
16151 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16152
16153 @itemize @minus
16154 @item
16155 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16156 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16157
16158 @item
16159 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16160
16161 @item
16162 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16163
16164 @item
16165 @t{'Tag}.
16166
16167 @item
16168 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16169 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16170
16171 @item
16172 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16173 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16174
16175 @item
16176 @t{'Address}.
16177 @end itemize
16178
16179 @item
16180 The names in
16181 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16182 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16183 not currently available.
16184
16185 @item
16186 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16187 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16188 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16189 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16190 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16191 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16192 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16193 indeterminate values.
16194
16195 @item
16196 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16197 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16198 are not implemented.
16199
16200 @item
16201 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16202 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16203 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16204 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16205 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16206
16207 @smallexample
16208 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16209 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16210 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16211 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16212 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16213 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16214 @end smallexample
16215
16216 Changing a
16217 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16218 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16219 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16220 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16221 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16222 declared to have a type such as:
16223
16224 @smallexample
16225 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16226 Id : Integer;
16227 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16228 end record;
16229 @end smallexample
16230
16231 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16232 assignments:
16233
16234 @smallexample
16235 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16236 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16237 @end smallexample
16238
16239 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16240 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16241 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16242 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16243 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16244 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16245 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16246 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16247
16248 @item
16249 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16250
16251 @item
16252 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16253 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16254 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16255 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16256 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16257 the proper resolution.
16258
16259 @item
16260 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16261
16262 @item
16263 Entry calls are not implemented.
16264
16265 @item
16266 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16267 formats are not supported.
16268
16269 @item
16270 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16271
16272 @item
16273 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16274 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16275 context.
16276 Should your program
16277 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16278 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16279 @end itemize
16280
16281 @node Additions to Ada
16282 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16283 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16284
16285 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16286 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16287
16288 @itemize @bullet
16289 @item
16290 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16291 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16292 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16293 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16294 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16295 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16296 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16297 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16298
16299 @item
16300 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16301 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16302 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16303
16304 @item
16305 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16306 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16307
16308 @item
16309 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16310 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16311 @end itemize
16312
16313 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16314 additions specific to Ada:
16315
16316 @itemize @bullet
16317 @item
16318 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16319 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16320
16321 @smallexample
16322 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16323 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16324 @end smallexample
16325
16326 @item
16327 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16328 the value of its right-hand operand.
16329 This allows, for example,
16330 complex conditional breaks:
16331
16332 @smallexample
16333 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16334 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16335 @end smallexample
16336
16337 @item
16338 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16339 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16340 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16341 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16342 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16343 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16344 in strings. For example,
16345 @smallexample
16346 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16347 @end smallexample
16348 @noindent
16349 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16350 after each period.
16351
16352 @item
16353 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16354 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16355 to write
16356
16357 @smallexample
16358 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16359 @end smallexample
16360
16361 @item
16362 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16363 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16364 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16365 of 3 might print as
16366
16367 @smallexample
16368 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16369 @end smallexample
16370
16371 @noindent
16372 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16373 clause.
16374
16375 @item
16376 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16377 multi-character subsequence of
16378 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16379 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16380 in place of @t{a'length}.
16381
16382 @item
16383 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16384 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16385 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16386 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16387 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16388 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16389 For example,
16390 @smallexample
16391 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16392 @end smallexample
16393
16394 @item
16395 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16396 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16397 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16398 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16399 object.
16400
16401 @end itemize
16402
16403 @node Overloading support for Ada
16404 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16405 @cindex overloading, Ada
16406
16407 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16408 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16409 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16410 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16411 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16412 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16413
16414 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16415 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16416 use, for instance:
16417
16418 @smallexample
16419 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16420 Multiple matches for f
16421 [0] cancel
16422 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16423 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16424 >
16425 @end smallexample
16426
16427 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16428 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16429 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16430
16431 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16432 case:
16433
16434 @table @code
16435
16436 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16437 @item set ada print-signatures
16438 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16439 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16440 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16441
16442 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16443 @item show ada print-signatures
16444 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16445 overloads selection menu.
16446 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16447
16448 @end table
16449
16450 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16451 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16452
16453 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16454 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16455 before reaching the main procedure.
16456 As defined in the Ada Reference
16457 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16458 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16459 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16460 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16461
16462 @node Ada Exceptions
16463 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16464
16465 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16466
16467 @table @code
16468 @kindex info exceptions
16469 @item info exceptions
16470 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16471 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16472 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16473 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16474 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16475 @end table
16476
16477 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16478 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16479 argument.
16480
16481 @smallexample
16482 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16483 All defined Ada exceptions:
16484 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16485 program_error: 0x613d20
16486 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16487 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16488 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16489 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16490 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16491 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16492 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16493 @end smallexample
16494
16495 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16496 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16497
16498 @node Ada Tasks
16499 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16500 @cindex Ada, tasking
16501
16502 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16503 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16504
16505 @table @code
16506 @kindex info tasks
16507 @item info tasks
16508 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16509
16510
16511 @smallexample
16512 @iftex
16513 @leftskip=0.5cm
16514 @end iftex
16515 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16516 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16517 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16518 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16519 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16520 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16521
16522 @end smallexample
16523
16524 @noindent
16525 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16526 task currently being inspected.
16527
16528 @table @asis
16529 @item ID
16530 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16531
16532 @item TID
16533 The Ada task ID.
16534
16535 @item P-ID
16536 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16537
16538 @item Pri
16539 The base priority of the task.
16540
16541 @item State
16542 Current state of the task.
16543
16544 @table @code
16545 @item Unactivated
16546 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16547 executing.
16548
16549 @item Runnable
16550 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16551 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16552
16553 @item Terminated
16554 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16555 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16556 terminated themselves.
16557
16558 @item Child Activation Wait
16559 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16560
16561 @item Accept Statement
16562 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16563
16564 @item Waiting on entry call
16565 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16566
16567 @item Async Select Wait
16568 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16569 select statement.
16570
16571 @item Delay Sleep
16572 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16573 alternative open.
16574
16575 @item Child Termination Wait
16576 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16577 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16578 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16579
16580 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16581 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16582 finish terminating.
16583
16584 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16585 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16586 @end table
16587
16588 @item Name
16589 Name of the task in the program.
16590
16591 @end table
16592
16593 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16594 @item info task @var{taskno}
16595 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16596 the following example:
16597 @smallexample
16598 @iftex
16599 @leftskip=0.5cm
16600 @end iftex
16601 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16602 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16603 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16604 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16605 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16606 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16607 Name: task_1
16608 Thread: 0x807f378
16609 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16610 Base Priority: 15
16611 State: Runnable
16612 @end smallexample
16613
16614 @item task
16615 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16616 @cindex current Ada task ID
16617 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16618
16619 @smallexample
16620 @iftex
16621 @leftskip=0.5cm
16622 @end iftex
16623 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16624 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16625 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16626 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16627 (@value{GDBP}) task
16628 [Current task is 2]
16629 @end smallexample
16630
16631 @item task @var{taskno}
16632 @cindex Ada task switching
16633 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16634 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16635 from the current task to the given task.
16636
16637 @smallexample
16638 @iftex
16639 @leftskip=0.5cm
16640 @end iftex
16641 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16642 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16643 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16644 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16645 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16646 [Switching to task 1]
16647 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16648 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16649 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16650 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16651 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16652 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16653 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16654 @end smallexample
16655
16656 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16657 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16658 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16659 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16660 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16661 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16662 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16663 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16664 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16665
16666 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16667 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16668 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16669 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16670 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16671
16672 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16673 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16674 program.
16675
16676 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16677 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16678 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16679
16680 For example,
16681
16682 @smallexample
16683 @iftex
16684 @leftskip=0.5cm
16685 @end iftex
16686 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16687 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16688 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16689 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16690 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16691 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16692 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16693 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16694 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16695 Continuing.
16696 task # 1 running
16697 task # 2 running
16698
16699 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16700 15 flush;
16701 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16702 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16703 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16704 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16705 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16706 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16707 @end smallexample
16708 @end table
16709
16710 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16711 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16712 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16713
16714 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16715 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16716 the platform being used.
16717 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16718 switching is not supported.
16719
16720 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16721 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16722 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16723 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16724 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16725 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16726
16727 @node Ravenscar Profile
16728 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16729 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16730
16731 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16732 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16733 requirements.
16734
16735 @table @code
16736 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16737 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16738 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16739 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16740 Profile. This is the default.
16741
16742 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16743 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16744 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16745 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16746 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16747 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16748 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16749
16750 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16751 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16752 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16753 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16754
16755 @end table
16756
16757 @node Ada Glitches
16758 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16759 @cindex Ada, problems
16760
16761 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16762 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16763 @value{GDBN},
16764 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16765 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16766
16767 @itemize @bullet
16768 @item
16769 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16770 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16771
16772 @item
16773 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16774 argument lists are treated as positional).
16775
16776 @item
16777 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16778
16779 @item
16780 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16781 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16782 the host machine.
16783
16784 @item
16785 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16786 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16787 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16788 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16789 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16790 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16791 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16792 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16793 you can usually resolve the confusion
16794 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16795 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16796 @end itemize
16797
16798 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16799 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16800 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16801 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16802 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16803 enabled.
16804
16805 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16806 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16807 @table @code
16808
16809 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16810 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16811 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16812 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16813 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16814 This is the default.
16815
16816 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16817 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16818 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16819 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16820 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16821 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16822 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16823
16824 @end table
16825
16826 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16827 @cindex GNAT encoding
16828 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16829 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16830 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16831 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16832 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16833 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16834
16835 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16836 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16837 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16838 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16839 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16840 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16841 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16842 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16843
16844 @table @code
16845
16846 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16847 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16848 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16849 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16850
16851 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16852 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16853 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16854
16855 @end table
16856
16857 @node Unsupported Languages
16858 @section Unsupported Languages
16859
16860 @cindex unsupported languages
16861 @cindex minimal language
16862 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16863 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16864 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16865 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16866 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16867 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16868
16869 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16870 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16871 language.
16872
16873 @node Symbols
16874 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16875
16876 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16877 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16878 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16879 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16880 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16881 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16882 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16883
16884 @cindex symbol names
16885 @cindex names of symbols
16886 @cindex quoting names
16887 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16888 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16889 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16890 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16891 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16892 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16893 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16894 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16895
16896 @smallexample
16897 p 'foo.c'::x
16898 @end smallexample
16899
16900 @noindent
16901 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16902
16903 @table @code
16904 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16905 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16906 @kindex set case-sensitive
16907 @item set case-sensitive on
16908 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16909 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16910 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16911 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16912 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16913 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16914 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16915 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16916 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16917 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16918 case-insensitive matches.
16919
16920 @kindex show case-sensitive
16921 @item show case-sensitive
16922 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16923 lookups.
16924
16925 @kindex set print type methods
16926 @item set print type methods
16927 @itemx set print type methods on
16928 @itemx set print type methods off
16929 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16930 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16931 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16932 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16933 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16934 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16935
16936 @kindex show print type methods
16937 @item show print type methods
16938 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16939 classes.
16940
16941 @kindex set print type typedefs
16942 @item set print type typedefs
16943 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16944 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16945
16946 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16947 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16948 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16949 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16950 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16951 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16952 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16953 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16954 types.
16955
16956 @kindex show print type typedefs
16957 @item show print type typedefs
16958 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16959 printing classes.
16960
16961 @kindex info address
16962 @cindex address of a symbol
16963 @item info address @var{symbol}
16964 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16965 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16966 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16967 is always stored.
16968
16969 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16970 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16971 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16972
16973 @kindex info symbol
16974 @cindex symbol from address
16975 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16976 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16977 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16978 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16979 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16980
16981 @smallexample
16982 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16983 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16984 @end smallexample
16985
16986 @noindent
16987 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16988 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16989
16990 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16991 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16992
16993 @smallexample
16994 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16995 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16996 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16997 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16998 @end smallexample
16999
17000 @kindex demangle
17001 @cindex demangle
17002 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17003 Demangle @var{name}.
17004 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17005 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17006
17007 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17008 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17009
17010 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17011 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17012
17013 @kindex whatis
17014 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17015 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17016 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17017 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17018
17019 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17020 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17021 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17022
17023 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17024 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17025 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17026 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17027 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17028 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17029 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17030 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17031 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17032
17033 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17034 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17035 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17036 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17037 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17038 unroll it.
17039
17040 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17041 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17042 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17043
17044 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17045 Available flags are:
17046
17047 @table @code
17048 @item r
17049 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17050 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17051 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17052
17053 @item m
17054 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17055
17056 @item M
17057 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17058 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17059
17060 @item t
17061 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17062 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17063 names are substituted when printing other types.
17064
17065 @item T
17066 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17067 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17068 @end table
17069
17070 @kindex ptype
17071 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17072 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17073 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17074 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17075
17076 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17077 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17078 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17079 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17080 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17081 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17082 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17083 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17084
17085 For example, for this variable declaration:
17086
17087 @smallexample
17088 typedef double real_t;
17089 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17090 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17091 complex_t var;
17092 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17093 @end smallexample
17094
17095 @noindent
17096 the two commands give this output:
17097
17098 @smallexample
17099 @group
17100 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17101 type = complex_t
17102 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17103 type = struct complex @{
17104 real_t real;
17105 double imag;
17106 @}
17107 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17108 type = struct complex
17109 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17110 type = struct complex
17111 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17112 type = struct complex @{
17113 real_t real;
17114 double imag;
17115 @}
17116 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17117 type = real_t *
17118 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17119 type = double *
17120 @end group
17121 @end smallexample
17122
17123 @noindent
17124 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17125 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17126
17127 @cindex incomplete type
17128 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17129 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17130 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17131 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17132 given these declarations:
17133
17134 @smallexample
17135 struct foo;
17136 struct foo *fooptr;
17137 @end smallexample
17138
17139 @noindent
17140 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17141
17142 @smallexample
17143 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17144 $1 = <incomplete type>
17145 @end smallexample
17146
17147 @noindent
17148 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17149 completely specified.
17150
17151 @cindex unknown type
17152 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17153 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17154 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17155 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17156 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17157 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17158 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17159 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17160
17161 @smallexample
17162 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17163 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17164 @end smallexample
17165
17166 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17167 of such variables.
17168
17169 @kindex info types
17170 @item info types @var{regexp}
17171 @itemx info types
17172 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17173 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17174 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17175 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17176 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17177 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17178 name is @code{value}.
17179
17180 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17181 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17182 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17183
17184 @kindex info type-printers
17185 @item info type-printers
17186 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17187 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17188 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17189 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17190 type printers.
17191
17192 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17193
17194 @kindex enable type-printer
17195 @kindex disable type-printer
17196 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17197 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17198 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17199
17200 @kindex info scope
17201 @cindex local variables
17202 @item info scope @var{location}
17203 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17204 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17205 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17206 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17207 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17208
17209 @smallexample
17210 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17211 Scope for command_line_handler:
17212 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17213 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17214 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17215 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17216 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17217 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17218 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17219 @end smallexample
17220
17221 @noindent
17222 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17223 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17224 collect}.
17225
17226 @kindex info source
17227 @item info source
17228 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17229 the function containing the current point of execution:
17230 @itemize @bullet
17231 @item
17232 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17233 @item
17234 the directory it was compiled in,
17235 @item
17236 its length, in lines,
17237 @item
17238 which programming language it is written in,
17239 @item
17240 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17241 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17242 @item
17243 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17244 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17245 @item
17246 whether the debugging information includes information about
17247 preprocessor macros.
17248 @end itemize
17249
17250
17251 @kindex info sources
17252 @item info sources
17253 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17254 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17255 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17256
17257 @kindex info functions
17258 @item info functions
17259 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17260
17261 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17262 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17263 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17264 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17265 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17266 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17267 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17268 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17269
17270 @kindex info variables
17271 @item info variables
17272 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17273 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17274
17275 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17276 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17277 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17278 @var{regexp}.
17279
17280 @kindex info classes
17281 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17282 @item info classes
17283 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17284 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17285 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17286 expression.
17287
17288 @kindex info selectors
17289 @item info selectors
17290 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17291 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17292 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17293 expression.
17294
17295 @ignore
17296 This was never implemented.
17297 @kindex info methods
17298 @item info methods
17299 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17300 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17301 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17302 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17303 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17304 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17305 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17306 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17307 @end ignore
17308
17309 @cindex opaque data types
17310 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17311 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17312 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17313 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17314 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17315 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17316 another source file. The default is on.
17317
17318 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17319 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17320
17321 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17322 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17323 is printed as follows:
17324 @smallexample
17325 @{<no data fields>@}
17326 @end smallexample
17327
17328 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17329 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17330 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17331
17332 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17333 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17334 @item set print symbol-loading
17335 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17336 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17337 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17338 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17339 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17340 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17341 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17342 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17343 can be annoying.
17344 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17345 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17346 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17347 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17348
17349 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17350 @item show print symbol-loading
17351 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17352 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17353
17354 @kindex maint print symbols
17355 @cindex symbol dump
17356 @kindex maint print psymbols
17357 @cindex partial symbol dump
17358 @kindex maint print msymbols
17359 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17360 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17361 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17362 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17363 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17364 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17365 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17366 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17367 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17368 that objfile.
17369 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17370 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17371 @code{main}.
17372 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17373 source file.
17374
17375 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17376 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17377 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17378 tables.
17379 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17380 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17381 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17382 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17383 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17384 ``ELF symbols''.
17385
17386 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17387 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17388
17389 @kindex maint info symtabs
17390 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17391 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17392 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17393 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17394 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17395 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17396 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17397
17398 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17399 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17400 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17401 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17402 structure in more detail. For example:
17403
17404 @smallexample
17405 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17406 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17407 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17408 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17409 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17410 readin no
17411 fullname (null)
17412 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17413 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17414 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17415 dependencies (none)
17416 @}
17417 @}
17418 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17419 (@value{GDBP})
17420 @end smallexample
17421 @noindent
17422 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17423 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17424 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17425 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17426 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17427
17428 @smallexample
17429 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17430 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17431 line 1574.
17432 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17433 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17434 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17435 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17436 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17437 dirname (null)
17438 fullname (null)
17439 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17440 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17441 debugformat DWARF 2
17442 @}
17443 @}
17444 (@value{GDBP})
17445 @end smallexample
17446
17447 @kindex maint info line-table
17448 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17449 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17450 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17451
17452 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17453 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17454 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17455
17456 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17457 @cindex symbol cache size
17458 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17459 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17460 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17461 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17462 with different sizes.
17463
17464 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17465 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17466 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17467
17468 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17469 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17470 @item maint print symbol-cache
17471 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17472 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17473
17474 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17475 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17476 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17477 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17478 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17479
17480 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17481 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17482 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17483 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17484 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17485 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17486
17487 @end table
17488
17489 @node Altering
17490 @chapter Altering Execution
17491
17492 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17493 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17494 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17495 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17496 program.
17497
17498 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17499 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17500 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17501
17502 @menu
17503 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17504 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17505 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17506 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17507 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17508 * Patching:: Patching your program
17509 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17510 @end menu
17511
17512 @node Assignment
17513 @section Assignment to Variables
17514
17515 @cindex assignment
17516 @cindex setting variables
17517 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17518 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17519
17520 @smallexample
17521 print x=4
17522 @end smallexample
17523
17524 @noindent
17525 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17526 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17527 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17528 information on operators in supported languages.
17529
17530 @kindex set variable
17531 @cindex variables, setting
17532 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17533 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17534 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17535 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17536 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17537
17538 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17539 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17540 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17541 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17542 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17543 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17544 command @code{set width}:
17545
17546 @smallexample
17547 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17548 type = double
17549 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17550 $4 = 13
17551 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17552 Invalid syntax in expression.
17553 @end smallexample
17554
17555 @noindent
17556 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17557 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17558
17559 @smallexample
17560 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17561 @end smallexample
17562
17563 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17564 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17565 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17566 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17567 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17568 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17569
17570 @smallexample
17571 @group
17572 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17573 type = double
17574 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17575 $1 = 1
17576 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17577 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17578 $2 = 1
17579 (@value{GDBP}) r
17580 The program being debugged has been started already.
17581 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17582 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17583 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17584 Invalid bfd target.
17585 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17586 The current BFD target is "=4".
17587 @end group
17588 @end smallexample
17589
17590 @noindent
17591 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17592 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17593 @code{g}, use
17594
17595 @smallexample
17596 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17597 @end smallexample
17598
17599 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17600 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17601 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17602 same length or shorter.
17603 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17604 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17605
17606 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17607 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17608 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17609 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17610 and representation in memory), and
17611
17612 @smallexample
17613 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17614 @end smallexample
17615
17616 @noindent
17617 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17618
17619 @node Jumping
17620 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17621
17622 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17623 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17624 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17625
17626 @table @code
17627 @kindex jump
17628 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17629 @item jump @var{location}
17630 @itemx j @var{location}
17631 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17632 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17633 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17634 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17635 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17636
17637 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17638 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17639 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17640 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17641 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17642 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17643 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17644 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17645 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17646 @end table
17647
17648 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17649 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17650 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17651 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17652 example,
17653
17654 @smallexample
17655 set $pc = 0x485
17656 @end smallexample
17657
17658 @noindent
17659 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17660 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17661 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17662
17663 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17664 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17665 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17666 detail.
17667
17668 @c @group
17669 @node Signaling
17670 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17671 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17672
17673 @table @code
17674 @kindex signal
17675 @item signal @var{signal}
17676 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17677 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17678 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17679 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17680
17681 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17682 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17683 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17684 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17685 signal.
17686
17687 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17688 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17689 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17690 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17691 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17692 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17693 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17694 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17695
17696 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17697 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17698 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17699 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17700 passes the signal directly to your program.
17701
17702 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17703 after executing the command.
17704
17705 @kindex queue-signal
17706 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17707 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17708 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17709 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17710 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17711 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17712 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17713 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17714 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17715
17716 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17717 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17718 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17719 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17720 @code{continue} command.
17721
17722 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17723 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17724 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17725 (@pxref{Signals}).
17726 @end table
17727 @c @end group
17728
17729 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17730 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17731
17732 @node Returning
17733 @section Returning from a Function
17734
17735 @table @code
17736 @cindex returning from a function
17737 @kindex return
17738 @item return
17739 @itemx return @var{expression}
17740 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17741 command. If you give an
17742 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17743 value.
17744 @end table
17745
17746 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17747 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17748 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17749 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17750
17751 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17752 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17753 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17754 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17755 of functions.
17756
17757 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17758 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17759 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17760 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17761 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17762
17763 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17764 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17765 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17766 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17767 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17768 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17769 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17770 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17771 assignment into the right register(s).
17772
17773 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17774 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17775 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17776 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17777 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17778 into a @code{long long int}:
17779
17780 @smallexample
17781 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17782 29 return 31;
17783 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17784 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17785 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17786 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17787 (@value{GDBP})
17788 @end smallexample
17789
17790 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17791 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17792 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17793 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17794 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17795 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17796 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17797 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17798
17799 @smallexample
17800 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17801 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17802 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17803 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17804 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17805 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17806 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17807 (@value{GDBP})
17808 @end smallexample
17809
17810 @node Calling
17811 @section Calling Program Functions
17812
17813 @table @code
17814 @cindex calling functions
17815 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17816 @item print @var{expr}
17817 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17818 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17819 debugged.
17820
17821 @kindex call
17822 @item call @var{expr}
17823 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17824 returned values.
17825
17826 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17827 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17828 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17829 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17830 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17831 value history.
17832 @end table
17833
17834 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17835 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17836 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17837 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17838
17839 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17840 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17841 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17842 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17843 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17844 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17845 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17846 in that case is controlled by the
17847 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17848
17849 @table @code
17850 @item set unwindonsignal
17851 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17852 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17853 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17854 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17855 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17856 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17857 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17858 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17859 received.
17860
17861 @item show unwindonsignal
17862 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17863 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17864 @value{GDBN}.
17865
17866 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17867 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17868 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17869 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17870 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17871 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17872 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17873 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17874 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17875 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17876
17877 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17878 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17879 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17880 @value{GDBN}.
17881
17882 @end table
17883
17884 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
17885
17886 @cindex no debug info functions
17887 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
17888 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
17889 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
17890 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
17891 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
17892 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
17893
17894 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
17895 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
17896 declared return type. For example:
17897
17898 @smallexample
17899 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
17900 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
17901 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
17902 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
17903 @end smallexample
17904
17905 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
17906 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
17907 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
17908 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
17909
17910 @smallexample
17911 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
17912 @end smallexample
17913
17914 @noindent
17915 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
17916
17917 @smallexample
17918 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
17919 @end smallexample
17920
17921 @noindent
17922 these calls are equivalent:
17923
17924 @smallexample
17925 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
17926 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17927 @end smallexample
17928
17929 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
17930 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
17931 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
17932 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
17933 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
17934 float parameters, and no debug info:
17935
17936 @smallexample
17937 float
17938 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
17939 float v1, v2;
17940 @{
17941 return v1 * v2;
17942 @}
17943 @end smallexample
17944
17945 @noindent
17946 you call it like this:
17947
17948 @smallexample
17949 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17950 @end smallexample
17951
17952 @node Patching
17953 @section Patching Programs
17954
17955 @cindex patching binaries
17956 @cindex writing into executables
17957 @cindex writing into corefiles
17958
17959 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17960 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17961 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17962 patching your program's binary.
17963
17964 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17965 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17966 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17967 repairs.
17968
17969 @table @code
17970 @kindex set write
17971 @item set write on
17972 @itemx set write off
17973 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17974 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17975 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17976
17977 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17978 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17979 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17980
17981 @item show write
17982 @kindex show write
17983 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17984 as well as reading.
17985 @end table
17986
17987 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17988 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17989 @cindex injecting code
17990 @cindex writing into executables
17991 @cindex compiling code
17992
17993 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17994 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17995 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17996 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17997
17998 @table @code
17999 @kindex compile code
18000 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18001 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18002 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18003 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18004 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18005 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18006 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18007 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18008 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18009 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18010 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18011 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18012
18013 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18014 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18015 E.g.:
18016
18017 @smallexample
18018 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18019 @end smallexample
18020
18021 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18022 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18023 from actual source code. E.g.:
18024
18025 @smallexample
18026 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18027 @end smallexample
18028
18029 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18030 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18031 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18032 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18033 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18034 editor.
18035
18036 @smallexample
18037 compile code
18038 >printf ("hello\n");
18039 >printf ("world\n");
18040 >end
18041 @end smallexample
18042
18043 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18044 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18045 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18046 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18047 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18048 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18049 inferior symbols otherwise.
18050
18051 @kindex compile file
18052 @item compile file @var{filename}
18053 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18054 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18055
18056 @smallexample
18057 compile file /home/user/example.c
18058 @end smallexample
18059 @end table
18060
18061 @table @code
18062 @item compile print @var{expr}
18063 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18064 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18065 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18066 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18067 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18068 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18069 Formats}.
18070
18071 @item compile print
18072 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18073 @cindex reprint the last value
18074 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18075 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18076 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18077 multiple-line editor.
18078 @end table
18079
18080 @noindent
18081 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18082
18083 @table @code
18084 @anchor{set debug compile}
18085 @item set debug compile
18086 @cindex compile command debugging info
18087 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18088 injecting the code. The default is off.
18089
18090 @item show debug compile
18091 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18092 compiling and injecting the code.
18093 @end table
18094
18095 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18096
18097 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18098 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18099 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18100 injecting process.
18101
18102 @noindent
18103 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18104
18105 @table @asis
18106 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18107 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18108 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18109 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18110
18111 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18112 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18113 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18114 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18115 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18116 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18117 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18118 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18119
18120 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18121 @end table
18122
18123 @noindent
18124 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18125
18126 @table @code
18127 @item set compile-args
18128 @cindex compile command options override
18129 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18130 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18131 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18132 compilation.
18133
18134 @item show compile-args
18135 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18136 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18137 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18138 @end table
18139
18140 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18141
18142 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18143 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18144 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18145
18146 @table @asis
18147 @item C code examples and caveats
18148 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18149 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18150 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18151 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18152 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18153
18154 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18155 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18156 much like any other normal debugging session.
18157
18158 @smallexample
18159 void function1 (void)
18160 @{
18161 int i = 42;
18162 printf ("function 1\n");
18163 @}
18164
18165 void function2 (void)
18166 @{
18167 int j = 12;
18168 function1 ();
18169 @}
18170
18171 int main(void)
18172 @{
18173 int k = 6;
18174 int *p;
18175 function2 ();
18176 return 0;
18177 @}
18178 @end smallexample
18179
18180 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18181 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18182 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18183
18184 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18185 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18186 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18187 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18188 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18189
18190 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18191 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18192 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18193 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18194 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18195 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18196 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18197 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18198 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18199 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18200
18201 @smallexample
18202 compile code k = 3;
18203 @end smallexample
18204
18205 @noindent
18206 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18207 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18208 @code{compile} command changes it.
18209
18210 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18211 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18212 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18213 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18214 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18215
18216 @smallexample
18217 compile code j = 3;
18218 @end smallexample
18219
18220 @noindent
18221 will result in a compilation error message.
18222
18223 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18224 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18225 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18226
18227 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18228 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18229 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18230 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18231
18232 @smallexample
18233 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18234 @end smallexample
18235
18236 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18237 command has completed:
18238
18239 @smallexample
18240 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18241 @end smallexample
18242
18243 @noindent
18244 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18245 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18246 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18247 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18248 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18249
18250 @smallexample
18251 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18252 @end smallexample
18253
18254 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18255 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18256 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18257 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18258 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18259 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18260 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18261 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18262
18263 @smallexample
18264 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18265 @end smallexample
18266
18267 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18268 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18269 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18270 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18271 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18272 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18273 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18274
18275 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18276 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18277 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18278 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18279 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18280 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18281
18282 @smallexample
18283 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18284 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18285 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18286 Compilation failed.
18287 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18288 42
18289 @end smallexample
18290
18291 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18292 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18293 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18294 will print to the console.
18295 @end table
18296
18297 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18298
18299 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18300 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18301 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18302 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18303 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18304 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18305 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18306 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18307
18308
18309 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18310 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18311 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18312 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18313 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18314 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18315 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18316
18317 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18318 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18319 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18320 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18321 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18322 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18323 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18324
18325 @table @code
18326 @item set compile-gcc
18327 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18328 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18329 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18330 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18331 default.
18332
18333 @item show compile-gcc
18334 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18335 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18336 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18337 @end table
18338
18339 @node GDB Files
18340 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18341
18342 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18343 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18344 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18345 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18346
18347 @menu
18348 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18349 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18350 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18351 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18352 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18353 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18354 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18355 @end menu
18356
18357 @node Files
18358 @section Commands to Specify Files
18359
18360 @cindex symbol table
18361 @cindex core dump file
18362
18363 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18364 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18365 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18366 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18367
18368 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18369 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18370 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18371 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18372 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18373 new files are useful.
18374
18375 @table @code
18376 @cindex executable file
18377 @kindex file
18378 @item file @var{filename}
18379 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18380 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18381 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18382 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18383 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18384 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18385 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18386 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18387
18388 @cindex unlinked object files
18389 @cindex patching object files
18390 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18391 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18392 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18393 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18394 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18395 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18396 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18397 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18398
18399 @item file
18400 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18401 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18402
18403 @kindex exec-file
18404 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18405 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18406 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18407 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18408 discard information on the executable file.
18409
18410 @kindex symbol-file
18411 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18412 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18413 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18414 table and program to run from the same file.
18415
18416 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18417 program's symbol table.
18418
18419 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18420 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18421 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18422 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18423 @value{GDBN}.
18424
18425 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18426 executing it once.
18427
18428 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18429 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18430 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18431 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18432 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18433 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18434 optimized code.
18435
18436 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18437 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18438 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18439 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18440 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18441
18442 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18443 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18444 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18445 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18446 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18447 Warnings and Messages}.)
18448
18449 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18450 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18451 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18452 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18453 in stabs format.
18454
18455 @kindex readnow
18456 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18457 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18458 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18459 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18460 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18461 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18462 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18463 entire symbol table available.
18464
18465 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18466 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18467 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18468 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18469 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18470 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18471 @c files.
18472
18473 @kindex core-file
18474 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18475 @itemx core
18476 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18477 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18478 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18479 executable file itself for other parts.
18480
18481 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18482 to be used.
18483
18484 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18485 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18486 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18487 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18488 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18489
18490 @kindex add-symbol-file
18491 @cindex dynamic linking
18492 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18493 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18494 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18495 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18496 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18497 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18498 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18499 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18500 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18501 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18502 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18503 @var{address} as an expression.
18504
18505 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18506 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18507 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18508 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18509
18510 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18511
18512 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18513 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18514 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18515 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18516 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18517 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18518 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18519 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18520 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18521
18522 @itemize @bullet
18523 @item
18524 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18525 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18526 @item
18527 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18528 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18529 @item
18530 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18531 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18532 @end itemize
18533
18534 @noindent
18535 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18536 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18537 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18538 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18539 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18540 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18541 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18542 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18543 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18544 way.
18545
18546 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18547
18548 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18549 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18550 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18551 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18552 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18553 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18557 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18558 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18559 (y or n) y
18560 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18561 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18562 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18563 (gdb)
18564 @end smallexample
18565
18566
18567 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18568
18569 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18570 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18571 @cindex load symbols from memory
18572 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18573 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18574 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18575 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18576 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18577 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18578 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18579 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18580 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18581
18582 @kindex section
18583 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18584 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18585 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18586 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18587 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18588 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18589 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18590 their addresses.
18591
18592 @kindex info files
18593 @kindex info target
18594 @item info files
18595 @itemx info target
18596 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18597 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18598 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18599 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18600 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18601 current ones.
18602
18603 @kindex maint info sections
18604 @item maint info sections
18605 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18606 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18607 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18608 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18609 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18610 may be arbitrarily combined):
18611
18612 @table @code
18613 @item ALLOBJ
18614 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18615 @item @var{sections}
18616 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18617 @item @var{section-flags}
18618 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18619 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18620 @table @code
18621 @item ALLOC
18622 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18623 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18624 @item LOAD
18625 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18626 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18627 @item RELOC
18628 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18629 @item READONLY
18630 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18631 @item CODE
18632 Section contains executable code only.
18633 @item DATA
18634 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18635 @item ROM
18636 Section will reside in ROM.
18637 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18638 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18639 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18640 Section is not empty.
18641 @item NEVER_LOAD
18642 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18643 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18644 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18645 COFF shared library information.
18646 @item IS_COMMON
18647 Section contains common symbols.
18648 @end table
18649 @end table
18650 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18651 @cindex read-only sections
18652 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18653 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18654 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18655 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18656 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18657 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18658 enhancement to debugging performance.
18659
18660 The default is off.
18661
18662 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18663 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18664 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18665 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18666
18667 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18668 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18669 @end table
18670
18671 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18672 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18673 name and remembers it that way.
18674
18675 @cindex shared libraries
18676 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18677 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18678 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18679 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18680
18681 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18682 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18683
18684 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18685 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18686 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18687 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18688 debugging a core file).
18689
18690 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18691 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18692 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18693
18694 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18695 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18696 particularly large or there are many of them.
18697
18698 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18699 commands:
18700
18701 @table @code
18702 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18703 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18704 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18705 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18706 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18707 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18708 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18709 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18710
18711 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18712 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18713 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18714 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18715 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18716 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18717 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18718 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18719 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18720
18721 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18722 @item show auto-solib-add
18723 Display the current autoloading mode.
18724 @end table
18725
18726 @cindex load shared library
18727 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18728 command:
18729
18730 @table @code
18731 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18732 @kindex info share
18733 @item info share @var{regex}
18734 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18735 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18736 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18737 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18738
18739 @kindex info dll
18740 @item info dll @var{regex}
18741 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18742
18743 @kindex sharedlibrary
18744 @kindex share
18745 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18746 @itemx share @var{regex}
18747 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18748 Unix regular expression.
18749 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18750 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18751 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18752 loaded.
18753
18754 @item nosharedlibrary
18755 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18756 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18757 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18758 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18759 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18760 discarded.
18761 @end table
18762
18763 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18764 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18765 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18766 Catchpoints}).
18767
18768 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18769 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18770 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18771 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18772
18773 @table @code
18774 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18775 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18776 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18777 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18778 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18779 shared library.
18780
18781 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18782 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18783 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18784 library events happen.
18785 @end table
18786
18787 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18788 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18789 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18790 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18791 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18792 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18793 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18794 not.
18795
18796 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18797 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18798 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18799 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18800 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18801
18802 @table @code
18803 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18804 @cindex system root, alternate
18805 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18806 @kindex set sysroot
18807 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18808 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18809 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18810 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18811 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18812 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18813 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18814 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18815 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18816 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18817 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18818 @var{path}.
18819
18820 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18821 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18822 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18823 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18824 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18825 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18826 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18827 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18828 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18829 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18830 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18831 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18832 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18833 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18834
18835 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18836 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18837 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18838 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18839 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18840
18841 @smallexample
18842 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18843 @end smallexample
18844
18845 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18846 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18847 system:
18848
18849 @smallexample
18850 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18854 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18855 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18856 colons:
18857
18858 @smallexample
18859 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18860 @end smallexample
18861
18862 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18863 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18864 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18865 @samp{z}):
18866
18867 @smallexample
18868 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18869 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18870 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18871 @end smallexample
18872
18873 @noindent
18874 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18875 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18876 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18877
18878 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18879 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18880
18881 @smallexample
18882 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18883 @end smallexample
18884
18885 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18886 if you don't want or need to.
18887
18888 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18889 sysroot}.
18890
18891 @cindex default system root
18892 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18893 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18894 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18895 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18896 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18897 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18898 location.
18899
18900 @kindex show sysroot
18901 @item show sysroot
18902 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18903
18904 @kindex set solib-search-path
18905 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18906 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18907 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18908 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18909 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18910 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18911 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18912 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18913 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18914 of shared library symbols.
18915
18916 @kindex show solib-search-path
18917 @item show solib-search-path
18918 Display the current shared library search path.
18919
18920 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18921 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18922 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18923 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18924 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18925
18926 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18927 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18928 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18929 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18930 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18931 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18932 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18933 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18934 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18935 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18936 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18937 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18938 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18939 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18940 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18941 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18942 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18943 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18944 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18945 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18946 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18947 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18948
18949 @table @code
18950 @item unix
18951 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18952 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18953 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18954 the forward slash.
18955
18956 @item dos-based
18957 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18958 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18959 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18960 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18961 considered directory separators.
18962
18963 @item auto
18964 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18965 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18966 This is the default.
18967 @end table
18968 @end table
18969
18970 @cindex file name canonicalization
18971 @cindex base name differences
18972 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18973 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18974 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18975 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18976 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18977 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18978 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18979 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18980 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18981 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18982 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18983 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18984 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18985 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18986 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18987
18988 @table @code
18989 @item set basenames-may-differ
18990 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18991 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18992
18993 @item show basenames-may-differ
18994 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18995 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18996 @end table
18997
18998 @node File Caching
18999 @section File Caching
19000 @cindex caching of opened files
19001 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19002
19003 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19004 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19005 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19006 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19007
19008 @table @code
19009 @kindex maint info bfds
19010 @item maint info bfds
19011 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19012 @value{GDBN}.
19013
19014 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19015 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19016 @kindex bfd caching
19017 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19018 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19019 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19020 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19021 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19022 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19023 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19024 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19025 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19026
19027 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19028 @kindex bfd caching
19029 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19030 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19031
19032 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19033 @kindex bfd caching
19034 @item show debug bfd-cache
19035 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19036 @end table
19037
19038 @node Separate Debug Files
19039 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19040 @cindex separate debugging information files
19041 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19042 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19043 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19044 @cindex global debugging information directories
19045 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19046 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19047
19048 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19049 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19050 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19051 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19052 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19053 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19054 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19055
19056 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19057 file:
19058
19059 @itemize @bullet
19060 @item
19061 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19062 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19063 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19064 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19065 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19066 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19067 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19068 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19069
19070 @item
19071 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19072 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19073 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19074 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19075 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19076 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19077 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19078 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19079 below.
19080 @end itemize
19081
19082 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19083 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19084
19085 @itemize @bullet
19086 @item
19087 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19088 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19089 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19090 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19091 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19092
19093 @item
19094 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19095 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19096 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19097 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19098 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19099 hex characters, not 10.)
19100 @end itemize
19101
19102 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19103 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19104 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19105 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19106 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19107 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19108
19109 @itemize @minus
19110 @item
19111 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19112 @item
19113 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19114 @item
19115 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19116 @item
19117 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19118 @end itemize
19119
19120 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19121 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19122 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19123 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19124 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19125
19126 @table @code
19127
19128 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19129 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19130 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19131 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19132 concatenating them by a path separator.
19133
19134 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19135 @item show debug-file-directory
19136 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19137 information files.
19138
19139 @end table
19140
19141 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19142 @cindex debug link sections
19143 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19144 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19145
19146 @itemize
19147 @item
19148 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19149 a zero byte,
19150 @item
19151 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19152 boundary within the section, and
19153 @item
19154 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19155 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19156 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19157 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19158 @end itemize
19159
19160 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19161 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19162 described above.
19163
19164 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19165 @cindex build ID sections
19166 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19167 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19168 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19169 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19170 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19171 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19172 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19173 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19174 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19175
19176 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19177 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19178 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19179 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19180 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19181 in an ordinary executable.
19182
19183 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19184 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19185 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19186 following commands:
19187
19188 @smallexample
19189 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19190 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19191 @end smallexample
19192
19193 @noindent
19194 These commands remove the debugging
19195 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19196 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19197 two files:
19198
19199 @itemize @bullet
19200 @item
19201 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19202 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19203
19204 @smallexample
19205 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19206 @end smallexample
19207
19208 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19209 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19210 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19211 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19212
19213 @item
19214 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19215 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19216 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19217 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19218 @end itemize
19219
19220 @noindent
19221
19222 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19223 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19224 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19225
19226 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19227 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19228 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19229 @c different ways!
19230 @ifhtml
19231 @display
19232 @html
19233 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19234 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19235 @end html
19236 @end display
19237 @end ifhtml
19238 @ifnothtml
19239 @display
19240 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19241 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19242 @end display
19243 @end ifnothtml
19244
19245 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19246 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19247 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19248 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19249 CRC.
19250
19251 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19252 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19253 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19254 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19255 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19256
19257 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19258 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19259 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19260 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19261 @code{0xffffffff}.
19262
19263 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19264 @smallexample
19265 unsigned long
19266 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19267 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19268 @{
19269 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19270 @{
19271 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19272 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19273 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19274 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19275 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19276 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19277 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19278 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19279 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19280 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19281 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19282 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19283 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19284 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19285 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19286 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19287 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19288 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19289 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19290 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19291 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19292 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19293 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19294 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19295 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19296 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19297 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19298 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19299 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19300 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19301 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19302 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19303 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19304 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19305 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19306 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19307 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19308 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19309 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19310 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19311 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19312 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19313 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19314 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19315 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19316 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19317 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19318 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19319 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19320 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19321 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19322 0x2d02ef8d
19323 @};
19324 unsigned char *end;
19325
19326 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19327 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19328 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19329 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19330 @}
19331 @end smallexample
19332
19333 @noindent
19334 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19335
19336 @node MiniDebugInfo
19337 @section Debugging information in a special section
19338 @cindex separate debug sections
19339 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19340
19341 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19342 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19343 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19344 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19345
19346 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19347 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19348 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19349 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19350 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19351 debugging information might be included in the section.
19352
19353 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19354 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19355 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19356
19357 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19358 standard utilities:
19359
19360 @smallexample
19361 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19362 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19363 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19364 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19365
19366 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19367 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19368 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19369 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19370 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19371 | sort > funcsyms
19372
19373 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19374 # table.
19375 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19376
19377 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19378 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19379
19380 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19381 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19382 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19383 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19384
19385 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19386 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19387
19388 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19389 # original binary.
19390 xz mini_debuginfo
19391 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19392 @end smallexample
19393
19394 @node Index Files
19395 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19396 @cindex index files
19397 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19398
19399 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19400 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19401 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19402 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19403 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19404 startup.
19405
19406 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19407 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19408 using @command{objcopy}.
19409
19410 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19411
19412 @table @code
19413 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19414 @kindex save gdb-index
19415 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19416 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19417 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19418 @var{directory}.
19419 @end table
19420
19421 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19422 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19423
19424 @smallexample
19425 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19426 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19427 @end smallexample
19428
19429 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19430 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19431 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19432 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19433 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19434 The default is @code{off}.
19435 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19436 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19437
19438 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19439 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19440
19441 @smallexample
19442 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19443 @end smallexample
19444
19445 Instead you must do, for example,
19446
19447 @smallexample
19448 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19449 @end smallexample
19450
19451 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19452 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19453 currently work for programs using Ada.
19454
19455 @node Symbol Errors
19456 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19457
19458 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19459 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19460 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19461 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19462 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19463 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19464 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19465 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19466 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19467 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19468 Messages}).
19469
19470 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19471
19472 @table @code
19473 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19474
19475 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19476 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19477 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19478 in its outer scope blocks.
19479
19480 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19481 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19482 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19483 function.
19484
19485 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19486
19487 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19488 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19489 do so.
19490
19491 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19492 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19493 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19494 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19495 Messages}.)
19496
19497 @item bad block start address patched
19498
19499 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19500 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19501 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19502
19503 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19504 starting on the previous source line.
19505
19506 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19507
19508 @cindex foo
19509 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19510 larger than the size of the string table.
19511
19512 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19513 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19514 with this name.
19515
19516 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19517
19518 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19519 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19520 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19521
19522 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19523 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19524 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19525 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19526 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19527 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19528
19529 @item stub type has NULL name
19530
19531 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19532
19533 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19534 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19535 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19536 it.
19537
19538 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19539
19540 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19541
19542 @end table
19543
19544 @node Data Files
19545 @section GDB Data Files
19546
19547 @cindex prefix for data files
19548 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19549 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19550
19551 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19552 is currently using.
19553
19554 @table @code
19555 @kindex set data-directory
19556 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19557 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19558 to @var{directory}.
19559
19560 @kindex show data-directory
19561 @item show data-directory
19562 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19563 @end table
19564
19565 @cindex default data directory
19566 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19567 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19568 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19569 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19570 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19571 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19572 location.
19573
19574 The data directory may also be specified with the
19575 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19576 @xref{Mode Options}.
19577
19578 @node Targets
19579 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19580
19581 @cindex debugging target
19582 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19583
19584 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19585 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19586 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19587 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19588 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19589 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19590 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19591 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19592
19593 @cindex target architecture
19594 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19595 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19596 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19597 command.
19598
19599 @table @code
19600 @kindex set architecture
19601 @kindex show architecture
19602 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19603 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19604 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19605 supported architectures.
19606
19607 @item show architecture
19608 Show the current target architecture.
19609
19610 @item set processor
19611 @itemx processor
19612 @kindex set processor
19613 @kindex show processor
19614 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19615 and @code{show architecture}.
19616 @end table
19617
19618 @menu
19619 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19620 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19621 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19622 @end menu
19623
19624 @node Active Targets
19625 @section Active Targets
19626
19627 @cindex stacking targets
19628 @cindex active targets
19629 @cindex multiple targets
19630
19631 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19632 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19633 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19634 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19635 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19636 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19637 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19638 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19639 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19640
19641 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19642 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19643 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19644 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19645
19646 @node Target Commands
19647 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19648
19649 @table @code
19650 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19651 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19652 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19653 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19654 protocol of the target machine.
19655
19656 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19657 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19658 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19659
19660 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19661 after executing the command.
19662
19663 @kindex help target
19664 @item help target
19665 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19666 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19667 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19668
19669 @item help target @var{name}
19670 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19671 select it.
19672
19673 @kindex set gnutarget
19674 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19675 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19676 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19677 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19678 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19679 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19680
19681 @quotation
19682 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19683 you must know the actual BFD name.
19684 @end quotation
19685
19686 @noindent
19687 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19688
19689 @kindex show gnutarget
19690 @item show gnutarget
19691 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19692 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19693 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19694 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19695 @end table
19696
19697 @cindex common targets
19698 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19699 configuration):
19700
19701 @table @code
19702 @kindex target
19703 @item target exec @var{program}
19704 @cindex executable file target
19705 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19706 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19707
19708 @item target core @var{filename}
19709 @cindex core dump file target
19710 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19711 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19712
19713 @item target remote @var{medium}
19714 @cindex remote target
19715 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19716 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19717 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19718
19719 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19720 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19721
19722 @smallexample
19723 target remote /dev/ttya
19724 @end smallexample
19725
19726 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19727 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19728 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19729 clobbered by the download.
19730
19731 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19732 @cindex built-in simulator target
19733 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19734 In general,
19735 @smallexample
19736 target sim
19737 load
19738 run
19739 @end smallexample
19740 @noindent
19741 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19742 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19743 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19744 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19745 Processors}.
19746
19747 @item target native
19748 @cindex native target
19749 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19750 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19751 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19752 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19753
19754 @end table
19755
19756 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19757 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19758
19759 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19760 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19761 various aspects of this process.
19762
19763 @table @code
19764
19765 @item set hash
19766 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19767 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19768 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19769 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19770 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19771 monitor.
19772
19773 @item show hash
19774 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19775 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19776
19777 @item set debug monitor
19778 @kindex set debug monitor
19779 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19780 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19781 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19782
19783 @item show debug monitor
19784 @kindex show debug monitor
19785 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19786 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19787 @end table
19788
19789 @table @code
19790
19791 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19792 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19793 @anchor{load}
19794 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19795 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19796 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19797 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19798 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19799 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19800
19801 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19802 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19803 target is @dots{}}''
19804
19805 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19806 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19807 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19808 specifies a fixed address.
19809 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19810
19811 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19812 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19813 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19814
19815 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19816 load programs into flash memory.
19817
19818 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19819 @end table
19820
19821 @table @code
19822
19823 @kindex flash-erase
19824 @item flash-erase
19825 @anchor{flash-erase}
19826
19827 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19828
19829 @end table
19830
19831 @node Byte Order
19832 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19833
19834 @cindex choosing target byte order
19835 @cindex target byte order
19836
19837 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19838 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19839 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19840 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19841 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19842 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19843
19844 @table @code
19845 @kindex set endian
19846 @item set endian big
19847 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19848
19849 @item set endian little
19850 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19851
19852 @item set endian auto
19853 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19854 executable.
19855
19856 @item show endian
19857 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19858
19859 @end table
19860
19861 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19862 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19863 target system.
19864
19865
19866 @node Remote Debugging
19867 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19868 @cindex remote debugging
19869
19870 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19871 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19872 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19873 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19874 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19875
19876 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19877 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19878 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19879 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19880 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19881 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19882
19883 Other remote targets may be available in your
19884 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19885
19886 @menu
19887 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19888 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19889 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19890 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19891 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19892 @end menu
19893
19894 @node Connecting
19895 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19896 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19897 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19898 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19899 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19900 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19901 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19902
19903 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19904 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19905 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19906 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19907
19908 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19909
19910 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19911 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19912 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19913 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19914
19915 @table @asis
19916
19917 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19918 @item Result of detach or program exit
19919 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19920 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19921 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19922
19923 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19924 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19925 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19926 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19927
19928 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19929 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19930 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19931 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19932
19933 @item Specifying the program to debug
19934 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19935 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19936 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19937 target.
19938
19939 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19940 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19941 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19942
19943 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19944 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19945 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19946 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19947
19948 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19949 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19950 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19951 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19952 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19953 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19954 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19955 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19956 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19957
19958 @item The @code{run} command
19959 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19960 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19961 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19962 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19963 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19964
19965 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19966 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19967 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19968 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19969 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19970
19971 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19972 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19973 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19974 @code{target remote} mode.
19975
19976 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19977 @item Attaching
19978 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19979 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19980 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19981
19982 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19983 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19984 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19985 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19986 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19987
19988 @end table
19989
19990 @anchor{Host and target files}
19991 @subsection Host and Target Files
19992 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19993 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19994
19995 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19996 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19997 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19998 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19999 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20000
20001 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20002 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20003 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20004 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20005 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20006
20007 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20008 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20009 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20010 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20011 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20012 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20013 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20014 target libraries.
20015
20016 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20017 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20018 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20019 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20020 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20021 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20022 programs.
20023
20024 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20025 @cindex remote connection commands
20026 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20027 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20028 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20029 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20030 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20031 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20032 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20033
20034 @table @code
20035
20036 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20037 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20038 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20039 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20040 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20041
20042 @smallexample
20043 target remote /dev/ttyb
20044 @end smallexample
20045
20046 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20047 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20048 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20049 @code{target} command.
20050
20051 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20052 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20053 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20054 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20055 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20056 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20057 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20058 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20059 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20060 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20061 target.
20062
20063 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20064 @code{manyfarms}:
20065
20066 @smallexample
20067 target remote manyfarms:2828
20068 @end smallexample
20069
20070 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20071 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20072 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20073 port 1234 on your local machine:
20074
20075 @smallexample
20076 target remote :1234
20077 @end smallexample
20078 @noindent
20079
20080 Note that the colon is still required here.
20081
20082 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20083 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20084 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20085 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20086 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20087
20088 @smallexample
20089 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20090 @end smallexample
20091
20092 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20093 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20094 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20095 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20096
20097 @item target remote | @var{command}
20098 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20099 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20100 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20101 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20102 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20103 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20104 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20105 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20106 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20107
20108 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20109 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20110 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20111
20112 @end table
20113
20114 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20115 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20116 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20117 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20118 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20119 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20120 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20121
20122 @smallexample
20123 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20124 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20125 @end smallexample
20126
20127 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20128 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20129 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20130 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20131
20132 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20133 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20134
20135 @table @code
20136 @kindex detach (remote)
20137 @item detach
20138 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20139 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20140 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20141 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20142 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20143 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20144 still connected to the target.
20145
20146 @kindex disconnect
20147 @item disconnect
20148 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20149 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20150 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20151 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20152 another target.
20153
20154 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20155 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20156 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20157 @kindex monitor
20158 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20159 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20160 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20161 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20162 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20163 and implement.
20164 @end table
20165
20166 @node File Transfer
20167 @section Sending files to a remote system
20168 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20169 @cindex file transfer
20170 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20171
20172 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20173 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20174 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20175 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20176 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20177 the only way to upload or download files.
20178
20179 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20180
20181 @table @code
20182 @kindex remote put
20183 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20184 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20185 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20186
20187 @kindex remote get
20188 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20189 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20190 on the host system.
20191
20192 @kindex remote delete
20193 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20194 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20195
20196 @end table
20197
20198 @node Server
20199 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20200
20201 @kindex gdbserver
20202 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20203 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20204 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20205 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20206 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20207
20208 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20209 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20210 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20211 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20212 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20213 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20214 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20215 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20216 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20217 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20218 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20219 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20220 choice for debugging.
20221
20222 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20223 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20224 protocol.
20225
20226 @quotation
20227 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20228 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20229 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20230 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20231 @code{gdbserver}.
20232 @end quotation
20233
20234 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20235 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20236 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20237 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20238
20239 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20240 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20241 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20242 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20243 system does all the symbol handling.
20244
20245 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20246 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20247 syntax is:
20248
20249 @smallexample
20250 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20251 @end smallexample
20252
20253 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20254 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20255 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20256 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20257 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20258 @file{/dev/com1}:
20259
20260 @smallexample
20261 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20262 @end smallexample
20263
20264 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20265 with it.
20266
20267 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20268
20269 @smallexample
20270 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20271 @end smallexample
20272
20273 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20274 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20275 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20276 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20277 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20278 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20279 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20280 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20281 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20282 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20283 @code{target remote} command.
20284
20285 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20286 with ssh:
20287
20288 @smallexample
20289 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20290 @end smallexample
20291
20292 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20293 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20294 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20295 You could elide it if you want to.
20296
20297 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20298 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20299 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20300 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20301
20302 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20303 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20304 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20305 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20306
20307 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20308 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20309
20310 @smallexample
20311 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20312 @end smallexample
20313
20314 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20315 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20316
20317 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20318 @value{GDBN} attach command
20319 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20320
20321 @pindex pidof
20322 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20323 @code{pidof} utility:
20324
20325 @smallexample
20326 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20327 @end smallexample
20328
20329 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20330 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20331 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20332
20333 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20334
20335 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20336 port.
20337
20338 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20339 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20340 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20341 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20342 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20343 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20344 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20345 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20346
20347 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20348 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20349 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20350
20351 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20352 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20353 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20354 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20355 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20356 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20357 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20358 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20359 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20360 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20361 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20362 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20363
20364 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20365 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20366
20367 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20368 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20369 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20370 program. For more information,
20371 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20372
20373 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20374 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20375 status information about the debugging process.
20376 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20377 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20378 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20379 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20380
20381 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20382 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20383 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20384 Possible options are:
20385
20386 @table @code
20387 @item none
20388 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20389 @item all
20390 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20391 @item timestamps
20392 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20393 @end table
20394
20395 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20396 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20397
20398 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20399 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20400 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20401 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20402 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20403
20404 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20405 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20406 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20407 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20408
20409 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20410 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20411 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20412 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20413
20414 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20415 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20416 environment:
20417
20418 @smallexample
20419 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20420 @end smallexample
20421
20422 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20423 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20424
20425 @smallexample
20426 $ gdbserver --selftest
20427 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20428 @end smallexample
20429
20430 These tests are disabled in release.
20431 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20432
20433 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20434 @itemize
20435
20436 @item
20437 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20438
20439 @item
20440 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20441 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20442 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20443 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20444 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20445 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20446
20447 @item
20448 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20449 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20450 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20451 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20452 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20453 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20454 program is already on the target.
20455
20456 @end itemize
20457
20458 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20459 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20460 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20461
20462 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20463 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20464 Here are the available commands.
20465
20466 @table @code
20467 @item monitor help
20468 List the available monitor commands.
20469
20470 @item monitor set debug 0
20471 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20472 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20473
20474 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20475 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20476 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20477 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20478
20479 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20480 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20481 Possible options are:
20482
20483 @table @code
20484 @item none
20485 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20486 @item all
20487 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20488 @item timestamps
20489 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20490 @end table
20491
20492 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20493 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20494
20495 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20496 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20497 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20498 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20499 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20500 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20501
20502 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20503 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20504
20505 @item monitor exit
20506 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20507 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20508 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20509 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20510 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20511
20512 @end table
20513
20514 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20515 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20516
20517 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20518 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20519
20520 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20521 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20522 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20523 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20524 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20525 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20526 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20527 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20528 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20529 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20530 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20531 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20532
20533 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20534
20535 @table @code
20536 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20537
20538 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20539 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20540 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20541
20542 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20543
20544 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20545 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20546 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20547 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20548 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20549 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20550
20551 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20552
20553 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20554 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20555 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20556 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20557 command for that. For example:
20558
20559 @smallexample
20560 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20561 @end smallexample
20562
20563 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20564 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20565 @end table
20566
20567 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20568 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20569 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20570 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20571 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20572 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20573 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20574 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20575 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20576 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20577
20578 @smallexample
20579 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20580 @end smallexample
20581
20582 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20583
20584 @smallexample
20585 $ gdb myprogram
20586 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20587 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20588 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20589 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20590 @end smallexample
20591
20592 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20593 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20594 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20595 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20596 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20597 tracing.
20598
20599 @node Remote Configuration
20600 @section Remote Configuration
20601
20602 @kindex set remote
20603 @kindex show remote
20604 This section documents the configuration options available when
20605 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20606 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20607 system-call-allowed}.
20608
20609 @table @code
20610 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20611 @cindex address size for remote targets
20612 @cindex bits in remote address
20613 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20614 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20615 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20616 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20617
20618 @item show remoteaddresssize
20619 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20620
20621 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20622 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20623 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20624 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20625 remote targets.
20626
20627 @item show serial baud
20628 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20629
20630 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20631 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20632 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20633
20634 @item show serial parity
20635 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20636
20637 @item set remotebreak
20638 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20639 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20640 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20641 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20642 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20643 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20644 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20645 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20646
20647 @item show remotebreak
20648 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20649 interrupt the remote program.
20650
20651 @item set remoteflow on
20652 @itemx set remoteflow off
20653 @kindex set remoteflow
20654 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20655 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20656
20657 @item show remoteflow
20658 @kindex show remoteflow
20659 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20660
20661 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20662 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20663 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20664 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20665 @code{ascii}.
20666
20667 @item show remotelogbase
20668 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20669 protocol.
20670
20671 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20672 @cindex record serial communications on file
20673 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20674 default is not to record at all.
20675
20676 @item show remotelogfile.
20677 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20678 serial communications.
20679
20680 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20681 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20682 @cindex remote timeout
20683 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20684 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20685
20686 @item show remotetimeout
20687 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20688 responses.
20689
20690 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20691 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20692 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20693 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20694 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20695 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20696 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20697 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20698
20699 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20700 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20701 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20702 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20703 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20704 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20705 as unlimited.
20706
20707 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20708 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20709 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20710
20711 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20712 @itemx show remote exec-file
20713 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20714 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20715 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20716 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20717 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20718 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20719
20720 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20721 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20722 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20723 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20724 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20725 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20726 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20727 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20728 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20729 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20730
20731 @item show interrupt-sequence
20732 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20733 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20734 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20735 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20736
20737 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20738 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20739 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20740 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20741 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20742 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20743
20744 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20745 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20746 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20747
20748 @kindex set tcp
20749 @kindex show tcp
20750 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20751 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20752 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20753 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20754 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20755 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20756 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20757 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20758 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20759
20760 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20761 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20762
20763 @item show tcp auto-retry
20764 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20765
20766 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20767 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20768 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20769 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20770 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20771 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20772 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20773 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20774 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20775 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20776 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20777
20778 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20779 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20780 @end table
20781
20782 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20783 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20784 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20785 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20786 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20787 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20788 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20789 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20790 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20791
20792 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20793 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20794 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20795 @value{GDBN} developers.
20796
20797 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20798 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20799 are:
20800
20801 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20802 @item Command Name
20803 @tab Remote Packet
20804 @tab Related Features
20805
20806 @item @code{fetch-register}
20807 @tab @code{p}
20808 @tab @code{info registers}
20809
20810 @item @code{set-register}
20811 @tab @code{P}
20812 @tab @code{set}
20813
20814 @item @code{binary-download}
20815 @tab @code{X}
20816 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20817
20818 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20819 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20820 @tab @code{info auxv}
20821
20822 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20823 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20824 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20825
20826 @item @code{attach}
20827 @tab @code{vAttach}
20828 @tab @code{attach}
20829
20830 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20831 @tab @code{vCont}
20832 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20833
20834 @item @code{run}
20835 @tab @code{vRun}
20836 @tab @code{run}
20837
20838 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20839 @tab @code{Z0}
20840 @tab @code{break}
20841
20842 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20843 @tab @code{Z1}
20844 @tab @code{hbreak}
20845
20846 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20847 @tab @code{Z2}
20848 @tab @code{watch}
20849
20850 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20851 @tab @code{Z3}
20852 @tab @code{rwatch}
20853
20854 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20855 @tab @code{Z4}
20856 @tab @code{awatch}
20857
20858 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20859 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20860 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20861
20862 @item @code{target-features}
20863 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20864 @tab @code{set architecture}
20865
20866 @item @code{library-info}
20867 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20868 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20869
20870 @item @code{memory-map}
20871 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20872 @tab @code{info mem}
20873
20874 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20875 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20876 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20877
20878 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20879 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20880 @tab @code{info spu}
20881
20882 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20883 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20884 @tab @code{info spu}
20885
20886 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20887 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20888 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20889
20890 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20891 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20892 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20893
20894 @item @code{threads}
20895 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20896 @tab @code{info threads}
20897
20898 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20899 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20900 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20901
20902 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20903 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20904 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20905
20906 @item @code{search-memory}
20907 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20908 @tab @code{find}
20909
20910 @item @code{supported-packets}
20911 @tab @code{qSupported}
20912 @tab Remote communications parameters
20913
20914 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20915 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20916 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20917
20918 @item @code{pass-signals}
20919 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20920 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20921
20922 @item @code{program-signals}
20923 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20924 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20925
20926 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20927 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20928 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20929
20930 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20931 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20932 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20933
20934 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20935 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20936 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20937
20938 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20939 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20940 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20941
20942 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20943 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20944 @tab @code{remote delete}
20945
20946 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20947 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20948 @tab Host I/O
20949
20950 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20951 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20952 @tab Host I/O
20953
20954 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20955 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20956 @tab Host I/O
20957
20958 @item @code{noack-packet}
20959 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20960 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20961
20962 @item @code{osdata}
20963 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20964 @tab @code{info os}
20965
20966 @item @code{query-attached}
20967 @tab @code{qAttached}
20968 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20969
20970 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20971 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20972 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20973
20974 @item @code{trace-status}
20975 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20976 @tab @code{tstatus}
20977
20978 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20979 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20980 @tab Traceframe info
20981
20982 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20983 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20984 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20985
20986 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20987 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20988 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20989
20990 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
20991 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
20992 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
20993
20994 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
20995 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
20996 @tab @code{set environment}
20997
20998 @item @code{environment-unset}
20999 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21000 @tab @code{unset environment}
21001
21002 @item @code{environment-reset}
21003 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21004 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21005
21006 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21007 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21008 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21009
21010 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21011 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21012 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21013
21014 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21015 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21016 @tab @code{break}
21017
21018 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21019 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21020 @tab @code{hbreak}
21021
21022 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21023 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21024 @tab @code{fork}
21025
21026 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21027 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21028 @tab @code{vfork}
21029
21030 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21031 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21032 @tab @code{exec}
21033
21034 @item @code{thread-events}
21035 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21036 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21037
21038 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21039 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21040 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21041
21042 @end multitable
21043
21044 @node Remote Stub
21045 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21046
21047 @cindex debugging stub, example
21048 @cindex remote stub, example
21049 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21050 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21051 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21052 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21053 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21054 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21055 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21056 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21057
21058 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21059 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21060 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21061 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21062 program, you need:
21063
21064 @enumerate
21065 @item
21066 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21067 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21068 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21069
21070 @item
21071 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21072 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21073
21074 @item
21075 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21076 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21077 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21078 documentation.
21079 @end enumerate
21080
21081 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21082 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21083 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21084
21085 @table @emph
21086 @item On the host,
21087 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21088 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21089 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21090
21091 @item On the target,
21092 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21093 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21094 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21095
21096 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21097 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21098 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21099 @end table
21100
21101 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21102 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21103 @sc{sparc} boards.
21104
21105 @cindex remote serial stub list
21106 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21107
21108 @table @code
21109
21110 @item i386-stub.c
21111 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21112 @cindex Intel
21113 @cindex i386
21114 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21115
21116 @item m68k-stub.c
21117 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21118 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21119 @cindex m680x0
21120 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21121
21122 @item sh-stub.c
21123 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21124 @cindex Renesas
21125 @cindex SH
21126 For Renesas SH architectures.
21127
21128 @item sparc-stub.c
21129 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21130 @cindex Sparc
21131 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21132
21133 @item sparcl-stub.c
21134 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21135 @cindex Fujitsu
21136 @cindex SparcLite
21137 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21138
21139 @end table
21140
21141 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21142 recently added stubs.
21143
21144 @menu
21145 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21146 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21147 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21148 @end menu
21149
21150 @node Stub Contents
21151 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21152
21153 @cindex remote serial stub
21154 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21155 subroutines:
21156
21157 @table @code
21158 @item set_debug_traps
21159 @findex set_debug_traps
21160 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21161 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21162 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21163 program's startup code.
21164
21165 @item handle_exception
21166 @findex handle_exception
21167 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21168 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21169 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21170 run when a trap is triggered.
21171
21172 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21173 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21174 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21175 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21176 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21177 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21178 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21179 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21180 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21181 machine.
21182
21183 @item breakpoint
21184 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21185 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21186 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21187 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21188 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21189 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21190 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21191 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21192 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21193 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21194 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21195
21196 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21197 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21198 start of your debugging session.
21199 @end table
21200
21201 @node Bootstrapping
21202 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21203
21204 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21205 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21206 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21207 debugging target machine.
21208
21209 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21210 serial port.
21211
21212 @table @code
21213 @item int getDebugChar()
21214 @findex getDebugChar
21215 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21216 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21217 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21218
21219 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21220 @findex putDebugChar
21221 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21222 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21223 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21224 @end table
21225
21226 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21227 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21228 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21229 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21230 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21231 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21232 remote system to stop.
21233
21234 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21235 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21236 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21237 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21238
21239 Other routines you need to supply are:
21240
21241 @table @code
21242 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21243 @findex exceptionHandler
21244 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21245 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21246 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21247 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21248 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21249 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21250 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21251 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21252 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21253 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21254 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21255 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21256 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21257
21258 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21259 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21260 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21261 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21262 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21263
21264 @item void flush_i_cache()
21265 @findex flush_i_cache
21266 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21267 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21268 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21269
21270 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21271 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21272 @end table
21273
21274 @noindent
21275 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21276
21277 @table @code
21278 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21279 @findex memset
21280 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21281 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21282 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21283 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21284 @end table
21285
21286 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21287 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21288 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21289 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21290
21291
21292 @node Debug Session
21293 @subsection Putting it All Together
21294
21295 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21296 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21297 steps.
21298
21299 @enumerate
21300 @item
21301 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21302 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21303 @display
21304 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21305 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21306 @end display
21307
21308 @item
21309 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21310 procedure is called:
21311
21312 @smallexample
21313 set_debug_traps();
21314 breakpoint();
21315 @end smallexample
21316
21317 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21318 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21319 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21320 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21321 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21322 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21323 progress.
21324
21325 @item
21326 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21327 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21328
21329 @smallexample
21330 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21331 @end smallexample
21332
21333 @noindent
21334 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21335 function in your program, that function is called when
21336 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21337 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21338 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21339
21340 @item
21341 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21342 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21343
21344 @item
21345 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21346 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21347
21348 @item
21349 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21350 @c document that. FIXME.
21351 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21352 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21353
21354 @item
21355 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21356 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21357
21358 @end enumerate
21359
21360 @node Configurations
21361 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21362
21363 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21364 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21365 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21366
21367 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21368 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21369 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21370 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21371 are quite different from each other.
21372
21373 @menu
21374 * Native::
21375 * Embedded OS::
21376 * Embedded Processors::
21377 * Architectures::
21378 @end menu
21379
21380 @node Native
21381 @section Native
21382
21383 This section describes details specific to particular native
21384 configurations.
21385
21386 @menu
21387 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21388 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21389 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21390 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21391 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21392 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21393 @end menu
21394
21395 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21396 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21397
21398 @cindex libkvm
21399 @cindex kernel memory image
21400 @cindex kernel crash dump
21401
21402 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21403 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21404 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21405 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21406 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21407 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21408 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21409 @code{kvm} target:
21410
21411 @smallexample
21412 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21413 @end smallexample
21414
21415 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21416 argument:
21417
21418 @smallexample
21419 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21420 @end smallexample
21421
21422 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21423 available:
21424
21425 @table @code
21426 @kindex kvm
21427 @item kvm pcb
21428 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21429
21430 @item kvm proc
21431 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21432 modern FreeBSD systems.
21433 @end table
21434
21435 @node SVR4 Process Information
21436 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21437 @cindex /proc
21438 @cindex examine process image
21439 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21440
21441 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21442 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21443 process using file-system subroutines.
21444
21445 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21446 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21447 information about the process running your program, or about any
21448 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21449 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21450
21451 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21452 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21453
21454 @table @code
21455 @kindex info proc
21456 @cindex process ID
21457 @item info proc
21458 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21459 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21460 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21461 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21462 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21463 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21464 executable file's absolute file name.
21465
21466 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21467 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21468 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21469 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21470 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21471 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21472
21473 @item info proc cmdline
21474 @cindex info proc cmdline
21475 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21476 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21477
21478 @item info proc cwd
21479 @cindex info proc cwd
21480 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21481 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21482
21483 @item info proc exe
21484 @cindex info proc exe
21485 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21486 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21487
21488 @item info proc mappings
21489 @cindex memory address space mappings
21490 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21491 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21492 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21493 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21494 memory access rights to that range.
21495
21496 @item info proc stat
21497 @itemx info proc status
21498 @cindex process detailed status information
21499 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21500 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21501 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21502 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21503 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21504 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21505 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21506
21507 @item info proc all
21508 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21509 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21510
21511 @ignore
21512 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21513 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21514 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21515 @kindex info proc times
21516 @item info proc times
21517 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21518 its children.
21519
21520 @kindex info proc id
21521 @item info proc id
21522 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21523 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21524 @end ignore
21525
21526 @item set procfs-trace
21527 @kindex set procfs-trace
21528 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21529 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21530
21531 @item show procfs-trace
21532 @kindex show procfs-trace
21533 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21534
21535 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21536 @kindex set procfs-file
21537 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21538 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21539 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21540 standard output.
21541
21542 @item show procfs-file
21543 @kindex show procfs-file
21544 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21545
21546 @item proc-trace-entry
21547 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21548 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21549 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21550 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21551 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21552 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21553 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21554 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21555 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21556
21557 @item info pidlist
21558 @kindex info pidlist
21559 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21560 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21561 processes and all the threads within each process.
21562
21563 @item info meminfo
21564 @kindex info meminfo
21565 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21566 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21567 @end table
21568
21569 @node DJGPP Native
21570 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21571 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21572 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21573 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21574
21575 @cindex DPMI
21576 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21577 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21578 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21579 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21580
21581 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21582 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21583 subsection describes those commands.
21584
21585 @table @code
21586 @kindex info dos
21587 @item info dos
21588 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21589 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21590
21591 @kindex sysinfo
21592 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21593 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21594 @item info dos sysinfo
21595 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21596 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21597 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21598
21599 @cindex GDT
21600 @cindex LDT
21601 @cindex IDT
21602 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21603 @cindex descriptor tables display
21604 @item info dos gdt
21605 @itemx info dos ldt
21606 @itemx info dos idt
21607 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21608 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21609 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21610 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21611 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21612 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21613 rights.
21614
21615 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21616 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21617 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21618 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21619 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21620
21621 @cindex garbled pointers
21622 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21623 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21624 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21625 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21626 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21627 debugged program's data segment:
21628
21629 @smallexample
21630 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21631 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21632 @end smallexample
21633
21634 @noindent
21635 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21636 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21637
21638 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21639 @item info dos pde
21640 @itemx info dos pte
21641 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21642 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21643 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21644 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21645 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21646 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21647 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21648 that is currently in use.
21649
21650 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21651 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21652 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21653 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21654 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21655 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21656 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21657
21658 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21659 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21660 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21661 controller.
21662
21663 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21664
21665 @cindex physical address from linear address
21666 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21667 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21668 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21669 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21670 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21671 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21672 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21673
21674 @smallexample
21675 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21676 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21677 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21678 @end smallexample
21679
21680 @noindent
21681 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21682 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21683 attributes of that page.
21684
21685 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21686 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21687 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21688 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21689 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21690 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21691
21692 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21693 transfer buffer:
21694
21695 @smallexample
21696 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21697 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21698 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21699 @end smallexample
21700
21701 @noindent
21702 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21703 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21704 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21705 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21706 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21707
21708 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21709 @end table
21710
21711 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21712 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21713 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21714 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21715
21716 @table @code
21717 @kindex set com1base
21718 @kindex set com1irq
21719 @kindex set com2base
21720 @kindex set com2irq
21721 @kindex set com3base
21722 @kindex set com3irq
21723 @kindex set com4base
21724 @kindex set com4irq
21725 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21726 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21727 port.
21728
21729 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21730 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21731 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21732
21733 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21734 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21735 other 3 COM ports.
21736
21737 @kindex show com1base
21738 @kindex show com1irq
21739 @kindex show com2base
21740 @kindex show com2irq
21741 @kindex show com3base
21742 @kindex show com3irq
21743 @kindex show com4base
21744 @kindex show com4irq
21745 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21746 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21747 lines used by the COM ports.
21748
21749 @item info serial
21750 @kindex info serial
21751 @cindex DOS serial port status
21752 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21753 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21754 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21755 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21756 @end table
21757
21758
21759 @node Cygwin Native
21760 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21761 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21762 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21763 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21764
21765 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21766 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21767
21768 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21769 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21770 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21771 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21772 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21773 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21774 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21775 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21776
21777 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21778 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21779 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21780
21781 @table @code
21782 @kindex info w32
21783 @item info w32
21784 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21785 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21786
21787 @item info w32 selector
21788 This command displays information returned by
21789 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21790 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21791 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21792 Without argument, this command displays information
21793 about the six segment registers.
21794
21795 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21796 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21797 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21798 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21799
21800 @kindex signal-event
21801 @item signal-event @var{id}
21802 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21803 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21804
21805 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21806 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21807 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21808 (for x86_64 versions):
21809
21810 @itemize @minus
21811 @item
21812 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21813 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21814 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21815
21816 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21817 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21818 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21819 to attach.
21820
21821 @item
21822 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21823 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21824 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21825 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21826 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21827 @end itemize
21828
21829 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21830 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21831 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21832 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21833 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21834 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21835 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21836 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21837 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21838 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21839 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21840
21841 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21842 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21843 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21844 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21845
21846 @kindex set new-console
21847 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21848 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21849 be started in a new console on next start.
21850 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21851 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21852
21853 @kindex show new-console
21854 @item show new-console
21855 Displays whether a new console is used
21856 when the debuggee is started.
21857
21858 @kindex set new-group
21859 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21860 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21861 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21862 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21863 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21864
21865 @kindex show new-group
21866 @item show new-group
21867 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21868
21869 @kindex set debugevents
21870 @item set debugevents
21871 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21872 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21873 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21874 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21875 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21876
21877 @kindex set debugexec
21878 @item set debugexec
21879 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21880 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21881
21882 @kindex set debugexceptions
21883 @item set debugexceptions
21884 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21885 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21886
21887 @kindex set debugmemory
21888 @item set debugmemory
21889 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21890 and writes by the debugger.
21891
21892 @kindex set shell
21893 @item set shell
21894 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21895 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21896
21897 @kindex show shell
21898 @item show shell
21899 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21900
21901 @end table
21902
21903 @menu
21904 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21905 @end menu
21906
21907 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21908 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21909 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21910 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21911
21912 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21913 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21914 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21915 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21916 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21917 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21918 ``minimal symbols''.
21919
21920 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21921 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21922 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21923 program run once to completion.
21924
21925 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21926
21927 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21928 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21929 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21930 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21931 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21932 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21933 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21934 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21935 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21936
21937 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21938 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21939 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21940 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21941 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21942 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21943
21944 @smallexample
21945 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21946 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21947
21948 Non-debugging symbols:
21949 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21950 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21951 @end smallexample
21952
21953 @smallexample
21954 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21955 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21956
21957 Non-debugging symbols:
21958 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21959 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21960 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21961 [etc...]
21962 @end smallexample
21963
21964 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21965
21966 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21967 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21968 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21969 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21970 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21971 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21972 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21973
21974 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21975 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21976 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21977 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21978 problem:
21979
21980 @smallexample
21981 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21982 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
21983 @end smallexample
21984
21985 @smallexample
21986 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21987 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
21988 @end smallexample
21989
21990 And two possible solutions:
21991
21992 @smallexample
21993 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21994 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21995 @end smallexample
21996
21997 @smallexample
21998 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21999 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22000 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22001 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22002 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22003 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22004 @end smallexample
22005
22006 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22007 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22008 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22009 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22010 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22011
22012 @smallexample
22013 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22014 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22015 @end smallexample
22016
22017 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22018 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22019 safe.
22020
22021 @node Hurd Native
22022 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22023 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22024
22025 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22026 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22027
22028 @table @code
22029 @item set signals
22030 @itemx set sigs
22031 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22032 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22033 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22034 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22035 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22036 @code{signals}.
22037
22038 @item show signals
22039 @itemx show sigs
22040 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22041 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22042 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22043
22044 @item set signal-thread
22045 @itemx set sigthread
22046 @kindex set signal-thread
22047 @kindex set sigthread
22048 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22049 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22050 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22051 signal-thread}.
22052
22053 @item show signal-thread
22054 @itemx show sigthread
22055 @kindex show signal-thread
22056 @kindex show sigthread
22057 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22058 delivered a signal.
22059
22060 @item set stopped
22061 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22062 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22063 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22064 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22065
22066 @item show stopped
22067 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22068 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22069 stopped.
22070
22071 @item set exceptions
22072 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22073 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22074 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22075 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22076 trapping on.
22077
22078 @item show exceptions
22079 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22080 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22081
22082 @item set task pause
22083 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22084 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22085 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22086 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22087 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22088 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22089 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22090 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22091 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22092
22093 @item show task pause
22094 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22095 Show the current state of task suspension.
22096
22097 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22098 @cindex task suspend count
22099 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22100 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22101 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22102
22103 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22104 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22105
22106 @item set task exception-port
22107 @itemx set task excp
22108 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22109 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22110 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22111 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22112
22113 @item set noninvasive
22114 @cindex noninvasive task options
22115 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22116 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22117 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22118 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22119
22120 @item info send-rights
22121 @itemx info receive-rights
22122 @itemx info port-rights
22123 @itemx info port-sets
22124 @itemx info dead-names
22125 @itemx info ports
22126 @itemx info psets
22127 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22128 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22129 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22130 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22131 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22132 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22133 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22134 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22135 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22136
22137 @item set thread pause
22138 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22139 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22140 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22141 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22142 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22143 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22144 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22145 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22146 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22147 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22148 only the current thread.
22149
22150 @item show thread pause
22151 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22152 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22153
22154 @item set thread run
22155 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22156
22157 @item show thread run
22158 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22159
22160 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22161 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22162 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22163 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22164 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22165 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22166 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22167
22168 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22169 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22170 detaching.
22171
22172 @item set thread exception-port
22173 @itemx set thread excp
22174 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22175 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22176 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22177
22178 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22179 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22180 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22181 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22182
22183 @item set thread default
22184 @itemx show thread default
22185 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22186 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22187 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22188 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22189 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22190 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22191 the non-default commands.
22192 @end table
22193
22194 @node Darwin
22195 @subsection Darwin
22196 @cindex Darwin
22197
22198 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22199
22200 @table @code
22201 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22202 @kindex set debug darwin
22203 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22204 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22205
22206 @item show debug darwin
22207 @kindex show debug darwin
22208 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22209
22210 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22211 @kindex set debug mach-o
22212 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22213 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22214 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22215 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22216 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22217 usage.
22218
22219 @item show debug mach-o
22220 @kindex show debug mach-o
22221 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22222
22223 @item set mach-exceptions on
22224 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22225 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22226 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22227 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22228 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22229 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22230
22231 @item show mach-exceptions
22232 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22233 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22234 @end table
22235
22236
22237 @node Embedded OS
22238 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22239
22240 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22241 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22242 architectures.
22243
22244 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22245 various real-time operating systems.
22246
22247 @node Embedded Processors
22248 @section Embedded Processors
22249
22250 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22251 configurations.
22252
22253 @cindex send command to simulator
22254 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22255 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22256
22257 @table @code
22258 @item sim @var{command}
22259 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22260 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22261 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22262 acceptable commands.
22263 @end table
22264
22265
22266 @menu
22267 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22268 * ARM:: ARM
22269 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22270 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22271 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22272 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22273 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22274 * CRIS:: CRIS
22275 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22276 @end menu
22277
22278 @node ARC
22279 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22280 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22281 @cindex ARC specific commands
22282 @cindex ARC600
22283 @cindex ARC700
22284 @cindex ARC EM
22285 @cindex ARC HS
22286
22287 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22288
22289 @table @code
22290 @item set debug arc
22291 @kindex set debug arc
22292 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22293 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22294
22295 @item show debug arc
22296 @kindex show debug arc
22297 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22298
22299 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22300 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22301 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22302
22303 @end table
22304
22305 @node ARM
22306 @subsection ARM
22307
22308 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22309
22310 @table @code
22311 @item set arm disassembler
22312 @kindex set arm
22313 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22314 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22315
22316 @item show arm disassembler
22317 @kindex show arm
22318 Show the current disassembly style.
22319
22320 @item set arm apcs32
22321 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22322 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22323
22324 @item show arm apcs32
22325 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22326
22327 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22328 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22329 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22330
22331 @table @code
22332 @item auto
22333 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22334 @item softfpa
22335 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22336 processors.
22337 @item fpa
22338 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22339 @item softvfp
22340 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22341 @item vfp
22342 VFP co-processor.
22343 @end table
22344
22345 @item show arm fpu
22346 Show the current type of the FPU.
22347
22348 @item set arm abi
22349 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22350
22351 @item show arm abi
22352 Show the currently used ABI.
22353
22354 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22355 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22356 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22357 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22358 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22359 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22360 register).
22361
22362 @item show arm fallback-mode
22363 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22364
22365 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22366 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22367 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22368 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22369 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22370
22371 @item show arm force-mode
22372 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22373
22374 @item set debug arm
22375 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22376 target support subsystem.
22377
22378 @item show debug arm
22379 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22380 @end table
22381
22382 @table @code
22383 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22384 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22385
22386 @table @code
22387 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22388 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22389 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22390 The default value is @code{all}.
22391
22392 @table @code
22393 @item none
22394 @item demon
22395 @item angel
22396 @item redboot
22397 @item all
22398 @end table
22399 @end table
22400 @end table
22401
22402 @node M68K
22403 @subsection M68k
22404
22405 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22406
22407 @node MicroBlaze
22408 @subsection MicroBlaze
22409 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22410 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22411
22412 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22413 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22414 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22415 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22416 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22417 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22418 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22419 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22420 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22421 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22422 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22423
22424 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22425
22426 @table @code
22427 @item target remote :1234
22428 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22429 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22430
22431 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22432 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22433 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22434
22435 @item load
22436 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22437
22438 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22439 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22440
22441 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22442 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22443 @end table
22444
22445 @node MIPS Embedded
22446 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22447
22448 @noindent
22449 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22450
22451 @table @code
22452 @item set mipsfpu double
22453 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22454 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22455 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22456 @itemx show mipsfpu
22457 @kindex set mipsfpu
22458 @kindex show mipsfpu
22459 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22460 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22461 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22462 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22463 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22464 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22465 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22466 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22467 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22468 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22469 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22470 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22471 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22472
22473 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22474 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22475 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22476
22477 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22478 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22479 @end table
22480
22481 @node PowerPC Embedded
22482 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22483
22484 @cindex DVC register
22485 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22486 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22487
22488 @smallexample
22489 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22490 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22491 @end smallexample
22492
22493 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22494 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22495 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22496 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22497 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22498 or newer.
22499
22500 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22501 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22502 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22503 watching variables of scalar types.
22504
22505 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22506 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22507
22508 @smallexample
22509 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22510 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22511 @end smallexample
22512
22513 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22514 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22515
22516 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22517 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22518 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22519 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22520 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22521 use the @code{break-range} command.
22522
22523 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22524
22525 @table @code
22526 @kindex break-range
22527 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22528 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22529 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22530 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22531 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22532 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22533 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22534 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22535 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22536
22537 @kindex set powerpc
22538 @item set powerpc soft-float
22539 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22540 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22541 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22542 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22543
22544 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22545 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22546 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22547 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22548 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22549 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22550 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22551 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22552
22553 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22554 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22555 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22556 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22557 address of its first byte.
22558
22559 @end table
22560
22561 @node AVR
22562 @subsection Atmel AVR
22563 @cindex AVR
22564
22565 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22566 following AVR-specific commands:
22567
22568 @table @code
22569 @item info io_registers
22570 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22571 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22572 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22573 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22574 @end table
22575
22576 @node CRIS
22577 @subsection CRIS
22578 @cindex CRIS
22579
22580 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22581 following CRIS-specific commands:
22582
22583 @table @code
22584 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22585 @cindex CRIS version
22586 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22587 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22588 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22589
22590 @item show cris-version
22591 Show the current CRIS version.
22592
22593 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22594 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22595 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22596 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22597 @code{R59}.
22598
22599 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22600 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22601
22602 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22603 @cindex CRIS mode
22604 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22605 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22606 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22607
22608 @item show cris-mode
22609 Show the current CRIS mode.
22610 @end table
22611
22612 @node Super-H
22613 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22614 @cindex Super-H
22615
22616 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22617 commands:
22618
22619 @table @code
22620 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22621 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22622 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22623 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22624 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22625 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22626 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22627 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22628 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22629 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22630 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22631 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22632
22633 @item show sh calling-convention
22634 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22635 Show the current calling convention setting.
22636
22637 @end table
22638
22639
22640 @node Architectures
22641 @section Architectures
22642
22643 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22644 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22645
22646 @menu
22647 * AArch64::
22648 * i386::
22649 * Alpha::
22650 * MIPS::
22651 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22652 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22653 * PowerPC::
22654 * Nios II::
22655 * Sparc64::
22656 @end menu
22657
22658 @node AArch64
22659 @subsection AArch64
22660 @cindex AArch64 support
22661
22662 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22663 following special commands:
22664
22665 @table @code
22666 @item set debug aarch64
22667 @kindex set debug aarch64
22668 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22669 messages are to be displayed.
22670
22671 @item show debug aarch64
22672 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22673
22674 @end table
22675
22676 @node i386
22677 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22678
22679 @table @code
22680 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22681 @kindex set struct-convention
22682 @cindex struct return convention
22683 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22684 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22685 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22686 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22687 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22688 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22689 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22690 be returned in a register.
22691
22692 @item show struct-convention
22693 @kindex show struct-convention
22694 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22695 from functions.
22696 @end table
22697
22698
22699 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22700 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22701
22702 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22703 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22704 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22705 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22706 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22707 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22708 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22709
22710 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22711 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22712 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22713 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22714 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22715 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22716
22717 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22718 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22719 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22720
22721 @smallexample
22722 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22723 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22724 @end smallexample
22725
22726 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22727 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22728 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22729 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22730 the pointer.
22731
22732 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22733 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22734 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22735 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22736 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22737
22738 @table @code
22739 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22740 @kindex show mpx bound
22741 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22742
22743 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22744 @kindex set mpx bound
22745 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22746 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22747 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22748 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22749 @end table
22750
22751 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22752 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22753 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22754 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22755
22756 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22757 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22758 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22759 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22760 function.
22761
22762 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22763 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22764 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22765 continuing the execution. For example:
22766
22767 @smallexample
22768 $ break *upper
22769 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22770 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22771 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22772 $ print $bnd0
22773 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22774 @end smallexample
22775
22776 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22777 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22778 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22779
22780 @node Alpha
22781 @subsection Alpha
22782
22783 See the following section.
22784
22785 @node MIPS
22786 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22787
22788 @cindex stack on Alpha
22789 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22790 @cindex Alpha stack
22791 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22792 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22793 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22794 find the beginning of a function.
22795
22796 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22797 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22798 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22799 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22800 commands:
22801
22802 @table @code
22803 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22804 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22805 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22806 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22807 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22808 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22809 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22810 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22811
22812 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22813 Display the current limit.
22814 @end table
22815
22816 @noindent
22817 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22818 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22819
22820 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22821 programs:
22822
22823 @table @code
22824 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22825 @kindex set mips abi
22826 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22827 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22828 values of @var{arg} are:
22829
22830 @table @samp
22831 @item auto
22832 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22833 default).
22834 @item o32
22835 @item o64
22836 @item n32
22837 @item n64
22838 @item eabi32
22839 @item eabi64
22840 @end table
22841
22842 @item show mips abi
22843 @kindex show mips abi
22844 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22845
22846 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22847 @kindex set mips compression
22848 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22849 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22850 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22851 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22852 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22853 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22854 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22855 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22856 provided by the executable.
22857
22858 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22859 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22860 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22861 identified as such.
22862
22863 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22864 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22865 implicitly from an executable.
22866
22867 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22868 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22869 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22870 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22871 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22872
22873 @item show mips compression
22874 @kindex show mips compression
22875 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22876 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22877
22878 @item set mipsfpu
22879 @itemx show mipsfpu
22880 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22881
22882 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22883 @kindex set mips mask-address
22884 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22885 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22886 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22887 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22888 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22889
22890 @item show mips mask-address
22891 @kindex show mips mask-address
22892 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22893 not.
22894
22895 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22896 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22897 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22898 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22899 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22900 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22901
22902 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22903 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22904 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22905
22906 @item set debug mips
22907 @kindex set debug mips
22908 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22909 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22910
22911 @item show debug mips
22912 @kindex show debug mips
22913 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22914 @end table
22915
22916
22917 @node HPPA
22918 @subsection HPPA
22919 @cindex HPPA support
22920
22921 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22922 following special commands:
22923
22924 @table @code
22925 @item set debug hppa
22926 @kindex set debug hppa
22927 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22928 messages are to be displayed.
22929
22930 @item show debug hppa
22931 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22932
22933 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22934 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22935 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22936 given @var{address}.
22937
22938 @end table
22939
22940
22941 @node SPU
22942 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22943 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22944 @cindex SPU
22945
22946 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22947 it provides the following special commands:
22948
22949 @table @code
22950 @item info spu event
22951 @kindex info spu
22952 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22953 and pending event status.
22954
22955 @item info spu signal
22956 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22957 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22958 notification channels.
22959
22960 @item info spu mailbox
22961 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22962 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22963 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22964
22965 @item info spu dma
22966 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22967 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22968 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22969
22970 @item info spu proxydma
22971 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22972 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22973 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22974
22975 @end table
22976
22977 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22978 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22979 special commands:
22980
22981 @table @code
22982 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22983 @kindex set spu
22984 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22985 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22986 function. The default is @code{off}.
22987
22988 @item show spu stop-on-load
22989 @kindex show spu
22990 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22991
22992 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22993 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22994 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22995 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22996 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22997 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22998
22999 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23000 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23001
23002 @end table
23003
23004 @node PowerPC
23005 @subsection PowerPC
23006 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23007
23008 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23009 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23010 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23011 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23012 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23013
23014 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23015 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23016 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23017
23018 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23019 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23020
23021 @node Nios II
23022 @subsection Nios II
23023 @cindex Nios II architecture
23024
23025 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23026 it provides the following special commands:
23027
23028 @table @code
23029
23030 @item set debug nios2
23031 @kindex set debug nios2
23032 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23033 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23034
23035 @item show debug nios2
23036 @kindex show debug nios2
23037 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23038 @end table
23039
23040 @node Sparc64
23041 @subsection Sparc64
23042 @cindex Sparc64 support
23043 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23044 @subsubsection ADI Support
23045
23046 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23047 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23048 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23049 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23050 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23051 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23052 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23053 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23054 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23055 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23056 signal.
23057
23058 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23059 ADI-enabled.
23060
23061 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23062 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23063
23064
23065 @table @code
23066 @kindex adi examine
23067 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23068
23069 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23070 cacheline.
23071
23072 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23073 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23074 block size, to display.
23075
23076 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23077 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23078
23079 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23080
23081 @smallexample
23082 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23083 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23084 @end smallexample
23085
23086 @kindex adi assign
23087 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23088
23089 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23090 to an address.
23091
23092 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23093 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23094 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23095
23096 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23097 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23098
23099 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23100
23101 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23102 variable "shmaddr":
23103
23104 @smallexample
23105 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23106 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23107 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23108 @end smallexample
23109
23110 @end table
23111
23112 @node Controlling GDB
23113 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23114
23115 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23116 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23117 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23118 described here.
23119
23120 @menu
23121 * Prompt:: Prompt
23122 * Editing:: Command editing
23123 * Command History:: Command history
23124 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23125 * Numbers:: Numbers
23126 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23127 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23128 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23129 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23130 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23131 @end menu
23132
23133 @node Prompt
23134 @section Prompt
23135
23136 @cindex prompt
23137
23138 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23139 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23140 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23141 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23142 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23143 which one you are talking to.
23144
23145 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23146 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23147 or a prompt that does not.
23148
23149 @table @code
23150 @kindex set prompt
23151 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23152 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23153
23154 @kindex show prompt
23155 @item show prompt
23156 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23157 @end table
23158
23159 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23160 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23161 are:
23162
23163 @table @code
23164 @kindex set extended-prompt
23165 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23166 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23167 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23168 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23169 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23170 is displayed.
23171
23172 For example:
23173
23174 @smallexample
23175 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23176 @end smallexample
23177
23178 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23179 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23180
23181 @kindex show extended-prompt
23182 @item show extended-prompt
23183 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23184 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23185 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23186 @end table
23187
23188 @node Editing
23189 @section Command Editing
23190 @cindex readline
23191 @cindex command line editing
23192
23193 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23194 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23195 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23196 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23197 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23198 debugging sessions.
23199
23200 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23201 command @code{set}.
23202
23203 @table @code
23204 @kindex set editing
23205 @cindex editing
23206 @item set editing
23207 @itemx set editing on
23208 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23209
23210 @item set editing off
23211 Disable command line editing.
23212
23213 @kindex show editing
23214 @item show editing
23215 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23216 @end table
23217
23218 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23219 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23220 @end ifset
23221 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23222 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23223 @end ifclear
23224 for more details about the Readline
23225 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23226 encouraged to read that chapter.
23227
23228 @node Command History
23229 @section Command History
23230 @cindex command history
23231
23232 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23233 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23234 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23235 history facility.
23236
23237 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23238 package, to provide the history facility.
23239 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23240 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23241 @end ifset
23242 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23243 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23244 @end ifclear
23245 for the detailed description of the History library.
23246
23247 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23248 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23249 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23250 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23251 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23252 pressed on a line by itself.
23253
23254 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23255 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23256 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23257 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23258
23259 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23260 history.
23261
23262 @table @code
23263 @cindex history substitution
23264 @cindex history file
23265 @kindex set history filename
23266 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23267 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23268 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23269 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23270 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23271 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23272 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23273 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23274 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23275 is not set.
23276
23277 @cindex save command history
23278 @kindex set history save
23279 @item set history save
23280 @itemx set history save on
23281 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23282 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23283
23284 @item set history save off
23285 Stop recording command history in a file.
23286
23287 @cindex history size
23288 @kindex set history size
23289 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23290 @item set history size @var{size}
23291 @itemx set history size unlimited
23292 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23293 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23294 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23295 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23296 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23297 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23298
23299 @cindex remove duplicate history
23300 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23301 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23302 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23303 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23304 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23305 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23306 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23307 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23308 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23309
23310 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23311 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23312
23313 @end table
23314
23315 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23316 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23317 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23318 @end ifset
23319 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23320 @xref{Event Designators},
23321 @end ifclear
23322 for more details.
23323
23324 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23325 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23326 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23327 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23328 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23329 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23330 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23331 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23332
23333 The commands to control history expansion are:
23334
23335 @table @code
23336 @item set history expansion on
23337 @itemx set history expansion
23338 @kindex set history expansion
23339 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23340
23341 @item set history expansion off
23342 Disable history expansion.
23343
23344 @c @group
23345 @kindex show history
23346 @item show history
23347 @itemx show history filename
23348 @itemx show history save
23349 @itemx show history size
23350 @itemx show history expansion
23351 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23352 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23353 @c @end group
23354 @end table
23355
23356 @table @code
23357 @kindex show commands
23358 @cindex show last commands
23359 @cindex display command history
23360 @item show commands
23361 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23362
23363 @item show commands @var{n}
23364 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23365
23366 @item show commands +
23367 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23368 @end table
23369
23370 @node Screen Size
23371 @section Screen Size
23372 @cindex size of screen
23373 @cindex screen size
23374 @cindex pagination
23375 @cindex page size
23376 @cindex pauses in output
23377
23378 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23379 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23380 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23381 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23382 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23383 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23384 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23385 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23386
23387 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23388 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23389 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23390 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23391 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23392 width} commands:
23393
23394 @table @code
23395 @kindex set height
23396 @kindex set width
23397 @kindex show width
23398 @kindex show height
23399 @item set height @var{lpp}
23400 @itemx set height unlimited
23401 @itemx show height
23402 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23403 @itemx set width unlimited
23404 @itemx show width
23405 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23406 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23407 commands display the current settings.
23408
23409 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23410 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23411 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23412 buffer.
23413
23414 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23415 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23416
23417 @item set pagination on
23418 @itemx set pagination off
23419 @kindex set pagination
23420 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23421 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23422 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23423 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23424
23425 @item show pagination
23426 @kindex show pagination
23427 Show the current pagination mode.
23428 @end table
23429
23430 @node Numbers
23431 @section Numbers
23432 @cindex number representation
23433 @cindex entering numbers
23434
23435 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23436 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23437 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23438 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23439 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23440 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23441 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23442 both input and output with the commands described below.
23443
23444 @table @code
23445 @kindex set input-radix
23446 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23447 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23448 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23449 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23450 example, any of
23451
23452 @smallexample
23453 set input-radix 012
23454 set input-radix 10.
23455 set input-radix 0xa
23456 @end smallexample
23457
23458 @noindent
23459 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23460 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23461 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23462 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23463 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23464 change the radix.
23465
23466 @kindex set output-radix
23467 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23468 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23469 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23470 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23471
23472 @kindex show input-radix
23473 @item show input-radix
23474 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23475
23476 @kindex show output-radix
23477 @item show output-radix
23478 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23479
23480 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23481 @itemx show radix
23482 @kindex set radix
23483 @kindex show radix
23484 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23485 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23486 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23487 default value of 10.
23488
23489 @end table
23490
23491 @node ABI
23492 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23493
23494 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23495 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23496 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23497 current ABI.
23498
23499 @cindex OS ABI
23500 @kindex set osabi
23501 @kindex show osabi
23502 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23503
23504 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23505 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23506 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23507 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23508 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23509 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23510 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23511 platform provides.
23512
23513 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23514 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23515 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23516 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23517
23518 @table @code
23519 @item show osabi
23520 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23521
23522 @item set osabi
23523 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23524
23525 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23526 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23527 @end table
23528
23529 @cindex float promotion
23530
23531 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23532 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23533 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23534 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23535 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23536 @code{double} and then passed.
23537
23538 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23539 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23540 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23541
23542 @table @code
23543 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23544 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23545 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23546 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23547 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23548
23549 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23550 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23551 functions.
23552
23553 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23554 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23555 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23556 @end table
23557
23558 @kindex set cp-abi
23559 @kindex show cp-abi
23560 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23561 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23562 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23563 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23564 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23565 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23566 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23567 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23568 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23569 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23570 ``auto''.
23571
23572 @table @code
23573 @item show cp-abi
23574 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23575
23576 @item set cp-abi
23577 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23578
23579 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23580 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23581 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23582 @end table
23583
23584 @node Auto-loading
23585 @section Automatically loading associated files
23586 @cindex auto-loading
23587
23588 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23589 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23590 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23591 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23592 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23593 sources).
23594
23595 @menu
23596 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23597 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23598
23599 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23600 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23601 @end menu
23602
23603 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23604 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23605 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23606
23607 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23608 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23609 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23610
23611 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23612 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23613
23614 @table @code
23615 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23616 @kindex set auto-load off
23617 @item set auto-load off
23618 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23619 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23620 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23621 @smallexample
23622 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23623 @end smallexample
23624
23625 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23626 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23627 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23628 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23629 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23630 @code{set auto-load no}.
23631
23632 @anchor{show auto-load}
23633 @kindex show auto-load
23634 @item show auto-load
23635 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23636 or disabled.
23637
23638 @smallexample
23639 (gdb) show auto-load
23640 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23641 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23642 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23643 is on.
23644 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23645 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23646 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23647 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23648 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23649 @end smallexample
23650
23651 @anchor{info auto-load}
23652 @kindex info auto-load
23653 @item info auto-load
23654 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23655 not.
23656
23657 @smallexample
23658 (gdb) info auto-load
23659 gdb-scripts:
23660 Loaded Script
23661 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23662 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23663 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23664 loaded.
23665 python-scripts:
23666 Loaded Script
23667 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23668 @end smallexample
23669 @end table
23670
23671 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23672
23673 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23674 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23675 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23676 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23677 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23678 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23679 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23680 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23681 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23682 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23683 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23684 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23685 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23686 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23687 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23688 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23689 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23690 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23691 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23692 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23693 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23694 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23695 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23696 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23697 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23698 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23699 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23700 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23701 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23702 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23703 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23704 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23705 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23706 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23707 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23708 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23709 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23710 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23711 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23712 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23713 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23714 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23715 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23716 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23717 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23718 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23719 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23720 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23721 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23722 @end multitable
23723
23724 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23725 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23726 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23727
23728 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23729 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23730 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23731
23732 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23733 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23734
23735 @table @code
23736 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23737 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23738 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23739 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23740 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23741
23742 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23743 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23744 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23745 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23746 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23747
23748 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23749 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23750 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23751 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23752 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23753 @end table
23754
23755 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23756 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23757 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23758
23759 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23760
23761 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23762 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23763
23764 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23765 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23766 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23767 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23768 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23769 library.
23770
23771 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23772 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23773
23774 @table @code
23775 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23776 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23777 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23778 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23779
23780 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23781 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23782 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23783 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23784 enabled or disabled.
23785
23786 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23787 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23788 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23789 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23790 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23791 @end table
23792
23793 @node Auto-loading safe path
23794 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23795 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23796
23797 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23798 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23799 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23800 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23801 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23802
23803 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23804 get loaded:
23805
23806 @smallexample
23807 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23808 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23809 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23810 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23811 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23812 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23813 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23814 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23815 @end smallexample
23816
23817 @noindent
23818 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23819 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23820
23821 @smallexample
23822 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23823 @end smallexample
23824
23825 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23826
23827 @table @code
23828 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23829 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23830 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23831 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23832 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23833 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23834 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23835 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23836 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23837 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23838
23839 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23840 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23841 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23842
23843 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23844 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23845 @item show auto-load safe-path
23846 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23847 scripts.
23848
23849 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23850 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23851 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23852 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23853 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23854 by the host platform path separator in use.
23855 @end table
23856
23857 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23858 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23859 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23860 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23861 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23862
23863 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23864 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23865 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23866 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23867 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23868 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23869 init file in the current directory
23870 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23871
23872 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23873 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23874
23875 @table @asis
23876 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23877 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23878 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23879 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23880
23881 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23882 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23883 @value{GDBN} session.
23884
23885 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23886 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23887 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23888 from trusted sources.
23889
23890 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23891 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23892 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23893 trusted sources.
23894 @end table
23895
23896 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23897 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23898
23899 @table @asis
23900 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23901 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23902
23903 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23904 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23905 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23906 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23907 @end table
23908
23909 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23910 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23911 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23912 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23913 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23914 recommended to be entered.
23915
23916 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23917 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23918 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23919
23920 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23921 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23922 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23923 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23924 be printed.
23925
23926 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23927 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23928 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23929
23930 @smallexample
23931 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23932 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23933 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23934 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23935 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23936 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23937 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23938 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23939 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23940 @end smallexample
23941
23942 @table @code
23943 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23944 @kindex set debug auto-load
23945 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23946 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23947
23948 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23949 @kindex show debug auto-load
23950 @item show debug auto-load
23951 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23952 on or off.
23953 @end table
23954
23955 @node Messages/Warnings
23956 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23957
23958 @cindex verbose operation
23959 @cindex optional warnings
23960 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23961 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23962 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23963 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23964
23965 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23966 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23967 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23968
23969 @table @code
23970 @kindex set verbose
23971 @item set verbose on
23972 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23973
23974 @item set verbose off
23975 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23976
23977 @kindex show verbose
23978 @item show verbose
23979 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23980 @end table
23981
23982 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23983 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23984 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23985 Symbol Files}).
23986
23987 @table @code
23988
23989 @kindex set complaints
23990 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23991 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23992 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23993 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23994 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23995
23996 @kindex show complaints
23997 @item show complaints
23998 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23999
24000 @end table
24001
24002 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24003 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24004 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24005 you try to run a program which is already running:
24006
24007 @smallexample
24008 (@value{GDBP}) run
24009 The program being debugged has been started already.
24010 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24011 @end smallexample
24012
24013 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24014 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24015
24016 @table @code
24017
24018 @kindex set confirm
24019 @cindex flinching
24020 @cindex confirmation
24021 @cindex stupid questions
24022 @item set confirm off
24023 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24024 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24025 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24026
24027 @item set confirm on
24028 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24029
24030 @kindex show confirm
24031 @item show confirm
24032 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24033
24034 @end table
24035
24036 @cindex command tracing
24037 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24038 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24039 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24040 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24041
24042 @table @code
24043 @kindex set trace-commands
24044 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24045 @item set trace-commands on
24046 Enable command tracing.
24047 @item set trace-commands off
24048 Disable command tracing.
24049 @item show trace-commands
24050 Display the current state of command tracing.
24051 @end table
24052
24053 @node Debugging Output
24054 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24055 @cindex optional debugging messages
24056
24057 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24058 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24059 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24060 section documents those commands.
24061
24062 @table @code
24063 @kindex set exec-done-display
24064 @item set exec-done-display
24065 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24066 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24067 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24068 @kindex show exec-done-display
24069 @item show exec-done-display
24070 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24071 notification.
24072 @kindex set debug
24073 @cindex ARM AArch64
24074 @item set debug aarch64
24075 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24076 The default is off.
24077 @kindex show debug
24078 @item show debug aarch64
24079 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24080 ARM AArch64.
24081 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24082 @cindex architecture debugging info
24083 @item set debug arch
24084 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24085 @item show debug arch
24086 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24087 @item set debug aix-solib
24088 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24089 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24090 support module. The default is off.
24091 @item show debug aix-thread
24092 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24093 @item set debug aix-thread
24094 @cindex AIX threads
24095 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24096 module.
24097 @item show debug aix-thread
24098 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24099 @item set debug check-physname
24100 @cindex physname
24101 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24102 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24103 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24104 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24105 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24106 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24107 @item show debug check-physname
24108 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24109 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24110 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24111 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24112 exported symbols. The default is off.
24113 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24114 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24115 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24116 @item set debug dwarf-die
24117 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24118 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24119 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24120 A value of zero turns off the display.
24121 @item show debug dwarf-die
24122 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24123 @item set debug dwarf-line
24124 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24125 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24126 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24127 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24128 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24129 @item show debug dwarf-line
24130 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24131 @item set debug dwarf-read
24132 @cindex DWARF Reading
24133 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24134 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24135 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24136 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24137 @item show debug dwarf-read
24138 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24139 @item set debug displaced
24140 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24141 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24142 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24143 @item show debug displaced
24144 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24145 related to displaced stepping.
24146 @item set debug event
24147 @cindex event debugging info
24148 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24149 default is off.
24150 @item show debug event
24151 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24152 info.
24153 @item set debug expression
24154 @cindex expression debugging info
24155 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24156 expression parsing. The default is off.
24157 @item show debug expression
24158 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24159 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24160 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24161 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24162 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24163 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24164 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24165 @item set debug frame
24166 @cindex frame debugging info
24167 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24168 default is off.
24169 @item show debug frame
24170 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24171 info.
24172 @item set debug gnu-nat
24173 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24174 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24175 @item show debug gnu-nat
24176 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24177 @item set debug infrun
24178 @cindex inferior debugging info
24179 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24180 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24181 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24182 @item show debug infrun
24183 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24184 @item set debug jit
24185 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24186 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24187 @item show debug jit
24188 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24189 @item set debug lin-lwp
24190 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24191 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24192 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24193 @item show debug lin-lwp
24194 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24195 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24196 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24197 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24198 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24199 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24200 @item set debug mach-o
24201 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24202 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24203 processing. The default is off.
24204 @item show debug mach-o
24205 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24206 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24207 @item set debug notification
24208 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24209 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24210 The default is off.
24211 @item show debug notification
24212 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24213 @item set debug observer
24214 @cindex observer debugging info
24215 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24216 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24217 @item show debug observer
24218 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24219 @item set debug overload
24220 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24221 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24222 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24223 is off.
24224 @item show debug overload
24225 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24226 debugging info.
24227 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24228 @cindex debug expression parser
24229 @item set debug parser
24230 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24231 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24232 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24233 details. The default is off.
24234 @item show debug parser
24235 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24236 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24237 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24238 @cindex debug remote protocol
24239 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24240 @cindex display remote packets
24241 @item set debug remote
24242 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24243 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24244 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24245 @item show debug remote
24246 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24247
24248 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24249 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24250 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24251 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24252
24253 @item set debug serial
24254 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24255 default is off.
24256 @item show debug serial
24257 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24258 info.
24259 @item set debug solib-frv
24260 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24261 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24262 @item show debug solib-frv
24263 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24264 messages.
24265 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24266 @cindex symbol lookup
24267 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24268 The default is 0 (off).
24269 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24270 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24271 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24272 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24273 @item set debug symfile
24274 @cindex symbol file functions
24275 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24276 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24277 @item show debug symfile
24278 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24279 @item set debug symtab-create
24280 @cindex symbol table creation
24281 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24282 The default is 0 (off).
24283 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24284 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24285 @item show debug symtab-create
24286 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24287 @item set debug target
24288 @cindex target debugging info
24289 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24290 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24291 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24292 value of large memory transfers.
24293 @item show debug target
24294 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24295 info.
24296 @item set debug timestamp
24297 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24298 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24299 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24300 message.
24301 @item show debug timestamp
24302 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24303 debugging info.
24304 @item set debug varobj
24305 @cindex variable object debugging info
24306 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24307 info. The default is off.
24308 @item show debug varobj
24309 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24310 debugging info.
24311 @item set debug xml
24312 @cindex XML parser debugging
24313 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24314 @item show debug xml
24315 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24316 @end table
24317
24318 @node Other Misc Settings
24319 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24320 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24321
24322 @table @code
24323 @kindex set interactive-mode
24324 @item set interactive-mode
24325 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24326 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24327 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24328 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24329 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24330 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24331 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24332 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24333
24334 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24335 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24336 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24337 inside a cygwin window.
24338
24339 @kindex show interactive-mode
24340 @item show interactive-mode
24341 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24342 @end table
24343
24344 @node Extending GDB
24345 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24346 @cindex extending GDB
24347
24348 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24349 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24350 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24351 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24352 being debugged.
24353
24354 @menu
24355 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24356 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24357 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24358 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24359 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24360 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24361 @end menu
24362
24363 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24364 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24365 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24366 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24367 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24368 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24369
24370 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24371 setting:
24372
24373 @table @code
24374 @kindex set script-extension
24375 @kindex show script-extension
24376 @item set script-extension off
24377 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24378
24379 @item set script-extension soft
24380 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24381 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24382 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24383 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24384
24385 @item set script-extension strict
24386 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24387 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24388 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24389
24390 @item show script-extension
24391 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24392
24393 @end table
24394
24395 @node Sequences
24396 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24397
24398 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24399 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24400 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24401 files.
24402
24403 @menu
24404 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24405 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24406 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24407 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24408 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24409 @end menu
24410
24411 @node Define
24412 @subsection User-defined Commands
24413
24414 @cindex user-defined command
24415 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24416 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24417 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24418 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24419 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24420 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24421
24422 @smallexample
24423 define adder
24424 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24425 end
24426 @end smallexample
24427
24428 @noindent
24429 To execute the command use:
24430
24431 @smallexample
24432 adder 1 2 3
24433 @end smallexample
24434
24435 @noindent
24436 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24437 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24438 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24439 functions calls.
24440
24441 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24442 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24443 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24444 been passed.
24445
24446 @smallexample
24447 define adder
24448 if $argc == 2
24449 print $arg0 + $arg1
24450 end
24451 if $argc == 3
24452 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24453 end
24454 end
24455 @end smallexample
24456
24457 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24458 to process a variable number of arguments:
24459
24460 @smallexample
24461 define adder
24462 set $i = 0
24463 set $sum = 0
24464 while $i < $argc
24465 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24466 set $i = $i + 1
24467 end
24468 print $sum
24469 end
24470 @end smallexample
24471
24472 @table @code
24473
24474 @kindex define
24475 @item define @var{commandname}
24476 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24477 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24478 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24479 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24480 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24481 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24482
24483 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24484 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24485 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24486
24487 @kindex document
24488 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24489 @item document @var{commandname}
24490 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24491 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24492 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24493 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24494 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24495 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24496
24497 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24498 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24499 does not change the documentation.
24500
24501 @kindex dont-repeat
24502 @cindex don't repeat command
24503 @item dont-repeat
24504 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24505 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24506 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24507
24508 @kindex help user-defined
24509 @item help user-defined
24510 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24511 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24512 included (if any).
24513
24514 @kindex show user
24515 @item show user
24516 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24517 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24518 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24519 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24520 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24521
24522 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24523 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24524 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24525 @item show max-user-call-depth
24526 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24527 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24528 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24529 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24530 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24531 @end table
24532
24533 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24534 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24535
24536 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24537 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24538 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24539
24540 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24541 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24542 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24543 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24544
24545 @node Hooks
24546 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24547 @cindex command hooks
24548 @cindex hooks, for commands
24549 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24550
24551 @kindex hook
24552 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24553 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24554 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24555 before that command.
24556
24557 @cindex hooks, post-command
24558 @kindex hookpost
24559 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24560 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24561 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24562 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24563 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24564
24565 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24566 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24567
24568 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24569 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24570
24571 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24572 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24573 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24574 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24575 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24576
24577 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24578 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24579 you could define:
24580
24581 @smallexample
24582 define hook-stop
24583 handle SIGALRM nopass
24584 end
24585
24586 define hook-run
24587 handle SIGALRM pass
24588 end
24589
24590 define hook-continue
24591 handle SIGALRM pass
24592 end
24593 @end smallexample
24594
24595 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24596 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24597 you could define:
24598
24599 @smallexample
24600 define hook-echo
24601 echo <<<---
24602 end
24603
24604 define hookpost-echo
24605 echo --->>>\n
24606 end
24607
24608 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24609 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24610 (@value{GDBP})
24611
24612 @end smallexample
24613
24614 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24615 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24616 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24617 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24618 @c or not?
24619 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24620 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24621 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24622
24623 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24624 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24625 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24626
24627 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24628 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24629
24630 @node Command Files
24631 @subsection Command Files
24632
24633 @cindex command files
24634 @cindex scripting commands
24635 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24636 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24637 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24638 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24639 terminal.
24640
24641 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24642 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24643 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24644 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24645 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24646
24647 @table @code
24648 @kindex source
24649 @cindex execute commands from a file
24650 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24651 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24652 @end table
24653
24654 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24655 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24656 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24657 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24658 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24659
24660 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24661 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24662 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24663 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24664 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24665 is not relevant to scripts.
24666
24667 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24668 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24669 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24670 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24671 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24672 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24673 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24674 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24675 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24676 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24677 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24678 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24679 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24680 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24681
24682 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24683 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24684 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24685
24686 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24687 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24688 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24689 when called from command files.
24690
24691 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24692 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24693 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24694 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24695 the next command.
24696
24697 @smallexample
24698 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24699 @end smallexample
24700
24701 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24702 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24703 would be directed to @file{log}.
24704
24705 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24706 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24707 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24708 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24709 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24710 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24711 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24712 conditionally, etc.
24713
24714 @table @code
24715 @kindex if
24716 @kindex else
24717 @item if
24718 @itemx else
24719 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24720 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24721 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24722 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24723 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24724 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24725 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24726
24727 @kindex while
24728 @item while
24729 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24730 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24731 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24732 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24733 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24734 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24735
24736 @kindex loop_break
24737 @item loop_break
24738 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24739 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24740 line.
24741
24742 @kindex loop_continue
24743 @item loop_continue
24744 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24745 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24746 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24747 the controlling expression.
24748
24749 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24750 @item end
24751 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24752 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24753 @end table
24754
24755
24756 @node Output
24757 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24758
24759 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24760 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24761 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24762 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24763 want.
24764
24765 @table @code
24766 @kindex echo
24767 @item echo @var{text}
24768 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24769 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24770 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24771 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24772 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24773 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24774 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24775 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24776 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24777 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24778 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24779
24780 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24781 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24782
24783 @smallexample
24784 echo This is some text\n\
24785 which is continued\n\
24786 onto several lines.\n
24787 @end smallexample
24788
24789 produces the same output as
24790
24791 @smallexample
24792 echo This is some text\n
24793 echo which is continued\n
24794 echo onto several lines.\n
24795 @end smallexample
24796
24797 @kindex output
24798 @item output @var{expression}
24799 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24800 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24801 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24802 on expressions.
24803
24804 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24805 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24806 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24807 Formats}, for more information.
24808
24809 @kindex printf
24810 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24811 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24812 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24813 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24814 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24815 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24816 executing the code below:
24817
24818 @smallexample
24819 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24820 @end smallexample
24821
24822 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24823 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24824 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24825 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24826 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24827 printed.
24828
24829 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24830
24831 @smallexample
24832 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24833 @end smallexample
24834
24835 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24836 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24837 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24838
24839 @itemize @bullet
24840 @item
24841 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24842
24843 @item
24844 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24845 width.
24846
24847 @item
24848 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24849 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24850
24851 @item
24852 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24853 supported.
24854
24855 @item
24856 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24857
24858 @item
24859 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24860 @end itemize
24861
24862 @noindent
24863 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24864 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24865 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24866 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24867
24868 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24869 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24870 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24871 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24872 supported.
24873
24874 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24875 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24876 together with a floating point specifier.
24877 letters:
24878
24879 @itemize @bullet
24880 @item
24881 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24882
24883 @item
24884 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24885
24886 @item
24887 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24888 @end itemize
24889
24890 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24891 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24892 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24893
24894 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24895 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24896
24897 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24898 @smallexample
24899 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24900 @end smallexample
24901
24902 @anchor{eval}
24903 @kindex eval
24904 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24905 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24906 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24907
24908 @end table
24909
24910 @node Auto-loading sequences
24911 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24912 @cindex native script auto-loading
24913
24914 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24915 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24916 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24917 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24918
24919 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24920 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24921
24922 @table @code
24923 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24924 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24925 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24926 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24927
24928 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24929 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24930 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24931 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24932 disabled.
24933
24934 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24935 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24936 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24937 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24938 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24939 auto-loaded.
24940 @end table
24941
24942 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24943 matching names are printed.
24944
24945 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24946 @include python.texi
24947
24948 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24949 @include guile.texi
24950
24951 @node Auto-loading extensions
24952 @section Auto-loading extensions
24953 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24954
24955 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24956 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24957 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24958 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24959 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24960
24961 @menu
24962 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24963 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24964 * Which flavor to choose?::
24965 @end menu
24966
24967 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24968 debugging commands and features.
24969
24970 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24971 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24972 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24973 for more information.
24974 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24975 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24976
24977 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24978 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24979
24980 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24981 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24982 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24983 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24984 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24985
24986 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24987 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24988 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24989 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24990
24991 @table @code
24992 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24993 GDB's own command language
24994 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24995 Python
24996 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24997 Guile
24998 @end table
24999
25000 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25001 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25002 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25003 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25004 script in the specified extension language.
25005
25006 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25007 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25008
25009 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25010 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25011
25012 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25013 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25014 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25015 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25016 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25017 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25018
25019 @table @code
25020 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25021 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25022 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25023 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25024 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25025 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25026
25027 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25028 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25029
25030 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25031 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25032 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25033 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25034
25035 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25036 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25037 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25038 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25039 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25040 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25041 platform.
25042
25043 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25044 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25045 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25046
25047 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25048 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25049 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25050 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25051
25052 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25053 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25054 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25055 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25056 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25057 @end table
25058
25059 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25060 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25061 @var{objfile} is opened.
25062 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25063 is evaluated more than once.
25064
25065 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25066 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25067 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25068
25069 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25070 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25071 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25072 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25073 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25074 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25075 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25076
25077 The following entries are supported:
25078
25079 @table @code
25080 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25081 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25082 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25083 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25084 @end table
25085
25086 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25087
25088 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25089 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25090 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25091 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25092 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25093
25094 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25095 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25096
25097 @example
25098 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25099 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25100 asm("\
25101 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25102 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25103 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25104 .popsection \n\
25105 ");
25106 @end example
25107
25108 @noindent
25109 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25110 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25111
25112 @example
25113 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25114 @end example
25115
25116 The script name may include directories if desired.
25117
25118 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25119 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25120
25121 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25122 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25123 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25124 will remove duplicates.
25125
25126 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25127
25128 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25129 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25130 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25131 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25132 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25133 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25134 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25135 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25136 on its name.
25137
25138 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25139 testsuite.
25140
25141 @example
25142 #include "symcat.h"
25143 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25144 asm(
25145 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25146 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25147 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25148 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25149 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25150 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25151 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25152 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25153 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25154 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25155 ".byte 0\n"
25156 ".popsection\n"
25157 );
25158 @end example
25159
25160 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25161 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25162 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25163 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25164
25165 @node Which flavor to choose?
25166 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25167
25168 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25169 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25170
25171 @noindent
25172 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25173
25174 @itemize @bullet
25175 @item
25176 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25177
25178 @item
25179 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25180
25181 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25182 in the source search path.
25183 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25184 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25185
25186 @item
25187 Doesn't require source code additions.
25188 @end itemize
25189
25190 @noindent
25191 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25192
25193 @itemize @bullet
25194 @item
25195 Works with static linking.
25196
25197 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25198 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25199 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25200 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25201 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25202
25203 @item
25204 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25205
25206 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25207 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25208
25209 @item
25210 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25211
25212 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25213 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25214 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25215 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25216 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25217 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25218 @end itemize
25219
25220 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25221 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25222
25223 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25224 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25225 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25226
25227 @subsection Python comes first
25228
25229 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25230 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25231 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25232 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25233 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25234 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25235 pretty-printed form of a value).
25236 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25237 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25238 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25239
25240 @node Aliases
25241 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25242 @cindex aliases for commands
25243
25244 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25245 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25246 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25247 that involves less typing.
25248
25249 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25250 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25251 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25252
25253 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25254 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25255 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25256
25257 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25258
25259 @table @code
25260
25261 @kindex alias
25262 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25263
25264 @end table
25265
25266 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25267 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25268 underscores.
25269
25270 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25271 that is being aliased.
25272
25273 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25274 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25275 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25276
25277 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25278 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25279
25280 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25281 of a command so that there is less to type.
25282 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25283 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25284 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25285 The following will accomplish this.
25286
25287 @smallexample
25288 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25289 @end smallexample
25290
25291 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25292 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25293 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25294 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25295
25296 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25297 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25298 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25299 of a command.
25300
25301 @smallexample
25302 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25303 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25304 (gdb) set p elms 20
25305 (gdb) show p elms
25306 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25307 @end smallexample
25308
25309 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25310 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25311 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25312
25313 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25314 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25315
25316 @smallexample
25317 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25318 @end smallexample
25319
25320 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25321 alias for a more complex command.
25322 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25323
25324 @smallexample
25325 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25326 (gdb) spe 20
25327 @end smallexample
25328
25329 @node Interpreters
25330 @chapter Command Interpreters
25331 @cindex command interpreters
25332
25333 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25334 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25335 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25336
25337 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25338 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25339 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25340 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25341
25342 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25343 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25344 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25345 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25346
25347 @table @code
25348 @item console
25349 @cindex console interpreter
25350 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25351 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25352 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25353
25354 @item mi
25355 @cindex mi interpreter
25356 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25357 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25358 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25359 Interface}.
25360
25361 @item mi2
25362 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25363 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25364
25365 @item mi1
25366 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25367 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25368
25369 @end table
25370
25371 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25372
25373 @kindex interpreter-exec
25374 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25375 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25376 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25377
25378 @smallexample
25379 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25380 @end smallexample
25381
25382 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25383 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25384
25385 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25386 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25387 permanently.
25388
25389 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25390
25391 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25392 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25393 device (usually a tty).
25394
25395 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25396 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25397 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25398 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25399 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25400 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25401 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25402 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25403 the separate MI interpreter.
25404
25405 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25406 @code{new-ui} command:
25407
25408 @kindex new-ui
25409 @cindex new user interface
25410 @smallexample
25411 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25412 @end smallexample
25413
25414 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25415 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25416 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25417 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25418 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25419 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25420
25421 @smallexample
25422 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25423 @end smallexample
25424
25425 @noindent
25426 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25427
25428 @node TUI
25429 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25430 @cindex TUI
25431 @cindex Text User Interface
25432
25433 @menu
25434 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25435 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25436 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25437 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25438 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25439 @end menu
25440
25441 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25442 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25443 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25444 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25445 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25446 is available.
25447
25448 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25449 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25450 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25451 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25452 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25453 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25454
25455 @node TUI Overview
25456 @section TUI Overview
25457
25458 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25459
25460 @table @emph
25461 @item command
25462 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25463 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25464 managed using readline.
25465
25466 @item source
25467 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25468 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25469
25470 @item assembly
25471 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25472
25473 @item register
25474 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25475 when their values change.
25476 @end table
25477
25478 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25479 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25480 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25481 indicates the breakpoint type:
25482
25483 @table @code
25484 @item B
25485 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25486
25487 @item b
25488 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25489
25490 @item H
25491 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25492
25493 @item h
25494 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25495 @end table
25496
25497 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25498
25499 @table @code
25500 @item +
25501 Breakpoint is enabled.
25502
25503 @item -
25504 Breakpoint is disabled.
25505 @end table
25506
25507 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25508 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25509 changes.
25510
25511 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25512 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25513 layouts:
25514
25515 @itemize @bullet
25516 @item
25517 source only,
25518
25519 @item
25520 assembly only,
25521
25522 @item
25523 source and assembly,
25524
25525 @item
25526 source and registers, or
25527
25528 @item
25529 assembly and registers.
25530 @end itemize
25531
25532 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25533
25534 @table @emph
25535 @item target
25536 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25537 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25538
25539 @item process
25540 Gives the current process or thread number.
25541 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25542
25543 @item function
25544 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25545 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25546 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25547 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25548
25549 @item line
25550 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25551 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25552
25553 @item pc
25554 Indicates the current program counter address.
25555 @end table
25556
25557 @node TUI Keys
25558 @section TUI Key Bindings
25559 @cindex TUI key bindings
25560
25561 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25562 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25563 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25564 @end ifset
25565 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25566 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25567 @end ifclear
25568 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25569 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25570
25571 @table @kbd
25572 @kindex C-x C-a
25573 @item C-x C-a
25574 @kindex C-x a
25575 @itemx C-x a
25576 @kindex C-x A
25577 @itemx C-x A
25578 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25579 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25580 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25581 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25582 The screen is then refreshed.
25583
25584 @kindex C-x 1
25585 @item C-x 1
25586 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25587 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25588 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25589
25590 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25591
25592 @kindex C-x 2
25593 @item C-x 2
25594 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25595 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25596 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25597 previous layout and the new one.
25598
25599 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25600
25601 @kindex C-x o
25602 @item C-x o
25603 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25604 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25605 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25606
25607 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25608
25609 @kindex C-x s
25610 @item C-x s
25611 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25612 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25613 @end table
25614
25615 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25616
25617 @table @asis
25618 @kindex PgUp
25619 @item @key{PgUp}
25620 Scroll the active window one page up.
25621
25622 @kindex PgDn
25623 @item @key{PgDn}
25624 Scroll the active window one page down.
25625
25626 @kindex Up
25627 @item @key{Up}
25628 Scroll the active window one line up.
25629
25630 @kindex Down
25631 @item @key{Down}
25632 Scroll the active window one line down.
25633
25634 @kindex Left
25635 @item @key{Left}
25636 Scroll the active window one column left.
25637
25638 @kindex Right
25639 @item @key{Right}
25640 Scroll the active window one column right.
25641
25642 @kindex C-L
25643 @item @kbd{C-L}
25644 Refresh the screen.
25645 @end table
25646
25647 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25648 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25649 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25650 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25651 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25652
25653 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25654 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25655 @cindex TUI single key mode
25656
25657 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25658 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25659 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25660
25661 @table @kbd
25662 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25663 @item c
25664 continue
25665
25666 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25667 @item d
25668 down
25669
25670 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25671 @item f
25672 finish
25673
25674 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25675 @item n
25676 next
25677
25678 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25679 @item o
25680 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
25681
25682 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25683 @item q
25684 exit the SingleKey mode.
25685
25686 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25687 @item r
25688 run
25689
25690 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25691 @item s
25692 step
25693
25694 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25695 @item i
25696 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
25697
25698 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25699 @item u
25700 up
25701
25702 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25703 @item v
25704 info locals
25705
25706 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25707 @item w
25708 where
25709 @end table
25710
25711 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25712 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25713 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25714 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25715 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25716 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25717
25718
25719 @node TUI Commands
25720 @section TUI-specific Commands
25721 @cindex TUI commands
25722
25723 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25724 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25725 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25726 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25727
25728 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25729 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25730 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25731 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25732 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25733
25734 @table @code
25735 @item tui enable
25736 @kindex tui enable
25737 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25738 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25739 otherwise a default layout is used.
25740
25741 @item tui disable
25742 @kindex tui disable
25743 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25744
25745 @item info win
25746 @kindex info win
25747 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25748
25749 @item layout @var{name}
25750 @kindex layout
25751 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25752 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25753 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25754
25755 @table @code
25756 @item next
25757 Display the next layout.
25758
25759 @item prev
25760 Display the previous layout.
25761
25762 @item src
25763 Display the source and command windows.
25764
25765 @item asm
25766 Display the assembly and command windows.
25767
25768 @item split
25769 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25770
25771 @item regs
25772 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25773 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25774 register, assembler, and command windows.
25775 @end table
25776
25777 @item focus @var{name}
25778 @kindex focus
25779 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25780 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25781
25782 @table @code
25783 @item next
25784 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25785
25786 @item prev
25787 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25788
25789 @item src
25790 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25791
25792 @item asm
25793 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25794
25795 @item regs
25796 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25797
25798 @item cmd
25799 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25800 @end table
25801
25802 @item refresh
25803 @kindex refresh
25804 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25805
25806 @item tui reg @var{group}
25807 @kindex tui reg
25808 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25809 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25810 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25811 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25812 following groups are available on most targets:
25813 @table @code
25814 @item next
25815 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25816 through all of the available register groups.
25817
25818 @item prev
25819 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25820 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25821 @var{next}.
25822
25823 @item general
25824 Display the general registers.
25825 @item float
25826 Display the floating point registers.
25827 @item system
25828 Display the system registers.
25829 @item vector
25830 Display the vector registers.
25831 @item all
25832 Display all registers.
25833 @end table
25834
25835 @item update
25836 @kindex update
25837 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25838
25839 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25840 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25841 @kindex winheight
25842 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25843 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25844 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25845 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25846 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25847
25848 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25849 @kindex tabset
25850 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25851 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25852 assembly windows.
25853 @end table
25854
25855 @node TUI Configuration
25856 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25857 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25858
25859 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25860
25861 @table @code
25862 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25863 @kindex set tui border-kind
25864 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25865 The possible values are the following:
25866 @table @code
25867 @item space
25868 Use a space character to draw the border.
25869
25870 @item ascii
25871 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25872
25873 @item acs
25874 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25875 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25876 @end table
25877
25878 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25879 @kindex set tui border-mode
25880 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25881 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25882 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25883 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25884 @table @code
25885 @item normal
25886 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25887
25888 @item standout
25889 Use standout mode.
25890
25891 @item reverse
25892 Use reverse video mode.
25893
25894 @item half
25895 Use half bright mode.
25896
25897 @item half-standout
25898 Use half bright and standout mode.
25899
25900 @item bold
25901 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25902
25903 @item bold-standout
25904 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25905 @end table
25906 @end table
25907
25908 @node Emacs
25909 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25910
25911 @cindex Emacs
25912 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25913 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25914 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25915 @value{GDBN}.
25916
25917 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25918 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25919 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25920 created Emacs buffer.
25921 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25922
25923 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25924 things:
25925
25926 @itemize @bullet
25927 @item
25928 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25929 the GUD buffer.
25930
25931 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25932 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25933
25934 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25935 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25936 in this way.
25937
25938 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25939 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25940 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25941 stop.
25942
25943 @item
25944 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25945
25946 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25947 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25948 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25949 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25950 and the source.
25951
25952 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25953 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25954 @end itemize
25955
25956 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25957 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25958 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25959 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25960
25961 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25962 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25963 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25964 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25965 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25966 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25967 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25968 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25969 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25970
25971 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25972 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25973 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25974 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25975
25976 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25977 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25978 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25979 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25980 one you want.
25981
25982 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25983 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25984
25985 @table @kbd
25986 @item C-h m
25987 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25988
25989 @item C-c C-s
25990 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25991 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25992
25993 @item C-c C-n
25994 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25995 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25996 to show the current file and location.
25997
25998 @item C-c C-i
25999 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26000 display window accordingly.
26001
26002 @item C-c C-f
26003 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26004 @code{finish} command.
26005
26006 @item C-c C-r
26007 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26008 command.
26009
26010 @item C-c <
26011 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26012 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26013 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26014
26015 @item C-c >
26016 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26017 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26018 @end table
26019
26020 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26021 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26022
26023 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26024 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26025 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26026 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26027 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26028 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26029 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26030
26031 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26032 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26033 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26034 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26035 frame.
26036
26037 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26038 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26039 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26040 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26041 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26042 to correspond properly with the code.
26043
26044 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26045 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26046 Emacs Manual}).
26047
26048 @node GDB/MI
26049 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26050
26051 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26052
26053 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26054 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26055 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26056 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26057 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26058 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26059
26060 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26061 in the form of a reference manual.
26062
26063 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26064 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26065 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26066
26067 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26068
26069 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26070 This chapter uses the following notation:
26071
26072 @itemize @bullet
26073 @item
26074 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26075
26076 @item
26077 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26078 it may or may not be given.
26079
26080 @item
26081 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26082 may repeat zero or more times.
26083
26084 @item
26085 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26086 may repeat one or more times.
26087
26088 @item
26089 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26090 @end itemize
26091
26092 @ignore
26093 @heading Dependencies
26094 @end ignore
26095
26096 @menu
26097 * GDB/MI General Design::
26098 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26099 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26100 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26101 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26102 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26103 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26104 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26105 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26106 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26107 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26108 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26109 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26110 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26111 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26112 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26113 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26114 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26115 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26116 @ignore
26117 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26118 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26119 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26120 @end ignore
26121 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26122 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26123 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26124 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26125 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26126 @end menu
26127
26128 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26129 @node GDB/MI General Design
26130 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26131 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26132
26133 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26134 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26135 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26136 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26137 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26138 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26139 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26140 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26141 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26142 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26143
26144 The important examples of notifications are:
26145 @itemize @bullet
26146
26147 @item
26148 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26149 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26150 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26151 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26152 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26153 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26154 command itself was successfully executed.
26155
26156 @item
26157 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26158 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26159 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26160 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26161 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26162 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26163
26164 @item
26165 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26166 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26167 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26168 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26169 orthogonal frontend design.
26170
26171 @end itemize
26172
26173 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26174 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26175 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26176 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26177 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26178 the user interface.
26179
26180
26181 @menu
26182 * Context management::
26183 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26184 * Thread groups::
26185 @end menu
26186
26187 @node Context management
26188 @subsection Context management
26189
26190 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26191
26192 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26193 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26194 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26195 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26196 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26197 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26198 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26199 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26200 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26201
26202 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26203 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26204 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26205 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26206 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26207 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26208 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26209 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26210 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26211 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26212 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26213
26214 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26215 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26216 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26217 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26218 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26219 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26220 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26221 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26222 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26223 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26224
26225 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26226 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26227 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26228 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26229 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26230 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26231 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26232 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26233 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26234 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26235 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26236 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26237 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26238 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26239 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26240 @samp{--frame} options.
26241
26242 @subsubsection Language
26243
26244 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26245 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26246 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26247 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26248 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26249 For instance:
26250
26251 @smallexample
26252 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26253 ^done,value="4"
26254 (gdb)
26255 @end smallexample
26256
26257 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26258 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26259 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26260
26261 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26262 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26263
26264 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26265 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26266 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26267 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26268 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26269 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26270 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26271 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26272 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26273
26274 @table @code
26275 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26276 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26277 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26278
26279 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26280 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26281 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26282
26283 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26284 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26285 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26286 MI commands even while the target is running.
26287
26288 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26289 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26290 @end table
26291
26292 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26293 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26294 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26295 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26296 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26297 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26298
26299 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26300 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26301 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26302 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26303 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26304 are running.
26305
26306 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26307 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26308 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26309 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26310 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26311 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26312 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26313 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26314 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26315 @samp{--thread} option).
26316
26317 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26318 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26319 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26320 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26321
26322 @node Thread groups
26323 @subsection Thread groups
26324 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26325 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26326 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26327 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26328 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26329
26330 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26331 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26332 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26333 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26334 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26335 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26336 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26337 into processes.
26338
26339 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26340 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26341 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26342 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26343 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26344 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26345 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26346 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26347 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26348 the members of specific thread group.
26349
26350 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26351 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26352 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26353 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26354 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26355 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26356 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26357 after attaching to that thread group.
26358
26359 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26360 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26361 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26362 such thread groups.
26363
26364 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26365 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26366 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26367
26368 @menu
26369 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26370 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26371 @end menu
26372
26373 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26374 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26375
26376 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26377 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26378 @table @code
26379 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26380 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26381
26382 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26383 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26384 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26385
26386 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26387 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26388 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26389
26390 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26391 "any sequence of digits"
26392
26393 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26394 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26395
26396 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26397 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26398
26399 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26400 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26401
26402 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26403 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26404 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26405
26406 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26407 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26408
26409 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26410 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26411 @end table
26412
26413 @noindent
26414 Notes:
26415
26416 @itemize @bullet
26417 @item
26418 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26419 output is described below.
26420
26421 @item
26422 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26423 finishes.
26424
26425 @item
26426 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26427 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26428 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26429 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26430 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26431 @end itemize
26432
26433 Pragmatics:
26434
26435 @itemize @bullet
26436 @item
26437 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26438
26439 @item
26440 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26441 @end itemize
26442
26443 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26444 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26445
26446 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26447 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26448 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26449 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26450 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26451 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26452
26453 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26454 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26455 @var{token}.
26456
26457 @table @code
26458 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26459 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26460
26461 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26462 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26463
26464 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26465 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26466
26467 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26468 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26469
26470 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26471 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26472
26473 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26474 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26475
26476 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26477 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26478
26479 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26480 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26481
26482 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26483 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26484
26485 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26486 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26487 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26488
26489 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26490 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26491
26492 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26493 @code{ @var{string} }
26494
26495 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26496 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26497
26498 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26499 @code{@var{c-string}}
26500
26501 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26502 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26503
26504 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26505 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26506 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26507
26508 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26509 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26510
26511 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26512 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26513
26514 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26515 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26516
26517 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26518 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26519
26520 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26521 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26522
26523 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26524 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26525 @end table
26526
26527 @noindent
26528 Notes:
26529
26530 @itemize @bullet
26531 @item
26532 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26533
26534 @item
26535 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26536 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26537 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26538 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26539 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26540 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26541 prior command.
26542
26543 @item
26544 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26545 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26546 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26547 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26548
26549 @item
26550 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26551 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26552 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26553 @samp{*}.
26554
26555 @item
26556 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26557 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26558 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26559 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26560
26561 @item
26562 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26563 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26564 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26565 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26566
26567 @item
26568 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26569 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26570 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26571
26572 @item
26573 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26574 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26575 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26576 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26577
26578 @item
26579 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26580 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26581 @var{values}.
26582
26583
26584 @end itemize
26585
26586 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26587 details about the various output records.
26588
26589 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26590 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26591 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26592
26593 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26594 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26595
26596 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26597 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26598 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26599 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26600 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26601 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26602
26603 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26604 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26605 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26606
26607 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26608 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26609 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26610 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26611
26612 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26613 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26614
26615 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26616 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26617 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26618 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26619 might change.
26620
26621 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26622 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26623 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26624 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26625
26626 @itemize @bullet
26627 @item
26628 New MI commands may be added.
26629
26630 @item
26631 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26632
26633 @item
26634 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26635 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26636
26637 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26638 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26639
26640 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26641 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26642 @end itemize
26643
26644 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26645 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26646 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26647 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26648 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26649
26650 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26651 @c version?
26652
26653 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26654 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26655 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26656 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26657 @cindex mailing lists
26658
26659 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26660 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26661 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26662
26663 @menu
26664 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26665 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26666 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26667 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26668 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26669 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26670 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26671 @end menu
26672
26673 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26674 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26675
26676 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26677 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26678 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26679 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26680
26681 @table @code
26682 @findex ^done
26683 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26684 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26685 values.
26686
26687 @item "^running"
26688 @findex ^running
26689 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26690 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26691 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26692 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26693 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26694 which threads are resumed.
26695
26696 @item "^connected"
26697 @findex ^connected
26698 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26699
26700 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26701 @findex ^error
26702 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26703 the corresponding error message.
26704
26705 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26706 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26707 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26708
26709 @table @samp
26710 @item "undefined-command"
26711 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26712 @end table
26713
26714 @item "^exit"
26715 @findex ^exit
26716 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26717
26718 @end table
26719
26720 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26721 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26722
26723 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26724 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26725 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26726 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26727 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26728
26729 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26730 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26731 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26732 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26733 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26734
26735 @table @code
26736 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26737 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26738 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26739
26740 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26741 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26742 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26743 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26744
26745 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26746 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26747 internals.
26748 @end table
26749
26750 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26751 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26752
26753 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26754 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26755 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26756 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26757 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26758 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26759
26760 The following is the list of possible async records:
26761
26762 @table @code
26763
26764 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26765 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26766 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26767 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26768 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26769 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26770 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26771 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26772 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26773 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26774 it run freely.
26775
26776 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26777 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26778 following values:
26779
26780 @table @code
26781 @item breakpoint-hit
26782 A breakpoint was reached.
26783 @item watchpoint-trigger
26784 A watchpoint was triggered.
26785 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26786 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26787 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26788 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26789 @item function-finished
26790 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26791 @item location-reached
26792 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26793 @item watchpoint-scope
26794 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26795 @item end-stepping-range
26796 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26797 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26798 @item exited-signalled
26799 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26800 @item exited
26801 The inferior exited.
26802 @item exited-normally
26803 The inferior exited normally.
26804 @item signal-received
26805 A signal was received by the inferior.
26806 @item solib-event
26807 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26808 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26809 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26810 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26811 @item fork
26812 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26813 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26814 @item vfork
26815 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26816 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26817 @item syscall-entry
26818 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26819 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26820 @item syscall-return
26821 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26822 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26823 @item exec
26824 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26825 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26826 @end table
26827
26828 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26829 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26830 Depending on whether all-stop
26831 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26832 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26833 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26834 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26835 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26836 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26837 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26838 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26839 if such information is not available.
26840
26841 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26842 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26843 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26844 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26845 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26846 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26847 cannot be used in any way.
26848
26849 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26850 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26851 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26852 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26853 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26854 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26855
26856 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26857 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26858 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26859 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26860 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26861 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26862
26863 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26864 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26865 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26866 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26867 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26868
26869 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26870 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26871 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26872 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26873 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26874 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26875 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26876 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26877 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26878
26879 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26880 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26881
26882 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26883 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26884 that thread.
26885
26886 @item =library-loaded,...
26887 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26888 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26889 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
26890 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26891 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26892 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26893 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26894 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26895 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26896 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26897 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26898 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26899 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26900 to this library.
26901
26902 @item =library-unloaded,...
26903 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26904 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26905 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26906 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26907 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26908 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26909 thread groups.
26910
26911 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26912 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26913 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26914 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26915 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26916
26917 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26918 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26919 initial value @var{initial}.
26920
26921 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26922 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26923 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26924 trace state variables are deleted.
26925
26926 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26927 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26928 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26929 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26930 value of trace state variable is known.
26931
26932 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26933 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26934 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26935 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26936 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26937 user.
26938
26939 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26940 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26941 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26942
26943 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26944 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26945
26946 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26947 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26948 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26949 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26950 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26951
26952 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26953 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26954 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26955 for existing method and format values.
26956
26957 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26958 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26959 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26960 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26961 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26962 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26963
26964 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26965 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26966 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26967 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26968 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26969 executable code.
26970 @end table
26971
26972 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26973 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26974
26975 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26976 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26977 following fields:
26978
26979 @table @code
26980 @item number
26981 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26982 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26983 @samp{1.2}.
26984
26985 @item type
26986 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26987 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26988
26989 @item catch-type
26990 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26991 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26992
26993 @item disp
26994 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26995 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26996 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26997
26998 @item enabled
26999 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27000 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27001 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27002
27003 @item addr
27004 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27005 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27006 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27007 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27008 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27009
27010 @item func
27011 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27012 If not known, this field is not present.
27013
27014 @item filename
27015 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27016 If not known, this field is not present.
27017
27018 @item fullname
27019 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27020 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27021
27022 @item line
27023 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27024 If not known, this field is not present.
27025
27026 @item at
27027 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27028 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27029 by a symbol name.
27030
27031 @item pending
27032 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27033 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27034
27035 @item evaluated-by
27036 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27037 @samp{target}.
27038
27039 @item thread
27040 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27041 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27042
27043 @item task
27044 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27045 field will hold the task identifier.
27046
27047 @item cond
27048 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27049
27050 @item ignore
27051 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27052
27053 @item enable
27054 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27055
27056 @item traceframe-usage
27057 FIXME.
27058
27059 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27060 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27061
27062 @item mask
27063 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27064
27065 @item pass
27066 A tracepoint's pass count.
27067
27068 @item original-location
27069 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27070 This field is optional.
27071
27072 @item times
27073 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27074
27075 @item installed
27076 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27077 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27078 is not.
27079
27080 @item what
27081 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27082
27083 @end table
27084
27085 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27086 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27087
27088 @smallexample
27089 -> -break-insert main
27090 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27091 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27092 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27093 times="0"@}
27094 <- (gdb)
27095 @end smallexample
27096
27097 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27098 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27099
27100 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27101 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27102 fields:
27103
27104 @table @code
27105 @item level
27106 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27107 zero. This field is always present.
27108
27109 @item func
27110 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27111 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27112
27113 @item addr
27114 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27115
27116 @item file
27117 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27118 address. This field may be absent.
27119
27120 @item line
27121 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27122 may be absent.
27123
27124 @item from
27125 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27126 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27127
27128 @end table
27129
27130 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27131 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27132
27133 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27134 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27135 stated otherwise.
27136
27137 @table @code
27138 @item id
27139 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27140
27141 @item target-id
27142 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27143
27144 @item details
27145 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27146 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27147 frontend. This field is optional.
27148
27149 @item name
27150 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27151 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27152 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27153 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27154 field is omitted.
27155
27156 @item state
27157 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27158 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27159
27160 @item frame
27161 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27162 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27163 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27164
27165 @item core
27166 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27167 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27168 @end table
27169
27170 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27171 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27172
27173 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27174 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27175 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27176 the @code{exception-name} field.
27177
27178 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27179 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27180 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27181 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27182
27183 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27184 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27185 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27186 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27187
27188 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27189 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27190
27191 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27192
27193 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27194 information of the breakpoint.
27195
27196 @smallexample
27197 -> -break-insert main
27198 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27199 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27200 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27201 times="0"@}
27202 <- (gdb)
27203 @end smallexample
27204
27205 @subheading Program Execution
27206
27207 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27208 reason that execution stopped.
27209
27210 @smallexample
27211 -> -exec-run
27212 <- ^running
27213 <- (gdb)
27214 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27215 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27216 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27217 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27218 <- (gdb)
27219 -> -exec-continue
27220 <- ^running
27221 <- (gdb)
27222 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27223 <- (gdb)
27224 @end smallexample
27225
27226 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27227
27228 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27229
27230 @smallexample
27231 -> (gdb)
27232 <- -gdb-exit
27233 <- ^exit
27234 @end smallexample
27235
27236 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27237 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27238 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27239 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27240 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27241 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27242
27243 @subheading A Bad Command
27244
27245 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27246
27247 @smallexample
27248 -> -rubbish
27249 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27250 <- (gdb)
27251 @end smallexample
27252
27253
27254 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27255 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27256 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27257
27258 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27259 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27260
27261 @subheading Motivation
27262
27263 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27264
27265 @subheading Introduction
27266
27267 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27268
27269 @subheading Commands
27270
27271 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27272
27273 @subsubheading Synopsis
27274
27275 @smallexample
27276 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27277 @end smallexample
27278
27279 @subsubheading Result
27280
27281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27282
27283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27284
27285 @subsubheading Example
27286
27287 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27288 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27289
27290
27291 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27292 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27293 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27294
27295 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27296 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27297 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27298 breakpoints.
27299
27300 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27301 @findex -break-after
27302
27303 @subsubheading Synopsis
27304
27305 @smallexample
27306 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27307 @end smallexample
27308
27309 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27310 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27311 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27312 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27313
27314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27315
27316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27317
27318 @subsubheading Example
27319
27320 @smallexample
27321 (gdb)
27322 -break-insert main
27323 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27324 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27325 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27326 times="0"@}
27327 (gdb)
27328 -break-after 1 3
27329 ~
27330 ^done
27331 (gdb)
27332 -break-list
27333 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27334 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27335 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27336 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27337 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27338 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27339 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27340 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27341 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27342 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27343 (gdb)
27344 @end smallexample
27345
27346 @ignore
27347 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27348 @findex -break-catch
27349 @end ignore
27350
27351 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27352 @findex -break-commands
27353
27354 @subsubheading Synopsis
27355
27356 @smallexample
27357 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27358 @end smallexample
27359
27360 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27361 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27362 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27363 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27364 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27365 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27366
27367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27368
27369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27370
27371 @subsubheading Example
27372
27373 @smallexample
27374 (gdb)
27375 -break-insert main
27376 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27377 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27378 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27379 times="0"@}
27380 (gdb)
27381 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27382 ^done
27383 (gdb)
27384 @end smallexample
27385
27386 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27387 @findex -break-condition
27388
27389 @subsubheading Synopsis
27390
27391 @smallexample
27392 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27393 @end smallexample
27394
27395 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27396 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27397 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27398 command below).
27399
27400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27401
27402 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27403
27404 @subsubheading Example
27405
27406 @smallexample
27407 (gdb)
27408 -break-condition 1 1
27409 ^done
27410 (gdb)
27411 -break-list
27412 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27413 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27414 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27415 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27416 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27417 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27418 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27419 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27420 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27421 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27422 (gdb)
27423 @end smallexample
27424
27425 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27426 @findex -break-delete
27427
27428 @subsubheading Synopsis
27429
27430 @smallexample
27431 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27432 @end smallexample
27433
27434 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27435 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27436
27437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27438
27439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27440
27441 @subsubheading Example
27442
27443 @smallexample
27444 (gdb)
27445 -break-delete 1
27446 ^done
27447 (gdb)
27448 -break-list
27449 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27450 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27451 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27452 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27453 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27454 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27455 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27456 body=[]@}
27457 (gdb)
27458 @end smallexample
27459
27460 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27461 @findex -break-disable
27462
27463 @subsubheading Synopsis
27464
27465 @smallexample
27466 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27467 @end smallexample
27468
27469 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27470 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27471
27472 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27473
27474 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27475
27476 @subsubheading Example
27477
27478 @smallexample
27479 (gdb)
27480 -break-disable 2
27481 ^done
27482 (gdb)
27483 -break-list
27484 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27485 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27486 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27487 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27488 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27489 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27490 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27491 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27492 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27493 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27494 (gdb)
27495 @end smallexample
27496
27497 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27498 @findex -break-enable
27499
27500 @subsubheading Synopsis
27501
27502 @smallexample
27503 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27504 @end smallexample
27505
27506 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27507
27508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27509
27510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27511
27512 @subsubheading Example
27513
27514 @smallexample
27515 (gdb)
27516 -break-enable 2
27517 ^done
27518 (gdb)
27519 -break-list
27520 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27521 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27522 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27523 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27524 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27525 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27526 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27527 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27528 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27529 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27530 (gdb)
27531 @end smallexample
27532
27533 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27534 @findex -break-info
27535
27536 @subsubheading Synopsis
27537
27538 @smallexample
27539 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27540 @end smallexample
27541
27542 @c REDUNDANT???
27543 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27544
27545 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27546 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27547 table.
27548
27549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27550
27551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27552
27553 @subsubheading Example
27554 N.A.
27555
27556 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27557 @findex -break-insert
27558 @anchor{-break-insert}
27559
27560 @subsubheading Synopsis
27561
27562 @smallexample
27563 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27564 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27565 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27566 @end smallexample
27567
27568 @noindent
27569 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27570
27571 @table @var
27572 @item linespec location
27573 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27574
27575 @item explicit location
27576 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27577 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27578 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27579
27580 @table @samp
27581 @item --source @var{filename}
27582 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27583 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27584
27585 @item --function @var{function}
27586 The name of a function or method.
27587
27588 @item --label @var{label}
27589 The name of a label.
27590
27591 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27592 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27593 @end table
27594
27595 @item address location
27596 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27597 @end table
27598
27599 @noindent
27600 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27601
27602 @table @samp
27603 @item -t
27604 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27605 @item -h
27606 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27607 @item -f
27608 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27609 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27610 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27611 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27612 cannot be parsed.
27613 @item -d
27614 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27615 @item -a
27616 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27617 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27618 @item -c @var{condition}
27619 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27620 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27621 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27622 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27623 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27624 @var{thread-id}.
27625 @end table
27626
27627 @subsubheading Result
27628
27629 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27630 resulting breakpoint.
27631
27632 Note: this format is open to change.
27633 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27634
27635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27636
27637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27638 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27639
27640 @subsubheading Example
27641
27642 @smallexample
27643 (gdb)
27644 -break-insert main
27645 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27646 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27647 times="0"@}
27648 (gdb)
27649 -break-insert -t foo
27650 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27651 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27652 times="0"@}
27653 (gdb)
27654 -break-list
27655 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27656 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27657 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27658 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27659 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27660 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27661 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27662 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27663 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27664 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27665 times="0"@},
27666 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27667 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27668 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27669 times="0"@}]@}
27670 (gdb)
27671 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27672 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27673 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27674 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27675 @c times="0"@}
27676 @c (gdb)
27677 @end smallexample
27678
27679 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27680 @findex -dprintf-insert
27681
27682 @subsubheading Synopsis
27683
27684 @smallexample
27685 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27686 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27687 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27688 [ @var{argument} ]
27689 @end smallexample
27690
27691 @noindent
27692 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27693 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27694
27695 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27696
27697 @table @samp
27698 @item -t
27699 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27700 @item -f
27701 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27702 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27703 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27704 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27705 cannot be parsed.
27706 @item -d
27707 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27708 @item -c @var{condition}
27709 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27710 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27711 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27712 to @var{ignore-count}.
27713 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27714 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27715 @var{thread-id}.
27716 @end table
27717
27718 @subsubheading Result
27719
27720 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27721 resulting breakpoint.
27722
27723 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27724
27725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27726
27727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27728
27729 @subsubheading Example
27730
27731 @smallexample
27732 (gdb)
27733 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27734 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27735 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27736 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27737 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27738 original-location="foo"@}
27739 (gdb)
27740 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27741 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27742 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27743 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27744 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27745 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27746 (gdb)
27747 @end smallexample
27748
27749 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27750 @findex -break-list
27751
27752 @subsubheading Synopsis
27753
27754 @smallexample
27755 -break-list
27756 @end smallexample
27757
27758 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27759
27760 @table @samp
27761 @item Number
27762 number of the breakpoint
27763 @item Type
27764 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27765 @item Disposition
27766 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27767 or @samp{nokeep}
27768 @item Enabled
27769 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27770 @item Address
27771 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27772 @item What
27773 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27774 name, line number
27775 @item Thread-groups
27776 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27777 @item Times
27778 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27779 @end table
27780
27781 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27782 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27783
27784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27785
27786 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27787
27788 @subsubheading Example
27789
27790 @smallexample
27791 (gdb)
27792 -break-list
27793 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27794 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27795 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27796 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27797 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27798 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27799 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27800 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27801 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27802 times="0"@},
27803 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27804 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27805 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27806 (gdb)
27807 @end smallexample
27808
27809 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27810
27811 @smallexample
27812 (gdb)
27813 -break-list
27814 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27815 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27816 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27817 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27818 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27819 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27820 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27821 body=[]@}
27822 (gdb)
27823 @end smallexample
27824
27825 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27826 @findex -break-passcount
27827
27828 @subsubheading Synopsis
27829
27830 @smallexample
27831 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27832 @end smallexample
27833
27834 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27835 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27836 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27837 command @samp{passcount}.
27838
27839 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27840 @findex -break-watch
27841
27842 @subsubheading Synopsis
27843
27844 @smallexample
27845 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27846 @end smallexample
27847
27848 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27849 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27850 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27851 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27852 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27853 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27854 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27855 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27856
27857 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27858 breakpoints inserted.
27859
27860 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27861
27862 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27863 @samp{rwatch}.
27864
27865 @subsubheading Example
27866
27867 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27868
27869 @smallexample
27870 (gdb)
27871 -break-watch x
27872 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27873 (gdb)
27874 -exec-continue
27875 ^running
27876 (gdb)
27877 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27878 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27879 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27880 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27881 (gdb)
27882 @end smallexample
27883
27884 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27885 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27886 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27887
27888 @smallexample
27889 (gdb)
27890 -break-watch C
27891 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27892 (gdb)
27893 -exec-continue
27894 ^running
27895 (gdb)
27896 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27897 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27898 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27899 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27900 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27901 (gdb)
27902 -exec-continue
27903 ^running
27904 (gdb)
27905 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27906 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27907 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27908 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27909 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27910 (gdb)
27911 @end smallexample
27912
27913 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27914 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27915 deleted.
27916
27917 @smallexample
27918 (gdb)
27919 -break-watch C
27920 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27921 (gdb)
27922 -break-list
27923 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27924 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27925 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27926 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27927 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27928 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27929 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27930 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27931 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27932 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27933 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27934 times="1"@},
27935 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27936 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27937 (gdb)
27938 -exec-continue
27939 ^running
27940 (gdb)
27941 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27942 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27943 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27944 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27945 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27946 (gdb)
27947 -break-list
27948 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27949 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27950 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27951 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27952 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27953 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27954 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27955 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27956 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27957 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27958 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27959 times="1"@},
27960 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27961 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27962 (gdb)
27963 -exec-continue
27964 ^running
27965 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27966 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27967 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27968 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27969 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27970 (gdb)
27971 -break-list
27972 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27973 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27974 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27975 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27976 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27977 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27978 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27979 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27980 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27981 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27982 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27983 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27984 (gdb)
27985 @end smallexample
27986
27987
27988 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27989 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27990 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27991
27992 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27993 catchpoints.
27994
27995 @menu
27996 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27997 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27998 @end menu
27999
28000 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28001 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28002
28003 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28004 @findex -catch-load
28005
28006 @subsubheading Synopsis
28007
28008 @smallexample
28009 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28010 @end smallexample
28011
28012 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28013 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28014 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28015 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28016 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28017
28018
28019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28020
28021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28022
28023 @subsubheading Example
28024
28025 @smallexample
28026 -catch-load -t foo.so
28027 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28028 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28029 (gdb)
28030 @end smallexample
28031
28032
28033 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28034 @findex -catch-unload
28035
28036 @subsubheading Synopsis
28037
28038 @smallexample
28039 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28040 @end smallexample
28041
28042 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28043 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28044 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28045 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28046 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28047
28048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28049
28050 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28051
28052 @subsubheading Example
28053
28054 @smallexample
28055 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28056 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28057 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28058 (gdb)
28059 @end smallexample
28060
28061 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28062 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28063
28064 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28065 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28066
28067 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28068 @findex -catch-assert
28069
28070 @subsubheading Synopsis
28071
28072 @smallexample
28073 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28074 @end smallexample
28075
28076 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28077
28078 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28079
28080 @table @samp
28081 @item -c @var{condition}
28082 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28083 @item -d
28084 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28085 @item -t
28086 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28087 @end table
28088
28089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28090
28091 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28092
28093 @subsubheading Example
28094
28095 @smallexample
28096 -catch-assert
28097 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28098 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28099 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28100 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28101 (gdb)
28102 @end smallexample
28103
28104 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28105 @findex -catch-exception
28106
28107 @subsubheading Synopsis
28108
28109 @smallexample
28110 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28111 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28112 @end smallexample
28113
28114 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28115 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28116 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28117 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28118 catchpoints.
28119
28120 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28121
28122 @table @samp
28123 @item -c @var{condition}
28124 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28125 @item -d
28126 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28127 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28128 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28129 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28130 @item -t
28131 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28132 @item -u
28133 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28134 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28135 @end table
28136
28137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28138
28139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28140 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28141
28142 @subsubheading Example
28143
28144 @smallexample
28145 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28146 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28147 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28148 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28149 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28150 (gdb)
28151 @end smallexample
28152
28153 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28154 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28155 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28156
28157 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28158 @findex -exec-arguments
28159
28160
28161 @subsubheading Synopsis
28162
28163 @smallexample
28164 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28165 @end smallexample
28166
28167 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28168 @samp{-exec-run}.
28169
28170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28171
28172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28173
28174 @subsubheading Example
28175
28176 @smallexample
28177 (gdb)
28178 -exec-arguments -v word
28179 ^done
28180 (gdb)
28181 @end smallexample
28182
28183
28184 @ignore
28185 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28186 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28187
28188 @subsubheading Synopsis
28189
28190 @smallexample
28191 -exec-show-arguments
28192 @end smallexample
28193
28194 Print the arguments of the program.
28195
28196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28197
28198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28199
28200 @subsubheading Example
28201 N.A.
28202 @end ignore
28203
28204
28205 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28206 @findex -environment-cd
28207
28208 @subsubheading Synopsis
28209
28210 @smallexample
28211 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28212 @end smallexample
28213
28214 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28215
28216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28217
28218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28219
28220 @subsubheading Example
28221
28222 @smallexample
28223 (gdb)
28224 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28225 ^done
28226 (gdb)
28227 @end smallexample
28228
28229
28230 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28231 @findex -environment-directory
28232
28233 @subsubheading Synopsis
28234
28235 @smallexample
28236 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28237 @end smallexample
28238
28239 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28240 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28241 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28242 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28243 occurs as normal.
28244 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28245 multiple directories in a single command
28246 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28247 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28248 If blanks are needed as
28249 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28250 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28251 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28252 character must not be used
28253 in any directory name.
28254 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28255
28256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28257
28258 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28259
28260 @subsubheading Example
28261
28262 @smallexample
28263 (gdb)
28264 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28265 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28266 (gdb)
28267 -environment-directory ""
28268 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28269 (gdb)
28270 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28271 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28272 (gdb)
28273 -environment-directory -r
28274 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28275 (gdb)
28276 @end smallexample
28277
28278
28279 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28280 @findex -environment-path
28281
28282 @subsubheading Synopsis
28283
28284 @smallexample
28285 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28286 @end smallexample
28287
28288 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28289 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28290 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28291 supplied in addition to the
28292 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28293 occurs as normal.
28294 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28295 multiple directories in a single command
28296 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28297 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28298 If blanks are needed as
28299 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28300 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28301 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28302 character must not be used
28303 in any directory name.
28304 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28305
28306
28307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28308
28309 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28310
28311 @subsubheading Example
28312
28313 @smallexample
28314 (gdb)
28315 -environment-path
28316 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28317 (gdb)
28318 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28319 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28320 (gdb)
28321 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28322 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28323 (gdb)
28324 @end smallexample
28325
28326
28327 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28328 @findex -environment-pwd
28329
28330 @subsubheading Synopsis
28331
28332 @smallexample
28333 -environment-pwd
28334 @end smallexample
28335
28336 Show the current working directory.
28337
28338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28339
28340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28341
28342 @subsubheading Example
28343
28344 @smallexample
28345 (gdb)
28346 -environment-pwd
28347 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28348 (gdb)
28349 @end smallexample
28350
28351 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28352 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28353 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28354
28355
28356 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28357 @findex -thread-info
28358
28359 @subsubheading Synopsis
28360
28361 @smallexample
28362 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28363 @end smallexample
28364
28365 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28366 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28367 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28368 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28369 current thread.
28370
28371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28372
28373 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28374 about all threads.
28375
28376 @subsubheading Result
28377
28378 The result contains the following attributes:
28379
28380 @table @samp
28381 @item threads
28382 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28383 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28384
28385 @item current-thread-id
28386 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28387 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28388 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28389 the command.
28390
28391 @end table
28392
28393 @subsubheading Example
28394
28395 @smallexample
28396 -thread-info
28397 ^done,threads=[
28398 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28399 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28400 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28401 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28402 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28403 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28404 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28405 state="running"@}],
28406 current-thread-id="1"
28407 (gdb)
28408 @end smallexample
28409
28410 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28411 @findex -thread-list-ids
28412
28413 @subsubheading Synopsis
28414
28415 @smallexample
28416 -thread-list-ids
28417 @end smallexample
28418
28419 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28420 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28421 threads.
28422
28423 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28424 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28425
28426 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28427
28428 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28429
28430 @subsubheading Example
28431
28432 @smallexample
28433 (gdb)
28434 -thread-list-ids
28435 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28436 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28437 (gdb)
28438 @end smallexample
28439
28440
28441 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28442 @findex -thread-select
28443
28444 @subsubheading Synopsis
28445
28446 @smallexample
28447 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28448 @end smallexample
28449
28450 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28451 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28452 topmost frame for that thread.
28453
28454 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28455 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28456
28457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28458
28459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28460
28461 @subsubheading Example
28462
28463 @smallexample
28464 (gdb)
28465 -exec-next
28466 ^running
28467 (gdb)
28468 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28469 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28470 (gdb)
28471 -thread-list-ids
28472 ^done,
28473 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28474 number-of-threads="3"
28475 (gdb)
28476 -thread-select 3
28477 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28478 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28479 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28480 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28481 (gdb)
28482 @end smallexample
28483
28484 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28485 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28486 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28487
28488 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28489 @findex -ada-task-info
28490
28491 @subsubheading Synopsis
28492
28493 @smallexample
28494 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28495 @end smallexample
28496
28497 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28498 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28499
28500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28501
28502 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28503 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28504
28505 @subsubheading Result
28506
28507 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28508 defined for each Ada task:
28509
28510 @table @samp
28511 @item current
28512 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28513
28514 @item id
28515 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28516
28517 @item task-id
28518 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28519
28520 @item thread-id
28521 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28522 task.
28523
28524 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28525 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28526 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28527
28528 @item parent-id
28529 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28530 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28531
28532 @item priority
28533 The base priority of the task.
28534
28535 @item state
28536 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28537 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28538
28539 @item name
28540 The name of the task.
28541
28542 @end table
28543
28544 @subsubheading Example
28545
28546 @smallexample
28547 -ada-task-info
28548 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28549 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28550 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28551 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28552 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28553 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28554 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28555 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28556 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28557 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28558 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28559 (gdb)
28560 @end smallexample
28561
28562 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28563 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28564 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28565
28566 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28567 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28568 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28569 other cases.
28570
28571 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28572 @findex -exec-continue
28573
28574 @subsubheading Synopsis
28575
28576 @smallexample
28577 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28578 @end smallexample
28579
28580 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28581 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28582 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28583 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28584 @itemize @bullet
28585 @item
28586 breakpoints or watchpoints
28587 @item
28588 signals or exceptions
28589 @item
28590 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28591 @item
28592 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28593 @end itemize
28594 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28595 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28596 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28597 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28598 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28599 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28600
28601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28602
28603 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28604
28605 @subsubheading Example
28606
28607 @smallexample
28608 -exec-continue
28609 ^running
28610 (gdb)
28611 @@Hello world
28612 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28613 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28614 line="13"@}
28615 (gdb)
28616 @end smallexample
28617
28618
28619 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28620 @findex -exec-finish
28621
28622 @subsubheading Synopsis
28623
28624 @smallexample
28625 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28626 @end smallexample
28627
28628 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28629 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28630 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28631 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28632 function was called.
28633
28634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28635
28636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28637
28638 @subsubheading Example
28639
28640 Function returning @code{void}.
28641
28642 @smallexample
28643 -exec-finish
28644 ^running
28645 (gdb)
28646 @@hello from foo
28647 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28648 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28649 (gdb)
28650 @end smallexample
28651
28652 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28653 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28654 value itself.
28655
28656 @smallexample
28657 -exec-finish
28658 ^running
28659 (gdb)
28660 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28661 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28662 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28663 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28664 (gdb)
28665 @end smallexample
28666
28667
28668 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28669 @findex -exec-interrupt
28670
28671 @subsubheading Synopsis
28672
28673 @smallexample
28674 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28675 @end smallexample
28676
28677 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28678 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28679 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28680 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28681 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28682
28683 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28684 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28685 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28686 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28687
28688 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28689 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28690 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28691 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28692
28693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28694
28695 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28696
28697 @subsubheading Example
28698
28699 @smallexample
28700 (gdb)
28701 111-exec-continue
28702 111^running
28703
28704 (gdb)
28705 222-exec-interrupt
28706 222^done
28707 (gdb)
28708 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28709 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28710 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28711 (gdb)
28712
28713 (gdb)
28714 -exec-interrupt
28715 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28716 (gdb)
28717 @end smallexample
28718
28719 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28720 @findex -exec-jump
28721
28722 @subsubheading Synopsis
28723
28724 @smallexample
28725 -exec-jump @var{location}
28726 @end smallexample
28727
28728 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28729 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28730 different forms of @var{location}.
28731
28732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28733
28734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28735
28736 @subsubheading Example
28737
28738 @smallexample
28739 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28740 *running,thread-id="all"
28741 ^running
28742 @end smallexample
28743
28744
28745 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28746 @findex -exec-next
28747
28748 @subsubheading Synopsis
28749
28750 @smallexample
28751 -exec-next [--reverse]
28752 @end smallexample
28753
28754 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28755 of the next source line is reached.
28756
28757 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28758 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28759 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28760 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28761 source line where the function was called.
28762
28763
28764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28765
28766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28767
28768 @subsubheading Example
28769
28770 @smallexample
28771 -exec-next
28772 ^running
28773 (gdb)
28774 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28775 (gdb)
28776 @end smallexample
28777
28778
28779 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28780 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28781
28782 @subsubheading Synopsis
28783
28784 @smallexample
28785 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28786 @end smallexample
28787
28788 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28789 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28790 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28791 printed as well.
28792
28793 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28794 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28795 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28796 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28797 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28798
28799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28800
28801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28802
28803 @subsubheading Example
28804
28805 @smallexample
28806 (gdb)
28807 -exec-next-instruction
28808 ^running
28809
28810 (gdb)
28811 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28812 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28813 (gdb)
28814 @end smallexample
28815
28816
28817 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28818 @findex -exec-return
28819
28820 @subsubheading Synopsis
28821
28822 @smallexample
28823 -exec-return
28824 @end smallexample
28825
28826 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28827 Displays the new current frame.
28828
28829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28830
28831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28832
28833 @subsubheading Example
28834
28835 @smallexample
28836 (gdb)
28837 200-break-insert callee4
28838 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28839 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28840 (gdb)
28841 000-exec-run
28842 000^running
28843 (gdb)
28844 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28845 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28846 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28847 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28848 (gdb)
28849 205-break-delete
28850 205^done
28851 (gdb)
28852 111-exec-return
28853 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28854 args=[@{name="strarg",
28855 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28856 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28857 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28858 (gdb)
28859 @end smallexample
28860
28861
28862 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28863 @findex -exec-run
28864
28865 @subsubheading Synopsis
28866
28867 @smallexample
28868 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28869 @end smallexample
28870
28871 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28872 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28873 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28874 the program has exited exceptionally.
28875
28876 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28877 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28878 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28879 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28880 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28881
28882 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28883 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28884 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28885 (@pxref{Starting}).
28886
28887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28888
28889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28890
28891 @subsubheading Examples
28892
28893 @smallexample
28894 (gdb)
28895 -break-insert main
28896 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28897 (gdb)
28898 -exec-run
28899 ^running
28900 (gdb)
28901 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28902 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28903 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28904 (gdb)
28905 @end smallexample
28906
28907 @noindent
28908 Program exited normally:
28909
28910 @smallexample
28911 (gdb)
28912 -exec-run
28913 ^running
28914 (gdb)
28915 x = 55
28916 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28917 (gdb)
28918 @end smallexample
28919
28920 @noindent
28921 Program exited exceptionally:
28922
28923 @smallexample
28924 (gdb)
28925 -exec-run
28926 ^running
28927 (gdb)
28928 x = 55
28929 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28930 (gdb)
28931 @end smallexample
28932
28933 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28934 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28935
28936 @smallexample
28937 (gdb)
28938 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28939 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28940 @end smallexample
28941
28942
28943 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28944
28945
28946 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28947 @findex -exec-step
28948
28949 @subsubheading Synopsis
28950
28951 @smallexample
28952 -exec-step [--reverse]
28953 @end smallexample
28954
28955 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28956 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28957 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28958 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28959 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28960 previously executed source line.
28961
28962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28963
28964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28965
28966 @subsubheading Example
28967
28968 Stepping into a function:
28969
28970 @smallexample
28971 -exec-step
28972 ^running
28973 (gdb)
28974 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28975 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28976 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28978 (gdb)
28979 @end smallexample
28980
28981 Regular stepping:
28982
28983 @smallexample
28984 -exec-step
28985 ^running
28986 (gdb)
28987 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28988 (gdb)
28989 @end smallexample
28990
28991
28992 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28993 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28994
28995 @subsubheading Synopsis
28996
28997 @smallexample
28998 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28999 @end smallexample
29000
29001 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29002 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29003 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29004 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29005 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29006 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29007 as well.
29008
29009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29010
29011 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29012
29013 @subsubheading Example
29014
29015 @smallexample
29016 (gdb)
29017 -exec-step-instruction
29018 ^running
29019
29020 (gdb)
29021 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29022 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29023 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29024 (gdb)
29025 -exec-step-instruction
29026 ^running
29027
29028 (gdb)
29029 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29030 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29031 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29032 (gdb)
29033 @end smallexample
29034
29035
29036 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29037 @findex -exec-until
29038
29039 @subsubheading Synopsis
29040
29041 @smallexample
29042 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29043 @end smallexample
29044
29045 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29046 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29047 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29048 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29049
29050 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29051
29052 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29053
29054 @subsubheading Example
29055
29056 @smallexample
29057 (gdb)
29058 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29059 ^running
29060 (gdb)
29061 x = 55
29062 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29063 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29064 (gdb)
29065 @end smallexample
29066
29067 @ignore
29068 @subheading -file-clear
29069 Is this going away????
29070 @end ignore
29071
29072 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29073 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29074 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29075
29076 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29077 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29078
29079 @smallexample
29080 -enable-frame-filters
29081 @end smallexample
29082
29083 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29084 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29085 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29086 request that this functionality be enabled.
29087
29088 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29089
29090 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29091 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29092
29093 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29094 @findex -stack-info-frame
29095
29096 @subsubheading Synopsis
29097
29098 @smallexample
29099 -stack-info-frame
29100 @end smallexample
29101
29102 Get info on the selected frame.
29103
29104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29105
29106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29107 (without arguments).
29108
29109 @subsubheading Example
29110
29111 @smallexample
29112 (gdb)
29113 -stack-info-frame
29114 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29115 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29116 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29117 (gdb)
29118 @end smallexample
29119
29120 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29121 @findex -stack-info-depth
29122
29123 @subsubheading Synopsis
29124
29125 @smallexample
29126 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29127 @end smallexample
29128
29129 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29130 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29131
29132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29133
29134 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29135
29136 @subsubheading Example
29137
29138 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29139
29140 @smallexample
29141 (gdb)
29142 -stack-info-depth
29143 ^done,depth="12"
29144 (gdb)
29145 -stack-info-depth 4
29146 ^done,depth="4"
29147 (gdb)
29148 -stack-info-depth 12
29149 ^done,depth="12"
29150 (gdb)
29151 -stack-info-depth 11
29152 ^done,depth="11"
29153 (gdb)
29154 -stack-info-depth 13
29155 ^done,depth="12"
29156 (gdb)
29157 @end smallexample
29158
29159 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29160 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29161 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29162
29163 @subsubheading Synopsis
29164
29165 @smallexample
29166 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29167 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29168 @end smallexample
29169
29170 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29171 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29172 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29173 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29174 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29175 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29176 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29177 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29178
29179 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29180 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29181 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29182 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29183 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29184 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29185
29186 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29187 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29188 are still displayed, however.
29189
29190 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29191 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29192
29193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29194
29195 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29196 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29197 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29198
29199 @subsubheading Example
29200
29201 @smallexample
29202 (gdb)
29203 -stack-list-frames
29204 ^done,
29205 stack=[
29206 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29207 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29208 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29209 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29210 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29211 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29212 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29213 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29214 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29215 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29216 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29217 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29218 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29219 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29220 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29221 (gdb)
29222 -stack-list-arguments 0
29223 ^done,
29224 stack-args=[
29225 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29226 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29227 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29228 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29229 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29230 (gdb)
29231 -stack-list-arguments 1
29232 ^done,
29233 stack-args=[
29234 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29235 frame=@{level="1",
29236 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29237 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29238 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29239 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29240 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29241 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29242 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29243 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29244 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29245 (gdb)
29246 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29247 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29248 (gdb)
29249 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29250 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29251 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29252 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29253 (gdb)
29254 @end smallexample
29255
29256 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29257
29258
29259 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29260 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29261 @findex -stack-list-frames
29262
29263 @subsubheading Synopsis
29264
29265 @smallexample
29266 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29267 @end smallexample
29268
29269 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29270 following info:
29271
29272 @table @samp
29273 @item @var{level}
29274 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29275 @item @var{addr}
29276 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29277 @item @var{func}
29278 Function name.
29279 @item @var{file}
29280 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29281 @item @var{fullname}
29282 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29283 @item @var{line}
29284 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29285 @item @var{from}
29286 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29287 if the frame's function is not known.
29288 @end table
29289
29290 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29291 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29292 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29293 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29294 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29295 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29296 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29297 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29298 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29299
29300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29301
29302 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29303
29304 @subsubheading Example
29305
29306 Full stack backtrace:
29307
29308 @smallexample
29309 (gdb)
29310 -stack-list-frames
29311 ^done,stack=
29312 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29313 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29314 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29315 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29316 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29317 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29318 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29319 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29320 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29321 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29322 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29323 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29324 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29325 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29326 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29327 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29328 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29329 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29330 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29331 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29332 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29333 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29334 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29335 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29336 (gdb)
29337 @end smallexample
29338
29339 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29340
29341 @smallexample
29342 (gdb)
29343 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29344 ^done,stack=
29345 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29346 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29347 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29348 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29349 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29350 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29351 (gdb)
29352 @end smallexample
29353
29354 Show a single frame:
29355
29356 @smallexample
29357 (gdb)
29358 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29359 ^done,stack=
29360 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29361 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29362 (gdb)
29363 @end smallexample
29364
29365
29366 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29367 @findex -stack-list-locals
29368 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29369
29370 @subsubheading Synopsis
29371
29372 @smallexample
29373 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29374 @end smallexample
29375
29376 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29377 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29378 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29379 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29380 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29381 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29382 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29383 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29384 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29385 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29386
29387 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29388 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29389 variables are still displayed, however.
29390
29391 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29392 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29393
29394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29395
29396 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29397
29398 @subsubheading Example
29399
29400 @smallexample
29401 (gdb)
29402 -stack-list-locals 0
29403 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29404 (gdb)
29405 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29406 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29407 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29408 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29409 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29410 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29411 (gdb)
29412 @end smallexample
29413
29414 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29415 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29416 @findex -stack-list-variables
29417
29418 @subsubheading Synopsis
29419
29420 @smallexample
29421 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29422 @end smallexample
29423
29424 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29425 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29426 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29427 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29428 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29429 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29430 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29431
29432 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29433 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29434 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29435
29436 @subsubheading Example
29437
29438 @smallexample
29439 (gdb)
29440 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29441 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29442 (gdb)
29443 @end smallexample
29444
29445
29446 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29447 @findex -stack-select-frame
29448
29449 @subsubheading Synopsis
29450
29451 @smallexample
29452 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29456 the stack.
29457
29458 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29459 option to every command.
29460
29461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29462
29463 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29464 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29465
29466 @subsubheading Example
29467
29468 @smallexample
29469 (gdb)
29470 -stack-select-frame 2
29471 ^done
29472 (gdb)
29473 @end smallexample
29474
29475 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29476 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29477 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29478
29479 @ignore
29480
29481 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29482
29483 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29484 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29485 used by @code{Insight}.
29486
29487 The two main reasons for that are:
29488
29489 @enumerate 1
29490 @item
29491 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29492
29493 @item
29494 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29495 now).
29496 @end enumerate
29497
29498 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29499 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29500 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29501 hints about their use.
29502
29503 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29504 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29505 least, the following operations:
29506
29507 @itemize @bullet
29508 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29509 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29510 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29511 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29512 @end itemize
29513
29514 @end ignore
29515
29516 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29517
29518 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29519
29520 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29521 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29522 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29523 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29524 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29525 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29526 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29527 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29528 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29529 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29530 object, or to change display format.
29531
29532 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29533 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29534 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29535 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29536 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29537 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29538 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29539 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29540 child will be created.
29541
29542 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29543 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29544 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29545 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29546 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29547
29548 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29549 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29550 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29551 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29552 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29553 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29554 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29555 variables that frontend has created.
29556
29557 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29558 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29559 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29560 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29561 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29562 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29563 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29564 implicitly updated.
29565
29566 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29567 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29568 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29569 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29570 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29571 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29572 frame. Consider this example:
29573
29574 @smallexample
29575 void do_work(...)
29576 @{
29577 struct work_state state;
29578
29579 if (...)
29580 do_work(...);
29581 @}
29582 @end smallexample
29583
29584 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29585 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29586 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29587 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29588 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29589
29590 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29591 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29592 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29593 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29594 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29595 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29596
29597 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29598 access this functionality:
29599
29600 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29601 @item @strong{Operation}
29602 @tab @strong{Description}
29603
29604 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29605 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29606 @item @code{-var-create}
29607 @tab create a variable object
29608 @item @code{-var-delete}
29609 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29610 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29611 @tab set the display format of this variable
29612 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29613 @tab show the display format of this variable
29614 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29615 @tab tells how many children this object has
29616 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29617 @tab return a list of the object's children
29618 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29619 @tab show the type of this variable object
29620 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29621 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29622 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29623 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29624 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29625 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29626 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29627 @tab get the value of this variable
29628 @item @code{-var-assign}
29629 @tab set the value of this variable
29630 @item @code{-var-update}
29631 @tab update the variable and its children
29632 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29633 @tab set frozeness attribute
29634 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29635 @tab set range of children to display on update
29636 @end multitable
29637
29638 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29639 how it can be used.
29640
29641 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29642
29643 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29644 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29645
29646 @smallexample
29647 -enable-pretty-printing
29648 @end smallexample
29649
29650 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29651 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29652 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29653 request that this functionality be enabled.
29654
29655 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29656
29657 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29658 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29659
29660 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29661 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29662
29663 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29664 @findex -var-create
29665
29666 @subsubheading Synopsis
29667
29668 @smallexample
29669 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29670 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29671 @end smallexample
29672
29673 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29674 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29675 register.
29676
29677 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29678 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29679 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29680 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29681 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29682
29683 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29684 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29685 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29686 object must be created.
29687
29688 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29689 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29690
29691 @itemize @bullet
29692 @item
29693 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29694
29695 @item
29696 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29697
29698 @item
29699 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29700 @end itemize
29701
29702 @cindex dynamic varobj
29703 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29704 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29705 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29706 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29707 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29708 compatibility for existing clients.
29709
29710 @subsubheading Result
29711
29712 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29713 are:
29714
29715 @table @samp
29716 @item name
29717 The name of the varobj.
29718
29719 @item numchild
29720 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29721 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29722 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29723
29724 @item value
29725 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29726 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29727 will not be interesting.
29728
29729 @item type
29730 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29731 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29732 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29733 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29734 @emph{declared} one.
29735
29736 @item thread-id
29737 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29738 thread's global identifier.
29739
29740 @item has_more
29741 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29742 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29743
29744 @item dynamic
29745 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29746 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29747 then this attribute will not be present.
29748
29749 @item displayhint
29750 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29751 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29752 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29753 @end table
29754
29755 Typical output will look like this:
29756
29757 @smallexample
29758 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29759 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29760 @end smallexample
29761
29762
29763 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29764 @findex -var-delete
29765
29766 @subsubheading Synopsis
29767
29768 @smallexample
29769 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29770 @end smallexample
29771
29772 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29773 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29774
29775 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29776
29777
29778 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29779 @findex -var-set-format
29780
29781 @subsubheading Synopsis
29782
29783 @smallexample
29784 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29785 @end smallexample
29786
29787 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29788 @var{format-spec}.
29789
29790 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29791 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29792
29793 @smallexample
29794 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29795 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29796 @end smallexample
29797
29798 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29799 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29800 for pointers, etc.).
29801
29802 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29803 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29804 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29805 zero-hexadecimal format.
29806
29807 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29808 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29809
29810 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29811 @findex -var-show-format
29812
29813 @subsubheading Synopsis
29814
29815 @smallexample
29816 -var-show-format @var{name}
29817 @end smallexample
29818
29819 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29820
29821 @smallexample
29822 @var{format} @expansion{}
29823 @var{format-spec}
29824 @end smallexample
29825
29826
29827 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29828 @findex -var-info-num-children
29829
29830 @subsubheading Synopsis
29831
29832 @smallexample
29833 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29834 @end smallexample
29835
29836 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29837
29838 @smallexample
29839 numchild=@var{n}
29840 @end smallexample
29841
29842 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29843 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29844 be available.
29845
29846
29847 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29848 @findex -var-list-children
29849
29850 @subsubheading Synopsis
29851
29852 @smallexample
29853 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29854 @end smallexample
29855 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29856
29857 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29858 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29859 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29860 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29861 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29862 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29863 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29864 and unions.
29865
29866 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29867 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29868 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29869 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29870 reported.
29871
29872 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29873 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29874 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29875 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29876 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29877 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29878 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29879 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29880 the visible items.
29881
29882 For each child the following results are returned:
29883
29884 @table @var
29885
29886 @item name
29887 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29888
29889 @item exp
29890 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29891 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29892
29893 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29894 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29895
29896 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29897 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29898 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29899 type and value are not present.
29900
29901 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29902 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29903 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29904
29905 @item numchild
29906 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29907 0.
29908
29909 @item type
29910 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29911 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29912 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29913 @emph{declared} one.
29914
29915 @item value
29916 If values were requested, this is the value.
29917
29918 @item thread-id
29919 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29920 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29921
29922 @item frozen
29923 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29924
29925 @item displayhint
29926 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29927 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29928 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29929
29930 @item dynamic
29931 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29932 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29933 then this attribute will not be present.
29934
29935 @end table
29936
29937 The result may have its own attributes:
29938
29939 @table @samp
29940 @item displayhint
29941 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29942 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29943 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29944
29945 @item has_more
29946 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29947 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29948 @end table
29949
29950 @subsubheading Example
29951
29952 @smallexample
29953 (gdb)
29954 -var-list-children n
29955 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29956 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29957 (gdb)
29958 -var-list-children --all-values n
29959 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29960 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29961 @end smallexample
29962
29963
29964 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29965 @findex -var-info-type
29966
29967 @subsubheading Synopsis
29968
29969 @smallexample
29970 -var-info-type @var{name}
29971 @end smallexample
29972
29973 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29974 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29975 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29976
29977 @smallexample
29978 type=@var{typename}
29979 @end smallexample
29980
29981
29982 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29983 @findex -var-info-expression
29984
29985 @subsubheading Synopsis
29986
29987 @smallexample
29988 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29989 @end smallexample
29990
29991 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29992 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29993 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29994
29995 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29996 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29997
29998 @smallexample
29999 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30000 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30001 @end smallexample
30002
30003 @noindent
30004 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30005 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30006
30007 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30008 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30009 is of limited use.
30010
30011 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30012 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30013
30014 @subsubheading Synopsis
30015
30016 @smallexample
30017 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30018 @end smallexample
30019
30020 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30021 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30022 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30023 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30024 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30025 watchpoint from a variable object.
30026
30027 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30028 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30029
30030 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30031 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30032 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30033 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30034 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30035 @smallexample
30036 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30037 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30038 @end smallexample
30039
30040 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30041 @findex -var-show-attributes
30042
30043 @subsubheading Synopsis
30044
30045 @smallexample
30046 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30047 @end smallexample
30048
30049 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30050
30051 @smallexample
30052 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30053 @end smallexample
30054
30055 @noindent
30056 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30057
30058 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30059 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30060
30061 @subsubheading Synopsis
30062
30063 @smallexample
30064 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30065 @end smallexample
30066
30067 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30068 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30069 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30070 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30071 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30072 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30073 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30074
30075 @smallexample
30076 value=@var{value}
30077 @end smallexample
30078
30079 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30080 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30081
30082 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30083 @findex -var-assign
30084
30085 @subsubheading Synopsis
30086
30087 @smallexample
30088 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30089 @end smallexample
30090
30091 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30092 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30093 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30094 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30095
30096 @subsubheading Example
30097
30098 @smallexample
30099 (gdb)
30100 -var-assign var1 3
30101 ^done,value="3"
30102 (gdb)
30103 -var-update *
30104 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30105 (gdb)
30106 @end smallexample
30107
30108 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30109 @findex -var-update
30110
30111 @subsubheading Synopsis
30112
30113 @smallexample
30114 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30115 @end smallexample
30116
30117 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30118 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30119 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30120 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30121 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30122 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30123 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30124 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30125 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30126 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30127 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30128 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30129 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30130
30131 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30132 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30133 diagnostic.
30134
30135 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30136 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30137
30138 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30139 @samp{changelist}.
30140
30141 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30142
30143 @table @samp
30144 @item name
30145 The name of the varobj.
30146
30147 @item value
30148 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30149 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30150
30151 @item in_scope
30152 @anchor{-var-update}
30153 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30154
30155 @table @code
30156 @item "true"
30157 The variable object's current value is valid.
30158
30159 @item "false"
30160 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30161 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30162 scope.
30163
30164 @item "invalid"
30165 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30166 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30167 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30168 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30169 objects.
30170 @end table
30171
30172 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30173 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30174
30175 @item type_changed
30176 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30177 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30178 be @samp{false}.
30179
30180 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30181 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30182 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30183 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30184 unset.
30185
30186 @item new_type
30187 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30188 hold the new type.
30189
30190 @item new_num_children
30191 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30192 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30193
30194 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30195 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30196 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30197 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30198 children which may be available.
30199
30200 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30201 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30202 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30203 only happen at the end of the update range).
30204
30205 @item displayhint
30206 The display hint, if any.
30207
30208 @item has_more
30209 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30210 available outside the varobj's update range.
30211
30212 @item dynamic
30213 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30214 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30215 then this attribute will not be present.
30216
30217 @item new_children
30218 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30219 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30220 be listed in this attribute.
30221 @end table
30222
30223 @subsubheading Example
30224
30225 @smallexample
30226 (gdb)
30227 -var-assign var1 3
30228 ^done,value="3"
30229 (gdb)
30230 -var-update --all-values var1
30231 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30232 type_changed="false"@}]
30233 (gdb)
30234 @end smallexample
30235
30236 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30237 @findex -var-set-frozen
30238 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30239
30240 @subsubheading Synopsis
30241
30242 @smallexample
30243 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30244 @end smallexample
30245
30246 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30247 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30248 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30249 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30250 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30251 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30252 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30253 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30254 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30255 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30256 @code{-var-update} does.
30257
30258 @subsubheading Example
30259
30260 @smallexample
30261 (gdb)
30262 -var-set-frozen V 1
30263 ^done
30264 (gdb)
30265 @end smallexample
30266
30267 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30268 @findex -var-set-update-range
30269 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30270
30271 @subsubheading Synopsis
30272
30273 @smallexample
30274 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30275 @end smallexample
30276
30277 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30278 @code{-var-update}.
30279
30280 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30281 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30282 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30283 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30284
30285 @subsubheading Example
30286
30287 @smallexample
30288 (gdb)
30289 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30290 ^done
30291 @end smallexample
30292
30293 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30294 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30295 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30296
30297 @subsubheading Synopsis
30298
30299 @smallexample
30300 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30301 @end smallexample
30302
30303 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30304
30305 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30306 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30307
30308 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30309 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30310 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30311 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30312 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30313 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30314 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30315
30316 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30317 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30318 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30319 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30320
30321 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30322 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30323 can be used to check this.
30324
30325 @subsubheading Example
30326
30327 Resetting the visualizer:
30328
30329 @smallexample
30330 (gdb)
30331 -var-set-visualizer V None
30332 ^done
30333 @end smallexample
30334
30335 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30336
30337 @smallexample
30338 (gdb)
30339 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30340 ^done
30341 @end smallexample
30342
30343 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30344 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30345
30346 @smallexample
30347 (gdb)
30348 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30349 ^done
30350 @end smallexample
30351
30352 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30353 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30354 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30355
30356 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30357 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30358 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30359 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30360
30361 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30362 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30363
30364 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30365 @c @subheading -data-assign
30366 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30367 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30368 @c set variable
30369 @c @subsubheading Example
30370 @c N.A.
30371
30372 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30373 @findex -data-disassemble
30374
30375 @subsubheading Synopsis
30376
30377 @smallexample
30378 -data-disassemble
30379 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30380 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30381 -- @var{mode}
30382 @end smallexample
30383
30384 @noindent
30385 Where:
30386
30387 @table @samp
30388 @item @var{start-addr}
30389 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30390 @item @var{end-addr}
30391 is the end address
30392 @item @var{filename}
30393 is the name of the file to disassemble
30394 @item @var{linenum}
30395 is the line number to disassemble around
30396 @item @var{lines}
30397 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30398 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30399 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30400 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30401 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30402 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30403 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30404 are displayed.
30405 @item @var{mode}
30406 is one of:
30407 @itemize @bullet
30408 @item 0 disassembly only
30409 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30410 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30411 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30412 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30413 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30414 @end itemize
30415
30416 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30417 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30418 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30419 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30420 @end table
30421
30422 @subsubheading Result
30423
30424 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30425 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30426 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30427
30428 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30429 following fields:
30430
30431 @table @code
30432 @item address
30433 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30434
30435 @item func-name
30436 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30437
30438 @item offset
30439 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30440
30441 @item inst
30442 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30443
30444 @item opcodes
30445 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30446 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30447
30448 @end table
30449
30450 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30451 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30452
30453 @table @code
30454 @item line
30455 The line number within @samp{file}.
30456
30457 @item file
30458 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30459 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30460 used.
30461
30462 @item fullname
30463 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30464 using the source file search path
30465 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30466 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30467
30468 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30469 present in the debug information.
30470
30471 @item line_asm_insn
30472 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30473 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30474 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30475 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30476 @samp{opcodes}.
30477
30478 @end table
30479
30480 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30481 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30482 adjust its format.
30483
30484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30485
30486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30487
30488 @subsubheading Example
30489
30490 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30491
30492 @smallexample
30493 (gdb)
30494 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30495 ^done,
30496 asm_insns=[
30497 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30498 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30499 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30500 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30501 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30502 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30503 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30504 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30505 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30506 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30507 (gdb)
30508 @end smallexample
30509
30510 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30511 @code{main}.
30512
30513 @smallexample
30514 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30515 ^done,asm_insns=[
30516 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30517 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30518 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30519 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30520 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30521 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30522 [@dots{}]
30523 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30524 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30525 (gdb)
30526 @end smallexample
30527
30528 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30529
30530 @smallexample
30531 (gdb)
30532 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30533 ^done,asm_insns=[
30534 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30535 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30536 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30537 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30538 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30539 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30540 (gdb)
30541 @end smallexample
30542
30543 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30544
30545 @smallexample
30546 (gdb)
30547 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30548 ^done,asm_insns=[
30549 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30550 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30551 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30552 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30553 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30554 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30555 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30556 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30557 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30558 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30559 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30560 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30561 (gdb)
30562 @end smallexample
30563
30564
30565 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30566 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30567
30568 @subsubheading Synopsis
30569
30570 @smallexample
30571 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30572 @end smallexample
30573
30574 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30575 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30576 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30577
30578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30579
30580 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30581 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30582 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30583
30584 @subsubheading Example
30585
30586 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30587 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30588 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30589 output.
30590
30591 @smallexample
30592 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30593 211^done,value="1"
30594 (gdb)
30595 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30596 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30597 (gdb)
30598 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30599 411^done,value="4"
30600 (gdb)
30601 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30602 511^done,value="4"
30603 (gdb)
30604 @end smallexample
30605
30606
30607 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30608 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30609
30610 @subsubheading Synopsis
30611
30612 @smallexample
30613 -data-list-changed-registers
30614 @end smallexample
30615
30616 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30617
30618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30619
30620 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30621 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30622
30623 @subsubheading Example
30624
30625 On a PPC MBX board:
30626
30627 @smallexample
30628 (gdb)
30629 -exec-continue
30630 ^running
30631
30632 (gdb)
30633 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30634 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30635 line="5"@}
30636 (gdb)
30637 -data-list-changed-registers
30638 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30639 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30640 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30641 (gdb)
30642 @end smallexample
30643
30644
30645 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30646 @findex -data-list-register-names
30647
30648 @subsubheading Synopsis
30649
30650 @smallexample
30651 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30652 @end smallexample
30653
30654 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30655 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30656 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30657 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30658 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30659 include empty register names.
30660
30661 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30662
30663 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30664 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30665 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30666
30667 @subsubheading Example
30668
30669 For the PPC MBX board:
30670 @smallexample
30671 (gdb)
30672 -data-list-register-names
30673 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30674 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30675 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30676 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30677 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30678 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30679 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30680 (gdb)
30681 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30682 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30683 (gdb)
30684 @end smallexample
30685
30686 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30687 @findex -data-list-register-values
30688
30689 @subsubheading Synopsis
30690
30691 @smallexample
30692 -data-list-register-values
30693 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30694 @end smallexample
30695
30696 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30697 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30698 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30699 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30700 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30701 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30702
30703 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30704
30705 @table @code
30706 @item x
30707 Hexadecimal
30708 @item o
30709 Octal
30710 @item t
30711 Binary
30712 @item d
30713 Decimal
30714 @item r
30715 Raw
30716 @item N
30717 Natural
30718 @end table
30719
30720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30721
30722 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30723 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30724
30725 @subsubheading Example
30726
30727 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30728 don't appear in the actual output):
30729
30730 @smallexample
30731 (gdb)
30732 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30733 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30734 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30735 (gdb)
30736 -data-list-register-values x
30737 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30738 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30739 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30740 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30741 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30742 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30743 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30744 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30745 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30746 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30747 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30748 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30749 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30750 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30751 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30752 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30753 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30754 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30755 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30756 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30757 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30758 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30759 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30760 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30761 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30762 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30763 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30764 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30765 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30766 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30767 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30768 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30769 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30770 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30771 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30772 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30773 (gdb)
30774 @end smallexample
30775
30776
30777 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30778 @findex -data-read-memory
30779
30780 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30781
30782 @subsubheading Synopsis
30783
30784 @smallexample
30785 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30786 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30787 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30788 @end smallexample
30789
30790 @noindent
30791 where:
30792
30793 @table @samp
30794 @item @var{address}
30795 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30796 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30797 quoted using the C convention.
30798
30799 @item @var{word-format}
30800 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30801 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30802 ,Output Formats}).
30803
30804 @item @var{word-size}
30805 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30806
30807 @item @var{nr-rows}
30808 The number of rows in the output table.
30809
30810 @item @var{nr-cols}
30811 The number of columns in the output table.
30812
30813 @item @var{aschar}
30814 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30815 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30816 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30817 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30818
30819 @item @var{byte-offset}
30820 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30821 @end table
30822
30823 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30824 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30825 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30826 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30827 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30828 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30829 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30830 @samp{addr}.
30831
30832 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30833 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30834 @samp{prev-page}.
30835
30836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30837
30838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30839 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30840
30841 @subsubheading Example
30842
30843 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30844 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30845 word. Display each word in hex.
30846
30847 @smallexample
30848 (gdb)
30849 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30850 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30851 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30852 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30853 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30854 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30855 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30856 (gdb)
30857 @end smallexample
30858
30859 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30860 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30861
30862 @smallexample
30863 (gdb)
30864 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30865 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30866 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30867 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30868 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30869 (gdb)
30870 @end smallexample
30871
30872 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30873 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30874 used as the non-printable character.
30875
30876 @smallexample
30877 (gdb)
30878 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30879 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30880 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30881 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30882 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30883 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30884 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30885 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30886 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30887 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30888 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30889 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30890 (gdb)
30891 @end smallexample
30892
30893 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30894 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30895
30896 @subsubheading Synopsis
30897
30898 @smallexample
30899 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30900 @var{address} @var{count}
30901 @end smallexample
30902
30903 @noindent
30904 where:
30905
30906 @table @samp
30907 @item @var{address}
30908 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30909 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30910 quoted using the C convention.
30911
30912 @item @var{count}
30913 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30914 literal.
30915
30916 @item @var{offset}
30917 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30918 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30919 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30920 arithmetics itself.
30921
30922 @end table
30923
30924 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30925 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30926 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30927 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30928 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30929 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30930
30931 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30932 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30933 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30934 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30935 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30936 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30937 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30938 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30939
30940 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30941 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30942 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30943 and has the following fields:
30944
30945 @table @code
30946 @item begin
30947 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30948
30949 @item end
30950 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30951
30952 @item offset
30953 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30954 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30955
30956 @item contents
30957 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30958
30959 @end table
30960
30961
30962
30963 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30964
30965 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30966
30967 @subsubheading Example
30968
30969 @smallexample
30970 (gdb)
30971 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30972 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30973 end="0xbffff15e",
30974 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30975 (gdb)
30976 @end smallexample
30977
30978
30979 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30980 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30981
30982 @subsubheading Synopsis
30983
30984 @smallexample
30985 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30986 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30987 @end smallexample
30988
30989 @noindent
30990 where:
30991
30992 @table @samp
30993 @item @var{address}
30994 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30995 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30996 be quoted using the C convention.
30997
30998 @item @var{contents}
30999 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31000 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31001
31002 @item @var{count}
31003 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31004 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31005 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31006 @var{count} memory units.
31007
31008 @end table
31009
31010 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31011
31012 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31013
31014 @subsubheading Example
31015
31016 @smallexample
31017 (gdb)
31018 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31019 ^done
31020 (gdb)
31021 @end smallexample
31022
31023 @smallexample
31024 (gdb)
31025 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31026 ^done
31027 (gdb)
31028 @end smallexample
31029
31030 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31031 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31032 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31033
31034 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31035 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31036
31037 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31038 @findex -trace-find
31039
31040 @subsubheading Synopsis
31041
31042 @smallexample
31043 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31044 @end smallexample
31045
31046 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31047 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31048 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31049
31050 @table @samp
31051
31052 @item none
31053 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31054
31055 @item frame-number
31056 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31057 that index.
31058
31059 @item tracepoint-number
31060 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31061 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31062
31063 @item pc
31064 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31065 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31066 address.
31067
31068 @item pc-inside-range
31069 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31070 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31071 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31072
31073 @item pc-outside-range
31074 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31075 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31076 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31077
31078 @item line
31079 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31080 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31081 the specified location.
31082
31083 @end table
31084
31085 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31086 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31087
31088 @table @samp
31089 @item found
31090 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31091 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31092
31093 @item traceframe
31094 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31095 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31096
31097 @item tracepoint
31098 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31099 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31100
31101 @item frame
31102 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31103 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31104 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31105
31106 @end table
31107
31108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31109
31110 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31111
31112 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31113 @findex -trace-define-variable
31114
31115 @subsubheading Synopsis
31116
31117 @smallexample
31118 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31119 @end smallexample
31120
31121 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31122 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31123 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31124 with the @samp{$} character.
31125
31126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31127
31128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31129
31130 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31131 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31132
31133 @subsubheading Synopsis
31134
31135 @smallexample
31136 -trace-frame-collected
31137 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31138 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31139 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31140 [--memory-contents]
31141 @end smallexample
31142
31143 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31144 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31145 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31146 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31147 See the output description table below for more details.
31148
31149 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31150 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31151 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31152 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31153 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31154
31155 For instance, if the actions were
31156 @smallexample
31157 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31158 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31159 @end smallexample
31160
31161 @noindent
31162 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31163 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31164 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31165 objects would be computed expressions.
31166
31167 An example output would be:
31168
31169 @smallexample
31170 (gdb)
31171 -trace-frame-collected
31172 ^done,
31173 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31174 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31175 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31176 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31177 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31178 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31179 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31180 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31181 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31182 ...
31183 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31184 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31185 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31186 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31187 (gdb)
31188 @end smallexample
31189
31190 Where:
31191
31192 @table @code
31193 @item explicit-variables
31194 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31195 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31196 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31197 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31198 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31199 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31200 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31201 arrays, structures and unions.
31202
31203 @item computed-expressions
31204 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31205 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31206 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31207 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31208
31209 @item registers
31210 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31211 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31212 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31213 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31214 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31215
31216 @item tvars
31217 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31218 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31219 current value are returned.
31220
31221 @item memory
31222 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31223 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31224 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31225
31226 @table @code
31227 @item address
31228 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31229
31230 @item length
31231 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31232
31233 @item contents
31234 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31235 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31236
31237 @end table
31238
31239 @end table
31240
31241 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31242
31243 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31244
31245 @subsubheading Example
31246
31247 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31248 @findex -trace-list-variables
31249
31250 @subsubheading Synopsis
31251
31252 @smallexample
31253 -trace-list-variables
31254 @end smallexample
31255
31256 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31257 table has the following fields:
31258
31259 @table @samp
31260 @item name
31261 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31262
31263 @item initial
31264 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31265 field is always present.
31266
31267 @item current
31268 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31269 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31270 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31271 presently running.
31272
31273 @end table
31274
31275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31276
31277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31278
31279 @subsubheading Example
31280
31281 @smallexample
31282 (gdb)
31283 -trace-list-variables
31284 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31285 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31286 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31287 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31288 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31289 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31290 (gdb)
31291 @end smallexample
31292
31293 @subheading -trace-save
31294 @findex -trace-save
31295
31296 @subsubheading Synopsis
31297
31298 @smallexample
31299 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31300 @end smallexample
31301
31302 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31303 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31304 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31305 to perform the save.
31306
31307 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31308 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31309 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31310
31311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31312
31313 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31314
31315
31316 @subheading -trace-start
31317 @findex -trace-start
31318
31319 @subsubheading Synopsis
31320
31321 @smallexample
31322 -trace-start
31323 @end smallexample
31324
31325 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31326 have any fields.
31327
31328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31329
31330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31331
31332 @subheading -trace-status
31333 @findex -trace-status
31334
31335 @subsubheading Synopsis
31336
31337 @smallexample
31338 -trace-status
31339 @end smallexample
31340
31341 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31342 the following fields:
31343
31344 @table @samp
31345
31346 @item supported
31347 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31348 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31349 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31350 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31351 started. This field is always present.
31352
31353 @item running
31354 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31355 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31356 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31357
31358 @item stop-reason
31359 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31360 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31361 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31362 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31363 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31364 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31365 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31366 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31367 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31368
31369 @item stopping-tracepoint
31370 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31371 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31372 @samp{passcount}.
31373
31374 @item frames
31375 @itemx frames-created
31376 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31377 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31378 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31379 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31380
31381 @item buffer-size
31382 @itemx buffer-free
31383 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31384 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31385
31386 @item circular
31387 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31388 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31389 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31390 and may fill up.
31391
31392 @item disconnected
31393 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31394 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31395 that the trace run will stop.
31396
31397 @item trace-file
31398 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31399 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31400
31401 @end table
31402
31403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31404
31405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31406
31407 @subheading -trace-stop
31408 @findex -trace-stop
31409
31410 @subsubheading Synopsis
31411
31412 @smallexample
31413 -trace-stop
31414 @end smallexample
31415
31416 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31417 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31418 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31419
31420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31421
31422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31423
31424
31425 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31426 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31427 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31428
31429
31430 @ignore
31431 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31432 @findex -symbol-info-address
31433
31434 @subsubheading Synopsis
31435
31436 @smallexample
31437 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31438 @end smallexample
31439
31440 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31441
31442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31443
31444 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31445
31446 @subsubheading Example
31447 N.A.
31448
31449
31450 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31451 @findex -symbol-info-file
31452
31453 @subsubheading Synopsis
31454
31455 @smallexample
31456 -symbol-info-file
31457 @end smallexample
31458
31459 Show the file for the symbol.
31460
31461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31462
31463 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31464 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31465
31466 @subsubheading Example
31467 N.A.
31468
31469
31470 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31471 @findex -symbol-info-function
31472
31473 @subsubheading Synopsis
31474
31475 @smallexample
31476 -symbol-info-function
31477 @end smallexample
31478
31479 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31480
31481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31482
31483 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31484
31485 @subsubheading Example
31486 N.A.
31487
31488
31489 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31490 @findex -symbol-info-line
31491
31492 @subsubheading Synopsis
31493
31494 @smallexample
31495 -symbol-info-line
31496 @end smallexample
31497
31498 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31499
31500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31501
31502 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31503 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31504
31505 @subsubheading Example
31506 N.A.
31507
31508
31509 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31510 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31511
31512 @subsubheading Synopsis
31513
31514 @smallexample
31515 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31516 @end smallexample
31517
31518 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31519
31520 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31521
31522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31523
31524 @subsubheading Example
31525 N.A.
31526
31527
31528 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31529 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31530
31531 @subsubheading Synopsis
31532
31533 @smallexample
31534 -symbol-list-functions
31535 @end smallexample
31536
31537 List the functions in the executable.
31538
31539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31540
31541 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31542 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31543
31544 @subsubheading Example
31545 N.A.
31546 @end ignore
31547
31548
31549 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31550 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31551
31552 @subsubheading Synopsis
31553
31554 @smallexample
31555 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31556 @end smallexample
31557
31558 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31559 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31560 ascending PC order.
31561
31562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31563
31564 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31565
31566 @subsubheading Example
31567 @smallexample
31568 (gdb)
31569 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31570 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31571 (gdb)
31572 @end smallexample
31573
31574
31575 @ignore
31576 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31577 @findex -symbol-list-types
31578
31579 @subsubheading Synopsis
31580
31581 @smallexample
31582 -symbol-list-types
31583 @end smallexample
31584
31585 List all the type names.
31586
31587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31588
31589 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31590 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31591
31592 @subsubheading Example
31593 N.A.
31594
31595
31596 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31597 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31598
31599 @subsubheading Synopsis
31600
31601 @smallexample
31602 -symbol-list-variables
31603 @end smallexample
31604
31605 List all the global and static variable names.
31606
31607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31608
31609 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31610
31611 @subsubheading Example
31612 N.A.
31613
31614
31615 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31616 @findex -symbol-locate
31617
31618 @subsubheading Synopsis
31619
31620 @smallexample
31621 -symbol-locate
31622 @end smallexample
31623
31624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31625
31626 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31627
31628 @subsubheading Example
31629 N.A.
31630
31631
31632 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31633 @findex -symbol-type
31634
31635 @subsubheading Synopsis
31636
31637 @smallexample
31638 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31639 @end smallexample
31640
31641 Show type of @var{variable}.
31642
31643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31644
31645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31646 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31647
31648 @subsubheading Example
31649 N.A.
31650 @end ignore
31651
31652
31653 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31654 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31655 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31656
31657 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31658 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31659
31660 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31661 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31662
31663 @subsubheading Synopsis
31664
31665 @smallexample
31666 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31667 @end smallexample
31668
31669 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31670 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31671 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31672 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31673 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31674 notification.
31675
31676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31677
31678 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31679
31680 @subsubheading Example
31681
31682 @smallexample
31683 (gdb)
31684 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31685 ^done
31686 (gdb)
31687 @end smallexample
31688
31689
31690 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31691 @findex -file-exec-file
31692
31693 @subsubheading Synopsis
31694
31695 @smallexample
31696 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31697 @end smallexample
31698
31699 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31700 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31701 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31702 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31703 notification.
31704
31705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31706
31707 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31708
31709 @subsubheading Example
31710
31711 @smallexample
31712 (gdb)
31713 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31714 ^done
31715 (gdb)
31716 @end smallexample
31717
31718
31719 @ignore
31720 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31721 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31722
31723 @subsubheading Synopsis
31724
31725 @smallexample
31726 -file-list-exec-sections
31727 @end smallexample
31728
31729 List the sections of the current executable file.
31730
31731 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31732
31733 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31734 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31735 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31736
31737 @subsubheading Example
31738 N.A.
31739 @end ignore
31740
31741
31742 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31743 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31744
31745 @subsubheading Synopsis
31746
31747 @smallexample
31748 -file-list-exec-source-file
31749 @end smallexample
31750
31751 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31752 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31753 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31754 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31755
31756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31757
31758 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31759
31760 @subsubheading Example
31761
31762 @smallexample
31763 (gdb)
31764 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31765 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31766 (gdb)
31767 @end smallexample
31768
31769
31770 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31771 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31772
31773 @subsubheading Synopsis
31774
31775 @smallexample
31776 -file-list-exec-source-files
31777 @end smallexample
31778
31779 List the source files for the current executable.
31780
31781 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31782 name) of a source file.
31783
31784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31785
31786 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31787 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31788
31789 @subsubheading Example
31790 @smallexample
31791 (gdb)
31792 -file-list-exec-source-files
31793 ^done,files=[
31794 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31795 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31796 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31797 (gdb)
31798 @end smallexample
31799
31800 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31801 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31802
31803 @subsubheading Synopsis
31804
31805 @smallexample
31806 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31807 @end smallexample
31808
31809 List the shared libraries in the program.
31810 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31811 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31812
31813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31814
31815 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31816 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31817 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31818 library. Each range has the following fields:
31819
31820 @table @samp
31821 @item from
31822 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31823 @item to
31824 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31825 @end table
31826
31827 @subsubheading Example
31828 @smallexample
31829 (gdb)
31830 -file-list-exec-source-files
31831 ^done,shared-libraries=[
31832 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31833 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31834 (gdb)
31835 @end smallexample
31836
31837
31838 @ignore
31839 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31840 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31841
31842 @subsubheading Synopsis
31843
31844 @smallexample
31845 -file-list-symbol-files
31846 @end smallexample
31847
31848 List symbol files.
31849
31850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31851
31852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31853
31854 @subsubheading Example
31855 N.A.
31856 @end ignore
31857
31858
31859 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31860 @findex -file-symbol-file
31861
31862 @subsubheading Synopsis
31863
31864 @smallexample
31865 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31866 @end smallexample
31867
31868 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31869 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31870 produced, except for a completion notification.
31871
31872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31873
31874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31875
31876 @subsubheading Example
31877
31878 @smallexample
31879 (gdb)
31880 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31881 ^done
31882 (gdb)
31883 @end smallexample
31884
31885 @ignore
31886 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31887 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31888 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31889
31890 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31891
31892 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31893
31894 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31895
31896 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31897
31898 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31899
31900 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31901
31902 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31903
31904 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31905
31906 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31907 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31908 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31909
31910 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31911
31912 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31913
31914 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31915
31916 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31917 @end ignore
31918
31919
31920 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31921 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31922 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31923
31924
31925 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31926 @findex -target-attach
31927
31928 @subsubheading Synopsis
31929
31930 @smallexample
31931 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31932 @end smallexample
31933
31934 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31935 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31936 group, the id previously returned by
31937 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31938
31939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31940
31941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31942
31943 @subsubheading Example
31944 @smallexample
31945 (gdb)
31946 -target-attach 34
31947 =thread-created,id="1"
31948 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31949 ^done
31950 (gdb)
31951 @end smallexample
31952
31953 @ignore
31954 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31955 @findex -target-compare-sections
31956
31957 @subsubheading Synopsis
31958
31959 @smallexample
31960 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31961 @end smallexample
31962
31963 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31964 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31965
31966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31967
31968 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31969
31970 @subsubheading Example
31971 N.A.
31972 @end ignore
31973
31974
31975 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31976 @findex -target-detach
31977
31978 @subsubheading Synopsis
31979
31980 @smallexample
31981 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31982 @end smallexample
31983
31984 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31985 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31986 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31987
31988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31989
31990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31991
31992 @subsubheading Example
31993
31994 @smallexample
31995 (gdb)
31996 -target-detach
31997 ^done
31998 (gdb)
31999 @end smallexample
32000
32001
32002 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32003 @findex -target-disconnect
32004
32005 @subsubheading Synopsis
32006
32007 @smallexample
32008 -target-disconnect
32009 @end smallexample
32010
32011 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32012 generally not resumed.
32013
32014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32015
32016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32017
32018 @subsubheading Example
32019
32020 @smallexample
32021 (gdb)
32022 -target-disconnect
32023 ^done
32024 (gdb)
32025 @end smallexample
32026
32027
32028 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32029 @findex -target-download
32030
32031 @subsubheading Synopsis
32032
32033 @smallexample
32034 -target-download
32035 @end smallexample
32036
32037 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32038 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32039
32040 @table @samp
32041 @item section
32042 The name of the section.
32043 @item section-sent
32044 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32045 @item section-size
32046 The size of the section.
32047 @item total-sent
32048 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32049 @item total-size
32050 The size of the overall executable to download.
32051 @end table
32052
32053 @noindent
32054 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32055 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32056
32057 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32058 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32059
32060 @table @samp
32061 @item section
32062 The name of the section.
32063 @item section-size
32064 The size of the section.
32065 @item total-size
32066 The size of the overall executable to download.
32067 @end table
32068
32069 @noindent
32070 At the end, a summary is printed.
32071
32072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32073
32074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32075
32076 @subsubheading Example
32077
32078 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32079 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32080
32081 @smallexample
32082 (gdb)
32083 -target-download
32084 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32085 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32086 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32087 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32088 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32089 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32090 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32091 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32092 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32093 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32094 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32095 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32096 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32097 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32098 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32099 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32100 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32101 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32102 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32103 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32104 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32105 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32106 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32107 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32108 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32109 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32110 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32111 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32112 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32113 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32114 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32115 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32116 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32117 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32118 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32119 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32120 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32121 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32122 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32123 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32124 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32125 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32126 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32127 write-rate="429"
32128 (gdb)
32129 @end smallexample
32130
32131
32132 @ignore
32133 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32134 @findex -target-exec-status
32135
32136 @subsubheading Synopsis
32137
32138 @smallexample
32139 -target-exec-status
32140 @end smallexample
32141
32142 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32143 not, for instance).
32144
32145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32146
32147 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32148
32149 @subsubheading Example
32150 N.A.
32151
32152
32153 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32154 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32155
32156 @subsubheading Synopsis
32157
32158 @smallexample
32159 -target-list-available-targets
32160 @end smallexample
32161
32162 List the possible targets to connect to.
32163
32164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32165
32166 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32167
32168 @subsubheading Example
32169 N.A.
32170
32171
32172 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32173 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32174
32175 @subsubheading Synopsis
32176
32177 @smallexample
32178 -target-list-current-targets
32179 @end smallexample
32180
32181 Describe the current target.
32182
32183 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32184
32185 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32186 other things).
32187
32188 @subsubheading Example
32189 N.A.
32190
32191
32192 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32193 @findex -target-list-parameters
32194
32195 @subsubheading Synopsis
32196
32197 @smallexample
32198 -target-list-parameters
32199 @end smallexample
32200
32201 @c ????
32202 @end ignore
32203
32204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32205
32206 No equivalent.
32207
32208 @subsubheading Example
32209 N.A.
32210
32211 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32212 @findex -target-flash-erase
32213
32214 @subsubheading Synopsis
32215
32216 @smallexample
32217 -target-flash-erase
32218 @end smallexample
32219
32220 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32221
32222 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32223
32224 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32225 addresses and memory region sizes.
32226
32227 @smallexample
32228 (gdb)
32229 -target-flash-erase
32230 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32231 (gdb)
32232 @end smallexample
32233
32234 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32235 @findex -target-select
32236
32237 @subsubheading Synopsis
32238
32239 @smallexample
32240 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32241 @end smallexample
32242
32243 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32244
32245 @table @samp
32246 @item @var{type}
32247 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32248 @item @var{parameters}
32249 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32250 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32251 @end table
32252
32253 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32254 which the target program is, in the following form:
32255
32256 @smallexample
32257 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32258 args=[@var{arg list}]
32259 @end smallexample
32260
32261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32262
32263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32264
32265 @subsubheading Example
32266
32267 @smallexample
32268 (gdb)
32269 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32270 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32271 (gdb)
32272 @end smallexample
32273
32274 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32275 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32276 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32277
32278
32279 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32280 @findex -target-file-put
32281
32282 @subsubheading Synopsis
32283
32284 @smallexample
32285 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32286 @end smallexample
32287
32288 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32289 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32290
32291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32292
32293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32294
32295 @subsubheading Example
32296
32297 @smallexample
32298 (gdb)
32299 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32300 ^done
32301 (gdb)
32302 @end smallexample
32303
32304
32305 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32306 @findex -target-file-get
32307
32308 @subsubheading Synopsis
32309
32310 @smallexample
32311 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32312 @end smallexample
32313
32314 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32315 on the host system.
32316
32317 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32318
32319 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32320
32321 @subsubheading Example
32322
32323 @smallexample
32324 (gdb)
32325 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32326 ^done
32327 (gdb)
32328 @end smallexample
32329
32330
32331 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32332 @findex -target-file-delete
32333
32334 @subsubheading Synopsis
32335
32336 @smallexample
32337 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32338 @end smallexample
32339
32340 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32341
32342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32343
32344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32345
32346 @subsubheading Example
32347
32348 @smallexample
32349 (gdb)
32350 -target-file-delete remotefile
32351 ^done
32352 (gdb)
32353 @end smallexample
32354
32355
32356 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32357 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32358 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32359
32360 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32361 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32362
32363 @subsubheading Synopsis
32364
32365 @smallexample
32366 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32367 @end smallexample
32368
32369 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32370 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32371 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32372
32373 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32374
32375 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32376
32377 @subsubheading Result
32378
32379 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32380 defined for each exception:
32381
32382 @table @samp
32383 @item name
32384 The name of the exception.
32385
32386 @item address
32387 The address of the exception.
32388
32389 @end table
32390
32391 @subsubheading Example
32392
32393 @smallexample
32394 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32395 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32396 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32397 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32398 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32399 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32400 @end smallexample
32401
32402 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32403
32404 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32405 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32406 Catchpoint Commands}.
32407
32408
32409 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32410 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32411 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32412
32413 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32414 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32415 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32416 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32417
32418 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32419 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32420 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32421
32422 @subsubheading Synopsis
32423
32424 @smallexample
32425 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32426 @end smallexample
32427
32428 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32429
32430 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32431 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32432 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32433 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32434 dash.
32435
32436 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32437
32438 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32439
32440 @subsubheading Result
32441
32442 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32443
32444 @table @samp
32445 @item exists
32446 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32447 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32448
32449 @end table
32450
32451 @subsubheading Example
32452
32453 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32454
32455 @smallexample
32456 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32457 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32458 @end smallexample
32459
32460 @noindent
32461 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32462 to the debugger:
32463
32464 @smallexample
32465 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32466 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32467 @end smallexample
32468
32469 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32470 @findex -list-features
32471 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32472
32473 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32474 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32475 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32476 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32477 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32478 startup.
32479
32480 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32481 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32482 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32483 is given below.
32484
32485 Example output:
32486
32487 @smallexample
32488 (gdb) -list-features
32489 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32490 @end smallexample
32491
32492 The current list of features is:
32493
32494 @ftable @samp
32495 @item frozen-varobjs
32496 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32497 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32498 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32499 @item pending-breakpoints
32500 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32501 command.
32502 @item python
32503 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32504 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32505 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32506 @item thread-info
32507 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32508 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32509 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32510 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32511 @item breakpoint-notifications
32512 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32513 CLI will be announced via async records.
32514 @item ada-task-info
32515 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32516 @item language-option
32517 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32518 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32519 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32520 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32521 @item undefined-command-error-code
32522 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32523 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32524 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32525 @item exec-run-start-option
32526 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32527 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32528 @end ftable
32529
32530 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32531 @findex -list-target-features
32532
32533 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32534 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32535 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32536 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32537 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32538 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32539 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32540 Example output:
32541
32542 @smallexample
32543 (gdb) -list-target-features
32544 ^done,result=["async"]
32545 @end smallexample
32546
32547 The current list of features is:
32548
32549 @table @samp
32550 @item async
32551 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32552 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32553 while the target is running.
32554
32555 @item reverse
32556 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32557 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32558
32559 @end table
32560
32561 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32562 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32563 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32564
32565 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32566
32567 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32568 @findex -gdb-exit
32569
32570 @subsubheading Synopsis
32571
32572 @smallexample
32573 -gdb-exit
32574 @end smallexample
32575
32576 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32577
32578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32579
32580 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32581
32582 @subsubheading Example
32583
32584 @smallexample
32585 (gdb)
32586 -gdb-exit
32587 ^exit
32588 @end smallexample
32589
32590
32591 @ignore
32592 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32593 @findex -exec-abort
32594
32595 @subsubheading Synopsis
32596
32597 @smallexample
32598 -exec-abort
32599 @end smallexample
32600
32601 Kill the inferior running program.
32602
32603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32604
32605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32606
32607 @subsubheading Example
32608 N.A.
32609 @end ignore
32610
32611
32612 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32613 @findex -gdb-set
32614
32615 @subsubheading Synopsis
32616
32617 @smallexample
32618 -gdb-set
32619 @end smallexample
32620
32621 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32622 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32623
32624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32625
32626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32627
32628 @subsubheading Example
32629
32630 @smallexample
32631 (gdb)
32632 -gdb-set $foo=3
32633 ^done
32634 (gdb)
32635 @end smallexample
32636
32637
32638 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32639 @findex -gdb-show
32640
32641 @subsubheading Synopsis
32642
32643 @smallexample
32644 -gdb-show
32645 @end smallexample
32646
32647 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32648
32649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32650
32651 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32652
32653 @subsubheading Example
32654
32655 @smallexample
32656 (gdb)
32657 -gdb-show annotate
32658 ^done,value="0"
32659 (gdb)
32660 @end smallexample
32661
32662 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32663
32664
32665 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32666 @findex -gdb-version
32667
32668 @subsubheading Synopsis
32669
32670 @smallexample
32671 -gdb-version
32672 @end smallexample
32673
32674 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32675
32676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32677
32678 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32679 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32680
32681 @subsubheading Example
32682
32683 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32684 @c box in TeX.
32685 @smallexample
32686 (gdb)
32687 -gdb-version
32688 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32689 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32690 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32691 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32692 ~ certain conditions.
32693 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32694 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32695 ~ details.
32696 ~This GDB was configured as
32697 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32698 ^done
32699 (gdb)
32700 @end smallexample
32701
32702 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32703 @findex -list-thread-groups
32704
32705 @subheading Synopsis
32706
32707 @smallexample
32708 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32709 @end smallexample
32710
32711 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32712 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32713 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32714 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32715 top-level thread groups.
32716
32717 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32718 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32719 available on the target.
32720
32721 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32722 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32723 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32724 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32725 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32726 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32727 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32728 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32729
32730 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32731 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32732 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32733 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32734 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32735 @samp{threads} field.
32736
32737 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32738 the following caveats:
32739
32740 @itemize @bullet
32741 @item
32742 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32743 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32744 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32745
32746 @item
32747 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32748 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32749 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32750 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32751 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32752 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32753
32754 @end itemize
32755
32756 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32757 have the following fields:
32758
32759 @table @code
32760 @item id
32761 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32762 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32763 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32764
32765 @item type
32766 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32767 valid type.
32768
32769 @item pid
32770 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32771 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32772
32773 @item exit-code
32774 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32775 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32776 only if the process is not running.
32777
32778 @item num_children
32779 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32780 absent for an available thread group.
32781
32782 @item threads
32783 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32784 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32785 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32786
32787 @item cores
32788 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32789 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32790 such information is not available.
32791
32792 @item executable
32793 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32794 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32795 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32796
32797 @end table
32798
32799 @subheading Example
32800
32801 @smallexample
32802 @value{GDBP}
32803 -list-thread-groups
32804 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32805 -list-thread-groups 17
32806 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32807 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32808 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32809 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32810 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32811 -list-thread-groups --available
32812 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32813 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32814 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32815 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32816 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32817 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32818 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32819 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32820 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32821 @end smallexample
32822
32823 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32824 @findex -info-os
32825
32826 @subsubheading Synopsis
32827
32828 @smallexample
32829 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32830 @end smallexample
32831
32832 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32833 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32834 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32835 of data of that type.
32836
32837 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32838 system.
32839
32840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32841
32842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32843
32844 @subsubheading Example
32845
32846 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32847 like this:
32848
32849 @smallexample
32850 @value{GDBP}
32851 -info-os
32852 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32853 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32854 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32855 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32856 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32857 col2="CPUs"@},
32858 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32859 col2="File descriptors"@},
32860 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32861 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32862 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32863 col2="Message queues"@},
32864 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32865 col2="Processes"@},
32866 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32867 col2="Process groups"@},
32868 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32869 col2="Semaphores"@},
32870 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32871 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32872 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32873 col2="Sockets"@},
32874 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32875 col2="Threads"@}]
32876 @value{GDBP}
32877 -info-os processes
32878 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32879 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32880 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32881 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32882 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32883 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32884 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32885 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32886 ...
32887 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32888 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32889 (gdb)
32890 @end smallexample
32891
32892 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32893 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32894 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32895 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32896 @code{info os} omits it.)
32897
32898 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32899 @findex -add-inferior
32900
32901 @subheading Synopsis
32902
32903 @smallexample
32904 -add-inferior
32905 @end smallexample
32906
32907 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32908 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32909 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32910 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32911 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32912 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32913
32914 @subheading Example
32915
32916 @smallexample
32917 @value{GDBP}
32918 -add-inferior
32919 ^done,inferior="i3"
32920 @end smallexample
32921
32922 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32923 @findex -interpreter-exec
32924
32925 @subheading Synopsis
32926
32927 @smallexample
32928 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32929 @end smallexample
32930 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32931
32932 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32933
32934 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32935
32936 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32937
32938 @subheading Example
32939
32940 @smallexample
32941 (gdb)
32942 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32943 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32944 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32945 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32946 ^done
32947 (gdb)
32948 @end smallexample
32949
32950 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32951 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32952
32953 @subheading Synopsis
32954
32955 @smallexample
32956 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32957 @end smallexample
32958
32959 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32960
32961 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32962
32963 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32964
32965 @subheading Example
32966
32967 @smallexample
32968 (gdb)
32969 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32970 ^done
32971 (gdb)
32972 @end smallexample
32973
32974 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32975 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32976
32977 @subheading Synopsis
32978
32979 @smallexample
32980 -inferior-tty-show
32981 @end smallexample
32982
32983 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32984
32985 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32986
32987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32988
32989 @subheading Example
32990
32991 @smallexample
32992 (gdb)
32993 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32994 ^done
32995 (gdb)
32996 -inferior-tty-show
32997 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32998 (gdb)
32999 @end smallexample
33000
33001 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33002 @findex -enable-timings
33003
33004 @subheading Synopsis
33005
33006 @smallexample
33007 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33008 @end smallexample
33009
33010 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33011 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33012 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33013 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33014
33015 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33016
33017 No equivalent.
33018
33019 @subheading Example
33020
33021 @smallexample
33022 (gdb)
33023 -enable-timings
33024 ^done
33025 (gdb)
33026 -break-insert main
33027 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33028 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33029 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33030 times="0"@},
33031 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33032 (gdb)
33033 -enable-timings no
33034 ^done
33035 (gdb)
33036 -exec-run
33037 ^running
33038 (gdb)
33039 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33040 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33041 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33042 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33043 (gdb)
33044 @end smallexample
33045
33046 @node Annotations
33047 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33048
33049 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33050 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33051 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33052 relatively high level.
33053
33054 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33055 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33056
33057 @ignore
33058 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33059 @end ignore
33060
33061 @menu
33062 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33063 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33064 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33065 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33066 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33067 * Annotations for Running::
33068 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33069 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33070 @end menu
33071
33072 @node Annotations Overview
33073 @section What is an Annotation?
33074 @cindex annotations
33075
33076 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33077 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33078 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33079 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33080 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33081 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33082 cannot contain newline characters.
33083
33084 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33085 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33086 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33087 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33088 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33089 means those three characters as output.
33090
33091 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33092 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33093 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33094 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33095 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33096 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33097 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33098 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33099 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33100
33101 @table @code
33102 @kindex set annotate
33103 @item set annotate @var{level}
33104 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33105 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33106
33107 @item show annotate
33108 @kindex show annotate
33109 Show the current annotation level.
33110 @end table
33111
33112 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33113
33114 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33115
33116 @smallexample
33117 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33118 GNU gdb 6.0
33119 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33120 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33121 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33122 under certain conditions.
33123 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33124 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33125 for details.
33126 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33127
33128 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33129 (@value{GDBP})
33130 ^Z^Zprompt
33131 @kbd{quit}
33132
33133 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33134 $
33135 @end smallexample
33136
33137 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33138 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33139 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33140 output from @value{GDBN}.
33141
33142 @node Server Prefix
33143 @section The Server Prefix
33144 @cindex server prefix
33145
33146 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33147 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33148 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33149 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33150 a transparent manner.
33151
33152 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33153 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33154 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33155 @code{print} command.
33156
33157 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33158 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33159
33160 @node Prompting
33161 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33162
33163 @cindex annotations for prompts
33164 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33165 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33166 over, etc.
33167
33168 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33169 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33170 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33171 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33172 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33173 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33174 features the following annotations:
33175
33176 @smallexample
33177 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33178 ^Z^Zprompt
33179 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33180 @end smallexample
33181
33182 The input types are
33183
33184 @table @code
33185 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33186 @findex prompt annotation
33187 @findex post-prompt annotation
33188 @item prompt
33189 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33190
33191 @findex pre-commands annotation
33192 @findex commands annotation
33193 @findex post-commands annotation
33194 @item commands
33195 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33196 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33197
33198 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33199 @findex overload-choice annotation
33200 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33201 @item overload-choice
33202 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33203
33204 @findex pre-query annotation
33205 @findex query annotation
33206 @findex post-query annotation
33207 @item query
33208 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33209
33210 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33211 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33212 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33213 @item prompt-for-continue
33214 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33215 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33216 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33217 presence of annotations.
33218 @end table
33219
33220 @node Errors
33221 @section Errors
33222 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33223
33224 @findex quit annotation
33225 @smallexample
33226 ^Z^Zquit
33227 @end smallexample
33228
33229 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33230
33231 @findex error annotation
33232 @smallexample
33233 ^Z^Zerror
33234 @end smallexample
33235
33236 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33237
33238 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33239 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33240 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33241 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33242 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33243 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33244 to the top level.
33245
33246 @findex error-begin annotation
33247 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33248
33249 @smallexample
33250 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33251 @end smallexample
33252
33253 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33254 message.
33255
33256 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33257 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33258 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33259
33260 @node Invalidation
33261 @section Invalidation Notices
33262
33263 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33264 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33265 changed.
33266
33267 @table @code
33268 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33269 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33270
33271 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33272 have changed.
33273
33274 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33275 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33276
33277 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33278 deleted a breakpoint.
33279 @end table
33280
33281 @node Annotations for Running
33282 @section Running the Program
33283 @cindex annotations for running programs
33284
33285 @findex starting annotation
33286 @findex stopping annotation
33287 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33288 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33289
33290 @smallexample
33291 ^Z^Zstarting
33292 @end smallexample
33293
33294 is output. When the program stops,
33295
33296 @smallexample
33297 ^Z^Zstopped
33298 @end smallexample
33299
33300 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33301 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33302
33303 @table @code
33304 @findex exited annotation
33305 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33306 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33307 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33308
33309 @findex signalled annotation
33310 @findex signal-name annotation
33311 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33312 @findex signal-string annotation
33313 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33314 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33315 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33316 annotation continues:
33317
33318 @smallexample
33319 @var{intro-text}
33320 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33321 @var{name}
33322 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33323 @var{middle-text}
33324 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33325 @var{string}
33326 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33327 @var{end-text}
33328 @end smallexample
33329
33330 @noindent
33331 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33332 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33333 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33334 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33335 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33336
33337 @findex signal annotation
33338 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33339 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33340 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33341 terminated with it.
33342
33343 @findex breakpoint annotation
33344 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33345 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33346
33347 @findex watchpoint annotation
33348 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33349 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33350 @end table
33351
33352 @node Source Annotations
33353 @section Displaying Source
33354 @cindex annotations for source display
33355
33356 @findex source annotation
33357 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33358
33359 @smallexample
33360 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33361 @end smallexample
33362
33363 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33364 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33365 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33366 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33367 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33368 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33369 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33370 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33371 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33372 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33373 depend on the language).
33374
33375 @node JIT Interface
33376 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33377 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33378 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33379
33380 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33381 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33382 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33383 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33384
33385 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33386 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33387 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33388 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33389 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33390 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33391
33392 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33393 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33394 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33395 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33396 LLVM JIT.
33397
33398 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33399 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33400 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33401 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33402 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33403 out about additional code.
33404
33405 @menu
33406 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33407 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33408 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33409 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33410 @end menu
33411
33412 @node Declarations
33413 @section JIT Declarations
33414
33415 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33416 implement the interface:
33417
33418 @smallexample
33419 typedef enum
33420 @{
33421 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33422 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33423 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33424 @} jit_actions_t;
33425
33426 struct jit_code_entry
33427 @{
33428 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33429 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33430 const char *symfile_addr;
33431 uint64_t symfile_size;
33432 @};
33433
33434 struct jit_descriptor
33435 @{
33436 uint32_t version;
33437 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33438 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33439 uint32_t action_flag;
33440 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33441 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33442 @};
33443
33444 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33445 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33446
33447 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33448 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33449 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33450 @end smallexample
33451
33452 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33453 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33454 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33455
33456 @node Registering Code
33457 @section Registering Code
33458
33459 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33460
33461 @itemize @bullet
33462 @item
33463 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33464 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33465
33466 @item
33467 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33468 file.
33469
33470 @item
33471 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33472
33473 @item
33474 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33475
33476 @item
33477 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33478 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33479 @end itemize
33480
33481 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33482 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33483 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33484 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33485
33486 @node Unregistering Code
33487 @section Unregistering Code
33488
33489 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33490
33491 @itemize @bullet
33492 @item
33493 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33494
33495 @item
33496 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33497
33498 @item
33499 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33500 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33501 @end itemize
33502
33503 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33504 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33505
33506 @node Custom Debug Info
33507 @section Custom Debug Info
33508 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33509 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33510
33511 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33512 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33513 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33514 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33515 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33516 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33517 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33518 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33519 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33520
33521 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33522 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33523 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33524 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33525 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33526 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33527 compiler.
33528
33529 @menu
33530 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33531 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33532 @end menu
33533
33534 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33535 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33536 @kindex jit-reader-load
33537 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33538
33539 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33540 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33541
33542 @table @code
33543 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33544 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33545 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33546 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33547 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33548 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33549 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33550
33551 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33552 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33553 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33554 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33555 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33556
33557 @item jit-reader-unload
33558 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33559
33560 @end table
33561
33562 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33563 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33564 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33565
33566 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33567 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33568
33569 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33570 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33571 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33572 the system include directory.
33573
33574 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33575 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33576 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33577
33578 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33579 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33580
33581 @findex gdb_init_reader
33582 @smallexample
33583 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33584 @end smallexample
33585
33586 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33587
33588 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33589 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33590 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33591 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33592 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33593 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33594
33595 @smallexample
33596 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33597 @{
33598 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33599 int reader_version;
33600
33601 /* For use by the reader. */
33602 void *priv_data;
33603
33604 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33605 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33606 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33607 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33608 @};
33609 @end smallexample
33610
33611 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33612 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33613
33614 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33615 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33616 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33617 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33618 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33619 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33620 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33621 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33622 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33623 target's address space.
33624
33625 @node In-Process Agent
33626 @chapter In-Process Agent
33627 @cindex debugging agent
33628 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33629 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33630 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33631 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33632 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33633 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33634 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33635 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33636 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33637 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33638 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33639 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33640 behavior without interrupting it.
33641
33642 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33643 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33644 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33645 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33646 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33647 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33648 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33649 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33650 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33651
33652 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33653 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33654 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33655 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33656
33657 @anchor{Control Agent}
33658 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33659 debugging with the following commands:
33660
33661 @table @code
33662 @kindex set agent on
33663 @item set agent on
33664 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33665 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33666 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33667 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33668 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33669 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33670
33671 @kindex set agent off
33672 @item set agent off
33673 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33674 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33675
33676 @kindex show agent
33677 @item show agent
33678 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33679 the in-process agent.
33680 @end table
33681
33682 @menu
33683 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33684 @end menu
33685
33686 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33687 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33688 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33689
33690 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33691 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33692 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33693 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33694 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33695 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33696 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33697 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33698 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33699
33700 @menu
33701 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33702 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33703 @end menu
33704
33705 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33706 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33707 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33708
33709 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33710 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33711
33712 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33713 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33714 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33715 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33716
33717 @enumerate
33718 @item
33719 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33720 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33721 @item
33722 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33723 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33724 the other one.
33725 @end enumerate
33726
33727 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33728
33729 @enumerate
33730 @item
33731 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33732 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33733 @anchor{agent expression object}
33734 @item
33735 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33736 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33737 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33738 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33739 @item
33740 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33741 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33742
33743 @end enumerate
33744
33745 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33746 object:
33747
33748 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33749 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33750 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33751 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33752 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33753 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33754 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33755 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33756 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33757 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33758 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33759 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33760 memory address for collecting.
33761 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33762 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33763 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33764 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33765 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33766 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33767 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33768 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33769 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33770 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33771 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33772 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33773 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33774 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33775 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33776 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33777 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33778 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33779 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33780 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33781 @ref{agent expression object}
33782 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33783 @ref{agent expression object}
33784 @item actions @tab variable
33785 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33786 @end multitable
33787
33788 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33789 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33790 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33791
33792 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33793 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33794
33795 @table @samp
33796
33797 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33798 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33799 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33800 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33801 in IPA finally.
33802
33803 Replies:
33804 @table @samp
33805 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33806 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33807 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33808 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33809 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33810 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33811 @item E @var{NN}
33812 for an error
33813
33814 @end table
33815
33816 @item close
33817 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33818 is about to kill inferiors.
33819
33820 @item qTfSTM
33821 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33822 @item qTsSTM
33823 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33824 @item qTSTMat
33825 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33826 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33827 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33828
33829 Replies:
33830 @table @samp
33831 @item E @var{NN}
33832 for an error
33833 @end table
33834 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33835 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33836 @end table
33837
33838 @node GDB Bugs
33839 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33840 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33841 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33842
33843 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33844
33845 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33846 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33847 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33848 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33849
33850 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33851 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33852
33853 @menu
33854 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33855 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33856 @end menu
33857
33858 @node Bug Criteria
33859 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33860 @cindex bug criteria
33861
33862 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33863
33864 @itemize @bullet
33865 @cindex fatal signal
33866 @cindex debugger crash
33867 @cindex crash of debugger
33868 @item
33869 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33870 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33871
33872 @cindex error on valid input
33873 @item
33874 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33875 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33876 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33877
33878 @cindex invalid input
33879 @item
33880 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33881 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33882 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33883 for traditional practice''.
33884
33885 @item
33886 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33887 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33888 @end itemize
33889
33890 @node Bug Reporting
33891 @section How to Report Bugs
33892 @cindex bug reports
33893 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33894
33895 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33896 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33897 contact that organization first.
33898
33899 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33900 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33901 distribution.
33902 @c should add a web page ref...
33903
33904 @ifset BUGURL
33905 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33906 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33907 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33908 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33909 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33910 be used.
33911
33912 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33913 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33914 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33915 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33916
33917 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33918 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33919 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33920 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33921 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33922 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33923 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33924 bug reports to the mailing list.
33925 @end ifset
33926 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33927 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33928 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33929 @end ifclear
33930 @end ifset
33931
33932 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33933 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33934 fact or leave it out, state it!
33935
33936 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33937 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33938 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33939 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33940 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33941 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33942 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33943 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33944 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33945
33946 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33947 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33948 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33949 self-contained.
33950
33951 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33952 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33953 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33954 bugs properly.
33955
33956 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33957
33958 @itemize @bullet
33959 @item
33960 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33961 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33962 version}.
33963
33964 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33965 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33966
33967 @item
33968 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33969 version number.
33970
33971 @item
33972 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33973 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33974 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33975 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33976
33977 @item
33978 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33979 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33980
33981 @item
33982 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33983 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33984 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33985 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33986 those compilers.
33987
33988 @item
33989 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33990 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33991 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33992 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33993
33994 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33995 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33996
33997 @item
33998 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33999 reproduce the bug.
34000
34001 @item
34002 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34003 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34004
34005 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34006 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34007 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34008 a chance to make a mistake.
34009
34010 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34011 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34012 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34013 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34014 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34015 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34016 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34017 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34018
34019 @pindex script
34020 @cindex recording a session script
34021 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34022 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34023 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34024 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34025
34026 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34027 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34028
34029 @item
34030 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34031 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34032 it by context, not by line number.
34033
34034 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34035 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34036
34037 @end itemize
34038
34039 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34040
34041 @itemize @bullet
34042 @item
34043 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34044
34045 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34046 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34047 changes will not affect it.
34048
34049 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34050 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34051 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34052 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34053
34054 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34055 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34056 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34057 less time, and so on.
34058
34059 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34060 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34061
34062 @item
34063 A patch for the bug.
34064
34065 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34066 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34067 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34068 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34069
34070 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34071 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34072 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34073 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34074
34075 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34076 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34077 help us to understand.
34078
34079 @item
34080 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34081
34082 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34083 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34084 @end itemize
34085
34086 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34087 @c and consists of the two following files:
34088 @c rluser.texi
34089 @c hsuser.texi
34090 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34091 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34092 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34093 @include rluser.texi
34094 @include hsuser.texi
34095 @end ifclear
34096
34097 @node In Memoriam
34098 @appendix In Memoriam
34099
34100 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34101 contributors:
34102
34103 @table @code
34104 @item Fred Fish
34105 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34106 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34107 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34108
34109 @item Michael Snyder
34110 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34111 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34112 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34113 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34114 @end table
34115
34116 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34117 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34118
34119 @node Formatting Documentation
34120 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34121
34122 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34123 @cindex reference card
34124 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34125 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34126 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34127 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34128 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34129 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34130
34131 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34132 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34133
34134 @smallexample
34135 make refcard.dvi
34136 @end smallexample
34137
34138 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34139 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34140 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34141 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34142 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34143
34144 @cindex documentation
34145
34146 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34147 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34148 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34149 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34150 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34151 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34152
34153 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34154 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34155 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34156 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34157 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34158 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34159 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34160 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34161
34162 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34163 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34164 @code{makeinfo}.
34165
34166 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34167 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34168 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34169
34170 @smallexample
34171 cd gdb
34172 make gdb.info
34173 @end smallexample
34174
34175 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34176 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34177 Texinfo definitions file.
34178
34179 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34180 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34181 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34182 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34183 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34184 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34185 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34186
34187 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34188 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34189 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34190 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34191 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34192 directory.
34193
34194 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34195 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34196 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34197 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34198
34199 @smallexample
34200 make gdb.dvi
34201 @end smallexample
34202
34203 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34204
34205 @node Installing GDB
34206 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34207 @cindex installation
34208
34209 @menu
34210 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34211 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34212 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34213 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34214 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34215 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34216 @end menu
34217
34218 @node Requirements
34219 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34220 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34221
34222 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34223 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34224
34225 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34226 @table @asis
34227 @item ISO C90 compiler
34228 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34229 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34230
34231 @end table
34232
34233 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34234 @table @asis
34235 @item Expat
34236 @anchor{Expat}
34237 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34238 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34239 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34240 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34241 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34242 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34243
34244 Expat is used for:
34245
34246 @itemize @bullet
34247 @item
34248 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34249 @item
34250 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34251 @item
34252 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34253 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34254 @item
34255 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34256 @item
34257 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34258 @item
34259 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34260 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34261 @end itemize
34262
34263 @item zlib
34264 @cindex compressed debug sections
34265 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34266 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34267 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34268 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34269 information in such binaries.
34270
34271 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34272 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34273 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34274
34275 @item iconv
34276 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34277 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34278 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34279 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34280
34281 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34282 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34283 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34284 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34285
34286 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34287 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34288 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34289
34290 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34291 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34292 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34293 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34294 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34295 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34296 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34297 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34298 @end table
34299
34300 @node Running Configure
34301 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34302 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34303 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34304 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34305 build the @code{gdb} program.
34306 @iftex
34307 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34308 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34309 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34310 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34311 @end iftex
34312
34313 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34314 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34315 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34316
34317 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34318 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34319
34320 @table @code
34321 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34322 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34323
34324 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34325 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34326
34327 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34328 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34329
34330 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34331 @sc{gnu} include files
34332
34333 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34334 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34335
34336 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34337 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34338
34339 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34340 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34341
34342 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34343 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34344
34345 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34346 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34347 @end table
34348
34349 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34350 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34351 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34352
34353 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34354 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34355 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34356 argument.
34357
34358 For example:
34359
34360 @smallexample
34361 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34362 ./configure @var{host}
34363 make
34364 @end smallexample
34365
34366 @noindent
34367 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34368 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34369 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34370 correct value by examining your system.)
34371
34372 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34373 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34374 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34375 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34376
34377 @need 750
34378 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34379 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34380 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34381
34382 @smallexample
34383 sh configure @var{host}
34384 @end smallexample
34385
34386 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34387 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34388 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34389 @file{configure}
34390 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34391 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34392
34393 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34394 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34395 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34396 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34397 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34398 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34399 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34400 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34401 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34402
34403 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34404 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34405 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34406 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34407 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34408
34409 @node Separate Objdir
34410 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34411
34412 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34413 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34414 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34415 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34416 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34417 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34418 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34419 program specified there.
34420
34421 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34422 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34423 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34424 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34425 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34426 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34427
34428 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34429 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34430
34431 @smallexample
34432 @group
34433 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34434 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34435 cd ../gdb-sun4
34436 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34437 make
34438 @end group
34439 @end smallexample
34440
34441 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34442 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34443 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34444 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34445 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34446 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34447
34448 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34449 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34450 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34451 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34452 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34453
34454 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34455 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34456 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34457 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34458 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34459 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34460
34461 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34462 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34463 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34464
34465 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34466 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34467 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34468 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34469 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34470
34471 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34472 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34473 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34474 with each other.
34475
34476 @node Config Names
34477 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34478
34479 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34480 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34481 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34482 of information in the following pattern:
34483
34484 @smallexample
34485 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34486 @end smallexample
34487
34488 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34489 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34490 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34491
34492 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34493 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34494 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34495 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34496 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34497 abbreviations---for example:
34498
34499 @smallexample
34500 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34501 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34502 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34503 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34504 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34505 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34506 % sh config.sub sun4
34507 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34508 % sh config.sub sun3
34509 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34510 % sh config.sub i986v
34511 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34512 @end smallexample
34513
34514 @noindent
34515 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34516 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34517
34518 @node Configure Options
34519 @section @file{configure} Options
34520
34521 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34522 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34523 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34524 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34525
34526 @smallexample
34527 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34528 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34529 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34530 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34531 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34532 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34533 @var{host}
34534 @end smallexample
34535
34536 @noindent
34537 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34538 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34539 @samp{--}.
34540
34541 @table @code
34542 @item --help
34543 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34544
34545 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34546 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34547 @file{@var{dir}}.
34548
34549 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34550 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34551 @file{@var{dir}}.
34552
34553 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34554 @need 2000
34555 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34556 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34557 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34558 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34559 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34560 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34561 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34562 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34563 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34564 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34565 @var{dirname}.
34566
34567 @item --norecursion
34568 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34569 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34570
34571 @item --target=@var{target}
34572 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34573 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34574 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34575
34576 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34577
34578 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34579 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34580
34581 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34582 @end table
34583
34584 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34585 needed for special purposes only.
34586
34587 @node System-wide configuration
34588 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34589 @cindex system-wide init file
34590
34591 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34592 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34593 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34594
34595 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34596
34597 @table @code
34598 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34599 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34600 @var{file}.
34601 @end table
34602
34603 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34604 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34605
34606 @itemize @bullet
34607 @item
34608 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34609 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34610 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34611 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34612 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34613 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34614
34615 @item
34616 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34617 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34618 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34619 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34620 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34621 @end itemize
34622
34623 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34624 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34625 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34626 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34627 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34628 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34629 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34630 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34631 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34632 reread.
34633
34634 @menu
34635 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34636 @end menu
34637
34638 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34639 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34640 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34641
34642 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34643 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34644 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34645 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34646 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34647 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34648
34649 The following scripts are currently available:
34650 @itemize @bullet
34651
34652 @item @file{elinos.py}
34653 @pindex elinos.py
34654 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34655 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34656 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34657 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34658 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34659 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34660
34661 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34662 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34663 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34664 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34665 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34666 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34667
34668 @end itemize
34669
34670 @node Maintenance Commands
34671 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34672 @cindex maintenance commands
34673 @cindex internal commands
34674
34675 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34676 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34677 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34678 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34679 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34680
34681 @table @code
34682 @kindex maint agent
34683 @kindex maint agent-eval
34684 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34685 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34686 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34687 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34688 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34689 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34690 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34691 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34692 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34693 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34694 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34695 addition and return the sum.
34696 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34697 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34698
34699 @kindex maint agent-printf
34700 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34701 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34702 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34703 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34704 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34705
34706 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34707 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34708 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34709 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34710 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34711 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34712 is shown:
34713
34714 @table @code
34715 @item breakpoint
34716 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34717
34718 @item watchpoint
34719 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34720
34721 @item longjmp
34722 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34723 @code{longjmp} calls.
34724
34725 @item longjmp resume
34726 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34727
34728 @item until
34729 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34730
34731 @item finish
34732 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34733
34734 @item shlib events
34735 Shared library events.
34736
34737 @end table
34738
34739 @kindex maint info btrace
34740 @item maint info btrace
34741 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34742
34743 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34744 @item maint btrace packet-history
34745 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34746 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34747 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34748 recording format.
34749
34750 @table @code
34751 @item bts
34752 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34753 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34754
34755 @table @asis
34756 @item Block number
34757 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34758 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34759 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34760 @end table
34761
34762 @item pt
34763 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34764 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34765 information is printed:
34766
34767 @table @asis
34768 @item Packet number
34769 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34770 @item Trace offset
34771 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34772 @item Packet opcode and payload
34773 @end table
34774 @end table
34775
34776 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34777 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34778 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34779 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34780 needed.
34781
34782 @kindex maint btrace clear
34783 @item maint btrace clear
34784 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34785 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34786
34787 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34788 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34789 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34790 buffer.
34791
34792 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34793 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34794 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34795 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34796 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34797 packet history.
34798
34799 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34800 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34801 @cindex displaced stepping support
34802 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34803 @item set displaced-stepping
34804 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34805 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34806 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34807 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34808 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34809 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34810
34811 @table @code
34812 @item set displaced-stepping on
34813 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34814 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34815
34816 @item set displaced-stepping off
34817 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34818 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34819
34820 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34821 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34822 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34823 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34824 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34825 @end table
34826
34827 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34828 @item maint check-psymtabs
34829 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34830 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34831
34832 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34833 @item maint check-symtabs
34834 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34835
34836 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34837 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34838 Expand symbol tables.
34839 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34840 names matching @var{regexp}.
34841
34842 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34843 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34844 @cindex demangler crashes
34845 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34846 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34847 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34848 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34849 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34850 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34851 option to terminate the current session.
34852
34853 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34854 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34855 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34856
34857 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34858 @item maint cplus namespace
34859 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34860
34861 @kindex maint deprecate
34862 @kindex maint undeprecate
34863 @cindex deprecated commands
34864 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34865 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34866 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34867 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34868 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34869 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34870 the replacement as part of the warning.
34871
34872 @kindex maint dump-me
34873 @item maint dump-me
34874 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34875 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34876 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34877 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34878
34879 @kindex maint internal-error
34880 @kindex maint internal-warning
34881 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34882 @cindex demangler crashes
34883 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34884 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34885 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34886
34887 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34888 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34889 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34890 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34891 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34892 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34893 @value{GDBN} session.
34894
34895 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34896 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34897
34898 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34899
34900 @smallexample
34901 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34902 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34903 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34904 debugging may prove unreliable.
34905 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34906 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34907 (@value{GDBP})
34908 @end smallexample
34909
34910 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34911 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34912 @cindex demangler crashes
34913
34914 @kindex maint set internal-error
34915 @kindex maint show internal-error
34916 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34917 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34918 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34919 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34920 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34921 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34922 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34923 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34924 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34925 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34926 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34927 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34928 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34929 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34930 described in the table below.
34931
34932 @table @samp
34933 @item quit
34934 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34935 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34936
34937 @item corefile
34938 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34939 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34940 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34941 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34942 disabled.
34943 @end table
34944
34945 @kindex maint packet
34946 @item maint packet @var{text}
34947 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34948 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34949 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34950 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34951 checksum.
34952
34953 @kindex maint print architecture
34954 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34955 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34956 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34957
34958 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34959 @item maint print c-tdesc
34960 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34961 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
34962 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
34963 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
34964 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
34965 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
34966 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
34967 modify XML target descriptions.
34968
34969 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
34970 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
34971 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
34972 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
34973
34974 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34975 @item maint print dummy-frames
34976 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34977
34978 @smallexample
34979 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34980 @dots{}
34981 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34982 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34983 58 return (a + b);
34984 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34985 @dots{}
34986 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34987 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34988 (@value{GDBP})
34989 @end smallexample
34990
34991 Takes an optional file parameter.
34992
34993 @kindex maint print registers
34994 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34995 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34996 @kindex maint print register-groups
34997 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34998 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34999 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35000 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35001 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35002 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35003 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35004
35005 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35006 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35007 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35008 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35009 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35010 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35011 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35012 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35013
35014 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35015 write the information.
35016
35017 @kindex maint print reggroups
35018 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35019 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35020 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35021 information.
35022
35023 The register groups info looks like this:
35024
35025 @smallexample
35026 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35027 Group Type
35028 general user
35029 float user
35030 all user
35031 vector user
35032 system user
35033 save internal
35034 restore internal
35035 @end smallexample
35036
35037 @kindex flushregs
35038 @item flushregs
35039 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35040
35041 @kindex maint print objfiles
35042 @cindex info for known object files
35043 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35044 Print a dump of all known object files.
35045 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35046 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35047 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35048
35049 @kindex maint print user-registers
35050 @cindex user registers
35051 @item maint print user-registers
35052 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35053 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35054 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35055 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35056 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35057 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35058 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35059
35060 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35061 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35062 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35063 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35064 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35065 matching @var{regexp}.
35066 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35067 and the full path if known.
35068 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35069
35070 @kindex maint print statistics
35071 @cindex bcache statistics
35072 @item maint print statistics
35073 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35074 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35075 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35076 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35077 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35078 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35079 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35080 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35081 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35082 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35083 lengths.
35084
35085 @kindex maint print target-stack
35086 @cindex target stack description
35087 @item maint print target-stack
35088 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35089 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35090 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35091 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35092 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35093 address.
35094
35095 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35096 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35097
35098 @kindex maint print type
35099 @cindex type chain of a data type
35100 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35101 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35102 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35103 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35104 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35105 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35106
35107 @kindex maint selftest
35108 @cindex self tests
35109 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35110 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35111 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35112 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35113 name will by ran.
35114
35115 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35116 @cindex self tests
35117 @item maint info selftests
35118 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35119
35120 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35121 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35122 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35123 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35124 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35125 information.
35126
35127 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35128 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35129 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35130 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35131 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35132 always see the disassembly form.
35133
35134 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35135
35136 @smallexample
35137 (gdb) info addr argc
35138 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35139 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35140 @end smallexample
35141
35142 For more information on these expressions, see
35143 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35144
35145 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35146 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35147 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35148 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35149 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35150
35151 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35152 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35153 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35154 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35155 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35156 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35157 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35158 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35159 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35160
35161 @kindex maint set profile
35162 @kindex maint show profile
35163 @cindex profiling GDB
35164 @item maint set profile
35165 @itemx maint show profile
35166 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35167
35168 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35169 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35170 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35171 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35172 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35173 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35174 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35175
35176 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35177 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35178
35179 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35180 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35181 @cindex hardware debug registers
35182 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35183 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35184 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35185 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35186 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35187 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35188 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35189
35190 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35191 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35192 @item maint set show-all-tib
35193 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35194 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35195 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35196 command.
35197
35198 @kindex maint set target-async
35199 @kindex maint show target-async
35200 @item maint set target-async
35201 @itemx maint show target-async
35202 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35203 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35204 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35205 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35206
35207 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35208 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35209 @item maint set target-non-stop
35210 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35211
35212 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35213 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35214 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35215 if supported by the target.
35216
35217 @table @code
35218 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35219 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35220 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35221
35222 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35223 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35224 does not indicate support.
35225
35226 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35227 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35228 target supports it.
35229 @end table
35230
35231 @kindex maint set per-command
35232 @kindex maint show per-command
35233 @item maint set per-command
35234 @itemx maint show per-command
35235 @cindex resources used by commands
35236
35237 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35238 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35239
35240 @table @code
35241 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35242 @itemx maint show per-command space
35243 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35244 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35245 took, following the command's own output.
35246 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35247 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35248
35249 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35250 @itemx maint show per-command time
35251 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35252 for each command.
35253 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35254 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35255 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35256 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35257 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35258 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35259 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35260 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35261 spent by the program been debugged.
35262 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35263 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35264
35265 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35266 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35267 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35268 for each command.
35269 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35270
35271 @enumerate a
35272 @item
35273 number of symbol tables
35274 @item
35275 number of primary symbol tables
35276 @item
35277 number of blocks in the blockvector
35278 @end enumerate
35279 @end table
35280
35281 @kindex maint space
35282 @cindex memory used by commands
35283 @item maint space @var{value}
35284 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35285 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35286
35287 @kindex maint time
35288 @cindex time of command execution
35289 @item maint time @var{value}
35290 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35291 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35292
35293 @kindex maint translate-address
35294 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35295 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35296 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35297 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35298 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35299 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35300 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35301
35302 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35303 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35304 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35305
35306 @end table
35307
35308 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35309 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35310
35311 @table @code
35312 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35313 @kindex set watchdog
35314 @cindex watchdog timer
35315 @cindex timeout for commands
35316 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35317 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35318 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35319
35320 @item show watchdog
35321 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35322 @end table
35323
35324 @node Remote Protocol
35325 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35326
35327 @menu
35328 * Overview::
35329 * Packets::
35330 * Stop Reply Packets::
35331 * General Query Packets::
35332 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35333 * Tracepoint Packets::
35334 * Host I/O Packets::
35335 * Interrupts::
35336 * Notification Packets::
35337 * Remote Non-Stop::
35338 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35339 * Examples::
35340 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35341 * Library List Format::
35342 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35343 * Memory Map Format::
35344 * Thread List Format::
35345 * Traceframe Info Format::
35346 * Branch Trace Format::
35347 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35348 @end menu
35349
35350 @node Overview
35351 @section Overview
35352
35353 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35354 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35355 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35356 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35357
35358 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35359 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35360
35361 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35362 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35363 @cindex remote serial protocol
35364 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35365 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35366 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35367 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35368 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35369
35370 @smallexample
35371 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35372 @end smallexample
35373 @noindent
35374
35375 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35376 @noindent
35377 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35378 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35379 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35380
35381 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35382 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35383
35384 @smallexample
35385 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35386 @end smallexample
35387
35388 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35389 @noindent
35390 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35391 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35392 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35393
35394 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35395 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35396 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35397 retransmission):
35398
35399 @smallexample
35400 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35401 <- @code{+}
35402 @end smallexample
35403 @noindent
35404
35405 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35406 once a connection is established.
35407 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35408
35409 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35410 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35411 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35412 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35413 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35414 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35415 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35416
35417 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35418 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35419 exceptions).
35420
35421 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35422 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35423 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35424 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35425
35426 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35427 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35428 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35429
35430 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35431 @anchor{Binary Data}
35432 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35433 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35434 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35435 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35436 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35437 binary data.
35438
35439 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35440 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35441 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35442 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35443 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35444 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35445 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35446 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35447 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35448 (described next).
35449
35450 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35451 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35452 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35453 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35454 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35455 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35456 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35457 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35458 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35459 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35460 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35461 3}} more times.
35462
35463 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35464 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35465 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35466 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35467 @samp{0*"00}.
35468
35469 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35470 error number. That number is not well defined.
35471
35472 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35473 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35474 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35475 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35476 on that response.
35477
35478 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35479 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35480 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35481 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35482 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35483 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35484
35485 @node Packets
35486 @section Packets
35487
35488 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35489 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35490 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35491 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35492
35493 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35494 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35495 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35496 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35497 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35498 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35499 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35500 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35501 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35502 @var{baz}.
35503
35504 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35505 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35506 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35507 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35508 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35509 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35510 pick any thread.
35511
35512 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35513 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35514 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35515 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35516 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35517 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35518 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35519 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35520 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35521 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35522 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35523 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35524 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35525
35526 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35527 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35528 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35529 more information.
35530
35531 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35532 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35533
35534 Here are the packet descriptions.
35535
35536 @table @samp
35537
35538 @item !
35539 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35540 @anchor{extended mode}
35541 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35542 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35543 debugged.
35544
35545 Reply:
35546 @table @samp
35547 @item OK
35548 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35549 @end table
35550
35551 @item ?
35552 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35553 @anchor{? packet}
35554 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35555 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35556 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35557
35558 Reply:
35559 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35560
35561 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35562 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35563 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35564 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35565 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35566
35567 Reply:
35568 @table @samp
35569 @item OK
35570 The arguments were set.
35571 @item E @var{NN}
35572 An error occurred.
35573 @end table
35574
35575 @item b @var{baud}
35576 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35577 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35578 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35579
35580 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35581 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35582 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35583
35584 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35585 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35586 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35587 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35588 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35589
35590 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35591 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35592 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35593 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35594
35595 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35596 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35597
35598 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35599 @anchor{bc}
35600 @item bc
35601 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35602 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35603
35604 Reply:
35605 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35606
35607 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35608 @anchor{bs}
35609 @item bs
35610 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35611 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35612
35613 Reply:
35614 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35615
35616 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35617 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35618 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35619 is omitted, resume at current address.
35620
35621 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35622 packet}.
35623
35624 Reply:
35625 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35626
35627 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35628 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35629 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35630 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35631
35632 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35633 packet}.
35634
35635 Reply:
35636 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35637
35638 @item d
35639 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35640 Toggle debug flag.
35641
35642 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35643 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35644
35645 @item D
35646 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35647 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35648 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35649 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35650 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35651
35652 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35653 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35654 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35655 big-endian hex string.
35656
35657 Reply:
35658 @table @samp
35659 @item OK
35660 for success
35661 @item E @var{NN}
35662 for an error
35663 @end table
35664
35665 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35666 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35667 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35668 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35669 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35670
35671 @item g
35672 @anchor{read registers packet}
35673 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35674 Read general registers.
35675
35676 Reply:
35677 @table @samp
35678 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35679 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35680 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35681 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35682 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35683 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35684
35685 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35686 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35687 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35688 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35689 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35690 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35691 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35692 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35693
35694 @smallexample
35695 -> @code{g}
35696 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35697 @end smallexample
35698
35699 @item E @var{NN}
35700 for an error.
35701 @end table
35702
35703 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35704 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35705 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35706 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35707
35708 Reply:
35709 @table @samp
35710 @item OK
35711 for success
35712 @item E @var{NN}
35713 for an error
35714 @end table
35715
35716 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35717 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35718 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35719 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35720 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35721 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35722 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35723 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35724 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35725
35726 Reply:
35727 @table @samp
35728 @item OK
35729 for success
35730 @item E @var{NN}
35731 for an error
35732 @end table
35733
35734 @c FIXME: JTC:
35735 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35736 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35737 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35738 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35739 @c described. For example:
35740 @c
35741 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35742 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35743 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35744 @c
35745 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35746 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35747 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35748
35749 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35750 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35751 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35752 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35753 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35754 step starting at that address.
35755
35756 @item I
35757 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35758 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35759 step packet}.
35760
35761 @item k
35762 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35763 Kill request.
35764
35765 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35766
35767 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35768 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35769
35770 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35771
35772 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35773 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35774 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35775
35776 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35777 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35778 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35779
35780 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35781 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35782 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35783 (@pxref{? packet}).
35784
35785 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35786 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35787 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35788 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35789 any particular boundary.
35790
35791 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35792 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35793 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35794 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35795 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35796 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35797 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35798 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35799
35800 Reply:
35801 @table @samp
35802 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35803 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35804 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35805 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35806 @item E @var{NN}
35807 @var{NN} is errno
35808 @end table
35809
35810 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35811 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35812 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35813 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35814 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35815
35816 Reply:
35817 @table @samp
35818 @item OK
35819 for success
35820 @item E @var{NN}
35821 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35822 written).
35823 @end table
35824
35825 @item p @var{n}
35826 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35827 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35828 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35829 register value is encoded.
35830
35831 Reply:
35832 @table @samp
35833 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35834 the register's value
35835 @item E @var{NN}
35836 for an error
35837 @item @w{}
35838 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35839 @end table
35840
35841 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35842 @anchor{write register packet}
35843 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35844 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35845 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35846 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35847
35848 Reply:
35849 @table @samp
35850 @item OK
35851 for success
35852 @item E @var{NN}
35853 for an error
35854 @end table
35855
35856 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35857 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35858 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35859 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35860 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35861 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35862
35863 @item r
35864 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35865 Reset the entire system.
35866
35867 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35868
35869 @item R @var{XX}
35870 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35871 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35872 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35873
35874 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35875
35876 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35877 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35878 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35879 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35880
35881 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35882 packet}.
35883
35884 Reply:
35885 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35886
35887 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35888 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35889 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35890 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35891 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35892
35893 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35894 packet}.
35895
35896 Reply:
35897 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35898
35899 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35900 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35901 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35902 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35903 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35904
35905 @item T @var{thread-id}
35906 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35907 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35908
35909 Reply:
35910 @table @samp
35911 @item OK
35912 thread is still alive
35913 @item E @var{NN}
35914 thread is dead
35915 @end table
35916
35917 @item v
35918 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35919 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35920
35921 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35922 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35923 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35924 The process ID is a
35925 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35926 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35927 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35928
35929 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35930 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35931 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35932 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35933 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35934 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35935 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35936 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35937
35938 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35939
35940 Reply:
35941 @table @samp
35942 @item E @var{nn}
35943 for an error
35944 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35945 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35946 @item OK
35947 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35948 @end table
35949
35950 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35951 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35952 @anchor{vCont packet}
35953 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35954
35955 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35956 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35957 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35958 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35959 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35960 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35961 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35962 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35963 error.
35964
35965 Currently supported actions are:
35966
35967 @table @samp
35968 @item c
35969 Continue.
35970 @item C @var{sig}
35971 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35972 @item s
35973 Step.
35974 @item S @var{sig}
35975 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35976 @item t
35977 Stop.
35978 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35979 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35980 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35981 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35982 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35983 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35984
35985 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35986 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35987 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35988 jumps to @var{start}).
35989
35990 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35991 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35992 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35993
35994 @end table
35995
35996 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35997 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35998 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35999
36000 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36001 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36002 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36003 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36004 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36005 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36006 as an implementation detail.
36007
36008 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36009 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36010 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36011 stopped.
36012
36013 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36014 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36015 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36016
36017 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36018 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36019
36020 Reply:
36021 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36022
36023 @item vCont?
36024 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36025 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36026
36027 Reply:
36028 @table @samp
36029 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36030 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36031 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36032 @item @w{}
36033 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36034 @end table
36035
36036 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36037 @item vCtrlC
36038 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36039 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36040 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36041 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36042 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36043 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36044 variant.
36045
36046 Reply:
36047 @table @samp
36048 @item E @var{nn}
36049 for an error
36050 @item OK
36051 for success
36052 @end table
36053
36054 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36055 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36056 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36057 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36058
36059 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36060 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36061 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36062 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36063 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36064 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36065 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36066 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36067 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36068 packet is received.
36069
36070 Reply:
36071 @table @samp
36072 @item OK
36073 for success
36074 @item E @var{NN}
36075 for an error
36076 @end table
36077
36078 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36079 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36080 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36081 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36082 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36083 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36084 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36085 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36086 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36087 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36088 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36089 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36090
36091
36092 Reply:
36093 @table @samp
36094 @item OK
36095 for success
36096 @item E.memtype
36097 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36098 @item E @var{NN}
36099 for an error
36100 @end table
36101
36102 @item vFlashDone
36103 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36104 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36105 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36106 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36107 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36108 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36109 request is completed.
36110
36111 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36112 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36113 @anchor{vKill packet}
36114 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36115 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36116 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36117 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36118
36119 Reply:
36120 @table @samp
36121 @item E @var{nn}
36122 for an error
36123 @item OK
36124 for success
36125 @end table
36126
36127 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36128 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36129 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36130 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36131 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36132
36133 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36134 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36135 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36136 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36137 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36138 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36139
36140 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36141 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36142 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36143 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36144 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36145 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36146 state.
36147
36148 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36149
36150 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36151
36152 Reply:
36153 @table @samp
36154 @item E @var{nn}
36155 for an error
36156 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36157 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36158 @end table
36159
36160 @item vStopped
36161 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36162 @xref{Notification Packets}.
36163
36164 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36165 @anchor{X packet}
36166 @cindex @samp{X} packet
36167 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36168 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36169 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36170 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36171
36172 Reply:
36173 @table @samp
36174 @item OK
36175 for success
36176 @item E @var{NN}
36177 for an error
36178 @end table
36179
36180 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36181 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36182 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36183 @cindex @samp{z} packet
36184 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
36185 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36186 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36187
36188 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36189 separately.
36190
36191 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36192 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36193 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36194 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36195 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36196 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36197
36198 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36199 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36200 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36201 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36202 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36203 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36204
36205 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36206 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36207 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36208 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36209 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36210 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36211 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36212 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36213 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36214 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36215 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36216 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36217 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36218
36219 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36220 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36221
36222 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36223 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36224
36225 @table @samp
36226
36227 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36228 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36229 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36230
36231 @end table
36232
36233 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36234 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36235 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36236 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36237 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36238 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36239 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36240
36241 @table @samp
36242
36243 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36244 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36245 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36246
36247 @end table
36248
36249 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36250 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36251 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36252 target, is not defined.}
36253
36254 Reply:
36255 @table @samp
36256 @item OK
36257 success
36258 @item @w{}
36259 not supported
36260 @item E @var{NN}
36261 for an error
36262 @end table
36263
36264 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36265 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36266 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36267 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36268 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36269 address @var{addr}.
36270
36271 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36272 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36273 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36274 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36275
36276 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36277 movement.}
36278
36279 Reply:
36280 @table @samp
36281 @item OK
36282 success
36283 @item @w{}
36284 not supported
36285 @item E @var{NN}
36286 for an error
36287 @end table
36288
36289 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36290 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36291 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36292 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36293 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36294 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36295
36296 Reply:
36297 @table @samp
36298 @item OK
36299 success
36300 @item @w{}
36301 not supported
36302 @item E @var{NN}
36303 for an error
36304 @end table
36305
36306 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36307 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36308 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36309 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36310 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36311 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36312
36313 Reply:
36314 @table @samp
36315 @item OK
36316 success
36317 @item @w{}
36318 not supported
36319 @item E @var{NN}
36320 for an error
36321 @end table
36322
36323 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36324 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36325 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36326 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36327 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36328 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36329
36330 Reply:
36331 @table @samp
36332 @item OK
36333 success
36334 @item @w{}
36335 not supported
36336 @item E @var{NN}
36337 for an error
36338 @end table
36339
36340 @end table
36341
36342 @node Stop Reply Packets
36343 @section Stop Reply Packets
36344 @cindex stop reply packets
36345
36346 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36347 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36348 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36349 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36350 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36351 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36352 @value{GDBN} source code.
36353
36354 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36355 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36356 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36357
36358 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36359 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36360 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36361 components.
36362
36363 @table @samp
36364
36365 @item S @var{AA}
36366 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36367 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36368 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36369
36370 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36371 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36372 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36373 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36374 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36375 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36376 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36377 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36378
36379 @itemize @bullet
36380 @item
36381 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36382 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36383 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36384 two-digit hex number.
36385
36386 @item
36387 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36388 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36389
36390 @item
36391 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36392 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36393
36394 @item
36395 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36396 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36397 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36398 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36399
36400 @item
36401 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36402 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36403 future.
36404 @end itemize
36405
36406 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36407
36408 @table @samp
36409 @item watch
36410 @itemx rwatch
36411 @itemx awatch
36412 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36413 hex.
36414
36415 @item syscall_entry
36416 @itemx syscall_return
36417 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36418 syscall number, in hex.
36419
36420 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36421 @item library
36422 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36423 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36424 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36425
36426 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36427 @item replaylog
36428 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36429 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36430 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36431 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36432 for more information.
36433
36434 @item swbreak
36435 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36436 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36437 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36438 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36439 part must be left empty.
36440
36441 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36442 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36443 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36444 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36445 address.
36446
36447 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36448 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36449 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36450 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36451 indicating support.
36452
36453 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36454
36455 @item hwbreak
36456 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36457 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36458
36459 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36460 apply.
36461
36462 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36463 @item fork
36464 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36465 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36466 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36467 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36468 fork events.
36469
36470 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36471 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36472 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36473 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36474 indicating support.
36475
36476 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36477 @item vfork
36478 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36479 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36480 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36481 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36482 vfork events.
36483
36484 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36485 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36486 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36487 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36488 indicating support.
36489
36490 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36491 @item vforkdone
36492 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36493 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36494 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36495 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36496 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36497
36498 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36499 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36500 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36501 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36502 indicating support.
36503
36504 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36505 @item exec
36506 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36507 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36508 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36509
36510 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36511 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36512 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36513 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36514 indicating support.
36515
36516 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36517 @anchor{thread create event}
36518 @item create
36519 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36520 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36521 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36522 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36523 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36524 @var{r} part is ignored.
36525
36526 @end table
36527
36528 @item W @var{AA}
36529 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36530 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36531 applicable to certain targets.
36532
36533 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36534 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36535 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36536 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36537 hex strings.
36538
36539 @item X @var{AA}
36540 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36541 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36542
36543 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36544 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36545 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36546 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36547 hex strings.
36548
36549 @anchor{thread exit event}
36550 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36551 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36552
36553 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36554 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36555 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36556 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36557
36558 @item N
36559 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36560 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36561 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36562 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36563 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36564 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36565 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36566 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36567 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36568 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36569 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36570 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36571 support.
36572
36573 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36574 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36575 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36576 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36577 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36578
36579 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36580 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36581 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36582 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36583 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36584 system calls.
36585
36586 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36587 this very system call.
36588
36589 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36590 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36591 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36592 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36593 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36594 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36595
36596 @end table
36597
36598 @node General Query Packets
36599 @section General Query Packets
36600 @cindex remote query requests
36601
36602 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36603 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36604 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36605 sending information to and from the stub.
36606
36607 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36608 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36609 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36610 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36611 conventions:
36612
36613 @itemize @bullet
36614 @item
36615 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36616 @item
36617 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36618 letter.
36619 @item
36620 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36621 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36622 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36623 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36624 @end itemize
36625
36626 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36627 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36628 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36629 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36630 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36631 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36632 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36633 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36634 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36635 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36636 packet.}.
36637
36638 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36639 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36640 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36641 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36642 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36643
36644 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36645
36646 @table @samp
36647
36648 @item QAgent:1
36649 @itemx QAgent:0
36650 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36651 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36652
36653 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36654 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36655 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36656 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36657 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36658 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36659 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36660 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36661 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36662 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36663 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36664
36665 @item qC
36666 @cindex current thread, remote request
36667 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36668 Return the current thread ID.
36669
36670 Reply:
36671 @table @samp
36672 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36673 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36674 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36675 @item @r{(anything else)}
36676 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36677 @end table
36678
36679 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36680 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36681 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36682 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36683 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36684 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36685 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36686 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36687
36688 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36689 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36690 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36691 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36692 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36693 detect trailing zeros.
36694
36695 Reply:
36696 @table @samp
36697 @item E @var{NN}
36698 An error (such as memory fault)
36699 @item C @var{crc32}
36700 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36701 @end table
36702
36703 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36704 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36705 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36706 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36707 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36708 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36709 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36710 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36711 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36712 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36713 randomization.
36714
36715 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36716
36717 Reply:
36718 @table @samp
36719 @item OK
36720 The request succeeded.
36721
36722 @item E @var{nn}
36723 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36724
36725 @item @w{}
36726 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36727 by the stub.
36728 @end table
36729
36730 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36731 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36732 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36733 address space randomization.
36734
36735 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
36736 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
36737 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
36738 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
36739 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
36740 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
36741 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
36742 inferior using a shell or not.
36743
36744 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
36745 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
36746 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
36747 values are considered an error.
36748
36749 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36750 mode}).
36751
36752 Reply:
36753 @table @samp
36754 @item OK
36755 The request succeeded.
36756
36757 @item E @var{nn}
36758 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36759 @end table
36760
36761 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36762 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36763 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36764 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
36765
36766 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
36767 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
36768
36769 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
36770 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36771 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
36772 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
36773 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
36774 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
36775 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
36776 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
36777 environment}).
36778
36779 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36780 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
36781 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
36782 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
36783 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
36784 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
36785 not be present.
36786
36787 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36788 mode}).
36789
36790 Reply:
36791 @table @samp
36792 @item OK
36793 The request succeeded.
36794 @end table
36795
36796 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36797 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36798 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36799 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36800 inferior.
36801
36802 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
36803 @pxref{set environment}.
36804
36805 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
36806 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
36807 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
36808 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
36809 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
36810 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
36811 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
36812 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
36813
36814 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36815 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
36816
36817 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36818 mode}).
36819
36820 Reply:
36821 @table @samp
36822 @item OK
36823 The request succeeded.
36824 @end table
36825
36826 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36827 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36828 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36829 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36830 inferior.
36831
36832 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
36833 @pxref{unset environment}.
36834
36835 @item QEnvironmentReset
36836 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
36837 @cindex reset environment, remote request
36838 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
36839 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
36840 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
36841 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
36842 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
36843 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
36844 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36845 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
36846 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
36847
36848 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36849 mode}).
36850
36851 Reply:
36852 @table @samp
36853 @item OK
36854 The request succeeded.
36855 @end table
36856
36857 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36858 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36859 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36860 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36861 inferior.
36862
36863 @item qfThreadInfo
36864 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36865 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36866 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36867 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36868 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36869 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36870 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36871 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36872 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36873 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36874
36875 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36876
36877 Reply:
36878 @table @samp
36879 @item m @var{thread-id}
36880 A single thread ID
36881 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36882 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36883 @item l
36884 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36885 @end table
36886
36887 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36888 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36889 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36890 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36891 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36892 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36893 fields.
36894
36895 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36896 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36897 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36898 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36899 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36900
36901 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36902 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36903 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36904 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36905 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36906
36907 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36908 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36909
36910 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36911 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36912 information associated with the variable.)
36913
36914 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36915 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36916 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36917 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36918 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36919 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36920
36921 Reply:
36922 @table @samp
36923 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36924 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36925 local storage requested.
36926
36927 @item E @var{nn}
36928 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36929
36930 @item @w{}
36931 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36932 @end table
36933
36934 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36935 @cindex get thread information block address
36936 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36937 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36938
36939 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36940
36941 Reply:
36942 @table @samp
36943 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36944 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36945 thread information block.
36946
36947 @item E @var{nn}
36948 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36949 address could not be retrieved.
36950
36951 @item @w{}
36952 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36953 @end table
36954
36955 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36956 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36957 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36958 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36959 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36960 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36961 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36962
36963 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36964
36965 Reply:
36966 @table @samp
36967 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36968 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36969 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36970 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36971 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36972 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36973 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36974 @end table
36975
36976 @item qOffsets
36977 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36978 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36979 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36980 image.
36981
36982 Reply:
36983 @table @samp
36984 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36985 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36986 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36987 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36988 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36989 segments by the supplied offsets.
36990
36991 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36992 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36993 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36994
36995 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36996 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36997 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36998 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36999 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37000 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37001 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37002 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37003 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37004 @end table
37005
37006 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37007 @cindex thread information, remote request
37008 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
37009 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37010 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
37011 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
37012
37013 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
37014 (see below).
37015
37016 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
37017
37018 @item QNonStop:1
37019 @itemx QNonStop:0
37020 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
37021 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
37022 @anchor{QNonStop}
37023 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
37024 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
37025
37026 Reply:
37027 @table @samp
37028 @item OK
37029 The request succeeded.
37030
37031 @item E @var{nn}
37032 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37033
37034 @item @w{}
37035 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37036 the stub.
37037 @end table
37038
37039 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37040 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37041 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37042 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37043
37044 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37045 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37046 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37047 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37048 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37049 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37050 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37051
37052 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37053 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37054 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37055
37056 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37057 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37058 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37059 report the requested syscalls.
37060
37061 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37062 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37063
37064 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37065 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37066 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37067 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37068
37069 Reply:
37070 @table @samp
37071 @item OK
37072 The request succeeded.
37073
37074 @item E @var{nn}
37075 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37076
37077 @item @w{}
37078 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37079 the stub.
37080 @end table
37081
37082 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37083 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37084 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37085 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37086
37087 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37088 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37089 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37090 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37091 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37092 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37093 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37094 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37095 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37096 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37097 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37098 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37099 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37100
37101 Reply:
37102 @table @samp
37103 @item OK
37104 The request succeeded.
37105
37106 @item E @var{nn}
37107 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37108
37109 @item @w{}
37110 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37111 the stub.
37112 @end table
37113
37114 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37115 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37116 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37117 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37118
37119 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37120 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37121 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37122 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
37123 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37124 Others should be silently discarded.
37125
37126 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37127 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37128 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37129 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37130 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37131 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37132 signals.
37133
37134 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37135 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37136
37137 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37138 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37139 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37140 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37141 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37142
37143 Reply:
37144 @table @samp
37145 @item OK
37146 The request succeeded.
37147
37148 @item E @var{nn}
37149 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37150
37151 @item @w{}
37152 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37153 by the stub.
37154 @end table
37155
37156 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37157 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37158 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37159 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37160
37161 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
37162 @item QThreadEvents:1
37163 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
37164 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37165 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37166
37167 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37168 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37169 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37170 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37171 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37172 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37173 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37174 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37175 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37176 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37177
37178 Reply:
37179 @table @samp
37180 @item OK
37181 The request succeeded.
37182
37183 @item E @var{nn}
37184 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37185
37186 @item @w{}
37187 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37188 the stub.
37189 @end table
37190
37191 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37192 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37193
37194 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
37195 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
37196 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37197 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37198 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37199 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37200 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37201 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37202 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37203
37204 Reply:
37205 @table @samp
37206 @item OK
37207 A command response with no output.
37208 @item @var{OUTPUT}
37209 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37210 @item E @var{NN}
37211 Indicate a badly formed request.
37212 @item @w{}
37213 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37214 @end table
37215
37216 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37217 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37218 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37219 packets.)
37220
37221 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37222 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37223 @ifnotinfo
37224 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37225 @end ifnotinfo
37226 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37227 @anchor{qSearch memory}
37228 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37229 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37230 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37231
37232 Reply:
37233 @table @samp
37234 @item 0
37235 The pattern was not found.
37236 @item 1,address
37237 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37238 @item E @var{NN}
37239 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37240 @item @w{}
37241 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37242 @end table
37243
37244 @item QStartNoAckMode
37245 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37246 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37247 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37248 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37249
37250 Reply:
37251 @table @samp
37252 @item OK
37253 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37254 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37255 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37256 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37257 @item @w{}
37258 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37259 @end table
37260
37261 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37262 @cindex supported packets, remote query
37263 @cindex features of the remote protocol
37264 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37265 @anchor{qSupported}
37266 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37267 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37268 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37269 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37270 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37271 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37272 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37273 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37274 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37275 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37276 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37277 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37278 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37279 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37280
37281 Reply:
37282 @table @samp
37283 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37284 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37285 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37286 possible forms).
37287 @item @w{}
37288 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37289 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37290 @end table
37291
37292 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37293 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37294 are:
37295
37296 @table @samp
37297 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37298 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37299 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37300 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37301 @item @var{name}+
37302 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37303 need an associated value.
37304 @item @var{name}-
37305 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37306 @item @var{name}?
37307 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37308 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37309 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37310 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37311 @end table
37312
37313 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37314 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37315 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37316 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37317 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37318
37319 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37320 are defined:
37321
37322 @table @samp
37323 @item multiprocess
37324 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37325 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37326 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37327 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37328 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37329
37330 @item xmlRegisters
37331 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37332 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37333 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37334 description.
37335
37336 @item qRelocInsn
37337 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37338 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37339 instruction reply packet}).
37340
37341 @item swbreak
37342 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37343 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37344
37345 @item hwbreak
37346 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37347 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37348
37349 @item fork-events
37350 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37351 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37352 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37353 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37354
37355 @item vfork-events
37356 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37357 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37358 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37359 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37360
37361 @item exec-events
37362 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37363 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37364 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37365 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37366
37367 @item vContSupported
37368 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37369 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37370 @end table
37371
37372 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37373 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37374 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37375 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37376 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37377 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37378 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37379 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37380 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37381 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37382 all the features it supports.
37383
37384 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37385 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37386
37387 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37388 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37389 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37390 form response.
37391
37392 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37393 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37394 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37395 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37396
37397 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37398 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37399 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37400 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37401 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37402
37403 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37404
37405 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37406 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37407 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37408 @item Feature Name
37409 @tab Value Required
37410 @tab Default
37411 @tab Probe Allowed
37412
37413 @item @samp{PacketSize}
37414 @tab Yes
37415 @tab @samp{-}
37416 @tab No
37417
37418 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37419 @tab No
37420 @tab @samp{-}
37421 @tab Yes
37422
37423 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37424 @tab No
37425 @tab @samp{-}
37426 @tab Yes
37427
37428 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37429 @tab No
37430 @tab @samp{-}
37431 @tab Yes
37432
37433 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37434 @tab No
37435 @tab @samp{-}
37436 @tab Yes
37437
37438 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37439 @tab No
37440 @tab @samp{-}
37441 @tab Yes
37442
37443 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37444 @tab No
37445 @tab @samp{-}
37446 @tab Yes
37447
37448 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37449 @tab No
37450 @tab @samp{-}
37451 @tab Yes
37452
37453 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37454 @tab No
37455 @tab @samp{-}
37456 @tab No
37457
37458 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37459 @tab No
37460 @tab @samp{-}
37461 @tab Yes
37462
37463 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37464 @tab No
37465 @tab @samp{-}
37466 @tab Yes
37467
37468 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37469 @tab No
37470 @tab @samp{-}
37471 @tab Yes
37472
37473 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37474 @tab No
37475 @tab @samp{-}
37476 @tab Yes
37477
37478 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37479 @tab No
37480 @tab @samp{-}
37481 @tab Yes
37482
37483 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37484 @tab No
37485 @tab @samp{-}
37486 @tab Yes
37487
37488 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37489 @tab No
37490 @tab @samp{-}
37491 @tab Yes
37492
37493 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37494 @tab No
37495 @tab @samp{-}
37496 @tab Yes
37497
37498 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37499 @tab No
37500 @tab @samp{-}
37501 @tab Yes
37502
37503 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37504 @tab No
37505 @tab @samp{-}
37506 @tab Yes
37507
37508 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37509 @tab Yes
37510 @tab @samp{-}
37511 @tab Yes
37512
37513 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37514 @tab Yes
37515 @tab @samp{-}
37516 @tab Yes
37517
37518 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37519 @tab Yes
37520 @tab @samp{-}
37521 @tab Yes
37522
37523 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37524 @tab Yes
37525 @tab @samp{-}
37526 @tab Yes
37527
37528 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37529 @tab Yes
37530 @tab @samp{-}
37531 @tab Yes
37532
37533 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37534 @tab No
37535 @tab @samp{-}
37536 @tab Yes
37537
37538 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37539 @tab No
37540 @tab @samp{-}
37541 @tab Yes
37542
37543 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37544 @tab No
37545 @tab @samp{-}
37546 @tab Yes
37547
37548 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37549 @tab No
37550 @tab @samp{-}
37551 @tab Yes
37552
37553 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37554 @tab No
37555 @tab @samp{-}
37556 @tab No
37557
37558 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37559 @tab No
37560 @tab @samp{-}
37561 @tab No
37562
37563 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37564 @tab No
37565 @tab @samp{-}
37566 @tab No
37567
37568 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37569 @tab No
37570 @tab @samp{-}
37571 @tab No
37572
37573 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37574 @tab No
37575 @tab @samp{-}
37576 @tab No
37577
37578 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37579 @tab No
37580 @tab @samp{-}
37581 @tab No
37582
37583 @item @samp{QAgent}
37584 @tab No
37585 @tab @samp{-}
37586 @tab No
37587
37588 @item @samp{QAllow}
37589 @tab No
37590 @tab @samp{-}
37591 @tab No
37592
37593 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37594 @tab No
37595 @tab @samp{-}
37596 @tab No
37597
37598 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37599 @tab No
37600 @tab @samp{-}
37601 @tab No
37602
37603 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37604 @tab No
37605 @tab @samp{-}
37606 @tab No
37607
37608 @item @samp{tracenz}
37609 @tab No
37610 @tab @samp{-}
37611 @tab No
37612
37613 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37614 @tab No
37615 @tab @samp{-}
37616 @tab No
37617
37618 @item @samp{swbreak}
37619 @tab No
37620 @tab @samp{-}
37621 @tab No
37622
37623 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37624 @tab No
37625 @tab @samp{-}
37626 @tab No
37627
37628 @item @samp{fork-events}
37629 @tab No
37630 @tab @samp{-}
37631 @tab No
37632
37633 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37634 @tab No
37635 @tab @samp{-}
37636 @tab No
37637
37638 @item @samp{exec-events}
37639 @tab No
37640 @tab @samp{-}
37641 @tab No
37642
37643 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37644 @tab No
37645 @tab @samp{-}
37646 @tab No
37647
37648 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37649 @tab No
37650 @tab @samp{-}
37651 @tab No
37652
37653 @end multitable
37654
37655 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37656
37657 @table @samp
37658 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37659 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37660 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37661 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37662 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37663 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37664 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37665 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37666 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37667 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37668
37669 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37670 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37671 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37672
37673 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37674 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37675 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37676
37677 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37678 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37679 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37680
37681 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37682 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37683 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37684
37685 @item qXfer:features:read
37686 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37687 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37688
37689 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37690 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37691 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37692
37693 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37694 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37695 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37696
37697 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37698 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37699 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37700 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37701
37702 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37703 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37704 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37705
37706 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37707 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37708 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37709
37710 @item qXfer:spu:read
37711 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37712 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37713
37714 @item qXfer:spu:write
37715 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37716 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37717
37718 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37719 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37720 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37721
37722 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37723 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37724 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37725
37726 @item qXfer:threads:read
37727 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37728 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37729
37730 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37731 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37732 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37733
37734 @item qXfer:uib:read
37735 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37736 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37737
37738 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37739 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37740 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37741
37742 @item QNonStop
37743 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37744 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37745
37746 @item QCatchSyscalls
37747 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37748 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37749
37750 @item QPassSignals
37751 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37752 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37753
37754 @item QStartNoAckMode
37755 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37756 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37757
37758 @item multiprocess
37759 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37760 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37761 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37762 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37763 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37764 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37765 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37766 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37767 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37768 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37769 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37770
37771 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37772 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37773 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37774
37775 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37776 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37777 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37778 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37779
37780 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37781 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37782 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37783
37784 @item ReverseContinue
37785 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37786 (@pxref{bc}).
37787
37788 @item ReverseStep
37789 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37790 (@pxref{bs}).
37791
37792 @item TracepointSource
37793 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37794 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37795
37796 @item QAgent
37797 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37798
37799 @item QAllow
37800 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37801
37802 @item QDisableRandomization
37803 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37804
37805 @item StaticTracepoint
37806 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37807 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37808
37809 @item InstallInTrace
37810 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37811 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37812
37813 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37814 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37815 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37816 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37817
37818 @item QTBuffer:size
37819 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37820 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37821
37822 @item tracenz
37823 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37824 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37825 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37826
37827 @item BreakpointCommands
37828 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37829 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37830 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37831
37832 @item Qbtrace:off
37833 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37834
37835 @item Qbtrace:bts
37836 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37837
37838 @item Qbtrace:pt
37839 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37840
37841 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37842 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37843
37844 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37845 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37846
37847 @item swbreak
37848 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37849 breakpoints.
37850
37851 @item hwbreak
37852 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37853 breakpoints.
37854
37855 @item fork-events
37856 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37857
37858 @item vfork-events
37859 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37860 and vforkdone events.
37861
37862 @item exec-events
37863 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37864
37865 @item vContSupported
37866 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37867 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37868
37869 @item QThreadEvents
37870 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37871
37872 @item no-resumed
37873 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37874
37875 @end table
37876
37877 @item qSymbol::
37878 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37879 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37880 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37881 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37882
37883 Reply:
37884 @table @samp
37885 @item OK
37886 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37887 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37888 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37889 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37890 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37891 below.
37892 @end table
37893
37894 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37895 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37896
37897 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37898 target has previously requested.
37899
37900 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37901 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37902 will be empty.
37903
37904 Reply:
37905 @table @samp
37906 @item OK
37907 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37908 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37909 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37910 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37911 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37912 @end table
37913
37914 @item qTBuffer
37915 @itemx QTBuffer
37916 @itemx QTDisconnected
37917 @itemx QTDP
37918 @itemx QTDPsrc
37919 @itemx QTDV
37920 @itemx qTfP
37921 @itemx qTfV
37922 @itemx QTFrame
37923 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37924
37925 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37926
37927 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37928 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37929 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37930 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37931 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37932 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37933 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37934 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37935 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37936 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37937 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37938
37939 Reply:
37940 @table @samp
37941 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37942 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37943 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37944 the thread's attributes.
37945 @end table
37946
37947 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37948 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37949 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37950 packets.)
37951
37952 @item QTNotes
37953 @itemx qTP
37954 @itemx QTSave
37955 @itemx qTsP
37956 @itemx qTsV
37957 @itemx QTStart
37958 @itemx QTStop
37959 @itemx QTEnable
37960 @itemx QTDisable
37961 @itemx QTinit
37962 @itemx QTro
37963 @itemx qTStatus
37964 @itemx qTV
37965 @itemx qTfSTM
37966 @itemx qTsSTM
37967 @itemx qTSTMat
37968 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37969
37970 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37971 @cindex read special object, remote request
37972 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37973 @anchor{qXfer read}
37974 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37975 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37976 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37977 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37978 additional details about what data to access.
37979
37980 Reply:
37981 @table @samp
37982 @item m @var{data}
37983 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37984 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37985 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37986 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37987 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37988 request.
37989
37990 @item l @var{data}
37991 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37992 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37993 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37994
37995 @item l
37996 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37997 There is no more data to be read.
37998
37999 @item E00
38000 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38001
38002 @item E @var{nn}
38003 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38004 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38005
38006 @item @w{}
38007 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38008 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38009 @end table
38010
38011 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38012 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38013 formats, listed above.
38014
38015 @table @samp
38016 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38017 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
38018 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
38019 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
38020
38021 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38022 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38023
38024 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38025 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
38026
38027 Return a description of the current branch trace.
38028 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38029 packet may have one of the following values:
38030
38031 @table @code
38032 @item all
38033 Returns all available branch trace.
38034
38035 @item new
38036 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38037 the last read request.
38038
38039 @item delta
38040 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38041 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38042 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38043 used to stitch traces together.
38044
38045 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38046 @end table
38047
38048 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38049 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38050
38051 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38052 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38053
38054 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38055 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38056
38057 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38058 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38059
38060 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38061 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38062 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38063 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38064 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38065 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38066 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38067
38068 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38069 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38070
38071 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38072 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38073 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38074 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38075 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38076
38077 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38078 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38079
38080 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38081 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38082 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38083 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38084 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38085
38086 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38087 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38088 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38089
38090 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38091 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38092
38093 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38094 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38095 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38096 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38097 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38098 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38099 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38100 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38101
38102 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38103 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38104
38105 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38106 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38107
38108 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38109 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38110 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38111 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38112
38113 @table @code
38114 @item start=@var{address}
38115 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38116 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38117 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38118 chosen as the starting point.
38119
38120 @item prev=@var{address}
38121 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38122 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38123 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38124 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38125 exists prior to the starting point.
38126
38127 @end table
38128
38129 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38130 ignored.
38131
38132 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38133 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38134 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38135 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38136 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38137
38138 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38139 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38140
38141 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38142 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38143
38144 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38145 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38146 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38147 Action Lists}.
38148
38149 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38150 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38151 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38152
38153 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38154 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38155 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38156 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38157 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38158
38159 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38160 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38161 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38162
38163 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38164 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
38165 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38166 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38167 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38168 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38169 in that context to be accessed.
38170
38171 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38172 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38173 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38174
38175 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38176 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
38177 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38178 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38179 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38180
38181 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38182 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38183
38184 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38185 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38186
38187 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38188 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38189 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38190
38191 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38192 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38193
38194 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38195 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38196
38197 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38198 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38199
38200 This packet is not probed by default.
38201
38202 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38203 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38204 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38205 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38206 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38207
38208 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38209 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38210
38211 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38212 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38213 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38214 @xref{Operating System Information}.
38215
38216 @end table
38217
38218 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38219 @cindex write data into object, remote request
38220 @anchor{qXfer write}
38221 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38222 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38223 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38224 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38225 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38226 to access.
38227
38228 Reply:
38229 @table @samp
38230 @item @var{nn}
38231 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38232 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38233
38234 @item E00
38235 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38236
38237 @item E @var{nn}
38238 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38239 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38240
38241 @item @w{}
38242 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38243 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38244 @end table
38245
38246 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38247 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38248 formats, listed above.
38249
38250 @table @samp
38251 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38252 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38253 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38254 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38255 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38256
38257 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38258 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38259 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38260
38261 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38262 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
38263 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38264 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38265 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38266 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38267 in that context to be accessed.
38268
38269 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38270 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38271 @end table
38272
38273 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38274 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38275 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38276 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38277 must respond with an empty packet.
38278
38279 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38280 @cindex query attached, remote request
38281 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38282 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38283 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38284 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38285 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38286 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38287 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38288
38289 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38290 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38291 the @code{quit} command.
38292
38293 Reply:
38294 @table @samp
38295 @item 1
38296 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38297 @item 0
38298 The remote server created a new process.
38299 @item E @var{NN}
38300 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38301 @end table
38302
38303 @item Qbtrace:bts
38304 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38305
38306 Reply:
38307 @table @samp
38308 @item OK
38309 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38310 @item E.errtext
38311 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38312 @end table
38313
38314 @item Qbtrace:pt
38315 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38316
38317 Reply:
38318 @table @samp
38319 @item OK
38320 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38321 @item E.errtext
38322 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38323 @end table
38324
38325 @item Qbtrace:off
38326 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38327
38328 Reply:
38329 @table @samp
38330 @item OK
38331 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38332 @item E.errtext
38333 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38334 @end table
38335
38336 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38337 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38338 btrace recording method in bts format.
38339
38340 Reply:
38341 @table @samp
38342 @item OK
38343 The ring buffer size has been set.
38344 @item E.errtext
38345 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38346 @end table
38347
38348 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38349 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38350 btrace recording method in pt format.
38351
38352 Reply:
38353 @table @samp
38354 @item OK
38355 The ring buffer size has been set.
38356 @item E.errtext
38357 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38358 @end table
38359
38360 @end table
38361
38362 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38363 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38364
38365 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38366 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38367 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38368
38369 @menu
38370 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38371 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38372 @end menu
38373
38374 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38375 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38376
38377 @menu
38378 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38379 @end menu
38380
38381 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38382 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38383 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38384
38385 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38386
38387 @table @r
38388
38389 @item 2
38390 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38391
38392 @item 3
38393 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38394
38395 @item 4
38396 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38397
38398 @end table
38399
38400 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38401 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38402
38403 @menu
38404 * MIPS Register packet Format::
38405 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38406 @end menu
38407
38408 @node MIPS Register packet Format
38409 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38410 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38411
38412 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38413 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38414 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38415 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38416 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38417 most-significant -- least-significant.
38418
38419 @table @r
38420
38421 @item MIPS32
38422 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38423 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38424 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38425
38426 @item MIPS64
38427 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38428 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38429 as @code{MIPS32}.
38430
38431 @end table
38432
38433 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38434 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38435 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38436
38437 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38438
38439 @table @r
38440
38441 @item 2
38442 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38443
38444 @item 3
38445 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38446
38447 @item 4
38448 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38449
38450 @item 5
38451 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38452
38453 @end table
38454
38455 @node Tracepoint Packets
38456 @section Tracepoint Packets
38457 @cindex tracepoint packets
38458 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38459
38460 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38461 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38462
38463 @table @samp
38464
38465 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38466 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38467 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38468 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38469 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38470 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38471 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38472 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38473 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38474 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38475 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38476 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38477 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38478 actions.
38479
38480 Replies:
38481 @table @samp
38482 @item OK
38483 The packet was understood and carried out.
38484 @item qRelocInsn
38485 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38486 @item @w{}
38487 The packet was not recognized.
38488 @end table
38489
38490 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38491 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38492 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38493 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38494 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38495 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38496 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38497
38498 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38499 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38500 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38501 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38502 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38503 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38504 tracepoint actions.
38505
38506 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38507 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38508 following forms:
38509
38510 @table @samp
38511
38512 @item R @var{mask}
38513 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38514 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38515 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38516 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38517 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38518
38519 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38520 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38521 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38522 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38523 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38524 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38525 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38526
38527 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38528 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38529 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38530 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38531 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38532 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38533 packet).
38534
38535 @end table
38536
38537 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38538 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38539 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38540 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38541 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38542 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38543 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38544 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38545
38546 Replies:
38547 @table @samp
38548 @item OK
38549 The packet was understood and carried out.
38550 @item qRelocInsn
38551 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38552 @item @w{}
38553 The packet was not recognized.
38554 @end table
38555
38556 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38557 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38558 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38559 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38560 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38561 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38562 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38563 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38564
38565 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38566 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38567 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38568 fit in a single packet.
38569 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38570 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38571
38572 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38573 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38574 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38575 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38576
38577 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38578 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38579 query packets.
38580
38581 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38582 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38583 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38584 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38585 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38586 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38587 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38588 be found.
38589
38590 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38591 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38592 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38593 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38594 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38595 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38596 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38597 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38598 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38599 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38600 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38601 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38602 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38603 variable.
38604
38605 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38606 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38607 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38608 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38609 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38610
38611 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38612 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38613 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38614 one of the following forms:
38615
38616 @table @samp
38617 @item F @var{f}
38618 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38619 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38620 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38621
38622 @item T @var{t}
38623 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38624 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38625
38626 @end table
38627
38628 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38629 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38630 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38631 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38632
38633 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38634 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38635 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38636 is a hexadecimal number.
38637
38638 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38639 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38640 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38641 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38642 numbers.
38643
38644 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38645 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38646 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38647
38648 @item qTMinFTPILen
38649 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38650 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38651 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38652 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38653 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38654 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38655 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38656 arrange for that.
38657
38658 Replies:
38659
38660 @table @samp
38661 @item 0
38662 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38663 @item @var{length}
38664 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38665 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38666 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38667 regardless of size.
38668 @item E
38669 An error has occurred.
38670 @item @w{}
38671 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38672 @end table
38673
38674 @item QTStart
38675 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38676 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38677 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38678 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38679 instruction reply packet}).
38680
38681 @item QTStop
38682 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38683 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38684
38685 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38686 @anchor{QTEnable}
38687 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38688 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38689 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38690 of data from it will resume.
38691
38692 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38693 @anchor{QTDisable}
38694 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38695 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38696 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38697 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38698
38699 @item QTinit
38700 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38701 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38702
38703 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38704 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38705 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38706 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38707 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38708
38709 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38710 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38711 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38712 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38713
38714 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38715 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38716 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38717 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38718 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38719 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38720
38721 @item qTStatus
38722 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38723 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38724
38725 The reply has the form:
38726
38727 @table @samp
38728
38729 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38730 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38731 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38732 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38733
38734 @end table
38735
38736 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38737 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38738
38739 @table @samp
38740
38741 @item tnotrun:0
38742 No trace has been run yet.
38743
38744 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38745 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38746 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38747 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38748 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38749
38750 @item tfull:0
38751 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38752
38753 @item tdisconnected:0
38754 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38755
38756 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38757 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38758
38759 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38760 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38761 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38762 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38763 is hex encoded.
38764
38765 @item tunknown:0
38766 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38767
38768 @end table
38769
38770 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38771 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38772 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38773 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38774 trace.
38775
38776 @table @samp
38777
38778 @item tframes:@var{n}
38779 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38780
38781 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38782 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38783 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38784
38785 @item tsize:@var{n}
38786 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38787
38788 @item tfree:@var{n}
38789 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38790
38791 @item circular:@var{n}
38792 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38793 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38794 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38795 and may fill up.
38796
38797 @item disconn:@var{n}
38798 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38799 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38800 that the trace run will stop.
38801
38802 @end table
38803
38804 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38805 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38806 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38807 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38808 address @var{addr}.
38809
38810 Replies:
38811 @table @samp
38812 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38813 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38814 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38815 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38816 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38817
38818 @end table
38819
38820 @item qTV:@var{var}
38821 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38822 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38823 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38824
38825 Replies:
38826 @table @samp
38827 @item V@var{value}
38828 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38829 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38830 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38831 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38832 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38833 program is running.
38834
38835 @item U
38836 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38837 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38838 was not collected.
38839 @end table
38840
38841 @item qTfP
38842 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38843 @itemx qTsP
38844 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38845 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38846 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38847 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38848 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38849 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38850
38851 @item qTfV
38852 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38853 @itemx qTsV
38854 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38855 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38856 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38857 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38858 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38859 trace state variables.
38860
38861 @item qTfSTM
38862 @itemx qTsSTM
38863 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38864 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38865 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38866 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38867 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38868 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38869 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38870 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38871
38872 Reply:
38873 @table @samp
38874 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38875 A single marker
38876 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38877 a comma-separated list of markers
38878 @item l
38879 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38880 @item E @var{nn}
38881 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38882 @item @w{}
38883 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38884 stub.
38885 @end table
38886
38887 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38888 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38889
38890 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38891 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38892 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38893 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38894 @dfn{last}).
38895
38896 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38897 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38898 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38899 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38900 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38901 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38902 tracepoint markers.
38903
38904 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38905 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38906 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38907 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38908 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38909 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38910
38911 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38912 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38913 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38914 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38915 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38916 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38917 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38918 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38919 available.
38920
38921 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38922 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38923 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38924
38925 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38926 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38927 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38928 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38929 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38930 use whatever size it prefers.
38931
38932 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38933 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38934 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38935 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38936 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38937
38938 @end table
38939
38940 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38941 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38942 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38943 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38944 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38945 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38946 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38947 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38948 it had executed in the original location.
38949
38950 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38951 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38952 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38953 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38954 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38955 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38956 format of the request is:
38957
38958 @table @samp
38959 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38960
38961 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38962 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38963 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38964 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38965 memory starting at @var{to}.
38966 @end table
38967
38968 Replies:
38969 @table @samp
38970 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38971 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38972 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38973 @item E @var{NN}
38974 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38975 relocating the instruction.
38976 @end table
38977
38978 @node Host I/O Packets
38979 @section Host I/O Packets
38980 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38981 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38982
38983 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38984 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38985 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38986 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38987 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38988 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38989 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38990 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38991 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38992 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38993
38994 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38995 its arguments. They have this format:
38996
38997 @table @samp
38998
38999 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39000 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39001 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39002 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39003 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39004 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39005 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39006 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39007 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39008
39009 @end table
39010
39011 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39012
39013 @table @samp
39014
39015 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39016 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39017 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39018 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
39019 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39020 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39021 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39022 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39023 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39024 @var{attachment}.
39025
39026 @item @w{}
39027 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39028
39029 @end table
39030
39031 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39032
39033 @table @samp
39034 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39035 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39036 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39037 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39038 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39039 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39040 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39041
39042 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39043 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39044 -1 if an error occurs.
39045
39046 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39047 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39048 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39049 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39050 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39051 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39052 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39053 @var{count} was zero.
39054
39055 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39056 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39057 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39058 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39059 some characters were escaped.
39060
39061 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39062 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39063 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39064 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39065 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39066 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39067 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39068 error occurred.
39069
39070 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39071 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39072 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39073 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39074 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39075 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39076
39077 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39078 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39079 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39080
39081 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39082 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39083 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39084
39085 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39086 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39087 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39088 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39089 some characters were escaped.
39090
39091 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39092 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39093 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39094 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39095 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39096 inferior(s).
39097
39098 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39099 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39100 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39101 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39102 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39103 operation.
39104
39105 @end table
39106
39107 @node Interrupts
39108 @section Interrupts
39109 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39110 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39111
39112 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39113 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39114 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39115 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39116
39117 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39118 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39119 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39120 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39121 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39122
39123 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39124 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39125 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39126 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39127 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39128 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39129 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39130 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39131
39132 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39133 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39134 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39135
39136 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39137 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39138 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39139 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39140 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39141 @code{0x03}.
39142
39143 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39144 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39145 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39146 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39147 currently-executing threads and processes.
39148 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39149 running program, it should send one of the stop
39150 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39151 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39152 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39153 Interrupts received while the
39154 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39155 it is resumed next time.
39156
39157 @node Notification Packets
39158 @section Notification Packets
39159 @cindex notification packets
39160 @cindex packets, notification
39161
39162 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39163 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39164 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39165 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39166 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39167 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39168 is not a problem.
39169
39170 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39171 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39172 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39173 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39174 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39175 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39176 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39177
39178 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39179 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39180
39181 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39182 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39183 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39184 not they understand it.
39185
39186 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39187 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39188 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39189 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39190 recipients.
39191
39192 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39193 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39194 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39195 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39196 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39197
39198 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39199 @table @samp
39200 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
39201 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39202 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39203 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39204 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39205 @item @var{ack}
39206 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39207 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39208 @end table
39209
39210 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39211 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39212
39213 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39214 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39215 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39216 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39217 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39218 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39219 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39220 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39221 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39222 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39223
39224 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39225 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39226 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39227 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39228 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39229 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39230
39231 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39232 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39233 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39234 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39235 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39236
39237 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39238 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39239 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39240 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39241 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39242 normally.
39243
39244 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39245 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39246 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39247 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39248 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39249 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39250 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39251 the process shall be repeated.
39252
39253 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39254 following example:
39255 @smallexample
39256 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39257 @code{...}
39258 -> @code{vStopped}
39259 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39260 -> @code{vStopped}
39261 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39262 -> @code{vStopped}
39263 <- @code{OK}
39264 @end smallexample
39265
39266 The following notifications are defined:
39267 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39268
39269 @item Notification
39270 @tab Ack
39271 @tab Event
39272 @tab Description
39273
39274 @item Stop
39275 @tab vStopped
39276 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39277 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39278 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39279 @value{GDBN}.
39280 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39281
39282 @end multitable
39283
39284 @node Remote Non-Stop
39285 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39286
39287 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39288 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39289 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39290 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39291
39292 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39293 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39294 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39295 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39296 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39297 probe the target state after a mode change.
39298
39299 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39300 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39301 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39302 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39303 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39304 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39305 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39306 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39307 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39308 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39309 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39310
39311 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39312 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39313 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39314 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39315 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39316 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39317 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39318 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39319 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39320 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39321 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39322 @samp{OK}.
39323
39324 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39325 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39326 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39327 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39328 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39329 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39330 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39331 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39332 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39333 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39334 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39335 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39336 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39337
39338 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39339 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39340
39341 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39342 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39343 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39344 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39345 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39346 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39347 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39348
39349 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39350 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39351 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39352 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39353 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39354
39355 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39356 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39357 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39358 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39359
39360 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39361 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39362 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39363 @pxref{qSupported}.
39364 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39365 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39366 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39367 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39368 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39369 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39370 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39371
39372 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39373 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39374 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39375 connection.
39376 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39377 new connection is established,
39378 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39379 for the current connection, once disabled.
39380
39381 @node Examples
39382 @section Examples
39383
39384 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39385 does not get any direct output:
39386
39387 @smallexample
39388 -> @code{R00}
39389 <- @code{+}
39390 @emph{target restarts}
39391 -> @code{?}
39392 <- @code{+}
39393 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39394 -> @code{+}
39395 @end smallexample
39396
39397 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39398
39399 @smallexample
39400 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39401 <- @code{+}
39402 -> @code{s}
39403 <- @code{+}
39404 @emph{time passes}
39405 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39406 -> @code{+}
39407 -> @code{g}
39408 <- @code{+}
39409 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
39410 -> @code{+}
39411 @end smallexample
39412
39413 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39414 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39415 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39416
39417 @menu
39418 * File-I/O Overview::
39419 * Protocol Basics::
39420 * The F Request Packet::
39421 * The F Reply Packet::
39422 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39423 * Console I/O::
39424 * List of Supported Calls::
39425 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39426 * Constants::
39427 * File-I/O Examples::
39428 @end menu
39429
39430 @node File-I/O Overview
39431 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39432 @cindex file-i/o overview
39433
39434 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39435 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39436 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39437 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39438 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39439 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39440
39441 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39442 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39443 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39444 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39445 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39446
39447 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39448 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39449 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39450 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39451 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39452 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39453 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39454
39455 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39456 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39457 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39458 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39459 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39460
39461 @smallexample
39462 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39463 <- target requests 'system call X'
39464 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39465 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39466 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39467 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39468 @end smallexample
39469
39470 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39471 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39472 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39473 system are not supported by this protocol.
39474
39475 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39476
39477 @node Protocol Basics
39478 @subsection Protocol Basics
39479 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39480
39481 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39482 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39483 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39484 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39485 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39486 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39487 to call the appropriate host system call:
39488
39489 @itemize @bullet
39490 @item
39491 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39492
39493 @item
39494 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39495 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39496 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39497 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39498
39499 @end itemize
39500
39501 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39502
39503 @itemize @bullet
39504 @item
39505 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39506 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39507 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39508 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39509 packet.
39510
39511 @item
39512 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39513 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39514
39515 @item
39516 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39517
39518 @item
39519 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39520
39521 @item
39522 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39523 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39524 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39525 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39526 packet.
39527
39528 @end itemize
39529
39530 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39531 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39532
39533 @itemize @bullet
39534 @item
39535 Return value.
39536
39537 @item
39538 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39539
39540 @item
39541 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39542
39543 @end itemize
39544
39545 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39546 the latest continue or step action.
39547
39548 @node The F Request Packet
39549 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39550 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39551 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39552
39553 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39554
39555 @table @samp
39556 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39557
39558 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39559 This is just the name of the function.
39560
39561 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39562 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39563 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39564 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39565 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39566 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39567 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39568
39569 @end table
39570
39571
39572
39573 @node The F Reply Packet
39574 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39575 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39576 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39577
39578 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39579
39580 @table @samp
39581
39582 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39583
39584 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39585
39586 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39587 representation.
39588 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39589
39590 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39591 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39592 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39593
39594 @smallexample
39595 F0,0,C
39596 @end smallexample
39597
39598 @noindent
39599 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39600
39601 @smallexample
39602 F-1,4,C
39603 @end smallexample
39604
39605 @noindent
39606 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39607
39608 @end table
39609
39610
39611 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39612 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39613 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39614
39615 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39616 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39617 the target should behave as if it had
39618 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39619 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39620 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39621 packet.
39622
39623 It's important for the target to know in which
39624 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39625
39626 @itemize @bullet
39627 @item
39628 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39629
39630 @item
39631 The system call on the host has been finished.
39632
39633 @end itemize
39634
39635 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39636 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39637 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39638 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39639 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39640 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39641
39642 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39643 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39644 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39645 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39646 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39647 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39648 or the full action has been completed.
39649
39650 @node Console I/O
39651 @subsection Console I/O
39652 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39653
39654 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39655 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39656 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39657 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39658 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39659 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39660 conditions is met:
39661
39662 @itemize @bullet
39663 @item
39664 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39665 @code{read}
39666 system call is treated as finished.
39667
39668 @item
39669 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39670 newline.
39671
39672 @item
39673 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39674 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39675
39676 @end itemize
39677
39678 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39679 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39680 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39681 is stopped at the user's request.
39682
39683
39684 @node List of Supported Calls
39685 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39686 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39687
39688 @menu
39689 * open::
39690 * close::
39691 * read::
39692 * write::
39693 * lseek::
39694 * rename::
39695 * unlink::
39696 * stat/fstat::
39697 * gettimeofday::
39698 * isatty::
39699 * system::
39700 @end menu
39701
39702 @node open
39703 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39704 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39705
39706 @table @asis
39707 @item Synopsis:
39708 @smallexample
39709 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39710 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39711 @end smallexample
39712
39713 @item Request:
39714 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39715
39716 @noindent
39717 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39718
39719 @table @code
39720 @item O_CREAT
39721 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39722 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39723 are concerned.
39724
39725 @item O_EXCL
39726 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39727 an error and open() fails.
39728
39729 @item O_TRUNC
39730 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39731 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39732 truncated to zero length.
39733
39734 @item O_APPEND
39735 The file is opened in append mode.
39736
39737 @item O_RDONLY
39738 The file is opened for reading only.
39739
39740 @item O_WRONLY
39741 The file is opened for writing only.
39742
39743 @item O_RDWR
39744 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39745 @end table
39746
39747 @noindent
39748 Other bits are silently ignored.
39749
39750
39751 @noindent
39752 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39753
39754 @table @code
39755 @item S_IRUSR
39756 User has read permission.
39757
39758 @item S_IWUSR
39759 User has write permission.
39760
39761 @item S_IRGRP
39762 Group has read permission.
39763
39764 @item S_IWGRP
39765 Group has write permission.
39766
39767 @item S_IROTH
39768 Others have read permission.
39769
39770 @item S_IWOTH
39771 Others have write permission.
39772 @end table
39773
39774 @noindent
39775 Other bits are silently ignored.
39776
39777
39778 @item Return value:
39779 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39780 occurred.
39781
39782 @item Errors:
39783
39784 @table @code
39785 @item EEXIST
39786 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39787
39788 @item EISDIR
39789 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39790
39791 @item EACCES
39792 The requested access is not allowed.
39793
39794 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39795 @var{pathname} was too long.
39796
39797 @item ENOENT
39798 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39799
39800 @item ENODEV
39801 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39802
39803 @item EROFS
39804 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39805 write access was requested.
39806
39807 @item EFAULT
39808 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39809
39810 @item ENOSPC
39811 No space on device to create the file.
39812
39813 @item EMFILE
39814 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39815
39816 @item ENFILE
39817 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39818 has been reached.
39819
39820 @item EINTR
39821 The call was interrupted by the user.
39822 @end table
39823
39824 @end table
39825
39826 @node close
39827 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39828 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39829
39830 @table @asis
39831 @item Synopsis:
39832 @smallexample
39833 int close(int fd);
39834 @end smallexample
39835
39836 @item Request:
39837 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39838
39839 @item Return value:
39840 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39841
39842 @item Errors:
39843
39844 @table @code
39845 @item EBADF
39846 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39847
39848 @item EINTR
39849 The call was interrupted by the user.
39850 @end table
39851
39852 @end table
39853
39854 @node read
39855 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39856 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39857
39858 @table @asis
39859 @item Synopsis:
39860 @smallexample
39861 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39862 @end smallexample
39863
39864 @item Request:
39865 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39866
39867 @item Return value:
39868 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39869 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39870 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39871
39872 @item Errors:
39873
39874 @table @code
39875 @item EBADF
39876 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39877 reading.
39878
39879 @item EFAULT
39880 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39881
39882 @item EINTR
39883 The call was interrupted by the user.
39884 @end table
39885
39886 @end table
39887
39888 @node write
39889 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39890 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39891
39892 @table @asis
39893 @item Synopsis:
39894 @smallexample
39895 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39896 @end smallexample
39897
39898 @item Request:
39899 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39900
39901 @item Return value:
39902 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39903 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39904 is returned.
39905
39906 @item Errors:
39907
39908 @table @code
39909 @item EBADF
39910 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39911 writing.
39912
39913 @item EFAULT
39914 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39915
39916 @item EFBIG
39917 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39918 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39919
39920 @item ENOSPC
39921 No space on device to write the data.
39922
39923 @item EINTR
39924 The call was interrupted by the user.
39925 @end table
39926
39927 @end table
39928
39929 @node lseek
39930 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39931 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39932
39933 @table @asis
39934 @item Synopsis:
39935 @smallexample
39936 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39937 @end smallexample
39938
39939 @item Request:
39940 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39941
39942 @var{flag} is one of:
39943
39944 @table @code
39945 @item SEEK_SET
39946 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39947
39948 @item SEEK_CUR
39949 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39950 bytes.
39951
39952 @item SEEK_END
39953 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39954 bytes.
39955 @end table
39956
39957 @item Return value:
39958 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39959 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39960 value of -1 is returned.
39961
39962 @item Errors:
39963
39964 @table @code
39965 @item EBADF
39966 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39967
39968 @item ESPIPE
39969 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39970
39971 @item EINVAL
39972 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39973
39974 @item EINTR
39975 The call was interrupted by the user.
39976 @end table
39977
39978 @end table
39979
39980 @node rename
39981 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39982 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39983
39984 @table @asis
39985 @item Synopsis:
39986 @smallexample
39987 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39988 @end smallexample
39989
39990 @item Request:
39991 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39992
39993 @item Return value:
39994 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39995
39996 @item Errors:
39997
39998 @table @code
39999 @item EISDIR
40000 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40001 directory.
40002
40003 @item EEXIST
40004 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40005
40006 @item EBUSY
40007 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40008 process.
40009
40010 @item EINVAL
40011 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40012 of itself.
40013
40014 @item ENOTDIR
40015 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40016 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40017 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40018
40019 @item EFAULT
40020 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40021
40022 @item EACCES
40023 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40024
40025 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40026
40027 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40028
40029 @item ENOENT
40030 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40031
40032 @item EROFS
40033 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40034
40035 @item ENOSPC
40036 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40037 directory entry.
40038
40039 @item EINTR
40040 The call was interrupted by the user.
40041 @end table
40042
40043 @end table
40044
40045 @node unlink
40046 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40047 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40048
40049 @table @asis
40050 @item Synopsis:
40051 @smallexample
40052 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40053 @end smallexample
40054
40055 @item Request:
40056 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40057
40058 @item Return value:
40059 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40060
40061 @item Errors:
40062
40063 @table @code
40064 @item EACCES
40065 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40066
40067 @item EPERM
40068 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40069
40070 @item EBUSY
40071 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40072 being used by another process.
40073
40074 @item EFAULT
40075 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40076
40077 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40078 @var{pathname} was too long.
40079
40080 @item ENOENT
40081 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40082
40083 @item ENOTDIR
40084 A component of the path is not a directory.
40085
40086 @item EROFS
40087 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40088
40089 @item EINTR
40090 The call was interrupted by the user.
40091 @end table
40092
40093 @end table
40094
40095 @node stat/fstat
40096 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40097 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40098 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40099
40100 @table @asis
40101 @item Synopsis:
40102 @smallexample
40103 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40104 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40105 @end smallexample
40106
40107 @item Request:
40108 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40109 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40110
40111 @item Return value:
40112 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40113
40114 @item Errors:
40115
40116 @table @code
40117 @item EBADF
40118 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40119
40120 @item ENOENT
40121 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40122 path is an empty string.
40123
40124 @item ENOTDIR
40125 A component of the path is not a directory.
40126
40127 @item EFAULT
40128 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40129
40130 @item EACCES
40131 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40132
40133 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40134 @var{pathname} was too long.
40135
40136 @item EINTR
40137 The call was interrupted by the user.
40138 @end table
40139
40140 @end table
40141
40142 @node gettimeofday
40143 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40144 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40145
40146 @table @asis
40147 @item Synopsis:
40148 @smallexample
40149 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40150 @end smallexample
40151
40152 @item Request:
40153 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40154
40155 @item Return value:
40156 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40157
40158 @item Errors:
40159
40160 @table @code
40161 @item EINVAL
40162 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40163
40164 @item EFAULT
40165 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40166 @end table
40167
40168 @end table
40169
40170 @node isatty
40171 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40172 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40173
40174 @table @asis
40175 @item Synopsis:
40176 @smallexample
40177 int isatty(int fd);
40178 @end smallexample
40179
40180 @item Request:
40181 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40182
40183 @item Return value:
40184 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40185
40186 @item Errors:
40187
40188 @table @code
40189 @item EINTR
40190 The call was interrupted by the user.
40191 @end table
40192
40193 @end table
40194
40195 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
40196 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40197 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40198 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40199 needed.
40200
40201
40202 @node system
40203 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
40204 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
40205
40206 @table @asis
40207 @item Synopsis:
40208 @smallexample
40209 int system(const char *command);
40210 @end smallexample
40211
40212 @item Request:
40213 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40214
40215 @item Return value:
40216 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40217 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40218 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40219 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40220 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40221 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40222 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40223
40224 @item Errors:
40225
40226 @table @code
40227 @item EINTR
40228 The call was interrupted by the user.
40229 @end table
40230
40231 @end table
40232
40233 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40234 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40235 the host is simplified before it's returned
40236 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40237 is discarded, and the return value consists
40238 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40239
40240 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40241 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40242 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40243
40244 @table @code
40245 @item set remote system-call-allowed
40246 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40247 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40248 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40249
40250 @item show remote system-call-allowed
40251 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40252 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40253 protocol.
40254 @end table
40255
40256 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40257 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40258 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40259
40260 @menu
40261 * Integral Datatypes::
40262 * Pointer Values::
40263 * Memory Transfer::
40264 * struct stat::
40265 * struct timeval::
40266 @end menu
40267
40268 @node Integral Datatypes
40269 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40270 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40271
40272 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40273 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40274 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40275
40276 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40277 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40278
40279 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40280
40281 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40282 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40283
40284 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40285
40286 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40287 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40288 byte order.
40289
40290 @node Pointer Values
40291 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40292 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40293
40294 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40295 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40296 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40297 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40298
40299 @smallexample
40300 @code{1aaf/12}
40301 @end smallexample
40302
40303 @noindent
40304 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40305 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40306 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40307 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40308
40309 @smallexample
40310 @code{123456/d}
40311 @end smallexample
40312
40313 @node Memory Transfer
40314 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40315 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40316
40317 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40318 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40319 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40320 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40321 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40322 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40323 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40324
40325
40326 @node struct stat
40327 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40328 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40329
40330 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40331 is defined as follows:
40332
40333 @smallexample
40334 struct stat @{
40335 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40336 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40337 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40338 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40339 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40340 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40341 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40342 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40343 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40344 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40345 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40346 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40347 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40348 @};
40349 @end smallexample
40350
40351 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40352 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40353 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40354
40355 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40356 range of values.
40357
40358 @table @code
40359
40360 @item st_dev
40361 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40362
40363 @item st_ino
40364 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40365
40366 @item st_mode
40367 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40368 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40369
40370 @item st_uid
40371 @itemx st_gid
40372 @itemx st_rdev
40373 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40374
40375 @item st_atime
40376 @itemx st_mtime
40377 @itemx st_ctime
40378 These values have a host and file system dependent
40379 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40380 support exact timing values.
40381 @end table
40382
40383 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40384 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40385 continuing.
40386
40387 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40388 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40389 get truncated on the target.
40390
40391 @node struct timeval
40392 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40393 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40394
40395 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40396 is defined as follows:
40397
40398 @smallexample
40399 struct timeval @{
40400 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40401 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40402 @};
40403 @end smallexample
40404
40405 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40406 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40407 structure is of size 8 bytes.
40408
40409 @node Constants
40410 @subsection Constants
40411 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40412
40413 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40414 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40415 values before and after the call as needed.
40416
40417 @menu
40418 * Open Flags::
40419 * mode_t Values::
40420 * Errno Values::
40421 * Lseek Flags::
40422 * Limits::
40423 @end menu
40424
40425 @node Open Flags
40426 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40427 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40428
40429 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40430
40431 @smallexample
40432 O_RDONLY 0x0
40433 O_WRONLY 0x1
40434 O_RDWR 0x2
40435 O_APPEND 0x8
40436 O_CREAT 0x200
40437 O_TRUNC 0x400
40438 O_EXCL 0x800
40439 @end smallexample
40440
40441 @node mode_t Values
40442 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40443 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40444
40445 All values are given in octal representation.
40446
40447 @smallexample
40448 S_IFREG 0100000
40449 S_IFDIR 040000
40450 S_IRUSR 0400
40451 S_IWUSR 0200
40452 S_IXUSR 0100
40453 S_IRGRP 040
40454 S_IWGRP 020
40455 S_IXGRP 010
40456 S_IROTH 04
40457 S_IWOTH 02
40458 S_IXOTH 01
40459 @end smallexample
40460
40461 @node Errno Values
40462 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40463 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40464
40465 All values are given in decimal representation.
40466
40467 @smallexample
40468 EPERM 1
40469 ENOENT 2
40470 EINTR 4
40471 EBADF 9
40472 EACCES 13
40473 EFAULT 14
40474 EBUSY 16
40475 EEXIST 17
40476 ENODEV 19
40477 ENOTDIR 20
40478 EISDIR 21
40479 EINVAL 22
40480 ENFILE 23
40481 EMFILE 24
40482 EFBIG 27
40483 ENOSPC 28
40484 ESPIPE 29
40485 EROFS 30
40486 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40487 EUNKNOWN 9999
40488 @end smallexample
40489
40490 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40491 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40492
40493 @node Lseek Flags
40494 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40495 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40496
40497 @smallexample
40498 SEEK_SET 0
40499 SEEK_CUR 1
40500 SEEK_END 2
40501 @end smallexample
40502
40503 @node Limits
40504 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40505 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40506
40507 All values are given in decimal representation.
40508
40509 @smallexample
40510 INT_MIN -2147483648
40511 INT_MAX 2147483647
40512 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40513 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40514 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40515 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40516 @end smallexample
40517
40518 @node File-I/O Examples
40519 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40520 @cindex file-i/o examples
40521
40522 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40523 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40524
40525 @smallexample
40526 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40527 @emph{request memory read from target}
40528 -> @code{m1234,6}
40529 <- XXXXXX
40530 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40531 -> @code{F6}
40532 @end smallexample
40533
40534 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40535 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40536
40537 @smallexample
40538 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40539 @emph{request memory write to target}
40540 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40541 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40542 -> @code{F6}
40543 @end smallexample
40544
40545 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40546 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40547
40548 @smallexample
40549 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40550 -> @code{F-1,9}
40551 @end smallexample
40552
40553 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40554 host is called:
40555
40556 @smallexample
40557 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40558 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40559 <- @code{T02}
40560 @end smallexample
40561
40562 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40563 host is called:
40564
40565 @smallexample
40566 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40567 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40568 <- @code{T02}
40569 @end smallexample
40570
40571 @node Library List Format
40572 @section Library List Format
40573 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40574
40575 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40576 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40577 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40578 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40579 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40580 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40581 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40582 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40583 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40584 are loaded.
40585
40586 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40587 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40588 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40589 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40590
40591 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40592 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40593 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40594 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40595 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40596 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40597
40598 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40599 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40600
40601 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40602 offset, looks like this:
40603
40604 @smallexample
40605 <library-list>
40606 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40607 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40608 </library>
40609 </library-list>
40610 @end smallexample
40611
40612 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40613 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40614
40615 @smallexample
40616 <library-list>
40617 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40618 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40619 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40620 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40621 </library>
40622 </library-list>
40623 @end smallexample
40624
40625 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40626
40627 @smallexample
40628 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40629 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40630 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40631 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40632 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40633 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40634 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40635 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40636 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40637 @end smallexample
40638
40639 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40640 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40641 section for each library.
40642
40643 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40644 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40645 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40646
40647 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40648 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40649 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40650 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40651
40652 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40653 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40654 target, the following parameters are reported:
40655
40656 @itemize @minus
40657 @item
40658 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40659 @code{struct link_map}.
40660 @item
40661 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40662 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40663 @item
40664 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40665 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40666 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40667 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40668 @item
40669 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40670 @end itemize
40671
40672 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40673 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40674 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40675
40676 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40677 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40678
40679 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40680 looks like this:
40681
40682 @smallexample
40683 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40684 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40685 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40686 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40687 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40688 </library-list-svr>
40689 @end smallexample
40690
40691 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40692
40693 @smallexample
40694 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40695 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40696 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40697 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40698 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40699 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40700 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40701 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40702 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40703 @end smallexample
40704
40705 @node Memory Map Format
40706 @section Memory Map Format
40707 @cindex memory map format
40708
40709 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40710 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40711 memory map.
40712
40713 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40714 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40715 lists memory regions.
40716
40717 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40718 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40719
40720 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40721
40722 @smallexample
40723 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40724 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40725 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40726 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40727 <memory-map>
40728 region...
40729 </memory-map>
40730 @end smallexample
40731
40732 Each region can be either:
40733
40734 @itemize
40735
40736 @item
40737 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40738 bytes from there:
40739
40740 @smallexample
40741 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40742 @end smallexample
40743
40744
40745 @item
40746 A region of read-only memory:
40747
40748 @smallexample
40749 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40750 @end smallexample
40751
40752
40753 @item
40754 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40755 bytes in length:
40756
40757 @smallexample
40758 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40759 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40760 </memory>
40761 @end smallexample
40762
40763 @end itemize
40764
40765 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40766 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40767 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40768
40769 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40770
40771 @smallexample
40772 <!-- ................................................... -->
40773 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40774 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40775 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40776 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40777 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40778 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40779 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40780 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40781 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40782 and its type, or device. -->
40783 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40784 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40785 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40786 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40787 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40788 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40789 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40790 @end smallexample
40791
40792 @node Thread List Format
40793 @section Thread List Format
40794 @cindex thread list format
40795
40796 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40797 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40798 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40799 the following structure:
40800
40801 @smallexample
40802 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40803 <threads>
40804 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40805 ... description ...
40806 </thread>
40807 </threads>
40808 @end smallexample
40809
40810 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40811 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40812 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40813 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40814 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40815 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40816 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
40817 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
40818
40819
40820 @node Traceframe Info Format
40821 @section Traceframe Info Format
40822 @cindex traceframe info format
40823
40824 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40825 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40826 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40827 collected in a traceframe.
40828
40829 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40830 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40831
40832 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40833 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40834
40835 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40836
40837 @smallexample
40838 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40839 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40840 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40841 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40842 <traceframe-info>
40843 block...
40844 </traceframe-info>
40845 @end smallexample
40846
40847 Each traceframe block can be either:
40848
40849 @itemize
40850
40851 @item
40852 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40853 @var{length} bytes from there:
40854
40855 @smallexample
40856 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40857 @end smallexample
40858
40859 @item
40860 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40861 collected:
40862
40863 @smallexample
40864 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40865 @end smallexample
40866
40867 @end itemize
40868
40869 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40870
40871 @smallexample
40872 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40873 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40874
40875 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40876 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40877 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40878 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40879 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40880 @end smallexample
40881
40882 @node Branch Trace Format
40883 @section Branch Trace Format
40884 @cindex branch trace format
40885
40886 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40887 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40888 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40889 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40890
40891 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40892 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40893
40894 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40895 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40896
40897 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40898
40899 @smallexample
40900 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40901 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40902 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40903 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40904 <btrace>
40905 block...
40906 </btrace>
40907 @end smallexample
40908
40909 @itemize
40910
40911 @item
40912 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40913 and ending at @var{end}:
40914
40915 @smallexample
40916 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40917 @end smallexample
40918
40919 @end itemize
40920
40921 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40922
40923 @smallexample
40924 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40925 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40926
40927 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40928 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40929 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40930
40931 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40932
40933 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40934
40935 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40936 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40937 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40938 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40939 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40940
40941 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40942 @end smallexample
40943
40944 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40945 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40946 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40947
40948 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40949 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40950 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40951
40952 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40953 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40954
40955 @table @code
40956 @item bts
40957 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40958 @table @code
40959 @item size
40960 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40961 @end table
40962 @item pt
40963 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40964 PT}) format.
40965 @table @code
40966 @item size
40967 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40968 @end table
40969 @end table
40970
40971 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40972 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40973
40974 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40975
40976 @smallexample
40977 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40978 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40979
40980 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40981 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40982
40983 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40984 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40985 @end smallexample
40986
40987 @include agentexpr.texi
40988
40989 @node Target Descriptions
40990 @appendix Target Descriptions
40991 @cindex target descriptions
40992
40993 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40994 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40995 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40996 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40997 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40998 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40999 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41000
41001 @itemize @bullet
41002 @item
41003 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41004 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41005 @item
41006 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41007 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41008 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41009 @item
41010 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41011 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41012 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41013 @end itemize
41014
41015 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41016 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41017 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41018 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41019 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41020
41021 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41022 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41023
41024 @menu
41025 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41026 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41027 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41028 descriptions.
41029 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
41030 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41031 @end menu
41032
41033 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41034 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41035
41036 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41037 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41038 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41039 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41040 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41041 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41042 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41043 Format}.
41044
41045 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41046 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41047 specify a file are:
41048
41049 @table @code
41050 @cindex set tdesc filename
41051 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41052 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41053
41054 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41055 @item unset tdesc filename
41056 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41057 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41058
41059 @cindex show tdesc filename
41060 @item show tdesc filename
41061 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41062 @end table
41063
41064
41065 @node Target Description Format
41066 @section Target Description Format
41067 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41068
41069 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41070 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41071 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41072 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41073 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41074 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41075 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41076
41077 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41078 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41079 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41080 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41081 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41082
41083 Here is a simple target description:
41084
41085 @smallexample
41086 <target version="1.0">
41087 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41088 </target>
41089 @end smallexample
41090
41091 @noindent
41092 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41093 the x86-64 architecture.
41094
41095 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41096 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41097 are explained further below.
41098
41099 @smallexample
41100 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41101 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41102 <target version="1.0">
41103 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41104 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41105 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41106 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41107 </target>
41108 @end smallexample
41109
41110 @noindent
41111 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41112 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41113 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41114 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41115 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41116 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41117 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41118 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41119 the version mismatch.
41120
41121 @subsection Inclusion
41122 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41123 @cindex XInclude
41124 @ifnotinfo
41125 @cindex <xi:include>
41126 @end ifnotinfo
41127
41128 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41129 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41130 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41131 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41132 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41133
41134 @smallexample
41135 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41136 @end smallexample
41137
41138 @noindent
41139 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41140 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41141 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41142 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41143 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41144 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41145 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41146 original description.
41147
41148 @subsection Architecture
41149 @cindex <architecture>
41150
41151 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41152
41153 @smallexample
41154 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41155 @end smallexample
41156
41157 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41158 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41159
41160 @subsection OS ABI
41161 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41162
41163 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41164 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41165
41166 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41167
41168 @smallexample
41169 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41170 @end smallexample
41171
41172 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41173 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41174
41175 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41176 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41177
41178 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41179 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41180
41181 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41182
41183 @smallexample
41184 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41185 @end smallexample
41186
41187 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41188 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41189
41190 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41191 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41192 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41193 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41194 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41195 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41196 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41197
41198 @smallexample
41199 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41200 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41201 @end smallexample
41202
41203 @subsection Features
41204 @cindex <feature>
41205
41206 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41207 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41208 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41209 has this form:
41210
41211 @smallexample
41212 <feature name="@var{name}">
41213 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41214 @var{reg}@dots{}
41215 </feature>
41216 @end smallexample
41217
41218 @noindent
41219 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41220 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41221 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41222 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41223
41224 @subsection Types
41225
41226 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41227 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41228 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41229 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41230 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41231 and enum types.
41232
41233 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41234 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41235 Types must be defined before they are used.
41236
41237 @cindex <vector>
41238 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41239 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41240 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41241 @var{count}:
41242
41243 @smallexample
41244 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41245 @end smallexample
41246
41247 @cindex <union>
41248 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41249 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41250 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41251 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41252
41253 @smallexample
41254 <union id="@var{id}">
41255 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41256 @dots{}
41257 </union>
41258 @end smallexample
41259
41260 @cindex <struct>
41261 @cindex <flags>
41262 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41263 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41264 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41265 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41266 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41267 specified.
41268
41269 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41270
41271 @smallexample
41272 <struct id="@var{id}">
41273 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41274 @dots{}
41275 </struct>
41276 @end smallexample
41277
41278 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41279 No implicit padding is added.
41280
41281 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41282
41283 @smallexample
41284 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41285 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41286 @dots{}
41287 </struct>
41288 @end smallexample
41289
41290 @smallexample
41291 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41292 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41293 @dots{}
41294 </flags>
41295 @end smallexample
41296
41297 The @var{name} value is required.
41298 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41299 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41300 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41301
41302 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41303 is optional.
41304 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41305 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41306
41307 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41308 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41309
41310 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41311
41312 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41313 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41314
41315 @itemize @bullet
41316 @item
41317 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41318 @item
41319 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41320 @end itemize
41321
41322 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41323 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41324
41325 @itemize @bullet
41326 @item
41327 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41328
41329 @smallexample
41330 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41331 $1 = 42
41332 @end smallexample
41333
41334 @end itemize
41335
41336 @subsection Registers
41337 @cindex <reg>
41338
41339 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41340
41341 @smallexample
41342 <reg name="@var{name}"
41343 bitsize="@var{size}"
41344 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41345 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41346 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41347 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41348 @end smallexample
41349
41350 @noindent
41351 The components are as follows:
41352
41353 @table @var
41354
41355 @item name
41356 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41357
41358 @item bitsize
41359 The register's size, in bits.
41360
41361 @item regnum
41362 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41363 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41364 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41365 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41366 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41367 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41368 in order of increasing register number.
41369
41370 @item save-restore
41371 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41372 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41373 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41374 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41375 ABI.
41376
41377 @item type
41378 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41379 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41380 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41381 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41382 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41383 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41384
41385 @item group
41386 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
41387 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
41388 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
41389 in @code{info registers}.
41390
41391 @end table
41392
41393 @node Predefined Target Types
41394 @section Predefined Target Types
41395 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41396
41397 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41398 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41399 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41400 types. The currently supported types are:
41401
41402 @table @code
41403
41404 @item bool
41405 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41406
41407 @item int8
41408 @itemx int16
41409 @itemx int32
41410 @itemx int64
41411 @itemx int128
41412 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41413
41414 @item uint8
41415 @itemx uint16
41416 @itemx uint32
41417 @itemx uint64
41418 @itemx uint128
41419 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41420
41421 @item code_ptr
41422 @itemx data_ptr
41423 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41424 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41425 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41426 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41427 may be marked as data pointers.
41428
41429 @item ieee_single
41430 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41431
41432 @item ieee_double
41433 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41434
41435 @item arm_fpa_ext
41436 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41437
41438 @item i387_ext
41439 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41440
41441 @item i386_eflags
41442 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41443
41444 @item i386_mxcsr
41445 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41446
41447 @end table
41448
41449 @node Enum Target Types
41450 @section Enum Target Types
41451 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41452
41453 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41454 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41455
41456 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41457
41458 @smallexample
41459 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41460 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41461 @dots{}
41462 </enum>
41463 @end smallexample
41464
41465 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41466
41467 @smallexample
41468 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41469 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41470 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41471 </enum>
41472 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41473 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41474 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41475 </flags>
41476 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41477 @end smallexample
41478
41479 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41480 would be printed as:
41481
41482 @smallexample
41483 (gdb) info register flags
41484 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41485 @end smallexample
41486
41487 @node Standard Target Features
41488 @section Standard Target Features
41489 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41490
41491 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41492 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41493 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41494 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41495 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41496 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41497 can recognize them.
41498
41499 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41500 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41501 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41502 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41503 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41504 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41505 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41506 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41507
41508 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41509 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41510 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41511
41512 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41513 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41514 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41515 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41516
41517 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41518 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41519 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41520
41521 @menu
41522 * AArch64 Features::
41523 * ARC Features::
41524 * ARM Features::
41525 * i386 Features::
41526 * MicroBlaze Features::
41527 * MIPS Features::
41528 * M68K Features::
41529 * NDS32 Features::
41530 * Nios II Features::
41531 * PowerPC Features::
41532 * S/390 and System z Features::
41533 * Sparc Features::
41534 * TIC6x Features::
41535 @end menu
41536
41537
41538 @node AArch64 Features
41539 @subsection AArch64 Features
41540 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41541
41542 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41543 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41544 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41545
41546 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41547 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41548 and @samp{fpcr}.
41549
41550 @node ARC Features
41551 @subsection ARC Features
41552 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41553
41554 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41555 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41556 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41557 that one of the core registers features is present.
41558 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41559
41560 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41561 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41562 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41563 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41564 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41565 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41566 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41567
41568 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41569 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41570 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41571 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41572 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41573 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41574
41575 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41576 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41577 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41578 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41579 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41580 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41581 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41582 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41583 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41584 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41585
41586 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41587 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41588
41589 @node ARM Features
41590 @subsection ARM Features
41591 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41592
41593 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41594 ARM targets.
41595 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41596 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41597
41598 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41599 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41600 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41601 and @samp{xpsr}.
41602
41603 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41604 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41605
41606 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41607 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41608 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41609 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41610
41611 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41612 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41613 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41614 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41615 halves of the double-precision registers.
41616
41617 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41618 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41619 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41620 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41621 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41622 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41623
41624 @node i386 Features
41625 @subsection i386 Features
41626 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41627
41628 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41629 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41630
41631 @itemize @minus
41632 @item
41633 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41634 @item
41635 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41636 @item
41637 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41638 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41639 @item
41640 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41641 @item
41642 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41643 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41644 @end itemize
41645
41646 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41647
41648 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41649 describe registers:
41650
41651 @itemize @minus
41652 @item
41653 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41654 @item
41655 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41656 @item
41657 @samp{mxcsr}
41658 @end itemize
41659
41660 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41661 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41662 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41663
41664 @itemize @minus
41665 @item
41666 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41667 @item
41668 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41669 @end itemize
41670
41671 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41672 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41673
41674 @itemize @minus
41675 @item
41676 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41677 @item
41678 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41679 @end itemize
41680
41681 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41682 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41683
41684 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41685 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41686
41687 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41688 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41689 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41690
41691 @itemize @minus
41692 @item
41693 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41694 @end itemize
41695
41696 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41697
41698 @itemize @minus
41699 @item
41700 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41701 @end itemize
41702
41703 It should
41704 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41705
41706 @itemize @minus
41707 @item
41708 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41709 @item
41710 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41711 @end itemize
41712
41713 It should
41714 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41715
41716 @itemize @minus
41717 @item
41718 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41719 @end itemize
41720
41721 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41722 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41723 valid for i386 and amd64.
41724
41725 @node MicroBlaze Features
41726 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41727 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41728
41729 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41730 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41731 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41732 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41733 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41734
41735 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41736 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41737
41738 @node MIPS Features
41739 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41740 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41741
41742 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41743 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41744 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41745 on the target.
41746
41747 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41748 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41749 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41750
41751 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41752 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41753 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41754 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41755
41756 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41757 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41758 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41759 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41760
41761 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41762 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41763 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41764
41765 @node M68K Features
41766 @subsection M68K Features
41767 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41768
41769 @table @code
41770 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41771 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41772 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41773 One of those features must be always present.
41774 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41775 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41776 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41777 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41778
41779 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41780 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41781 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41782 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41783 @end table
41784
41785 @node NDS32 Features
41786 @subsection NDS32 Features
41787 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41788
41789 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41790 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41791 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41792 and @samp{pc}.
41793
41794 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41795 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41796 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41797 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41798
41799 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41800 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41801 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41802 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41803 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41804 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41805 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41806
41807 @node Nios II Features
41808 @subsection Nios II Features
41809 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41810
41811 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41812 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41813 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41814 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41815 @samp{mpuacc}).
41816
41817 @node PowerPC Features
41818 @subsection PowerPC Features
41819 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41820
41821 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41822 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41823 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41824 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41825
41826 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41827 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41828
41829 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41830 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41831 and @samp{vrsave}.
41832
41833 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41834 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41835 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41836 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41837 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41838 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41839
41840 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41841 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41842 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41843 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41844 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41845 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41846 user.
41847
41848 @node S/390 and System z Features
41849 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41850 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41851 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41852
41853 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41854 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41855 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41856 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41857 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41858 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41859 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41860 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41861 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41862
41863 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41864 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41865 @samp{fpc}.
41866
41867 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41868 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41869
41870 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41871 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41872 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41873 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41874 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41875 32-bit wide.
41876
41877 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41878 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41879 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41880
41881 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41882 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41883 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41884 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41885 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41886 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41887 @samp{v31}.
41888
41889 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
41890 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
41891 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
41892
41893 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
41894 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
41895 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
41896
41897 @node Sparc Features
41898 @subsection Sparc Features
41899 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41900 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41901 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41902 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41903
41904 @itemize @minus
41905 @item
41906 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41907 @item
41908 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41909 @item
41910 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41911 @item
41912 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41913 @end itemize
41914
41915 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41916
41917 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41918 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41919
41920 @itemize @minus
41921 @item
41922 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41923 @item
41924 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41925 @end itemize
41926
41927 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41928 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41929
41930 @itemize @minus
41931 @item
41932 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41933 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41934 @item
41935 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
41936 for sparc64
41937 @end itemize
41938
41939 @node TIC6x Features
41940 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41941 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41942 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41943 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41944 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41945 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41946
41947 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41948 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41949 through @samp{B31}.
41950
41951 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41952 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41953
41954 @node Operating System Information
41955 @appendix Operating System Information
41956 @cindex operating system information
41957
41958 @menu
41959 * Process list::
41960 @end menu
41961
41962 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41963 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41964 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41965 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41966 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41967 on a different aspect of target.
41968
41969 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41970 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41971 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41972 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41973
41974 @node Process list
41975 @appendixsection Process list
41976 @cindex operating system information, process list
41977
41978 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41979 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41980 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41981 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41982
41983 An example document is:
41984
41985 @smallexample
41986 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41987 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41988 <osdata type="processes">
41989 <item>
41990 <column name="pid">1</column>
41991 <column name="user">root</column>
41992 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41993 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41994 </item>
41995 </osdata>
41996 @end smallexample
41997
41998 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41999 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42000 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42001 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42002 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42003 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42004 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42005
42006 @node Trace File Format
42007 @appendix Trace File Format
42008 @cindex trace file format
42009
42010 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42011 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42012
42013 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42014 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42015 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42016 in the future.
42017
42018 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42019 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42020 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42021 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42022 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42023 of this section.
42024
42025 @table @code
42026 @item R @var{size}
42027 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
42028 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
42029 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
42030 a single trace file.
42031
42032 @item status @var{status}
42033 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
42034 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
42035 file.
42036
42037 @item tp @var{payload}
42038 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42039 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42040 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42041 reply packets.
42042
42043 @item tsv @var{payload}
42044 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42045 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42046 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42047 reply packets.
42048
42049 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42050 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42051 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42052 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42053 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42054 file. Includes are not allowed.
42055
42056 @end table
42057
42058 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42059 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42060 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42061 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42062 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42063 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42064 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42065 endianness.
42066
42067 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42068
42069 @table @code
42070 @item R @var{bytes}
42071 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42072 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42073 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42074
42075 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42076 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42077 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42078 @var{length} bytes.
42079
42080 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42081 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42082 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42083
42084 @end table
42085
42086 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42087 of blocks.
42088
42089 @node Index Section Format
42090 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42091 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42092 @cindex index section format
42093
42094 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42095 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42096 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42097 description.
42098
42099 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42100 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42101 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42102 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42103 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42104 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42105
42106 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42107
42108 @enumerate
42109 @item
42110 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42111 unless otherwise noted:
42112
42113 @enumerate
42114 @item
42115 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42116 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42117 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42118 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42119 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42120 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42121 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42122
42123 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42124 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42125 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42126 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42127
42128 @item
42129 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42130
42131 @item
42132 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42133 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42134 to the next offset.
42135
42136 @item
42137 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42138
42139 @item
42140 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42141
42142 @item
42143 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42144 @end enumerate
42145
42146 @item
42147 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42148 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42149 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42150 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42151 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42152 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42153 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42154 CU indices.
42155
42156 @item
42157 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42158 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42159 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42160 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42161
42162 @item
42163 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42164 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42165
42166 @enumerate
42167 @item
42168 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42169
42170 @item
42171 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42172 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42173
42174 @item
42175 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42176 @end enumerate
42177
42178 @item
42179 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42180 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42181
42182 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42183 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42184 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42185 constant pool.
42186
42187 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42188 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42189 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42190
42191 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42192 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42193 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42194 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42195 index version:
42196
42197 @table @asis
42198 @item Version 4
42199 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42200
42201 @item Versions 5 to 7
42202 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42203 @end table
42204
42205 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42206
42207 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42208 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42209 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42210 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42211 collision.
42212
42213 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42214 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42215 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42216 the code.
42217
42218 @item
42219 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42220 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42221 strings.
42222
42223 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42224 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42225 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42226 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42227 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42228 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42229
42230 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42231 @end enumerate
42232
42233 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42234 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42235 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42236
42237 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42238 (bit 0 = LSB):
42239
42240 @table @asis
42241
42242 @item Bits 0-23
42243 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42244 @item Bits 24-27
42245 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42246 @item Bits 28-30
42247 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42248
42249 @table @asis
42250 @item 0
42251 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42252 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42253 with previous versions of the index.
42254 @item 1
42255 The symbol is a type.
42256 @item 2
42257 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42258 @item 3
42259 The symbol is a function.
42260 @item 4
42261 Any other kind of symbol.
42262 @item 5,6,7
42263 These values are reserved.
42264 @end table
42265
42266 @item Bit 31
42267 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42268
42269 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42270 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42271 @value{GDBN} sources.
42272
42273 @end table
42274
42275 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42276 global/static attributes in the index.
42277
42278 @smallexample
42279 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42280 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42281 switch (die->tag)
42282 @{
42283 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42284 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42285 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42286 kind = TYPE;
42287 is_static = 1;
42288 break;
42289 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42290 kind = VARIABLE;
42291 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42292 break;
42293 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42294 kind = FUNCTION;
42295 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42296 break;
42297 case DW_TAG_constant:
42298 kind = VARIABLE;
42299 is_static = ! is_external;
42300 break;
42301 case DW_TAG_variable:
42302 kind = VARIABLE;
42303 is_static = ! is_external;
42304 break;
42305 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42306 kind = TYPE;
42307 is_static = 0;
42308 break;
42309 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42310 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42311 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42312 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42313 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42314 kind = TYPE;
42315 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42316 break;
42317 default:
42318 assert (0);
42319 @}
42320 @end smallexample
42321
42322 @node Man Pages
42323 @appendix Manual pages
42324 @cindex Man pages
42325
42326 @menu
42327 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42328 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42329 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42330 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42331 @end menu
42332
42333 @node gdb man
42334 @heading gdb man
42335
42336 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42337
42338 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42339 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42340 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42341 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42342 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42343 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42344 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42345 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42346 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42347 @c man end
42348
42349 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42350 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42351 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42352 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42353
42354 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42355 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42356
42357 @itemize @bullet
42358 @item
42359 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42360
42361 @item
42362 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42363
42364 @item
42365 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42366
42367 @item
42368 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42369 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42370 @end itemize
42371
42372 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42373 Modula-2.
42374
42375 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42376 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42377 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42378 by using the command @code{help}.
42379
42380 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42381 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42382 executable program as the argument:
42383
42384 @smallexample
42385 gdb program
42386 @end smallexample
42387
42388 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42389
42390 @smallexample
42391 gdb program core
42392 @end smallexample
42393
42394 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42395 to debug a running process:
42396
42397 @smallexample
42398 gdb program 1234
42399 gdb -p 1234
42400 @end smallexample
42401
42402 @noindent
42403 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42404 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42405 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42406
42407 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42408
42409 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42410 @table @env
42411 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42412 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42413
42414 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42415 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42416
42417 @item bt
42418 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42419
42420 @item print @var{expr}
42421 Display the value of an expression.
42422
42423 @item c
42424 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42425
42426 @item next
42427 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42428 function calls in the line.
42429
42430 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42431 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42432
42433 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42434 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42435
42436 @item step
42437 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42438 function calls in the line.
42439
42440 @item help [@var{name}]
42441 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42442 about using @value{GDBN}.
42443
42444 @item quit
42445 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42446 @end table
42447
42448 @ifset man
42449 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42450 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42451 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42452 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42453 @end ifset
42454 @c man end
42455
42456 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42457 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42458 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42459 encountered with no
42460 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42461 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42462 Many options have
42463 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42464 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42465 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42466 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42467 more usual convention.)
42468
42469 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42470 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42471 option is used.
42472
42473 @table @env
42474 @item -help
42475 @itemx -h
42476 List all options, with brief explanations.
42477
42478 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42479 @itemx -s @var{file}
42480 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42481
42482 @item -write
42483 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42484
42485 @item -exec=@var{file}
42486 @itemx -e @var{file}
42487 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42488 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42489 dump.
42490
42491 @item -se=@var{file}
42492 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42493 file.
42494
42495 @item -core=@var{file}
42496 @itemx -c @var{file}
42497 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42498
42499 @item -command=@var{file}
42500 @itemx -x @var{file}
42501 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42502
42503 @item -ex @var{command}
42504 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42505
42506 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42507 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42508 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42509
42510 @item -nh
42511 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42512
42513 @item -nx
42514 @itemx -n
42515 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42516
42517 @item -quiet
42518 @itemx -q
42519 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42520 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42521
42522 @item -batch
42523 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42524 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42525 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42526 commands in the command files.
42527
42528 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42529 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42530 more useful, the message
42531
42532 @smallexample
42533 Program exited normally.
42534 @end smallexample
42535
42536 @noindent
42537 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42538 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42539
42540 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42541 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42542 instead of the current directory.
42543
42544 @item -fullname
42545 @itemx -f
42546 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42547 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42548 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42549 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42550 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42551 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42552 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42553 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42554
42555 @item -b @var{bps}
42556 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42557 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42558
42559 @item -tty=@var{device}
42560 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42561 @end table
42562 @c man end
42563
42564 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42565 @ifset man
42566 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42567 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42568 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42569
42570 @smallexample
42571 info gdb
42572 @end smallexample
42573
42574 @noindent
42575 should give you access to the complete manual.
42576
42577 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42578 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42579 @end ifset
42580 @c man end
42581
42582 @node gdbserver man
42583 @heading gdbserver man
42584
42585 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42586 @format
42587 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42588 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42589
42590 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42591
42592 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42593 @c man end
42594 @end format
42595
42596 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42597 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42598 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42599
42600 @ifclear man
42601 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42602 @end ifclear
42603 @ifset man
42604 Usage (server (target) side):
42605 @end ifset
42606
42607 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42608 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42609 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42610 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42611
42612 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42613 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42614 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42615
42616 @smallexample
42617 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42618 @end smallexample
42619
42620 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42621
42622 @smallexample
42623 @ifset man
42624 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42625 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42626 @end ifset
42627 @ifclear man
42628 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42629 @end ifclear
42630 @end smallexample
42631
42632 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42633 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42634 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42635
42636 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42637
42638 @smallexample
42639 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42640 @end smallexample
42641
42642 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42643 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42644 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42645 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42646 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42647 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42648 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42649 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42650 print an error message and exit.
42651
42652 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42653 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42654
42655 @smallexample
42656 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42657 @end smallexample
42658
42659 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42660 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42661
42662 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42663 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42664 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42665 the program you want to debug.
42666
42667 @smallexample
42668 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42669 @end smallexample
42670
42671 @ifclear man
42672 @subheading Usage (host side)
42673 @end ifclear
42674 @ifset man
42675 Usage (host side):
42676 @end ifset
42677
42678 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42679 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42680 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42681 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42682 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42683 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42684 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42685 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42686 descriptor. For example:
42687
42688 @smallexample
42689 @ifset man
42690 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42691 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42692 @end ifset
42693 @ifclear man
42694 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42695 @end ifclear
42696 @end smallexample
42697
42698 @noindent
42699 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42700
42701 @smallexample
42702 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42703 @end smallexample
42704
42705 @noindent
42706 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42707 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42708 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42709 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42710 `Connection refused'.
42711
42712 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42713 described in
42714 @ifset man
42715 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42716 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42717 @end ifset
42718 @ifclear man
42719 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42720 @end ifclear
42721 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42722
42723 @smallexample
42724 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42725 @end smallexample
42726
42727 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42728 case.
42729 @c man end
42730
42731 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42732 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42733
42734 @itemize @bullet
42735
42736 @item
42737 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42738
42739 @smallexample
42740 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42741 @end smallexample
42742
42743 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42744 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42745 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42746 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42747 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42748 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42749 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42750
42751 @item
42752 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42753 program:
42754
42755 @smallexample
42756 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42757 @end smallexample
42758
42759 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42760 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42761 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42762 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42763
42764 @item
42765 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42766
42767 @smallexample
42768 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42769 @end smallexample
42770
42771 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42772 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42773 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42774 debug several processes in the same session.
42775 @end itemize
42776
42777 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42778
42779 @table @env
42780
42781 @item --help
42782 List all options, with brief explanations.
42783
42784 @item --version
42785 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42786
42787 @item --attach
42788 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42789
42790 @smallexample
42791 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42792 @end smallexample
42793
42794 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42795 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42796
42797 @item --multi
42798 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42799 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42800 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42801 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42802
42803 @smallexample
42804 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42805 @end smallexample
42806
42807 @item --debug
42808 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42809 process.
42810 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42811 the developers.
42812
42813 @item --remote-debug
42814 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42815 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42816 the developers.
42817
42818 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42819 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42820 of debugging output.
42821 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42822
42823 @item --wrapper
42824 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42825 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42826 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42827 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42828
42829 @item --once
42830 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42831 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42832 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42833 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42834
42835 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42836
42837 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42838 @c QDisableRandomization.
42839
42840 @end table
42841 @c man end
42842
42843 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42844 @ifset man
42845 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42846 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42847 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42848
42849 @smallexample
42850 info gdb
42851 @end smallexample
42852
42853 should give you access to the complete manual.
42854
42855 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42856 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42857 @end ifset
42858 @c man end
42859
42860 @node gcore man
42861 @heading gcore
42862
42863 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42864
42865 @format
42866 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42867 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42868 @c man end
42869 @end format
42870
42871 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42872 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42873 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42874 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42875 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42876 running without any change.
42877 @c man end
42878
42879 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42880 @table @env
42881 @item -o @var{filename}
42882 The optional argument
42883 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42884 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42885 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42886 @end table
42887 @c man end
42888
42889 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42890 @ifset man
42891 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42892 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42893 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42894
42895 @smallexample
42896 info gdb
42897 @end smallexample
42898
42899 @noindent
42900 should give you access to the complete manual.
42901
42902 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42903 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42904 @end ifset
42905 @c man end
42906
42907 @node gdbinit man
42908 @heading gdbinit
42909
42910 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42911
42912 @format
42913 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42914 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42915 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42916 @end ifset
42917
42918 ~/.gdbinit
42919
42920 ./.gdbinit
42921 @c man end
42922 @end format
42923
42924 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42925 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42926 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42927 described in
42928 @ifset man
42929 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42930 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42931 @end ifset
42932 @ifclear man
42933 @ref{Sequences}.
42934 @end ifclear
42935
42936 Please read more in
42937 @ifset man
42938 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42939 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42940 @end ifset
42941 @ifclear man
42942 @ref{Startup}.
42943 @end ifclear
42944
42945 @table @env
42946 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42947 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42948 @end ifset
42949 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42950 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42951 @end ifclear
42952 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42953 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42954 See more in
42955 @ifset man
42956 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42957 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42958 @end ifset
42959 @ifclear man
42960 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42961 @end ifclear
42962
42963 @item ~/.gdbinit
42964 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42965 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42966
42967 @item ./.gdbinit
42968 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42969 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42970 See more in
42971 @ifset man
42972 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42973 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42974 @end ifset
42975 @ifclear man
42976 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42977 @end ifclear
42978 @end table
42979 @c man end
42980
42981 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42982 @ifset man
42983 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42984
42985 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42986 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42987 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42988
42989 @smallexample
42990 info gdb
42991 @end smallexample
42992
42993 should give you access to the complete manual.
42994
42995 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42996 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42997 @end ifset
42998 @c man end
42999
43000 @include gpl.texi
43001
43002 @node GNU Free Documentation License
43003 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43004 @include fdl.texi
43005
43006 @node Concept Index
43007 @unnumbered Concept Index
43008
43009 @printindex cp
43010
43011 @node Command and Variable Index
43012 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43013
43014 @printindex fn
43015
43016 @tex
43017 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43018 % meantime:
43019 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43020 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43021 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43022 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43023 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43024 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43025 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43026 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43027 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43028 \page\colophon
43029 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
43030 @end tex
43031
43032 @bye
This page took 1.507574 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.